summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/7334-h/7334-h.htm
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '7334-h/7334-h.htm')
-rw-r--r--7334-h/7334-h.htm12947
1 files changed, 12947 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/7334-h/7334-h.htm b/7334-h/7334-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a694233
--- /dev/null
+++ b/7334-h/7334-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,12947 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+
+<!DOCTYPE html
+ PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd" >
+
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+ <head>
+ <meta content="pg2html (binary v0.17)" name="linkgenerator" />
+ <title>
+ With Buller in Natal, by G. A. Henty
+ </title>
+ <style type="text/css" xml:space="preserve">
+ body { margin:5%; background:#faebd0; text-align:justify}
+ P { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: .75em; margin-bottom: .75em; }
+ H1,H2,H3,H4,H5,H6 { text-align: center; margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; }
+ hr { width: 50%; text-align: center;}
+ .foot { margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%; text-align: justify; font-size: 80%; font-style: italic;}
+ blockquote {font-size: 97%; font-style: italic; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
+ .mynote {background-color: #DDE; color: #000; padding: .5em; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-family: sans-serif; font-size: 95%;}
+ .toc { margin-left: 10%; margin-bottom: .75em;}
+ .toc2 { margin-left: 20%;}
+ .xx-small {font-size: 60%;}
+ .x-small {font-size: 75%;}
+ .small {font-size: 85%;}
+ .large {font-size: 115%;}
+ .x-large {font-size: 130%;}
+ .indent5 { margin-left: 5%;}
+ .indent10 { margin-left: 10%;}
+ .indent15 { margin-left: 15%;}
+ .indent20 { margin-left: 20%;}
+ .indent25 { margin-left: 25%;}
+ .indent30 { margin-left: 30%;}
+ .indent35 { margin-left: 35%;}
+ .indent40 { margin-left: 40%;}
+ div.fig { display:block; margin:0 auto; text-align:center; }
+ div.middle { margin-left: 20%; margin-right: 20%; text-align: justify; }
+ .figleft {float: left; margin-left: 0%; margin-right: 1%;}
+ .figright {float: right; margin-right: 0%; margin-left: 1%;}
+ .pagenum {position: absolute; right: 1%; font-size: 0.6em;
+ font-variant: normal; font-style: normal;
+ text-align: right; background-color: #FFFACD;
+ border: 1px solid; padding: 0.3em;text-indent: 0em;}
+ .side { float: left; font-size: 75%; width: 15%; padding-left: 0.8em;
+ border-left: dashed thin; text-align: left;
+ text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
+ font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
+ .head { float: left; font-size: 90%; width: 98%; padding-left: 0.8em;
+ border-left: dashed thin; text-align: center;
+ text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
+ font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
+ p.pfirst, p.noindent {text-indent: 0}
+ span.dropcap { float: left; margin: 0 0.1em 0 0; line-height: 0.8 }
+ pre { font-style: italic; font-size: 90%; margin-left: 10%;}
+</style>
+ </head>
+ <body>
+<pre xml:space="preserve">
+
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of With Buller in Natal, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: With Buller in Natal
+ A Born Leader
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: January, 2005 [EBook #7334]
+First Posted: April 15, 2003
+Last Updated: April 12, 2019
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK WITH BULLER IN NATAL ***
+
+
+
+
+Etext produced by Tony Hyland, Charles Franks and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team.
+
+HTML file produced by David Widger
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+ <div style="height: 8em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h1>
+ WITH BULLER IN NATAL
+ </h1>
+ <h2>
+ Or, A Born Leader
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ <br />
+ </p>
+ <h2>
+ BY G. A. HENTY
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ <br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <br />
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <b>CONTENTS</b>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2H_PREF"> PREFACE </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2H_4_0002"> <b>WITH BULLER IN NATAL</b> </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0001"> CHAPTER I &mdash; THE BURSTING OF THE STORM </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0002"> CHAPTER II &mdash; A TERRIBLE JOURNEY </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0003"> CHAPTER III &mdash; AT THE FRONT </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0004"> CHAPTER IV &mdash; DUNDEE </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0005"> CHAPTER V &mdash; THE FIRST BATTLE </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0006"> CHAPTER VI &mdash; ELANDSLAAGTE </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0007"> CHAPTER VII &mdash; LADYSMITH BESIEGED </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0008"> CHAPTER VIII &mdash; A DESPERATE PROJECT </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0009"> CHAPTER IX &mdash; KOMATI-POORT </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0010"> CHAPTER X &mdash; AN EXPLOSION </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0011"> CHAPTER XI &mdash; BACK WITH THE ARMY </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0012"> CHAPTER XII &mdash; THE BATTLE OF COLENSO </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0013"> CHAPTER XIII &mdash; PRISONERS </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0014"> CHAPTER XIV &mdash; SPION KOP </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0015"> CHAPTER XV &mdash; SPION KOP </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0016"> CHAPTER XVI &mdash; A COLONIST'S ADVENTURE </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0017"> CHAPTER XVII &mdash; A RESCUE. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0018"> CHAPTER XVIII &mdash; RAILWAY HILL </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0019"> CHAPTER XIX &mdash; MAJUBA DAY </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0020"> CHAPTER XX &mdash; LADYSMITH </a>
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2H_PREF" id="link2H_PREF"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ PREFACE
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ It will be a long time before the story of the late war can be written
+ fully and impartially. Even among the narratives of those who witnessed
+ the engagements there are many differences and discrepancies, as is
+ necessarily the case when the men who write are in different parts of the
+ field. Until, then, the very meagre military despatches are supplemented
+ by much fuller details, anything like an accurate history of the war would
+ be impossible. I have, however, endeavoured to reconcile the various
+ narratives of the fighting in Natal, and to make the account of the
+ military occurrences as clear as possible. Fortunately this is not a
+ history, but a story, to which the war forms the background, and, as is
+ necessary in such a case, it is the heroes of my tale, the little band of
+ lads from Johannesburg, rather than the leaders of the British troops, who
+ are the most conspicuous characters in the narrative. As these, although
+ possessed of many admirable qualities, had not the faculty of being at two
+ places at once, I was obliged to confine the action of the story to Natal.
+ With the doings of the main army I hope to deal next year.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ G. A. HENTY
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2H_4_0002" id="link2H_4_0002"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h1>
+ WITH BULLER IN NATAL
+ </h1>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0001" id="link2HCH0001"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER I &mdash; THE BURSTING OF THE STORM
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ A group of excited men were gathered in front of the Stock Exchange at
+ Johannesburg. It was evident that something altogether unusual had
+ happened. All wore anxious and angry expressions, but a few shook hands
+ with each other, as if the news that so much agitated them, although
+ painful, was yet welcome; and indeed this was so.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For months a war-cloud had hung over the town, but it had been thought
+ that it might pass over without bursting. None imagined that the blow
+ would come so suddenly, and when it fell it had all the force of a
+ complete surprise, although it had been so threatening for many weeks that
+ a considerable portion of the population had already fled. It was true
+ that great numbers of men, well armed, and with large numbers of cannon,
+ had been moving south, but negotiations were still going on and might
+ continue for some time yet; and now by the folly and arrogance of one man
+ the cloud had burst, and in thirty hours war would begin.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Similar though smaller groups were gathered here and there in the streets.
+ Parties of Boers from the country round rode up and down with an air of
+ insolent triumph, some of them shouting "We shall soon be rid of you; in
+ another month there will not be a rooinek left in South Africa."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Those addressed paid no heed to the words. They had heard the same thing
+ over and over again for the past two months. There was a tightening of the
+ lips and a closing of the fingers as if on a sword or rifle, but no one
+ replied to the insolent taunts. For years it had been the hope of the
+ Uitlanders that this would come, and that there would be an end to a
+ position that was well-nigh intolerable. Never before had a large body of
+ intelligent men been kept in a state of abject subjection by an inferior
+ race, a race almost without even the elements of civilization, ignorant
+ and brutal beyond any existing white community, and superior only in the
+ fact that they were organized and armed, whereas those they trampled upon
+ were deficient in both these respects. Having no votes, these were
+ powerless to better their condition by the means common to civilized
+ communities throughout the world. They were ground down by an enormous
+ taxation, towards which the Boers themselves contributed practically
+ nothing, and the revenue drawn from them was spent in the purchase of
+ munitions of war, artillery, and fortifications, so enormously beyond the
+ needs of the country, that it was no secret that they were intended not
+ only for the defence of the republic against invasion, but for a general
+ rising of the Boer population and the establishment of Dutch supremacy
+ throughout the whole of South Africa.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boer government was corrupt from the highest to the lowest. The
+ president and the members of his family piled up wealth to an enormous
+ amount, and nothing could be done without wholesale bribery. The price of
+ everything connected with the mining industry was doubled by the supply
+ being in the hands of monopolists, who shared their gains with high state
+ officials. Money was lavished like water on what was called secret
+ service, in subsidizing newspapers to influence public opinion throughout
+ Europe, and, as it was strongly suspected, in carrying on a propaganda
+ among the Dutch in Cape Colony, and in securing the return of members and
+ a ministry secretly pledged to further in every way the aims of the
+ Presidents of the Transvaal and the Orange Free State. The British and
+ other aliens were not only deprived of all rights of citizenship, but even
+ freedom of speech and the right of public meeting was denied them; they
+ were not allowed to carry arms except by a special license, their children
+ were taught in Dutch in the schools, they had no right of trial by jury;
+ judges who had the courage to refuse to carry out the illegal behests of
+ the president were deprived of their offices, and the few editors of
+ newspapers representing the Uitlanders&mdash;as all men not born in the
+ state were called-were imprisoned and their journals suppressed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Intolerable as was such a state of things to a civilized community, it
+ might have been borne with some patience had it not been that the
+ insolence of their masters was unbounded. Every Boer seemed to take a
+ pleasure in neglecting no opportunity of showing his contempt for the men
+ whose enterprise and labour had enormously enriched the country, and whose
+ superior intelligence he was too grossly ignorant to appreciate. A Boar
+ farmer would refuse a cup of water to a passing traveller, and would
+ enforce his refusal by producing his rifle immediately if the stranger
+ ventured to urge his request. Of late the insolence of the Boers had
+ greatly increased; the manner in which England had, instead of demanding
+ justice with the sternness and determination that the circumstances called
+ for, permitted her remonstrances to be simply ignored, was put down as a
+ consciousness of weakness. And having now collected arms sufficient not
+ only for themselves but for the whole Dutch population of South Africa,
+ the Boers were convinced that their hour of triumph had come, and that in
+ a very short time their flag would float over every public building
+ throughout the country and the Union Jack disappear for ever.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The long discussions that had been going on with regard to a five or seven
+ years' franchise were regarded with absolute indifference by the
+ Uitlanders&mdash;even the shorter time would have afforded them no
+ advantage whatever. The members from the mining districts would be in a
+ hopeless minority in the assembly; and indeed, very few of those entitled
+ to a vote would have cared to claim it, inasmuch as they would thereby
+ render themselves citizens of the republic, and be liable to be
+ commandeered and called upon to serve in arms, not only against the
+ natives, upon whom the Boers were always making aggressions, but against
+ England, when the war, which all foresaw could not long be delayed, broke
+ out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For months the negotiations went on between President Kruger and Mr.
+ Chamberlain, the British colonial minister, and the certainty that the
+ Boers were bent upon fighting became more and more evident. Vast
+ quantities of rifles, ammunition, and cannon poured into the Transvaal,
+ their passage being more than winked at by the Dutch ministry of Cape
+ Colony.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was that day known that President Kruger had thrown off the mask of a
+ pretended desire for peace, and that an ultimatum had been telegraphed to
+ England couched in terms of such studied insolence that it was certain war
+ must ensue. The greatest civilized power on earth would have shown less
+ arrogance towards the most feeble. Not only was England called upon to
+ send no more troops to South Africa, but to withdraw most of her forces
+ already in the country, and this by a state that owed its very existence
+ to her, and whose total population was not more than that of a small
+ English county.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The terms of that ultimatum had just become known in Johannesburg, and it
+ was not surprising that it had created an intense excitement. All had long
+ felt that war must come, and that at an early date, but the step that had
+ now been taken came as a surprise. From all appearances it had seemed that
+ the negotiations might be continued for months yet before the crisis
+ arrived, and that it should thus have been forced on by the wording of the
+ ultimatum showed that the Boers were satisfied that their preparations
+ were complete, and that they were in a position to overrun Natal and Cape
+ Colony before any British force capable of withstanding them could arrive.
+ England, indeed, had been placed in a most difficult position. The
+ ministry were not unaware of the enormous preparations that the Boers were
+ making, and had for some time past been quietly sending out a large number
+ of officers and a few non-commissioned officers and men to the Cape. But
+ so long as there was a hope that the Boers would finally grant some
+ redress to the Uitlanders, they could not despatch any considerable number
+ of troops, for had they done so they would have been accused not only on
+ the Continent, but by a section of Englishmen, of forcing on a war with a
+ weak state, whereas in point of fact the war was being forced on by a
+ country that most erroneously believed itself to be stronger than England.
+ The Boers of the Transvaal knew already that the Orange Free State would
+ join them at once, and believed firmly that every Dutchman in Natal and
+ Cape Colony would at the signal take up arms.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently a gentleman detached himself from the crowd in front of the
+ Exchange, and joined a lad of some sixteen years old who was standing on
+ the other side of the street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, father, is it all true what they say?" the latter asked&mdash;"that
+ Kruger has sent such an ultimatum to England that war is certain?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is quite true, Chris; war is absolutely certain. Kruger has given the
+ British Government only two days to reply to the most insolent demand ever
+ addressed to a great power, and worded in the most offensive manner. I
+ imagine that no reply will be given; and as the ultimatum was sent off
+ yesterday, we shall to-morrow morning be in a state of war."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, father, there is no doubt what the result will be."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No doubt whatever as to the final result, but I am afraid things will go
+ very badly for a time. I am glad, very glad, that Kruger should have sent
+ such an ultimatum. It cannot but be accepted as a defiance by all England;
+ and I should say that even the opposition, which has of late continually
+ attacked Mr. Chamberlain, will now be silenced, and that Government will
+ be supported by all parties."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After a quarter of an hour's walk they arrived at home. It was a handsome
+ house, for Mr. King was one of the leading men in Johannesburg. He had
+ come out with a wife and son ten years before, being sent by some London
+ capitalists to report to them fully upon the prospects of the gold-fields.
+ Under his advice they had purchased several properties, which had been
+ brought out as companies, and proved extremely valuable. He was himself a
+ large holder in each of these, and acted as manager and director of the
+ group. "What is the news, Robert?" his wife asked, as he and her son came
+ in. "I have had three or four visitors in here, and they all say that
+ there is quite an excitement in the town."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It has come at last," he said gravely; "war is inevitable, and will begin
+ in twenty-four hours. Kruger has sent one of the most extraordinary
+ demands ever drawn up. He calls upon England to cease sending out troops,
+ and to speedily recall most of those now in South Africa, and has given
+ two days for a reply, of which one has already expired. As it is
+ absolutely certain that England will not grant this modest request, we may
+ say that the war has begun. I wish now that I had sent you and Chris down
+ to Durban a fortnight ago, for there will be a fearful rush, and judging
+ by the attitude of the Boers, I fear they will make the journey a very
+ unpleasant one. As we have agreed, it is absolutely necessary that I
+ should remain here. There is no saying what steps the Boers will take with
+ reference to the mines; but it is certain that we must, if possible, keep
+ them going&mdash;not for the sake of the profit, which you may be sure
+ Kruger will not allow to go out of the country, but because if they were
+ to be stopped it would cost an immense deal of money to put them in
+ working condition again, especially if, as is likely enough, the Boers
+ damage the machinery. I shall do as little work as I can; and the Boers
+ will not, I fancy, interfere with us as long as they can benefit by the
+ working. For myself, I would risk any loss or damage rather than aid in
+ supplying them with gold, but for the sake of our shareholders in Europe I
+ must do my best to save the mines from destruction. Indeed, if I don't
+ work them, probably they will do so until the end is at hand, and will
+ then do as much damage as possible. You know we have agreed on this
+ point."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I suppose it is best, Robert; but it seems terrible leaving you
+ alone here, and I shall be in a perpetual state of anxiety about you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think there is any occasion for that; as long as I am working the
+ mines and they are taking the gold, which no doubt they will have to repay
+ when our army are masters here, they will not interfere with me. They
+ treat us badly enough, as we know; but they love the gold even more than
+ they hate us, so I have no fear whatever as to my personal safety. I am
+ afraid, dear, that for a time things will go very badly with us. Already
+ we know that commandos have gone forward in great strength to the
+ frontier, and I should not be surprised if the whole of South Africa
+ rises; at any rate, the Boers are confident that it will be so.
+ Gladstone's miserable surrender after our disasters at Laing's Nek and
+ Majuba have puffed them up with such an idea of their own fighting powers
+ and our weakness, that I believe they think they are going to have almost
+ a walk over. Still, though it was certain that we should have a hard time
+ whenever war came, we have been hoping for years that England would at
+ last interfere to obtain redress for us, and we must not grumble now that
+ what we have been so long expecting has at last come to pass. I believe
+ there will be some stern fighting. The Boers are no cowards; courage is,
+ indeed, as far as I know, the only virtue they possess. In the long run
+ they must certainly be beaten, but it will only be after very hard
+ fighting."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you think they will do, father?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I can't say what they will do, but I am sure that what they ought to do
+ is to merely hold the passes from Natal with enough men for the purpose,
+ and to march their whole force, broken up into half a dozen columns, into
+ Cape Colony. There is no force there that could resist them, they would be
+ undoubtedly joined by every Dutchman there, and I am convinced that the
+ Africander ministry would at once declare for them, in which case England
+ would have to undertake the tremendous work of conquering the whole of
+ South Africa afresh, for certainly she could not allow it to slip from her
+ hands, even if it should prove as stern a business as the conquering of
+ half India after the Sepoy Mutiny. Now to business. Fortunately we sent
+ down your clothes and everything we had of value to our friends the
+ Wilsons, at Durban, six weeks ago. What you have remaining you must leave
+ behind to take its chance. You will be able to take no luggage whatever
+ with you. We know how terribly the trains have been packed for the past
+ fortnight, and a week ago almost all the carriages were commandeered for
+ the use of the troops going south.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You must take with you a basket of provisions, sufficient, if necessary,
+ for two or three days for you both. There is no saying how long you may be
+ on your way to the frontier; once beyond that you will, of course, be able
+ to obtain anything you want. But you need expect no civility or courtesy
+ from the Boers, who, indeed, would feel a malicious pleasure in shunting
+ you off into a siding, and letting you wait there for any number of hours.
+ You must mind, Chris, above all things, to keep your temper, whatever may
+ happen. You know how our people have been insulted, and actually
+ maltreated in scores of cases, and in their present state of excitement
+ the Boers would be only too glad to find an excuse for acts of violence. I
+ was speaking to you about it three days ago, and I cannot impress it too
+ strongly upon you. I have already given you permission to join one or
+ other of the corps that are being raised in Natal, and if anything
+ unpleasant occurs on the road, you must bottle up your feelings and wait
+ till you get a rifle in your hand and stand on equal terms with them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I promise that, father. I think, after what we have had to put up with
+ here, during the past two or three months especially, I can bear anything
+ for these last few days."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, Chris; but it will be more trying now that you have your mother
+ under your charge. It is for her sake as well as your own that I impress
+ this so strongly upon you. Now, will you go down at once to the
+ railway-station and enquire about the trains? I shall go myself to the
+ manager and see whether I can get him to make any special arrangement in
+ your mother's favour, though I have no great hopes of that; for though I
+ know him well, he is, like all these Dutchmen in office, an uncivilized
+ brute puffed up with his own importance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris started at once, and returned an hour later with a very discouraging
+ report. The station was crowded with people. No regular trains were
+ running, but while he was there a large number of cattle-trucks had been
+ run up to the platform, and in these as many of the fugitives as could be
+ packed in were stowed away. As soon as this was done the train had
+ started, but not half the number collected on the platform had found room
+ in it. His father had left a few minutes after him, and presently
+ returned.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "From what I can hear," he said, "there is no chance whatever of your
+ being able to get any accommodation, but must take your chance with the
+ others. Viljoen told me that except the waggons there was not a carriage
+ of any sort or class left here, and that there was no saying at all when
+ any would return; but that even if they did, they would be taken for the
+ use of the troops going south. All he could say was that if, when I came
+ down to the station with you, he is there, he will see that you go by the
+ first waggons that leave."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is something at least," Mrs. King said quietly. "I certainly do not
+ wish to ask for any favour from these people, and do not want to be better
+ off than others. I have no doubt that it will be an unpleasant time, but
+ after all it will be nothing to what great numbers of people will have to
+ suffer during the war."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is so, Amy. And now I think that the sooner the start is made the
+ better. The rush to get away will increase every hour, and we shall have
+ the miners coming in in hundreds. Many of the mines will be shut down at
+ once, though some of them will, like ours, continue operations as long as
+ they are allowed to."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Make your basket, or bag, or whatever you take your provisions in, as
+ small as possible, mother. I saw lots of baggage left behind on the
+ platform. You see, there are no seats to stow things under. I should say
+ that a flat box which you can sit on would be the best thing. And you will
+ want your warmest cloak and a thick rug for night."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have a box that will do very well, Chris. Fortunately we have plenty of
+ cold meat and bread in the house. I shall not be more than half an hour,
+ Robert."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In less than that time the party were ready. Chris's preparations had been
+ of the simplest. He carried over his arm a long, thick greatcoat, in the
+ pocket of which he had thrust a fur cap and two woollen comforters. He had
+ also a light but warm rug, for he thought it probable that he might not be
+ able to be next to his mother. He had on his usual light tweed suit, but
+ had in addition put on a cardigan waistcoat, which he intended to take off
+ when once in the train. In his pockets he had a couple of packets of
+ tobacco, for although he seldom smoked, he thought that some of it might
+ be very acceptable to his fellow-passengers before the journey was over.
+ He wore a light gray, broad-brimmed wide-awake, with a white silk puggaree
+ twisted round it, for the heat of the sun in the middle of the day was
+ already very great, and would be greater still when they got down to
+ Natal. The box, which a Kaffir servant put on his shoulder, was about
+ eight inches deep and a foot wide, and eighteen inches long.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What have you in it, mother?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Two tin bottles of cold tea, each holding a gallon."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should hardly have thought that we wanted as much as that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; but there may be many women who have made no provision at all,
+ thinking that we shall at least be able to get water at any of the
+ stations we stop at. I have a small tin mug, and that joint of meat; the
+ rest of the box is filled up with bread-and-butter. I have cut it up and
+ spread it, so that it packs a good deal closer than it would do if we put
+ the loaves in whole."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. King had his wife's thick-wadded winter cloak and a rug over his arm,
+ and a small hand-bag with a few necessaries for the journey. Mrs. King was
+ in her usual attire, and carried only a white umbrella.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We look as if we were starting for a picnic rather than a journey that
+ will last three or four days," she said with an attempt at gaiety. "There
+ is one comfort, we shall have nothing to look after when we get to the
+ end."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris walked on ahead to let his father and mother talk together, for
+ although all arrangements had been discussed and settled during the past
+ two or three days, there was much they had to say to each other now that
+ the parting had come. The lad was a fine specimen of the young Uitlander.
+ A life passed largely in the open air, hard work and exercise, had
+ broadened his shoulders and made him look at least a year older than he
+ really was. He was a splendid rider and an excellent shot with his rifle,
+ for his father had obtained a permit from the authorities for him to carry
+ one, and he could bring down an antelope when running at full speed as
+ neatly as any of the young Boers. Four days a week he had spent in the
+ mines, for his father intended him to follow in his footsteps, and he had
+ worked by turns with the miners below and the engineers on the surface, so
+ that he might in the course of a few years be thoroughly acquainted with
+ all the details of his profession.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The last two days in each week he had to himself, and with three or four
+ lads of his own age went for long rides in search of sport. A couple of
+ hours every evening were spent in study under his father's direction. He
+ was quiet in manner, and talked but little. He deeply resented the
+ position in which the British population in the Transvaal were placed, the
+ insolence of the Boers towards them, and their brutal cruelty towards the
+ natives. The restraint which he so often found it necessary to exercise
+ had had no slight influence on his character, and had given a certain grim
+ expression to the naturally bright face. Many had been the discussions
+ between him and his friends as to the prospect of England's taking up
+ their cause. Their disappointment had been intense at the miserable
+ failure of the Jameson raid, which, however, they felt, and rightly, must
+ some day have a good result, inasmuch as it had brought out the wretched
+ position of the Uitlanders, who, though forming the majority of the
+ population, and the source of all the wealth of the country, and paying
+ all the taxes, were yet treated as an outcast race, and deprived of every
+ right possessed by people of all civilized nations.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had wondered and fretted at the apathy with which the enormous
+ warlike preparations of the Boers were regarded at home, and the fact that
+ they were permitted to become a formidable power, capable of offering a
+ desperate resistance even by the armies of England; whereas, before they
+ had been enriched by the industry and enterprise of the immigrants, they
+ had been in danger of being altogether wiped out by the Zulus and Swazis,
+ and had only been saved by the interference on their behalf of the British
+ power. Thus, then, while the war-cloud had been slowly but surely
+ gathering, the lads had watched the approaching crisis with delight,
+ unmingled with the anxiety and foreboding of the capitalists, who, without
+ doubting what the end must be, were sure that enormous losses and
+ sacrifices must result before their deliverance from Boer oppression could
+ be obtained.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The scene at the station was an extraordinary one. Men, women, and
+ children of all ranks were crowded on the platform; the greater
+ capitalists, the men whose fortunes could be counted by hundreds of
+ thousands, had for the most part left, but many who in England would be
+ considered as rich men had remained in the town till the last moment, to
+ make their final arrangements and wind up their affairs. With these were
+ well-to-do storekeepers, with their wives and families, together with
+ mining officials, miners, and mechanics of all kinds. Piles of baggage
+ rendered movement difficult, for many had supposed that the regular trains
+ were still running, and that they would be able to carry away with them
+ the greater portion of their belongings. The scenes at the departure of
+ the previous trains roughly awakened them to the fact that all this must
+ be abandoned, and women were crying and men cursing below their breath at
+ this last evidence of Boer indifference to the sufferings of those by
+ whose work they had so greatly benefited. Mr. King soon found that the
+ manager was still there, but on speaking to him he shrugged his shoulders,
+ and said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I do not see what I can do. Look at the crowd there. When the waggons
+ come up there will be a rush, and I have no men here to keep such a number
+ in order."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I see that, Mr. Viljoen, but if you would send a man with us to where the
+ waggons are standing in readiness to come up, my wife could take her place
+ then."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I will do that at once. You had better go with her outside the
+ station, and the porter shall take you on from there. If you were to get
+ off the platform here and walk up the lines, others would notice it, and
+ there would be an immediate rush."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He called to one of the porters on the platform, and gave him
+ instructions, and in a few minutes Mrs. King was seated on her box in the
+ corner of a truck, which, with a few others, had a covered roof, although
+ it was entirely open at the sides. In the next half-hour eight or ten
+ others, who had been similarly favoured by the manager, joined them. All
+ these were known to the Kings, and it was a great relief to them to find
+ that they would travel together, instead of being mixed up with the
+ general crowd. They had packed themselves together as closely as possible,
+ so that when the train became crowded there should be no room for anyone
+ to push in among them. Among the party was John Cairns, a great chum of
+ Chris's. He and his father and mother had been waiting for two hours at
+ the station, and he told him that there were seven or eight of their
+ companions there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We will take our seats on that side," Chris said, "and as we move in
+ shout to them to join us. It will be a great thing to get as many people
+ we know in here as possible."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently the train began to move. Fortunately, at the spot where it drew
+ up, a group of their acquaintances were clustered together, and these all
+ managed to get into the truck, which was speedily filled up until there
+ was scarce standing-room. Three minutes later the train moved on. A great
+ number were left behind, although everyone made as much room as possible,
+ women especially being helped in after the trucks seemed absolutely
+ choke-full. As soon as the train was fairly in motion many of the men
+ climbed up on to the roofs of the covered waggons, thereby relieving the
+ pressure below, and enabling all the women to sit down. Others ranged
+ themselves along the sides, sitting on the rail, and so minimizing the
+ space they occupied. But even with all this, the women were packed
+ inconveniently together. All, however, were so much pleased at their good
+ fortune in having got away that there was no complaining or grumbling.
+ That the journey would be a long one, all knew; but at least they had
+ started, and would soon be a free people in a free country. Chris and his
+ friends had been among the first to climb up on to the roof, and they sat
+ down in a group at one end of it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is going to be pretty cold here to-night, and desperately hot
+ to-morrow," Chris said; "but we can put up with that. I would stand it for
+ a month rather than stop any longer among these brutes." There was a
+ general murmur of agreement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank heavens," one of them said, "the next time we meet them will be
+ with arms in our hands. We have a long score to pay off, and we shall, I
+ expect, have plenty of chances. The Boers are boasting that they will soon
+ drive the last Englishman out of South Africa, and seem to regard it as a
+ sort of general picnic. They will find out their mistake before they have
+ done."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Still, we must not think that it is going to be a picnic our way," Chris
+ said. "They have quite made up their minds that every Boer in Cape Colony
+ and Natal will join them at once. If they do, it will be a very long
+ business to put them down, though I have no doubt it will all come right
+ in the end. Do you know anything about the others?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I know that Peters and Carmichael and Brown went off with their people
+ last night, but I don't know about the others."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Capper and Willesden and Horrocks went yesterday," another lad said.
+ "Sankey and Holdsworth were on the platform, and no doubt got into another
+ truck.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are seven of us here," Chris said, "and as six have gone on, that
+ makes thirteen certain, and there are eight more to come. Most of us will
+ stop at Pietermaritzburg, but I suppose some, whose friends are going
+ straight home, will go down with them to Durban."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There will not be many who have to do so," another said. "Sankey's people
+ and Carmichael's are going to Cape Town, but, so far as I know, all the
+ others will stay and see it out either at Maritzburg or Durban. Do you
+ think that we should take any others with us, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think so. You see we all know each other, and it would be a
+ nuisance having fellows with us of whom we know nothing. They might not
+ pull with us, while we have been so much together that there is no fear of
+ our having any disagreement. I think we have all pretty well settled that
+ it will be much better to act by ourselves, instead of joining any of the
+ corps that are sure to be formed down there. Still, if we knew one of the
+ men getting up a corps&mdash;and some of our people are pretty sure to do
+ so&mdash;I do think it would be a good plan to join, if they would accept
+ us as a sort of independent troop, ready to act with them when there is
+ any big fighting, and to go about on our own account at other times. You
+ see, none of us will want any pay. We shall all furnish our own horses and
+ arms, and shall therefore be on a different footing from men who have to
+ draw pay and be equipped at the public expense; and I don't see why any
+ officer commanding a troop in one of these corps should object to our
+ joining him on those terms. But anyhow, I feel sure that we should be able
+ to do a great deal more good by being free to move where we liked, and to
+ undertake expeditions on our own account, than if we were to act in a more
+ regular manner."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general chorus of agreement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, how long do you think it will be before we cross Laing's Nek? Of
+ course we ought to be there by to-morrow morning. It is only a hundred and
+ fifty miles, and at fifteen miles an hour, which is about their usual rate
+ of travelling, we should cross the frontier at two o'clock, for it was
+ about four when we started. But there is no saying. My father thought we
+ ought to take four days' provisions with us; I think we could hold out for
+ that time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You don't mean to say, Chris, he thought it possible we might be as long
+ as that?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "He did think so, Peters. He considered that we might be shunted off very
+ often to let trains with men and stores for the troops go on ahead of us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well," the other replied, "I don't care so much for myself, though I
+ don't say that it would be lively to be stuck up here for four days and
+ nights, but it would be awful for the women; and I should say that very
+ few of them have got more than enough provisions for a day. Still, of
+ course, if we are shunted at a station we shall be able to buy things."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am not so sure of that," Chris said. "You know what the Boers are at
+ their best; and now that they believe the time has arrived when they are
+ going to be the absolute lords of all South Africa, they are so puffed up
+ that there is no saying what they may do to show their hatred and contempt
+ for us. And whatever happens, you fellows, you must keep your temper. My
+ father spoke to me very strongly about it. You must remember that they
+ will not mind what they do, and would shoot any of us down on the smallest
+ excuse, knowing well enough that we are helpless, and that it is unlikely
+ any enquiry would ever be made, or anyone punished even if they shot a
+ dozen of us. We must remember that we intend to pay off old scores later
+ on, and that we mean to do it with interest."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0002" id="link2HCH0002"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER II &mdash; A TERRIBLE JOURNEY
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Twenty-four hours had gone, and not half the distance had yet been
+ covered. The night had passed painfully to all those in the waggons, for
+ though most of the women had provided themselves with wraps of one sort or
+ another, the cold was severe. This, however, was less felt than the
+ cramped position in which all had to sit on the floor, unable to move or
+ to stretch their legs, the only change obtainable being by standing up.
+ The pressure was most felt in the open waggons, where the men as well as
+ the women were packed together so closely that even sitting down was
+ impossible. Some slight relief had been afforded by the men on the covered
+ waggons taking as many from the uncovered trucks as could lie down there
+ with them; but as the latter were by far the more numerous, a
+ comparatively small number of men could be so entertained.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For a time the rising of the sun afforded some relief, but as it gained in
+ power the position of the fugitives became almost unbearable. The
+ stoppages were frequent, and at all the stations the Boers from the
+ neighbourhood had assembled, some from curiosity, but the majority to wait
+ for the trains that were to take them to the front. Although sometimes
+ detained for three or four hours, the passengers were not allowed to
+ alight. The men, indeed, at times, by common impulse, sprang out, but were
+ soon forced to take their places again, some of the Boers using their
+ heavy whips over their heads and shoulders, while others with pointed guns
+ prevented any attempt at retaliation. Men, and even women, crowded the
+ platform, jeering and cursing those in the waggons, menacing them with
+ their whips and snatching at such trinkets, and even cloaks as took their
+ fancy. The men were all several times searched for weapons, and made to
+ turn their pockets inside out, the contents being unceremoniously
+ transferred to those of the Boers. Chris and his companions would have
+ taken their places below with their friends, but these implored them not
+ to do so, being afraid that they would be enraged beyond endurance, and
+ might in their anger say or do something that would give an excuse to the
+ Boers to use their rifles, which they so often pointed threateningly at
+ women as well as men. It was only when the train was in motion that food
+ and drink were passed up from below, as these too would assuredly, had
+ they been seen, have been confiscated by the brutal tormentors.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When they steamed into Standerton in the afternoon, the distress of the
+ women and children for water was so great that men determined at all costs
+ to endeavour to get some for them. As if by one impulse, when the train
+ came to a standstill outside the station, they jumped out and made for the
+ little village. But here all refused to give or sell them water or food,
+ and in a few minutes a large party of Boers rode in, and falling upon them
+ with their whips, drove them back to the train. Had they been armed the
+ men would assuredly have resisted till the last, although certain to be
+ killed, so mad were they with passion. As it was, it would have been
+ throwing away their lives, without a chance of even avenging themselves on
+ their assailants. As they reached the waggons and climbed into their
+ places again, several had broad blue weals across their faces, while many
+ more were smarting from the cuts they had received on the body. Chris and
+ his companions had got out when the others did so, but had not followed
+ them. Their supply of water and cold tea was not yet exhausted, as most of
+ the ladies had made preparations for a journey of two or three days, and
+ Mrs. King and the mothers of the other lads begged them not to go.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The Boers are only waiting for an excuse to use their firearms," Mrs.
+ King said, "and whatever happens you had better stay here. You can do no
+ good by going." So, reluctantly, they had again taken their places on the
+ roofs of the carriages, and sat there with their pulses beating and their
+ fists clenched as they heard the shouts and the cracking of the heavy
+ whips in the village, and presently saw the men running back, pursued by
+ their cowardly assailants. Two or three of the lads were so enraged at the
+ sight that they would have jumped down had not Chris laid a restraining
+ hand on them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Wait your time," he said in a hard voice. "We can't repay them now, but
+ we will remember this when our turn comes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers, as they rode up, leapt from their horses, and with shouts of
+ exultation walked along the waggons, striking at the men, hurling every
+ epithet of contempt and hatred at them, and even spitting at them. Many of
+ the women were also struck as well as being grossly insulted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And these scoundrels call themselves Christian men, and their friends
+ speak of them as simple pious farmers! I call them, both from their
+ appearance and their actions, as unmitigated a set of ruffians as are to
+ be found on the face of the globe," Cairns exclaimed passionately.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They were indeed as unsavoury in appearance as they were brutal in manner.
+ Water is scarce in the Transvaal, and is used most sparingly for all
+ purposes of cleanliness. The Boer sleeps in his clothes, gives himself a
+ shake when he gets up, and his toilet is completed, unless on very
+ exceptional occasions when he goes outside the door to the water-cask,
+ fills his hands with water, and rubs them over his face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Four times in the year, however, the Boers indulge in a general wash
+ before starting with their wives and families for four or five days' stay
+ at the nearest town to attend the services of the church and to do their
+ quarter's marketing. In dress the Boer is almost universally slovenly, his
+ clothes hang about him stained and discoloured by long usage. In the
+ majority of cases he is altogether without education, and very many Boers
+ are scarcely able to sign their names. Most of them wear beards and long
+ unkempt hair. But in point of physique they are fine men, tall and
+ powerfully, though loosely, built, but capable of standing great fatigue
+ if necessary, although averse to all exercise save on horseback. All are
+ taught to shoot from boyhood, and even the women in the country districts
+ are trained in the use of firearms, for it is not so long since they lived
+ in dread of incursions by the Zulus and Swazis.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was no attempt whatever at uniformity of dress. Most of the men wore
+ high riding boots. Some of the young men from the towns were in tweed
+ suits, the vast majority wore either shooting jackets or long loose coats;
+ some were in straw hats, but the elder men all wore large felt hats with
+ wide brims. They were all, however, similarly armed with rifles of the
+ best and most modern construction. Their general appearance was that of a
+ large band of farmers of the roughest type and wholly without regard for
+ their personal appearance.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was fully an hour before the train moved again. Then it was shunted on
+ to a siding while the Boers entrained with their horses on a long line of
+ waggons which had just come up, and which started on its way south as soon
+ as they were on board. Then the emigrant tram crawled on again. There was
+ another night of wretchedness, and in the morning they arrived at
+ Volksrust, the frontier town. Here they were again closely searched for
+ arms, and what provisions remained among them were commandeered, or as the
+ emigrants called it, stolen. However, they knew that their troubles were
+ now nearly over, and did not grumble when they were informed that the
+ train would go no farther, and that they must make their way on foot to
+ Newcastle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They were told tauntingly that they might find some of their friends there
+ if they had not already run away, and that if they stopped at
+ Pietermaritzburg for a week they would have another journey down to Durban
+ as prisoners. All were too glad to get out of the clutches of the Boers to
+ utter complaints which they knew would be useless, and they went off at
+ once. The prospect was not, however, a pleasant one. Newcastle was nearly
+ thirty miles away, but they hoped that at least they might obtain shelter
+ and rest and food for the women at some of the scattered farms. At first
+ their progress was slow, for after being for more than two days and a half
+ packed up like cattle, they had almost lost the use of their limbs; but
+ gradually the pace was accelerated. Men took the little children on their
+ shoulders, others helped the women along. Charlestown, on the British side
+ of the frontier, was already occupied by the Boers, who hooted and abused
+ them as they passed through. At Laing's Nek there was a Dutch commando
+ with some guns.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two miles on the women could go no further, and they halted at a large
+ farmhouse which had been deserted by its owners. All the men, however, who
+ were alone, determined to push on at once to Newcastle, and promised they
+ would send vehicles of some sort to take them on if they could possibly be
+ obtained. Mrs. King and the other ladies authorized them to pay any sums
+ demanded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Thankful indeed were the tired women when they reached the farmhouse. They
+ found the doors unfastened, as the farmer knew that were he to lock them
+ the Boers would certainly batter them in when they arrived, and would
+ probably do greater damage to the furniture left behind than if they had
+ obtained an entry without trouble. The men soon found the wood-shed, and
+ in a short time great fires blazed in every room. The bedding had been
+ carried away, but utterly worn out as they were, the women were only too
+ glad to lie down on rugs and cover themselves with their cloaks. The men
+ gathered in the lower room and talked for some time before thinking of
+ going to sleep. There was scarce one who was not determined to join one of
+ the volunteer corps being raised at Durban and Maritzburg, and to avenge
+ the insults and ill-treatment to which they had been subjected. The
+ long-smouldering animosity towards the Boers had been fanned during the
+ past three days into a fierce fire, and even those who had not before
+ thought of taking part in the struggle were now as eager as the others to
+ do so.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the morning all were astir early. Had they been supplied with food they
+ would have waited until waggons came out from Newcastle, but these could
+ hardly arrive until evening, and at any moment the Boer advance might
+ commence. They therefore determined to move on early, for if they met the
+ waggons half-way these could return with them at once to the town. It was
+ desirable to start as soon as possible so as to get well on the way before
+ the heat of the day was at its fullest. Accordingly by six all were in
+ movement. The long night's rest had done them good, still more so the
+ thought that by the end of the day they would be among friends, and they
+ were disposed to laugh and joke over their present situation. All the men
+ had cut themselves heavy cudgels from the stock of firewood, and the fact
+ that they were not as before wholly defenceless was no slight
+ gratification to them. Even the ladies spoke confidently of being able to
+ walk the twenty miles to Newcastle should they not meet vehicles coming to
+ fetch them. They could go ten miles now and then halt till the sun was
+ setting, and after such a long rest could certainly go on to Newcastle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am afraid, mother," Chris said as they started, "that what seems so
+ easy now will be too much for many of the women. We started without
+ breakfast, and unless we can get something by the way I doubt if many will
+ reach the town to-night. Of course for the men it is nothing. Very often
+ when I have been out on the veldt and have started early, I have had
+ nothing till I got back late in the evening. What are you wearing that
+ veil for, mother? I saw that you pulled it down over your face yesterday
+ afternoon. I suppose you did it to keep the dust out of your eyes, but
+ there is none now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I had a reason for doing it, but I can put it up now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ She lifted the white veil to its usual place round her hat; as she did so,
+ Chris uttered a sharp exclamation as his eye fell on a bluish-red mark
+ across her face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You don't mean to say, mother," he said in a tone of horror, "that one of
+ those scoundrels struck you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They struck a good many of us, Chris, and there was no reason why I
+ should escape more than another."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lad's face grew white.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Why did you not call out? I would have&mdash;"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I know you would," she interrupted gently, "and so of course I did not
+ cry out. You had all had enough to try you to the utmost, and I was not
+ going to risk your life by letting you know what had happened. It flashed
+ across me at once that if you had seen it happen you would have been down
+ from the roof in an instant and struck the man. Had you done so, your fate
+ would have been sealed, you would have had half a dozen bullets in your
+ body; therefore, I simply dropped my veil, and I can assure you that the
+ smart of the Boer's sjambok gave me less pain when I felt that you knew
+ nothing of it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris walked along silently for a minute or two; then he said quietly:
+ "Thank you, mother. I am sure it would have been as you said. I could not
+ have helped it. No one could see his mother struck without interfering."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I can understand that, dear; but it would have been a poor consolation
+ for me had you been killed in endeavouring to right a wrong that I could
+ very well put up with, and shall forget in a week."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose so, mother. I should not so much mind if I only knew the
+ fellow's name, or even knew him by sight, so that I might possibly have
+ the chance some day of settling accounts with him."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They walked on until eight o'clock, and then rested under the shade of
+ some rocks. Fortunately there had been some rain two days before, and they
+ had been able to quench their thirst at a little stream that came down
+ from the hills. There were in all some thirty women and eighteen men.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Look here, Harris," Chris said, "there is a farmhouse over there, and as
+ I see cattle and horses, it evidently is not deserted. Let us go and see
+ if we can get some bread and some milk for the women."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "All right!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The other lads were quite ready to go also, and they walked across to the
+ house, which stood some half a mile away. As they approached it a Boer
+ came out. On seeing them he re-entered it, and appeared again with a
+ rifle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am afraid we shall get nothing here," Harris said. "The Dutchmen in
+ Natal are only waiting for the Boers to advance to join them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we will try anyhow," Chris said doggedly. "I dare say that you are
+ right; but Boer or no Boer, if there is any food in that house I mean to
+ get it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They went quietly on. When they were within fifty yards the Boer shouted
+ to them to go back.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have some women and children with us," Chris replied, continuing to
+ advance. "They are exhausted from want of food and fatigue, and we have
+ come to ask for some bread, and if you have it in the house, some milk."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If the house was full of both you should not have a crumb of bread or a
+ drop of milk. Halt! I say, or I will put a bullet into you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris did not heed the command.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have plenty of money to pay you, and are willing to give ten times its
+ fair price."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He was now within ten yards of the farmer. The latter burst into a torrent
+ of abuse, and was in the act of raising his rifle when Chris sprang at
+ him. The Boer, who had no idea that this lad would venture to attack him,
+ discharged his rifle almost at random, and the ball passed through the
+ brim of Chris's hat. An instant later his heavy stick fell on the Boer's
+ head, and levelled him to the ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, Harris," he shouted, "do you and the others go into the house, and
+ first of all bring me out one of these fellows' whips. Cairns, pick up his
+ rifle, and reload it. Sankey, do you and the others keep guard at the
+ door, and don't let those viragoes out"&mdash;for three women had just
+ appeared, and were cursing with a fluency that Billingsgate would have
+ envied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Harris had already come out with a heavy whip by the time Cairns had
+ reloaded. Chris took it and said to the Boer, who, in view of the
+ formidable sticks the lads carried, had thought it best to lie quiet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now you can get up, you hulking ruffian. I am going to give you a lesson
+ in civility. Oh, you won't get up? Well, it will make no difference to
+ me," and he proceeded to give the howling Boer a tremendous thrashing.
+ "There," he said, when his arm was tired, "you may get up and go, and I
+ hope that the lesson will do you good. Now, Cairns, we will search the
+ house. It is likely enough he has a lot of rifles hidden somewhere, and
+ perhaps when we have gone he may go and fetch some more of his class. We
+ may as well possess ourselves of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The seven lads went into the house, paying no further attention to the
+ Boer. In spite of the fury of the women, they searched the house
+ thoroughly, and in a large case in a disused room they found twelve Mauser
+ rifles, with a thousand cartridges. They then took a basket and filled it
+ with bread, and emptied the milk from two large pans into a pail.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are not thieves and robbers, like your people," Chris said to the
+ women, as he threw five shillings on the table. "Your man has been good
+ enough to tell us that he will be in Maritzburg with the Boers in a week's
+ time. Therefore, as war has been declared, the muskets are lawful spoil
+ taken from a rebel. Now, boys, let's be off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The cartridges were divided among them; then, with the thirteen guns, the
+ basket, and pail, they started to rejoin their friends. "Well, that is a
+ fair capture to begin with," Chris said. "As far as we are concerned, the
+ war has begun. The Boer has made off, I see. I should not be surprised if
+ we hear of him and some of his friends again. However, now we are well
+ armed they can come as soon as they like."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Great was the joy among the women and children when they returned with the
+ much-needed refreshment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I was getting very anxious about you, Chris," his mother said. "We heard
+ the man fire. But where have you got all these rifles from?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The owner of the farm is a Boer, mother, and as he told us, a rebel. As
+ he began the affair by putting a bullet through my hat, and abusing us and
+ our nation heartily, we took the liberty of searching his house, with good
+ success. I need not say that he did not give us this bread and the pail of
+ milk of his own free-will, but I left the money for them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ His mother had turned pale when he said that a bullet had gone through his
+ hat, but she said nothing.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What became of the man?" she asked. "You did not kill him, I hope?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, mother; I contented myself with thrashing him with one of his own
+ whips until my arm ached."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was enough bread for all to have a slice. The women and children had
+ as much milk as they could drink, the rest was divided among the men. The
+ extra rifles were given to those who could best use them. In half an hour
+ the women said that they were ready to go on again, and that they would
+ rather do that than wait, for they greatly feared that the Boer might
+ gather some of his friends and attack them. Feeling greatly strengthened
+ and refreshed, they started at a good pace. They had gone about a mile
+ when Sankey said to Chris:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Look, there is a party of mounted men across the valley."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then we had better plant ourselves among the rocks, and let the unarmed
+ men go on with the women and children, and take shelter a bit farther on.
+ I don't suppose they will venture to attack us when they find, to their
+ disgust, that we are armed with as good rifles as their own. They have a
+ great respect for their lives."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Accordingly the seven lads and the six men with rifles at once took up a
+ position among the rocks. The rest of the party went forward two hundred
+ yards and then took shelter also. The Boers, feeling certain that the
+ party was unarmed, did not trouble themselves to open fire at a distance,
+ but rode forward in a clump at full gallop.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are about a thousand yards away now," one of the men said. "We may
+ as well give them a volley."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The thirteen rifles flashed out almost simultaneously. There were, as they
+ had counted, sixteen Boers. Five horses fell, three others galloped off
+ riderless, and the party broke up and rode off at full speed in various
+ directions.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think we need trouble any more about them," said Sankey's father,
+ who, was one of the party, as he rose to his feet. "You may be sure that
+ several of those who got away carried bullets somewhere about them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As they turned to rejoin their friends there was a general exclamation of
+ satisfaction, for two large waggons were seen coming along the road. In
+ ten minutes the women and children, with all the older men, were
+ comfortably seated and on their way to Newcastle. Chris and his party
+ accompanied them on foot so as to form a rear-guard. "We have won our
+ first battle," Chris laughed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But for you there would not have been any battle at all," Field said. "I
+ don't think any of us would have gone forward after that fellow warned us
+ back had you not done so."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I was determined to get some milk for the children," Chris said, "and
+ would have gone forward even if I had been alone. I don't think I ever
+ felt such a satisfaction as I did in thrashing that Boer. One of them
+ struck my mother across the face, you know, in the train, and though it
+ was not the same man, I feel better now that I have taken it out of
+ someone."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At Newcastle they found a small British force, and learned that there were
+ four or five thousand troops at Dundee. Trains were still running, and
+ after only an hour's delay at Newcastle to obtain a meal, the whole party
+ went on. Late that evening they arrived at Colenso. Mrs. King and the
+ ladies and gentlemen of the party had decided to sleep there, but hearing
+ on the road that the little town was crowded with fugitives from the
+ Transvaal and the farms near the frontier, they determined to continue the
+ journey to the capital, which they reached the next morning. The lads had
+ quite decided upon their course before starting, and had arranged with
+ their parents to remain at Maritzburg. The general opinion was that the
+ British force at the front could not possibly maintain itself, but that as
+ soon as the invasion began in force they must fall back, as the Transvaal
+ Boers would be able to attack them in front and on the right flank, while
+ the Free Staters would pour down through Van Reenen and De Beers Passes
+ and make straight for Ladysmith, and so threaten their line of retreat.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were a few indeed who still believed that the Boers would stand
+ entirely upon the defensive so far as Natal went. They would occupy the
+ formidable passes through the Drakensberg and await attack there, while
+ they would invade Cape Colony at many points and raise the Boer
+ population. However, the general opinion was that they would advance into
+ Natal in great force, and in that case it was doubtful, indeed, whether
+ Sir George White could oppose them successfully north of Maritzburg. He
+ might even, it was thought, be obliged to fall back to Durban until
+ reinforcements arrived from England. Already there was a rush to the
+ offices that had been opened for the volunteer corps. Many of the
+ fugitives from the Transvaal had joined, as had most of the young farmers
+ who had been obliged by the hostility of their Dutch neighbours to abandon
+ their homes in the north of Natal, while numbers of all ranks in
+ Maritzburg, Durban, and other towns were giving in their names. All the
+ lads who had come down with Chris had some time before obtained their
+ parents' consent to join a volunteer corps, or form one among themselves,
+ and as it was evident that the crisis was at hand no objections were
+ raised to their doing so at once. Mrs. King would go down to Durban with
+ her friends, so that there was no need for her son to accompany her.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It had been agreed by the other lads that they would all meet at ten
+ o'clock at the hotel where Chris put up, and the party mustered in greater
+ strength than had been expected, for they found that the boys who had
+ preceded them had all waited in the town, and were stopping at the various
+ hotels. They too had been as badly treated by the Boers as the last
+ arrivals, and were all eager to begin work.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no getting a private room here," Chris said, "so we had better
+ go outside the town and talk things over." As they went they chatted over
+ their adventures on the road, and great satisfaction was felt among those
+ who had not been present on hearing how Chris had thrashed the Boer, and
+ had gone tip to him in spite of his threat to shoot. At their last meeting
+ at Johannesburg they had elected him their captain, but he had at the time
+ refused to accept the post, saying that it would be wiser to decide that
+ afterwards, as one of the others might show himself better fitted for the
+ position. However, their first step when they sat down by the bank of the
+ little river outside the town was to again elect him by acclamation.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well," he said, "as you all wish it I will accept the post. I
+ suppose we are well provided with funds. Our fathers all said they would
+ find our outfit, and money enough for all expenses." There was a general
+ assent. "Well, we start better than we had expected, for we have thirteen
+ rifles: twelve of them are Mausers, the other we will sell; so we shall
+ have to buy nine others. That had better be done this morning, for we may
+ be sure that there will be a rush to the gunsmiths' shops. In the next
+ place we must each buy a saddle and saddlery. We have agreed that we will
+ not have any approach to uniform; because, as we all speak Dutch, we shall
+ be able to pass unobserved, if necessary, among them. But I have been
+ thinking it over, and it seems to me that if we have nothing of the sort
+ we shall run the risk of being shot by our own men."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What are we to do, then, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think that we had better get flat caps, like the fatigue caps our
+ soldiers wear. They can be carried in our pockets inside our shirts when
+ we are in the neighbourhood of the Boers, and when we are riding anywhere
+ near our own troops we can put them on instead of our felt hats. It would
+ alter our appearance altogether when riding in groups, and even at a
+ distance we could hardly be taken for Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All agreed that it would be an excellent plan.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We shall, of course, have bandoliers for our cartridges, and haversacks
+ for our provisions and spare packets of ammunition. Not an hour must be
+ lost in getting these things. I hear that Captain Brookfield, who came up
+ to Johannesburg last year and stayed a fortnight with us, has raised a
+ corps, which he has named the Maritzburg Scouts. I will call upon him this
+ afternoon and tell him that there are one-and-twenty of us, all somewhere
+ about my age, and that we mean fighting; and that as we all speak Dutch we
+ think we can do more good by scouting about on our own account than by
+ joining any regular corps; but that at the same time we should like, if
+ there was anything like regular fighting, to place ourselves under the
+ orders of an officer like himself. It is rather difficult to explain, you
+ know, but I think he will understand what we mean. We should be, in fact,
+ a section of his troop, acting generally on independent service, either
+ scouting, or going in among the Boers and getting intelligence, trying to
+ blow up bridges, and engaging looting parties&mdash;for we may be sure
+ that the Boers will be scattering all over the country plundering.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Of course I shall say, if he won't accept us on those terms, we shall do
+ as we best can on our own account; but that as we don't require pay, and
+ will provide ourselves with all necessaries, we do not see that we should
+ be any burden when we join him. I propose that we meet here again this
+ afternoon, and I hope that by that time we shall all have got our mounts
+ and saddlery. I hear that many of the loyal farmers north have driven
+ their animals down here, and are only too glad to sell the horses at the
+ usual prices. Mind, the clothes we have now won't do; we must get them of
+ farmer fashion. Don't go together to any shop, but let each choose for
+ himself; we don't want anything like uniformity of pattern. The stuff must
+ be strong. We shall each want a couple of blankets; one of these, with a
+ slit cut in the middle to slip over the head, will serve as a greatcoat.
+ Now, let us be off! To save trouble, I should say that we had each better
+ put a certain sum, say twenty pounds, to go into a fund for general
+ expenditure&mdash;food and ammunition, and that sort of thing&mdash;into
+ one of the banks, and we can draw upon that as we require it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should say, Chris," Sankey said, "that we had better put all our money
+ into the fund. Our people are all going to pay for our outfit, and you
+ know they have agreed to give us a hundred pounds each to last us through
+ the war. It is of no use carrying money about with us. I think we should
+ agree to pay it all into the common fund, and that at the end of the
+ business what remains is to be divided among those of us who go through
+ it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think that is a good plan, Sankey. Certainly we cannot all expect to
+ come out alive, and that arrangement will save all trouble about money."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On going back into the town they learned that a large farmer had encamped
+ two miles away, with a big drove of cattle and a couple of hundred horses,
+ many of which were fine animals, and it was agreed at once that Sankey,
+ Carmichael, and Peters should hire a buggy and drive over there and choose
+ twenty-one good horses. Harris and Field undertook the purchase of the
+ rifles, and Chris went to the office which Captain Brookfield, who had
+ been an officer in the English army had taken. He had sent in his name,
+ and was at once shown in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, Chris," he said cordially as he entered, "I am glad to see you. You
+ have grown and widened out a good deal since last year. I suppose your
+ father and mother have both come down with you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "My mother has come down, sir, but my father thought that he ought to
+ remain behind to look after the mines."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you come here to enlist?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not exactly, sir, and yet I have to a certain extent;" and he told the
+ officer of the little corps that had been formed among his companions at
+ Johannesburg.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A very good idea. Speaking Dutch, as you say they all do, they ought to
+ do good service as scouts. But why have you come to me?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This Chris explained.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The captain laughed. "I suppose the fact is, Chris, you think that you
+ will be able to see and do more if you are altogether independent of other
+ people's orders."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Perhaps that is it, sir; but if there is any cavalry fighting we should
+ much rather be under orders. Such a small corps would look ridiculous
+ marching out by itself."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I don't see any reason why you should not carry out your plan. It
+ would certainly be better that you should have some&mdash;what I may call&mdash;official
+ sanction. All the men in our corps are paid five shillings a day, and as
+ your troop would serve under different conditions, you can to a certain
+ extent dictate your own terms. I will, if you like, accept you as an
+ independent corps, attached to my command when with me, but at other times
+ free to scout and to act as you choose; but mind, I cannot be responsible
+ for any scrape that you get into. You might call yourselves the
+ Johannesburg section of the Maritzburg Scouts, maintaining yourselves at
+ your own expense, and drawing neither pay nor rations."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you very much, sir; that is just what we want."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then, if you will bring your companions here this evening, I will swear
+ you in. I shall administer a different oath to you from that which the
+ others take, and merely pledge you, when under my orders, to obey them,
+ with permission to withdraw from the corps when you choose. And indeed,
+ receiving no pay or assistance from government, you would naturally be
+ free to do so."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Leaving Captain Brookfield, Chris went and bought his clothes, bandolier
+ and belt, and saddlery, and then returned to the hotel and told his mother
+ how he had got on, and that a horse and rifle would, he hoped, be obtained
+ that afternoon.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It seems to me a terribly dangerous business, Chris; but as your father
+ agreed to it, of course I need say no more. I have a cheque for five
+ hundred pounds for my expenses and yours."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Father gave me a hundred before I started, mother; that will more than
+ pay for my outfit. I don't know what we shall do for the horses, but there
+ will certainly not be much over."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I know, Chris; and he told me to hand you over another hundred when
+ I went to the bank, which I shall do this afternoon."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0003" id="link2HCH0003"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER III &mdash; AT THE FRONT
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ At five o'clock the lads from Johannesburg again met and reported the
+ result of the afternoon's work. The nine Mauser rifles had been bought,
+ and six thousand rounds of ammunition had been purchased. This appeared an
+ excessive amount, but as there might be a difficulty in obtaining this
+ ammunition, they bought up all that could be found in the town. Peters and
+ his party had chosen the horses for the troop. The farmer was a well-known
+ breeder of good stock, and was glad to dispose of some of them at a fair
+ price in order to lessen their number. He had already had several
+ enquiries from corps that were being raised, but the prices were higher
+ than could be paid for ordinary troopers, though several had been bought
+ by officers. The lot the lads had picked out had been put aside, and they
+ had given the farmer fifty pounds earnest-money, to hold them till the
+ next morning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are as good a looking lot of horses as I ever saw," Peters said, "in
+ fact, by a long way the best. I always heard that he was one of the
+ largest breeders of good horses in South Africa. He had eight or ten
+ extraordinarily good ones, but, of course, he wanted extra prices for
+ these; but from the rest&mdash;and he has some three hundred of them&mdash;he
+ let us choose any we liked at one price, and I think I can say that we
+ shall be as well mounted a corps as any out here. Of course we avoided the
+ showy-looking horses, and chose those specially suited to the country and
+ likely to be fast. Mr. Duncan had several thoroughbreds from home, and
+ there is no doubt that his stock has benefited by it; they are all of the
+ country type, sturdy and compact, and yet somewhat finer in the limb than
+ any I ever saw in the Transvaal. We were delighted with them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All the lads were accustomed from childhood to horses, but those Chris had
+ selected as the committee of inspection were admitted by their friends to
+ be the best judges of horseflesh in the party, their fathers being wealthy
+ men who always bought the finest horses money could obtain.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We will go over in a body to-morrow," Chris said, "and pay for them and
+ bring them back. We are lucky indeed to have got hold of such a good lot.
+ Are they pretty even animals, Peters?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I really don't think there is anything to choose between them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well then, the fair way will be, to make one-and-twenty tickets with as
+ many numbers and fasten one to the mane of each horse, then we will put
+ another twenty-one numbers into a hat and draw them; in that way everyone
+ will be satisfied. Those of you who have not got their money from their
+ people had better ask them for it this evening, so that we can settle up
+ to-morrow for the horses and rifles and ammunition. The hundred pounds we
+ have each been promised will well cover all our expenses up to the moment
+ we start, and I should think leave us with something like twenty pounds
+ apiece in pocket, but all we have and the other hundred for future
+ expenses we had better put into the bank here to-morrow. We must arrange
+ for four of us to sign cheques, each cheque to be signed by two, but we
+ had better give them all our signatures so that in case what we can call
+ the finance committee of four are all killed or taken prisoners there will
+ be no bother about having fresh signatures to arrange about."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well," Sankey said, "we might as well settle that at once. I propose that
+ Field, Carmichael, Capper, and, of course, you form the committee." As no
+ amendment was offered, this was at once agreed to.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What time did you say that we would come over to fetch the horses?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "About ten o'clock."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, will you all be at my hotel to-morrow at half-past eight with your
+ money? Then we will all sign our names on paper the committee first;
+ afterwards they shall go with me to the bank and pay all the money in,
+ give them the list of signatures, and tell them that until further notice
+ two of the four first names will sign the cheques, but that should
+ circumstances prevent any two of them being able to do so, others will
+ sign instead. The account had better stand as the Johannesburg Scouts.
+ When we have arranged that we will hire a couple of light waggons and
+ start. Have you all got your saddlery?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we will take it with us, and then we can ride the horses back. I
+ will get the tickets made out."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the bank opened in the morning, Chris and his three companions
+ presented themselves, and had an interview with the manager, who was
+ somewhat surprised when twenty-one cheques and cash to the amount of three
+ thousand five hundred pounds were handed in, each member having deducted
+ the amount paid for saddlery and clothes. "We wish the account to stand in
+ the name of the Johannesburg Scouts, and cheques will be signed by two of
+ the four names standing first on this list; but as casualties may occur,
+ you will please accept any of these signatures. Our little corps will form
+ part of the Maritzburg Scouts, but in money matters we keep to ourselves,
+ being all volunteers serving without pay."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The manager ran his eye over the cheques. All the names were well known to
+ him as those of prominent men at Johannesburg, and the great majority had
+ already accounts at his bank, as all had some time previously made
+ arrangements for drawing money in case of necessity.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose, Mr. King," he said, "that as you and your friends represent
+ the corps, you are all young men?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are all boys," Chris answered with a smile, "but we are old enough to
+ do men's work, and in the Transvaal the Boers are commandeering all boys
+ two or three years younger than we are."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I congratulate you all both on your patriotism and your pluck, Mr.
+ King, and I have no doubt that you will do good service."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Receiving a cheque-book, they drew two hundred pounds for current
+ expenses, and then going back to the hotel found the two Cape-carts and
+ their companions ready, and the saddlery already stowed away. On arriving
+ at the farm all were highly pleased with the horses their comrades had
+ selected. They had on the way agreed that it would be a good plan to buy
+ four others to act as pack-horses, and to furnish them with remounts in
+ case any of their own were shot. These were to be sent into the town by
+ two Kaffirs, whom they arranged to take into their service, for the farmer
+ said at once, when they asked him that he could very well spare them, as
+ he would be parting with a considerable number of his horses and cattle,
+ and would not require so many hands as he had at present. The two men he
+ chose for them were both active young natives; they made no objection to
+ the exchange of masters, and, indeed, seemed pleased at the thought of
+ going with them to fight the Boers, who were universally hated by the
+ natives.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A cheque was given to the farmer for their purchase, then the horses were
+ chosen by lot as agreed, and were at once saddled and mounted. They had
+ all been partially broken in, and as the boys were good riders, they were
+ after a little preliminary struggle soon at their ease, and, taking a
+ couple of hours' sharp ride through the country, returned on good terms
+ with their mounts. Two or three hours were spent in teaching the horses to
+ stand steady as soon as the reins were thrown over their heads, this being
+ a training to which all horses in the Cape are subjected. Then they rode
+ back to the town and arranged with a farmer near it to picket their horses
+ in one of his meadows, and for their feed while they remained there. The
+ rest of the day was spent in laying in their supplies. The rifles and
+ ammunition were paid for, pack saddles bought for the four spare horses, a
+ brace of revolvers purchased for each member, haversacks ordered for the
+ whole party, and bags to carry a supply of grain for each horse. In the
+ evening they went out to the farm, and after discharging their rifles a
+ few times fed their horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This they repeated in the morning, so as to familiarize them with the
+ sound of firearms; then they saddled and mounted them, and after riding
+ for half an hour drew up in line, as Captain Brookfield, who had sworn
+ them in on the previous afternoon, was to inspect them at eight o'clock.
+ They had all put on their working clothes, bandoliers and belts, and high
+ boots, and the captain on his arrival, after closely inspecting them,
+ expressed his strongest approval of their appearance.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I really congratulate you, Mr. King," he said, "on having command of
+ twenty such serviceable-looking young fellows. As they all can ride, and,
+ as you tell me, can all shoot, they ought to do really good service, and I
+ should be well pleased if all my troop were composed of such good
+ material. From the fact that you can all speak Dutch, and most of you
+ Kaffir, you will have great opportunities of obtaining information, and
+ can, in case of need, pass as young Boers. In fact, I may say that there
+ is some danger of your being mistaken for them by our men. I should take
+ you for them myself, except that you all look brighter and more wide-awake
+ than Boers generally do; but an artilleryman could hardly be blamed if he
+ plumped a shell among you at a distance of two or three thousand yards."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We thought of that, sir;" Chris turned to his band, "Change caps!" All
+ pulled field-service caps from their pockets, took off the soft felts,
+ rolled them up and forced them into their valises, and put on the caps.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is excellent!" Captain Brookfield exclaimed. "That certainly alters
+ your appearance altogether, and as far as your figures could be made out
+ through a glass, it could be seen that you are an irregular body of some
+ sort. And this can be still more plainly seen if, as I should advise you,
+ you always ride in fours when you are approaching our lines; there will
+ then be little chance of a mistake being made. Where did you pick up all
+ those horses?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We bought them yesterday from a farmer named Duncan, who has brought them
+ down from his place near Dundee."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Ah! that accounts for it; he is one of the best-known horse-breeders in
+ the colony. I had not heard that he had come down."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "He only arrived two days ago, sir. We were fortunate to hear of it, and
+ some of us rode over early yesterday and were lucky enough to secure
+ them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You were lucky. There are several mounted corps being formed here and at
+ Durban, and horses will go up in price rapidly. Where is he staying'?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "About a mile and a half farther out, sir. If you want horses I should
+ think that you had better go on at once, for he told me that he had sold
+ sixty yesterday, but that very few of them were anything like as good
+ horses as these."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No. People are subscribing handsomely, but we cannot afford to mount our
+ troopers on such horses as these. A good many gentlemen have found their
+ own horses, and of course will be well mounted; but a good, sound, country
+ horse is all we can afford for the others; they are excellent for ordinary
+ work, though, of course, not so fast as yours, nor quite so big. Your
+ horses have all a strain of English thoroughbred blood, and if you should
+ at any time have to ride for it there would be little chance of the Boers
+ overtaking you, though some of them are very well mounted, for the two
+ things a Boer will spend money on, are his horse and his rifle. And when
+ do you start?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are going to-morrow morning. I went to the station-master yesterday
+ evening and arranged for trucks for the horses to be attached to an early
+ train to Dundee. We want to get up in time to see the first of it, and we
+ should lose three days if we were to travel by road."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is the right spirit, and I wish I could go with you; but my troop
+ will wear a sort of uniform, Norfolk jackets and riding-breeches, and the
+ outfitters are so overwhelmed with orders that it will be another couple
+ of days at least before they are ready. Then the men must have two or
+ three days' drill before they start; I am still short of horses, so I will
+ ride on and see Duncan. I want thirty-five more, and as yet, although
+ subscriptions are coming in well, we are still a good deal short of our
+ requirements. However, I dare say I shall be able to make some arrangement
+ with Duncan, as I shall probably have enough to pay him in full by the end
+ of the week. Altogether, I don't suppose I shall be ready to start for
+ another ten days, and unless the Boers delay their advance I am afraid
+ that I shall not get to Dundee."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Do you not believe that we shall be able to hold the town?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hardly think that there is a chance of it, and I am sure we made a
+ mistake in sending a portion of the force there. I know the premier was
+ most anxious that our troops should be posted as far north as possible, in
+ order to save the loyal farmers from plunder. If the position were
+ stronger and impossible to be turned, the case would be different; but it
+ is not strong, and can be turned on each flank. If the Boers march to
+ attack General Symons, who is in command there, he may possibly beat them
+ off; but as they can advance towards Ladysmith either from the Free State
+ on one side or the Transvaal on the other, he and his troops would be cut
+ off, and the loyal farmers would be plundered just as much as if Symons
+ had remained at Ladysmith. I fancy all the military men think that a grave
+ mistake has been made, and that General White should not have exposed half
+ his force to disaster. Besides, the position of Ladysmith is no more
+ defensible than that of Dundee. The Tugela would be the natural line of
+ defence, but even that could be turned by troops from the Transvaal going
+ through Zululand, and the line of the river would be very difficult to
+ defend by a force of less than twenty thousand men. However, we shall see
+ how the thing works out&mdash;how enterprising the Boers are, and how
+ warmly the Free Staters throw themselves into the work."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You think that we shall have a hard time, Captain Brookfield?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I think that is certain, even if Cape Colony keeps quiet, which I am
+ very much afraid it will not do. If it rises, it will take all the
+ strength of England to put it down. Well, I wish you all luck. I can
+ assure you I feel proud of my Johannesburg section, and I shall be glad
+ when you join me."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He shook hands with the whole of the lads and then rode off.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The train starts at eight o'clock," Chris said. "We had better get our
+ good-byes over to-night, get some breakfast if we are able to do so at
+ half-past five, and meet here at six. We ought to be at the station at
+ least an hour before the train starts. We shall not only have to get the
+ horses into the trucks, which is certain to be a troublesome business, as
+ they are altogether new to it, but we shall have to see to our other
+ stores and belongings. I have arranged that we shall travel with the
+ horses, so that we can each stand at the heads of our own animals, and if
+ they are very wild, we can blindfold them until they become accustomed to
+ the situation. I have bought a couple of trusses of hay from Thomas, and
+ he will send down two of his native boys to the station. I should advise
+ you all to put some food into your haversacks, there is no saying how long
+ we may be on the road."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What sort of trucks are they, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They have high sides, but no roofs. Of course I would rather have had
+ roofs, but the station-master could not provide any waggons with them. But
+ he showed me these, and as the sides are quite high enough to prevent the
+ horses getting out, they will do very well."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The saddles were taken off and piled together. There was no chance of
+ rain, so they were left uncovered. The lads then walked back into the
+ town. There was, of course, a sad parting that evening between Chris and
+ his mother, but she bore up well. She knew that hundreds of other women
+ were parting with husbands or sons, and she felt that, as the main cause
+ of the war was to rescue the Uitlanders in the Transvaal from the
+ oppression of the Boers, it behooved all the fugitives from that country
+ to do their utmost.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the morning the lads all arrived punctually at the rendezvous. The
+ horses were fed to the accompaniment, as usual, of pistol shots. Then they
+ were saddled up, the valises the lads had brought down with them were
+ strapped on, and with their rifles slung behind them they rode to the
+ station.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was, as they had expected, a long and troublesome business to get the
+ horses into the trucks, but at last this was managed. Nose-bags were put
+ on, with a few double-handfuls of grain, then one trooper was left to each
+ two horses, while the rest saw to their bundles of blankets, their stores
+ of tea, sugar, and flour, preserved milk, cocoa, bacon, and tinned food. A
+ couple of frying-pans, and a canteen of tin cups and plates, a knife,
+ fork, and spoon each, and two kettles, completed their outfit. They had
+ put their soft felt hats in their valises, and were all in their flat
+ fatigue caps.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The train was a long one, but the carriages with it were empty, for while
+ the trains from the north were closely packed, there were few persons
+ indeed proceeding up country. The trucks, however, were well filled, as
+ great quantities of stores were being taken up, some to Ladysmith, and
+ others for the force at Dundee. The horses soon became accustomed to the
+ motion, and their masters took the opportunity of familiarizing themselves
+ with them, by talking to them, patting them, and giving them pieces of
+ bread and an occasional lump of sugar. The two Kaffirs had brought on the
+ pack-horses four water-skins and a couple of buckets, and in the heat of
+ the day the horses were allowed a good drink, while their masters, whose
+ haversacks had been filled by their friends, enjoyed a hearty meal, washed
+ down by tin mugs full of champagne.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They were in the highest spirits, although the meal was taken under
+ difficult circumstances, for all were seated on the upper rails of the
+ trucks, there being no room for them to sit down among the horses. The
+ plates were all packed up, and fingers and teeth served for knives and
+ forks, which was the less important since chickens were the staple of the
+ meal; and these had been cut up before starting. Many were the jokes that
+ passed along the line. All felt that it was the last experience they were
+ likely to have of civilized food, and that it would be a long while before
+ champagne or any other wine would fall to their lot. The Kaffirs, who had
+ each charge of two spare horses, enjoyed themselves no less, for they had
+ a fair share of the provisions of their masters, and were in a high state
+ of contentment with their prospects.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a halt of an hour at Ladysmith. Many of the officers and
+ soldiers gathered at the station, their work for the day finished, and the
+ arrival of the train being always an event of some importance in the
+ little town. They were amused and interested at the party of young fellows
+ who alighted to stretch their legs and get a change of position.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Which is your leader?" a major asked Field.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The one talking to an officer. His name is Chris King."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Is he chosen because he is the oldest of you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, that has nothing to do with it. We are all within a year of the same
+ age. We have all been chums and friends, and have hunted and shot
+ together, and he is the one we elected as our leader, just as you would
+ choose the captain of a cricket club. We all come from Johannesburg, find
+ our own horses, arms, and outfits, and ask nothing whatever from the
+ government; and as we speak Dutch, and all know more or less Kaffir, we
+ fancy we can make a good deal better scouts than your cavalry, who can't
+ ask a question of a Boer or get information from a native."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The major laughed. He saw that the lad a little resented the joking tone
+ in which he had asked the question.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no doubt that you are right," he said, "and I am quite sure I
+ should like half a dozen of you as subalterns. When did you come from
+ Johannesburg?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We left there about a week ago, and as we were only at Maritzburg three
+ days, we have not lost any time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Indeed, I think that is a record performance. Of course you are all
+ looking forward to your first skirmish; I can assure you we are."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We had our first on the way down here, when we were between Newcastle and
+ the frontier. Four or five of us went to a farmhouse to try and get some
+ food and milk for the women and children. It was a Boer's place, and the
+ fellow came out with a rifle and warned us off. We went forward, and he
+ took a shot at King when he was quite close to him, but fortunately the
+ bullet only went through his hat. Chris knocked him down and gave him a
+ tremendous thrashing with his own whip. Then we took some provisions and
+ paid for them, and searching the house, found twelve Mauser rifles and a
+ lot of ammunition. We took these off without paying for them. The Boer had
+ made off while we were searching the house, and he and some twenty others
+ pursued us, not dreaming that we were now armed. However, we gave them a
+ volley, and emptied three saddles and killed three or four horses, and
+ they moved off without trying to make our further acquaintance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well done, lads!" the officer said warmly, "that was an excellent
+ beginning, and I have no doubt that you will follow it up well."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Similar conversations were going on all along the platform, and when at
+ last the lads again took their places in the trucks, a hearty cheer was
+ given them. The sun was setting when they arrived at Dundee. It was a
+ larger place than Ladysmith, as there were some coal-mines in the
+ neighbourhood, and a considerable number of men were employed in them.
+ Like Ladysmith it is situated on a plain dominated by hills. The camp was
+ some little distance out of the town. An officer was at the station with a
+ party of men to receive the stores brought up by the train. Chris at once
+ went up to him and saluted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have just arrived, sir; we are a section of the Maritzburg Scouts,
+ acting independently. As we are all from Johannesburg, and find our own
+ horses, equipment, and food, provide our own rations, and, of course,
+ serve without pay, we propose to scout on our own account, and as we all
+ speak Dutch well, I think that we may be useful in obtaining information.
+ We shall, of course, search the country in whatever direction may be
+ considered most useful."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no doubt that you will be of good service, sir," the officer said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose we can camp anywhere we like."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should think so. As you do not draw rations, it can matter little where
+ you post yourselves; but I don't think that you will be able to get tents
+ to-night."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We shall not want them, sir; we have each a large waterproof sheet, and
+ intend to use them as tentes d'abri. I suppose I had better report myself
+ at the headquarters of the general?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, that would be the proper thing. The camp is a mile and a half away;
+ if you follow the Glencoe railway, you cannot miss it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the horses were detrained and the baggage packed, the little
+ party mounted and left the station, and choosing a piece of unoccupied
+ ground a few hundred yards away, proceeded to unsaddle and picket the
+ horses, while Chris rode away to the camp accompanied by one of the
+ natives to hold his horse there. He had no difficulty in finding it, and
+ dismounting, walked to the group of head-quarter tents. His appearance
+ excited a good deal of amusement and some chaff from the soldiers he
+ passed. He looked, indeed, like a young Dutch farmer in his rough clothes,
+ and his rifle, and a bandolier of cartridges. Seeing a young officer close
+ to a tent, he asked him which was that of the adjutant-general.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "He is there talking to the general at the door of his tent. Do you wish
+ to speak to him?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should be glad to do so," Chris replied. The officer walked across and
+ informed the colonel that Chris wanted to speak to him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Bring him across, Mr. Williams," the general himself said. "He is
+ evidently a young farmer, and possibly brings in some news of the enemy's
+ movements."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lieutenant returned to Chris and led him up to the general.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You have some news that you wish to give us, sir?" Sir Penn Symons said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, general; but I hope to be able to do so to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then stated his position and the nature of his command.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are all very well mounted, sir," he went on, "and as we all speak
+ Dutch, hope to be useful. At any rate, we shall be no trouble to you, as
+ we draw neither rations nor pay. We think we can pass anywhere as Boers;
+ that is why we have not adopted any uniform."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no doubt you will be of service," the general said, "though I
+ hardly think that you will pass as Boers with those caps."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have all wide-brimmed hats to use while we are scouting, general; but
+ we carry these too, so that on our return towards your lines we can be
+ recognized even at a distance as not being Boers, and so avoid being fired
+ at."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, that is a very necessary precaution. I will have officers commanding
+ cavalry and artillery detachments warned, that a section of Maritzburg
+ volunteers are dressed as farmers, but may be known in the distance by
+ having caps similar to the ordinary infantry field-service caps.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, sir, I shall be glad if you will to-morrow ride to the south,
+ following the river, and endeavour to find out whether the Boers have any
+ considerable force in that direction, either on this side of the river or
+ the other, I may tell you that five of the Natal police were captured on
+ the evening of the 13th at De Jagers Drift. The Boers have been in
+ possession of Newcastle for the past three days, and they are certainly
+ crossing the passes from the Free State. You must be very careful, for
+ they have scouting parties across the river almost as far as the Tugela.
+ However, we hardly expect any serious struggle for another week or ten
+ days; for all the accounts are to the effect that the Boers are still very
+ deficient in transport, and that for the past week those at Laing's Nek,
+ and the other passes, have been very much straitened for provisions. It
+ would be as well for you, while you are at Dundee, to come over once a day
+ to report your doings, and to receive orders as to the point where we most
+ need information. Have you gone into lodgings in the town?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, sir. We have waterproof sheets that form tentes d'abri, and we prefer
+ being with our horses, which were only bought a few days ago; so, as we
+ shall not have much opportunity of sleeping otherwise than in the open for
+ some time, we thought it as well to begin at once, especially as the
+ weather looks threatening, and the horses, being unaccustomed to be
+ picketed, might pull up the pegs and get loose were there a heavy rain."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You seem to be well fitted for the work, and to set about it in the right
+ spirit."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have all been accustomed to hunting expeditions, sir, when we have
+ often been out for some days, so that we understand how to shift for
+ ourselves, though we are new to campaigning."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What rifles have you? that does not look like a Lee-Metford."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, general, it is a Mauser. We captured twelve of them, at a Boer's
+ farmhouse three or four miles this side of Newcastle six days ago. He
+ fired at us, and though his bullet only went through my hat, we thought
+ ourselves justified in searching his house."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: CHRIS OFFERS HIS SERVICES TO SIR PENN SYMONS.]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Certainly you were. We heard that there had been a skirmish on the road,
+ and learned the particulars from one of those who took part in it, and who
+ stayed here for two or three days before going down the country. He said
+ that four or five young gentlemen, who were coming down with a party of
+ women and children from Volksrust, had gone to a farmhouse to try and get
+ food, milk, and bread for the females. The Boer farmer insulted them, and
+ shot at one of them when but two or three yards away; he had been
+ tremendously thrashed by the young fellow, and they returned laden with a
+ good supply of milk and bread, and twelve rifles and a lot of ammunition
+ that they had found at the farm. And with these they and some of the men
+ had beaten off an attack of a score of Boers without any loss to
+ themselves."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, general, that was our party; we had sent forward for some waggons,
+ and got into Dundee two hours after the skirmish; and as there was a train
+ just going we went on at once, and reached Maritzburg the next morning,
+ where we were joined by some of our party who had come down the day
+ before. As we had made all our plans before leaving Johannesburg, we were
+ able to start this morning, which was the third after our arrival there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You were prompt indeed," the general said with a smile, "and must have
+ needed money as well as brains."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We had all obtained leave of our families, general, and were well
+ provided with funds to carry us through the campaign if it lasts for a
+ year. We wanted to be in time for the first fight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think yours was the first fight, except that a few shots were exchanged
+ between our scouts and the Boers on the morning after the ultimatum
+ expired. Now, sir, if you should at any time be in want of necessaries I
+ shall be glad to supply you; but I cannot furnish you with ammunition, as
+ the Mausers carry a smaller bullet than our rifles."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, general, but we have enough to last us for a considerable
+ time, having brought up six thousand rounds."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A good provision indeed," the general laughed; "enough to last you
+ through half a dozen pitched battles. I shall be in the town at six
+ o'clock to-morrow morning, and shall be pleased to inspect your little
+ corps before you start."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I thank you, general; we shall all be very proud to be inspected by you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then saluting he returned to his horse and rode back to Dundee. He was
+ pleased to see that the eleven little tents had been erected strictly in
+ line, that the horses were all standing quietly at the picket-rope, and
+ that two of the troop were placed as sentries. A large fire was blazing in
+ front of the tents, the two natives were squatting by it, the kettles were
+ swung over it, and a joint of meat was roasting there. Two or three of the
+ lads were standing talking together; the rest had gone into the town.
+ Cairns came up to him as he dismounted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you heard the news, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, I have not heard any particular news."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I was at the station a quarter of an hour ago, and a telegram had just
+ been received that the Boers were, when it was sent off, entering
+ Elandslaagte station, and were in the act of capturing the passenger train
+ that was standing there. The message stopped abruptly, as no doubt the
+ Boers entered the room where the clerk was at work at the needles."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "By Jove we are in luck!" Chris said. "Of course that was the train that
+ had to leave three hours after us. If we had stopped for that, the horses,
+ rifles, and kit would all have gone, and we should now be prisoners. It is
+ serious news, though, for it is evident that not only are they marching
+ against us in front, and on both flanks, but have cut our communications
+ with Ladysmith. There can be no doubt that, as everyone said there, it was
+ a mistake to send General Symons forward here, as it was almost certain
+ that with four regiments, three batteries of artillery, a regiment of
+ cavalry, and a few hundred of the Natal police and volunteers, he could
+ never maintain himself here. Why, we heard at Ladysmith that a column had
+ gone out the day before towards Besters station, as the news had come in
+ that they were even then in the neighbourhood. It was a false alarm, but
+ it was enough to show that the Boers were likely to be coming down and
+ cutting the railway in our rear. General Symons told me that he did not
+ expect any general advance of the enemy just yet, because he heard that
+ their transport was incomplete, and that they were very short of
+ provisions. But I don't think the want of transport would prevent their
+ advancing. We know well enough that the Boers think nothing of going out
+ for three or four days without any prospect of getting any more provisions
+ than they carry about them, unless they have the luck to bring down an
+ antelope. And as Utrecht and Vryheid and Newcastle are all within a few
+ miles of us, and the Free Staters have already come down through some of
+ the passes of the Drakensberg, they must be within an easy ride of us; and
+ if they are in force enough to drive us out of this place, they must know
+ they would find themselves in clover, for we heard at Ladysmith that there
+ were provisions and stores for two months collected here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0004" id="link2HCH0004"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER IV &mdash; DUNDEE
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ After picketing his horse, Chris went into the town. He found the streets
+ full of excited people, for the news that the railway had been cut was
+ serious indeed, and the scene reminded Chris of that which he had
+ witnessed in the streets of Johannesburg but eight days before. Only eight
+ days! and yet it seemed to him as if weeks had passed since then. So much
+ had been done, so great had been the changes. As at Johannesburg, a
+ considerable portion of the population had left, seeing that, although the
+ troops might for a time defend the town, the Boers were certain to cut the
+ line of railway. Work at the coal-mines had been pushed on feverishly of
+ late, for strangely enough there was no store of coals either in Dundee
+ itself or at any of the stations down to Durban, and the authorities had
+ only woke up a few days before to the fact that coal would be required in
+ large quantities for the transports on the arrival of the troops. But now
+ all this was to come to a stop. The hands would be thrown out of
+ employment, and the town would become stagnant until it was captured by
+ the Boers, or until an army arrived of sufficient strength to clear Natal
+ of its invaders. That evening many who possessed vehicles started by road
+ for Ladysmith, feeling that in another twenty-four hours it might be too
+ late.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At seven o'clock, as had been arranged when they arrived, all the members
+ of the band met at the bivouac for supper. There was a general feeling of
+ excitement among them. They had known that hostilities must soon begin,
+ but to find that the line had already been cut, and that the enemy were
+ closing in in all directions, came almost as a surprise. This, however, in
+ no way prevented them from enjoying their meal. After it was over they
+ held, at Chris's suggestion, a sort of council. He had already told them
+ what the general had said to him, and that they were to be inspected in
+ the morning. As their saddlery was all new, there was nothing to be done
+ in the way of burnishing buckles and rubbing up leather. As Chris
+ remarked, all that would be necessary was an hour's work in the morning
+ grooming their horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," he said, "that the work is going to begin, we must draw up a few
+ rules, for, volunteers though we are, we must have some regulations. In
+ the first place, I find that the troops all parade in order of battle
+ before daybreak, so as to be able to repel a sudden attack or move in any
+ direction that may be required. If it is necessary for them, it is still
+ more necessary for us, and I think that it should be a standing rule that
+ we are all ready to mount at daybreak. Sentries must be posted at night,
+ however safe we may feel. I think there should be two, relieved every two
+ hours. There will be no hardship in that, as each would only go on duty
+ every other night. In the next place, I think there should be what they
+ call an officer of the day, who would generally be in charge of the
+ arrangements, see that the Kaffirs attended to their horses properly, and
+ so on. You see, we shall not be always acting together, but might
+ sometimes be broken into four troops, in which case one in each five
+ should command. I think the same lot should always keep together. What do
+ you think? Would it be better that in each group of five one should be in
+ charge each day, or that each group should choose one to act as
+ non-commissioned officer?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was no reply.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you think yourself, Chris?" Sankey asked after a pause.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are as well able to judge as I am," he replied. "I think that it
+ would perhaps be the best way to write down the twenty names and put them
+ in a hat, and draw them one by one. The first five should be number one
+ squad. I don't know whether that is the right word, but anyhow it will do
+ for them. The next five number two, and so on. Then each five can vote
+ whether they would prefer alternate commands, or to choose one of their
+ number as permanent non-commissioned officer. If they prefer this, they
+ must then ballot as to which among them shall be leader. If you can think
+ of any way that you would like better, by all means say so."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All agreed that the plan that he proposed should be adopted. Four groups
+ were first chosen. Before they proceeded to the next step, Peters said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Of course I am quite game to carry it out as you suggest, Chris, but
+ don't you think it would be a good plan to let the final decision stand
+ for a week or two, each taking the leadership of his group in rotation? At
+ the end of that time we should be better able to make a choice than we can
+ be now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think that is a very good idea, Peters. What do you all say? Will you
+ each take your turn alphabetically for the present, and at the end of
+ fifteen days, when each of you have led three times, you can decide
+ whether each squad shall choose a permanent leader or go on as you have
+ begun."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All at once agreed to the proposal. They felt, good friends as they were,
+ that it would be very difficult to decide now.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well, then, it shall be so," Chris said. "To-morrow we shall
+ certainly do some scouting, but in a day or two you may be shut up here;
+ and until we get away there will be no scouting to be done. We must have
+ some signals. Suppose we are scattered over two or three miles, we may
+ want to assemble, and must be able to signal. I thought of it before we
+ started from home, and put down in my pocket-book the sort of thing that I
+ fancied would be wanted. I will read it out to you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He stirred the fire into a blaze and then read:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "One shot followed by another and a third, with ten seconds between them,
+ will mean 'Enemy seen on the right'; with twenty seconds between, 'Enemy
+ seen on the left'; then, after a pause, two shots in quick succession will
+ mean 'Enemy in strength'; three shots will be 'Small party only'; one
+ shot, followed at an interval of ten seconds by two in succession, will
+ mean 'Retire to the point agreed on before we separated'; followed by
+ three shots in quick succession, will be 'Close in to the centre'. We can
+ think of others afterwards, but I think that will do to begin with. I know
+ that you have all pocketbooks, so take down these signals at once."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We ought to know where you will be," Field said, "so that we could rally
+ round you ready for the next order."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That might be so; therefore we had better fix on three shots in quick
+ succession, followed in ten seconds by a fourth. The sound will be
+ sufficient to let you know pretty well where I am, and you will on hearing
+ it, join me at once. Are there any other suggestions?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was silence and then the books were closed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I cannot too strongly impress upon you all," Chris said, after they had
+ chatted for some time, "the necessity for being extremely cautious. We
+ know how slim the Boers are, and how accustomed they are to stalk game;
+ and we shall have to be as watchful as deer, more so, in fact, since we
+ have not their power of smell. When we break up into four parties, each
+ party must scatter, keeping three or four hundred yards apart. On arriving
+ at any swell or the crest of a hill, a halt must be made, and every foot
+ of the country searched by your field glasses, no matter how long it
+ takes. You must assure yourself that there are no moving objects in sight.
+ When you get near such a point you must dismount, and, leaving your horse,
+ crawl forward until you reach a point from where you have a good view, and
+ on no account stand up. While you are making your observations any Boers
+ who might be lying in sight would be certain to notice a figure against
+ the skyline, and we know that many of them are provided with glasses as
+ good as our own. We must be as careful as if we were out after game
+ instead of men. You all know these things as well as I do, but I want to
+ impress them upon you. You see, they have captured five of the Natal
+ police, who are a very sharp set of fellows. However, a few days' scouting
+ will show us far better what is required than any amount of thinking
+ beforehand. There is one thing that I want to say to you. You elected me
+ for your leader, but it is quite probable that when we have worked
+ together for a bit some of you may prove much better qualified for the
+ post than I am. What I want to say now is, if this is the case, I shall
+ feel in no way aggrieved, and shall serve just as cheerfully under his
+ orders as I hope you will under mine so long as I command you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general chorus of "No fear of that, Chris. We all know you
+ well enough to be sure that we have made a good choice. We knew it before
+ we left Johannesburg, but your pluck in walking up to that Boer with his
+ loaded rifle clenched the matter."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we shall see," Chris said. "I shall do my best, but, as I said, the
+ moment you want a change I shall be ready to resign; and now I think that
+ we may as well turn in. It is nine o'clock, and we must be up at daybreak.
+ Squads number one and two will each furnish a man for the first watch,
+ taking the first on the list alphabetically. At eleven they will be
+ relieved by two from squads three and four; then one and two furnish the
+ next pair, and so on. Four watches will take us on till daybreak. The two
+ of each squad who will be on duty to-night turn in to the same tent
+ together, then the others will not be disturbed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The blankets were spread in the little shelter tents, and all except the
+ two men on duty were soon asleep. Chris had a tent to himself, there being
+ an odd number, and an extra waterproof sheet had been carried for this
+ purpose. Before leaving Maritzburg twenty-two poles, a little longer than
+ cricket stumps, had been made under Chris's direction. They were shod with
+ iron, so that they could be driven into hard ground. At the top was a sort
+ of crutch, with a notch cut in it deep enough to hold another of the same
+ size. Twenty-two other sticks of the same length were to form the
+ ridgepoles. Half these were provided with a long brass socket, into which
+ its fellow fitted. The whole, when they were accompanied by the spare
+ horses, would be packed with their stores and spare blankets. At other
+ times each rider would carry two of the poles strapped to his valise
+ behind him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris was the first to stir in the morning. There was but the slightest
+ gleam of daylight in the sky, but he at once blew a whistle that he had
+ bought that evening in the town, and heads appeared almost immediately at
+ the entrances of the other tents, and in half a minute all were out, some
+ alert and ready for business, others yawning and stretching themselves,
+ according to their dispositions.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "First of all, let's put on the nose-bags, and let the horses have a
+ meal," Chris said; "then set to work to groom them. Remember, there must
+ not be a speck of yesterday's dust left anywhere."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All were soon hard at work. The Kaffirs stirred up the embers of the fire,
+ which they had replenished two or three times during the night, hung the
+ kettles again over it, and cut up slices of ham ready to fry. By half-past
+ five Chris, after inspecting all the horses closely, declared that nothing
+ more could be done to them. Then they were saddled, the valises, with a
+ day's provisions and a spare blanket, being strapped on. Then all had a
+ wash, and made themselves, as far as possible, tidy. By this time
+ breakfast was ready, and they had just finished their meal when a party of
+ horsemen were seen in the distance. Rifles were slung over their
+ shoulders, and bandoliers and belts full of cartridges strapped on, and
+ they donned their forage-caps after coiling up the picket-ropes and
+ halters and fastening them with their valises to the saddles. Then they
+ mounted and formed up in line just as the general, with two of his staff,
+ rode up. After saying a few words to Chris, the general examined the
+ horses and their riders closely.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very good and serviceable," he said, "and a really splendid set of
+ horses. Of course, gentlemen, you would look better if you were in
+ uniform, but for your purpose the clothes you have on are far more useful.
+ Let me see you in your hats; I can then better judge how you would pass as
+ Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads all slipped their forage-caps in their pockets, and put on their
+ felt hats, which were of different shapes and colours. As they had agreed
+ beforehand they at once dropped the upright position in which they had
+ been sitting, and assumed the careless, slouching attitude of the Boers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very good indeed," the general said with a laugh. "As far as appearances
+ go, you would pass anywhere. The only criticism I can make is that your
+ boots look too new, but that is a fault that will soon be mended. A few
+ days' knocking about, especially as I fancy we are going to have bad
+ weather, will take the shine out of them, and, once off, take good care
+ not to put it on again. A Boer with clean boots would be an anomaly
+ indeed. Now, I will detain you no longer."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The only manoeuvre the boys had to learn was the simple one of forming
+ fours. This they had practised on foot, and performed the manoeuvre with
+ fair accuracy. Then Chris gave the word, and, after saluting the general,
+ led the way off at a trot.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are a fine set of young fellows," the general said to the two
+ officers with him. "They are all sons of rich men, and have equipped
+ themselves entirely at their own expense. They are admirably mounted, and
+ provided they are not caught in an ambush, are not likely to see the
+ inside of a Boer prison. It says a good deal for their zeal that they are
+ ready to disguise themselves as Boer farmers instead of going in for smart
+ uniforms. However, they are right; for, speaking Dutch, as I hear they all
+ do, they should be able singly to mingle with the Boers and gather
+ valuable information."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as they were fairly south of the town, Chris said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now our work begins. Number one squad will make its way towards the
+ river, and follow its course, keeping always at a distance from it, so
+ that while they themselves would escape notice, they can ascertain whether
+ any bodies of the enemy are this side of it, or within sight beyond the
+ other bank. Number four will take the right flank, and keep a sharp
+ look-out in that direction. Squads two and three will, under my command,
+ scout between the flanking parties, and examine the farmhouses and the
+ country generally. The whole will, as I said last night, maintain a
+ distance of about three hundred yards apart, and each man will as far as
+ possible keep those next to him on either hand in sight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two flanking companies starting off, those under Chris separating as
+ they rode off until they were as far apart as he had ordered, and then
+ moved forward. When on level ground they went fast, but broke into a walk
+ whenever they came to the foot of rising ground, and when near the top
+ halted, dismounted, and crawled forward. Each man carried a Union Jack
+ about the size of a handkerchief, elastic rings being sewn to two of the
+ corners. When necessary these flags could be slipped over the rifles, and
+ a signal could be passed from one to another along the whole line&mdash;to
+ halt by waving the flag, to advance by holding the rifles steadily erect.
+ Other signals were to be invented in the future. Chris took his place in
+ the centre of the line, in readiness to ride to either flank from which a
+ signal might be given.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For five or six miles no signs of the enemy could be perceived. Most of
+ the fields were entirely deserted, but round a few of the scattered
+ farmhouses animals could be seen grazing, and these Chris set down as
+ belonging to Dutch farmers who had no fear of interference by the Boers,
+ and were prepared to join them as soon as they advanced. Many of these,
+ indeed, during the past fortnight had trekked north, and were already in
+ the ranks of the enemy. Presently Chris, who was constantly using his
+ glasses, saw the flutter of a flag on a hill away to the left, and a
+ minute later the signal to halt passed along the line. It had been agreed
+ that signalling by shot should not be attempted unless the enemy seen were
+ so far distant that they would not be likely to hear.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you see, Brown?" Chris said as he reached the lad who had first
+ signalled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are a good many men and animals round a farmhouse about two miles
+ away. The house lies under the shoulder of a hill to the left, I suppose
+ that that is why the others did not see it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Dismounting, Chris crawled forward with the other until he could obtain a
+ view across the country. As Brown had said, the farmhouse stood at the
+ foot of the line of hills they were crossing, and was fully a mile nearer
+ to those on the right flank than to the point from which he was looking at
+ it, but hidden from their view. Bringing his glass to bear upon it, he
+ could distinctly make out that some forty or fifty men were moving about,
+ and that a large quantity of cattle were collected near the house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is certainly a raiding party," he said to his companion. "They are too
+ strong for us to attack openly, at least if they are all Boers. It would
+ not do to lose half our number in our first fight. Still, we may be able
+ to frighten them off, and save the farmer, who is certainly a loyalist,
+ and cattle. You gallop along the line as far as it extends and order all
+ to come over to the right. I shall go on at once and get a view of the
+ ground close by. By the time they have all assembled we can see what had
+ best be done."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Going back to their horses they started in opposite directions. In a few
+ minutes Chris reached a point which he believed to be nearly behind the
+ farmhouse, picking up some of the scouts by the way.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I expect I shall be back in about a quarter of a hour," he said as he
+ dismounted. "You, Peters and Field, may as well come with me, I may want
+ to send back orders."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They walked forward fast until so far down the hill that they could obtain
+ a view of the farmhouse. The moment they did so they lay down, and made
+ their way across some broken ground until they were within a quarter of a
+ mile of it; then seated among some rocks they had a look through their
+ glasses, and could see everything that was passing as clearly as if they
+ had been standing in the farmyard. It was evident the Boers had only
+ arrived there a short time before Brown noticed them. Parties of two or
+ three were still driving in cattle, others were going in and out of the
+ house, some returning with such articles as they fancied and putting them
+ down by their horses in readiness to carry them off. Two men and some
+ women and children were standing together in a group; these were beyond
+ doubt the owners of the farmhouse.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How many Boers do you make out? I have counted thirty-eight." Peters had
+ made out forty, and Field forty-three, the difference being accounted for
+ by those going in and out of the house and sheds.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we will say forty-five, and then we shan't be far wrong. We
+ certainly can't attack that number openly, but we may drive them off
+ empty-handed if we take them by surprise." He examined the ground for
+ another minute or two, and then said: "I think we might make our way down
+ among these rocks to within three hundred yards of the house. I will send
+ six more down to you. With the others I will go down farther to the left,
+ and work along in that little donga running into the flat a hundred yards
+ to the east of the house. You keep a sharp look-out in that direction, and
+ you will be able to see us, while we shall be hidden from the Boers. We
+ shall halt about three hundred yards beyond the house. As soon as we are
+ ready I will wave a flag, then you and your party will open fire. Be sure
+ you hide yourselves well, so that they may not know how many of you there
+ are; they are certain, at the first alarm, to run to their horses and ride
+ off. Directly they do so we will open fire on them, and finding themselves
+ taken in the flank they are likely to bolt without hesitation. Don't throw
+ away a shot if you can help it, but empty your magazines as fast as you
+ can be sure of your aim. Between us we ought to account for a good many of
+ them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I understand, Chris; we will wait here till the others join us, and then,
+ as you say, we will work down as far as we can find cover."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris at once returned to the main party, who had by this time all
+ assembled. "We can bring our horses down a good bit farther without being
+ seen," he said. "There is a dip farther on with some rough brushwood. We
+ had better fasten them there; they have learned to stand pretty fairly,
+ but they might not do so if they heard heavy firing."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Leading their own horses and those of Field and Peters they walked down to
+ the spot Chris had chosen, and there threw the reins over the horses'
+ heads as usual, unfastened the head ropes, and tied them to the bushes.
+ Chris had already explained the situation to the troop, and had told off
+ six of them to go down to join Peters. He now advanced cautiously with
+ these till he could point out to them exactly the spot where the two
+ scouts were lying. Then he returned to the others, and they walked along
+ fast until they came upon the break in the hill, which lower down
+ developed into a depression, and was during the rains a water-course. Down
+ this they made their way. On reaching the bottom they found it was some
+ twelve feet below the level of the surrounding ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A couple of hundred yards further they could tell by the sound of
+ shouting, the bellowing of cattle, and other noises, that they were
+ abreast of the farmhouse, and going another three hundred yards they
+ halted. Chris went up the bank until he could obtain a view, and saw that
+ he was just at the spot he had fixed on. Making signs to the others, they
+ took their places as he had directed, some ten yards apart. Then he raised
+ his rifle after slipping the little flag upon it. A moment later came the
+ crack of a rifle, followed by other shots in quick succession. Chris, with
+ his eyes just above the level of the ground, could see all that was
+ passing round the farmhouse. With shouts of alarm the Boers at once rushed
+ towards their horses, several dropping before they reached them. As they
+ rode out from the yard the magazine rifles kept up a constant rattle,
+ sounding as if a strong company of troops were at work. Chris waited until
+ they were nearly abreast of his party, and then fired.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ His companions followed his example, and in a moment a fire as rapid and
+ effective as that still kept up from the hill was maintained. This
+ completed the stampede of the enemy. They were soon half a mile away, but
+ even at that distance the Mauser bullets continued to whistle over and
+ among them, and they continued their flight until lost in the distance.
+ Chris's whistle gave the signal for ceasing fire, and the two parties
+ sprang to their feet, gave three hearty cheers, and then ran towards the
+ farmhouse. In the yard lay five Boers and seven or eight horses; the
+ riders had jumped up behind companions, for as they passed, Chris had seen
+ that several of the animals were carrying double. The little group, so
+ lately prisoners, advanced as they came up, almost bewildered at the
+ sudden transformation that had taken place, their surprise being increased
+ on seeing that they had apparently been rescued by another party of Boers,
+ and still more when on their reaching them they found that these were all
+ mere lads.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are a party of Maritzburg Scouts," Chris said, with a smile at their
+ astonished faces; "though, as you see, we are got up as Boers so as to be
+ able to get close to them without exciting suspicion. We were fortunate in
+ just arriving in time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We thank you indeed, sir," the settler said, "for you have saved us the
+ loss of all our property, and, for aught I know, from being carried off as
+ prisoners. We were intending to trek down to Ladysmith today, and had just
+ driven in our herds when the Boers arrived. If they had been content with
+ stealing them, they would have been away before you arrived; but they
+ stopped to plunder everything they could carry off, and, as I should say,
+ from noises that we heard in the house, to smash up all the furniture they
+ could not carry off. We are indeed grateful to you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are very glad to have had the chance of giving the plunderers a
+ lesson," Chris said. "It will make them a little cautious in future. But I
+ think that you are wise to go at once, for there are certainly parties
+ between this and Elandslaagte, where they have cut the line; so I should
+ advise you to travel west for a bit before you strike down to Ladysmith.
+ We have not heard of any of them being beyond the line of railway yet. Now
+ we have work to do. Number one and two squads will at once go up and fetch
+ down the horses, number three and four will examine the Boers who have
+ fallen here and out on the plain and will bring in any who may be only
+ wounded."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He went out with this party; they found that eight more had fallen. Three
+ of these lay at a short distance from the farmhouse, and had evidently
+ fallen under the fire of the party on the hill; the others had been hit by
+ those in the ambuscade. Altogether ten horses had been killed. Five of the
+ Boers were still alive.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you a spare cart?" Chris asked the farmer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I can spare one. Fortunately I have a small one besides two large
+ waggons. May I ask what you want it for?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I want it to carry these wounded men to within reach of their friends.
+ Which is the nearest drift?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Vant's Drift, and it is there, no doubt, that the party crossed. It is a
+ little more than two miles away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then we will place the wounded in the cart, and you might send one of
+ your Kaffirs with it to the drift and stick up a pole with a sheet on it;
+ they are sure to have halted on the other side, and will guess that there
+ are wounded in it. As soon as the Kaffir comes within two or three hundred
+ yards of the river he can take the horses out and return. I dare say he
+ will be back again before you are off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The cart was driven along the line that the Boers had taken, the wounded
+ being carefully lifted and placed in it as it reached them. Two more were
+ found dead and three wounded some distance beyond the spot where the
+ searchers had turned, having fallen nearly a mile from the farm; the lads
+ who accompanied the cart then returned. Long before they reached the house
+ the horses had been brought down. The settler and his Kaffirs were hard at
+ work loading the stores into two ox-waggons. The lads all lent their
+ assistance, and in less than an hour the settlers started for Ladysmith,
+ the women and children in the wagon, and the men on horseback driving
+ their herds with the aid of the Kaffirs. After a hearty adieu, Chris and
+ his party rode on together for some little distance before again
+ scattering widely to recommence their work of scouting. Hitherto they had
+ been too busy for conversation, but now they were able to give words to
+ the satisfaction they all felt at their success.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It has been splendid!" Sankey said enthusiastically. "We have defeated a
+ force twice as strong as ourselves, have killed or badly wounded eighteen
+ of them, and you may be sure that of those that got away several must have
+ been hit. Not one of us has a scratch."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Splendid!" another exclaimed. "It could not have been better managed. I
+ think we ought to give three cheers for Chris." Three rousing cheers were
+ given. "After this, Chris," Carmichael said, "I don't think you need talk
+ any more about resigning the command. General Symons himself could not
+ have done better."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think, at any rate, we have begun to wipe off old scores," Chris said.
+ "We have paid for a few of the insults the ladies had to submit to as we
+ came along, and I am heartily glad that we were in time to do it. We have
+ baulked them of the haul they expected to make, and saved something like a
+ thousand head of cattle for the colony, to say nothing of preventing these
+ people from being absolutely ruined. It is only a pity that we had not our
+ horses with us. If we had, not many of the Boers would have recrossed the
+ river. But we could not have taken them with us without being detected
+ before we got into position, and in that case we might have had a hard
+ fight, and matters would probably have turned out altogether differently."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general expression of assent, for all felt that in an equal
+ fight the Boers, being twice their own numbers, would have been more than
+ a match for them. It was evening when they returned to Dundee, having come
+ across no more Boers during the day's work. Directly they arrived at the
+ little camp where they had left the tents standing in charge of their two
+ Kaffirs, Chris wrote a short report of their doings, stating briefly that
+ they had come upon a party of forty-five Boers in the act of driving off
+ the cattle and sacking the house of Mr. Fraser, a loyal settler. Having
+ dismounted and divided into two parties, they had attacked the Boers and
+ driven them off, with the loss of ten killed and eight seriously wounded
+ left on the field. Many of their horses had been killed. The wounded Boers
+ had been sent in a cart to Vant's Drift, and the farmer and his herds had
+ been escorted as far as the line of railway, which they had crossed and
+ were making for Ladysmith. There had been no casualties among his party.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Field rode over with this report and delivered it at headquarters,
+ remaining to ask whether there were any orders for the next day. When he
+ returned he brought a line from the general. It contained only the words,
+ "I congratulate you most heartily. The affair must have been managed
+ excellently, and does you all the greatest credit. Continue scouting on
+ the same line to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads were all highly delighted when Chris read this aloud, and then
+ sat down to a well-earned meal, which was the more enjoyed as it had been
+ voted that Field, as one of the finance committee, should go into the town
+ and buy half a dozen of champagne in honour of their first victory. In the
+ course of the evening one of the general's staff rode into camp on his way
+ to town, having been requested by him to obtain full particulars of the
+ fight at Eraser's farm. He took his seat by the fire with them, and Chris
+ gave him a full account of their proceedings.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Upon my word, Mr. King," he said, "you managed the matter admirably; no
+ cavalry leader could have done it better."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no particular credit about the management," Chris said; "we
+ acted just as we should have done had we been stalking a herd of deer
+ instead of a party of Boers. One always manages, if possible, to put a
+ party on the line by which they are likely to take flight, before crawling
+ up within shot. If we could have taken our horses down with us before we
+ opened fire we should have done so, and being so well mounted, I think few
+ of them would have got away; but we could not manage it without risking
+ being seen, and in that case the Boers, on making out what our strength
+ was, would certainly have shown fight; and even if we had beaten them,
+ which I don't suppose we should have done, we should have suffered
+ heavily."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You were quite right not to risk it," the officer said; "we know by old
+ experience that the Boers are formidable antagonists when behind shelter,
+ and, accustomed as they are to shooting on horseback, I dare say they will
+ do well when not opposed by regular cavalry, who, I am convinced, would
+ ride through and through them. I am quite sure that in the open they will
+ not be able to make any stand whatever against infantry, which is the more
+ important, as in so hilly a country as Natal our cavalry would seldom be
+ able to act with advantage."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the course of conversation he told them that there was no news of any
+ large body of the Boers being near. Joubert's force had not moved out of
+ Newcastle, and nothing had been heard of the Free Staters or of the
+ Utrecht force under Lucas Meyer. "We have sentries on all the lower hills
+ round here and Glencoe, and there is no fear of our being surprised. The
+ sooner they come the better, for we are all longing to get at them; and I
+ can tell you we felt quite jealous when we heard of your spirited affair
+ to-day. I can assure you that we shall have a greater respect for the
+ volunteers than we had before, and if all do as well as you have done
+ to-day they will be a most valuable addition to our force."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After their visitor had left, they sat chatting round a fire till ten
+ o'clock, and then turned in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0005" id="link2HCH0005"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER V &mdash; THE FIRST BATTLE
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ All in the little camp, save the two sentries, slept soundly until, at two
+ in the morning, they awoke with a sudden start. A deep boom and a strange
+ rushing sound was in their ears. With exclamations of surprise they all
+ scrambled out of their tents.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What is that?" Chris asked the sentry.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is a big gun on the top of that high hill they call Talana. We saw the
+ flash of light, and directly after heard the report, and a rushing sound.
+ I suppose it was a shot overhead; if it had been a shell we should have
+ heard it burst and seen the flash. It must have been fired at the camp."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The horses, startled by the report, were plunging and kicking, and the
+ lads at once ran to their heads and patted and soothed them. Not until
+ they were quiet did they gather again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What time is it?" Chris asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The clock on the church struck two a few minutes ago," Brown, who was on
+ sentry, said. As he spoke another gun boomed from Talana, or as it was
+ generally called in the town, Smith's Hill, from a farm owned by a settler
+ of that name at its foot. It was about a mile and a half east of the town,
+ and therefore some three miles from the camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It must be a very heavy gun by its sound&mdash;as big as the largest of
+ those we have heard fired from that fort above Johannesburg. Joubert must
+ have started from Newcastle early to have managed to get it up there by
+ this time, or it may be the force from Utrecht; anyhow, they must be
+ strong to venture to attack us in this way. We may as well saddle up,
+ though it is hardly likely the cavalry will be engaged. I shall not send
+ to camp for orders; the general will have enough to think about, and it
+ will make no matter where twenty men place themselves. However, I shall
+ ride over to camp and see what is going on there; it is likely enough that
+ there will be an attack by the Free Staters on the other side. Carmichael
+ and Horrocks, do you run into the town and see what is going on there. I
+ will not start till you get back; if any of the staff see me they may ask
+ some questions about it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a quarter of an hour the two lads returned. The people there were
+ completely scared at the unexpected attack, and the streets were full of
+ half-dressed men; however, they seemed to be getting over their first
+ terror, now that they found it was the camp and not the town that was
+ being fired at, and the volunteer corps was already gathering in readiness
+ for orders.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We may be pretty sure that nothing will be done till daylight," Chris
+ said. "Our men know the ground now, and none of the Transvaal Boers can do
+ so, and I don't think they will venture to move till they can see their
+ way about. I am glad, indeed, that most of the women and children were
+ sent off two days ago, and that the scare on the evening that we arrived,
+ when the news came of the railway being cut at Elandslaagte, sent the
+ greater part of the men who had remained behind, and who did not mean
+ fighting, off by road. If they bombard the town they may do damage to
+ property, but there will be no great loss of life. You had better give the
+ horses a feed&mdash;that is, if they are disposed to eat at this hour&mdash;while
+ I am away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On reaching the camp, Chris found all the troops under arms. They had been
+ roused before the Boer fire began, as a picket to the east of Dundee had
+ been attacked and driven in. It was not, however, supposed that the Boers
+ were in force until their guns opened fire. All lights were out in the
+ camp, and the enemy's shot had gone wide. It was by no means clear why the
+ Boers should have betrayed their presence on the top of the hill until it
+ was light enough for them to use their guns with effect. Chris had, before
+ starting, put on his flat cap.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As he approached the camp he was challenged by a sentry: "Who comes
+ there?" and on his replying, "An officer of the Maritzburg Scouts," the
+ sentry called out: "Advance, officer of the Maritz Scouts, and give the
+ countersign."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Fortunately, as it happened, the officer had given it to Chris on his
+ visit to their camp, and he therefore answered at once, "Ladysmith," and
+ was relieved when the sentry called out, "Ladysmith pass, and all is
+ well."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When he entered the camp he found the men were standing in lines, but at
+ ease, with their rifles piled in front of them, and there was a hum of
+ conversation in the ranks. At the head-quarter tents everybody was astir.
+ Presently an officer came up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Who are you?" he asked as he advanced.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am in command of the party of Maritzburg Scouts."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Mr. King, is it not?" the officer asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir. I have ridden in to ask if there are any orders."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, and there will be none issued until it is daylight, and we can make
+ out how matters stand and what is the force of the Boers. It is not likely
+ that you will have any special orders, but can act with the cavalry and
+ mounted infantry."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, sir. Then I will ride back at once." On returning to camp, he
+ said: "There is nothing to be done till morning. So far they have no idea
+ of the force of the Boers. This is just the work we were formed for.
+ Peters, you and Field and Horrocks certainly speak Dutch better than any
+ of the others. It is half-past two now, and we have at least two and a
+ half hours of darkness, therefore I propose we try to find out what force
+ the Boers have got up there. It is no use for more than four of us to go,
+ so the others can turn in, except the two sentries; but all will, of
+ course, be ready to mount in case any party of Boers should come down upon
+ the town before it is light. The next time I want three men on special
+ duty I will give others a chance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Shall we ride, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think so. Of course it will be more difficult getting up there in the
+ dark; but I shall make a detour of three or four miles, and come up on the
+ other side, and we should be much more likely to be questioned if we were
+ on foot than on horseback. Should we come upon any party of armed Boers,
+ remember we have just arrived from Standerton, and finding when we got to
+ Newcastle that the force had moved on, and were to take up their station
+ at Talana Hill, we rode on to overtake them. When we get fairly there
+ among them, we will dismount; Field and Peters will stand by the four
+ horses, Horrocks and I will go on. If you hear a row, you will mount and
+ wait a minute or two, and then if we do not come, you will ride off with
+ our horses as well as your own. We shall try and make our way to the edge
+ of the hill, and ought to be able to slip away in the darkness if we can
+ get there before we are shot down or overtaken. However, I don't think
+ there is much chance of our being recognized. Indeed, I expect most of
+ them will be lying down for a sleep before the time comes for action. If
+ there is one thing a Boer hates it is being kept awake at night. I will
+ take one of the Kaffir boys with us. They can see in the dark a great deal
+ better than we can; and as the Boers are sure to have some natives with
+ them, he is quite as likely to pick up news as we are&mdash;more so,
+ perhaps, for the natives will sit and talk all night while their masters
+ are snoring. I think the one we call Jack is the sharpest."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Jack was called up, and on being told what was required, at once agreed to
+ accompany them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No time was lost. Chris and his three companions mounted, and with the
+ Kaffir running alongside they set off at a trot. Keeping to the north of
+ east, they rode on for some two miles, Jack leading the way with as much
+ ease as if it had been daylight. When they had, as they calculated, come
+ upon the ground the Boers must have passed over, they turned south, and
+ kept on until they saw the dark mass of Talana on their right, and made
+ towards it. On this side the hill sloped gradually, while on that facing
+ Dundee it was extremely steep and strewn with boulders. They were now
+ going at a walk, and they soon came upon an immense gathering of waggons,
+ carts, oxen and ponies, crowded without any order, just as they had
+ arrived two hours before. "There is no fear of our being detected," Chris
+ said in a whisper, "and we can't do better than stop here. There is no
+ getting the horses through this crowd, and if we did manage to do so there
+ would be no getting them back, certainly not in a hurry. You had better
+ lie down beside them, it is not likely that any Boers will be coming up or
+ down. If the whole camp is like this there is not the slightest fear of
+ our getting caught." Jack had already been instructed that when he got
+ into the camp he was to leave them and join any party of Kaffirs he found
+ awake, and talk to them as if he were one of the bullock drivers. As Chris
+ and his companions returned, the former would blow his whistle softly, and
+ he was then to make his way down to the horses at once.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Passing on unquestioned they neared the top of the hill, having left the
+ mass of the vehicles behind them. There were, however, large numbers of
+ ponies assembled here in readiness should their masters require them.
+ Hitherto they had heard no voices since entering the camp, but as they
+ went farther they heard talking. Here the fighting men were assembled. For
+ the most part they were lying down; some were asleep; others, however,
+ were moving about, and joining or leaving groups gathered together
+ discussing the events of the next day. Horrocks and Chris now separated
+ and joined different parties, some twenty yards from each other. They
+ attracted no attention whatever. Their appearance in their broad hats and
+ rough clothing, their bandoliers and rifles, was precisely similar to that
+ of the men standing about.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No doubt whatever that the morning would bring them a brilliant victory,
+ appeared to be entertained by the enemy. The artillery would first crush
+ that of the British, then they would charge down and finish the affair.
+ "They say that they have less than four thousand altogether," one said.
+ "We are as many, and, as everyone knows, one Boer is a match for any three
+ rooineks. It will not be a fight, it will be slaughter. We shall stop a
+ day to gather the plunder and send it off in the waggons, then we shall go
+ south and destroy the force at Ladysmith. Three days later we shall be in
+ Maritzburg, and within three or four days afterwards shall drive the
+ British on board their ships at Durban. We shall get grand plunder there
+ and at Maritzburg. But I think it is time now to take a hand at building
+ up that wall along the front. Ebers' commando have been at it for three
+ hours, and it is our turn now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: CHRIS AND HIS COMPANIONS SCOUTING.]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general movement, which was accelerated by a sharp order, and
+ a minute later Horrocks and Chris again came together and moved on with
+ the others. Three hundred yards farther they came upon six guns, beyond
+ which a number of men were at work carrying and placing great stones to
+ form a rough wall. These left off their work as soon as the party arrived.
+ Having now seen all that was necessary, the two lads joined them and
+ returned with them down the hill. The others threw themselves down near
+ their horses, but Chris and his companion went on. Through the huge
+ gathering of waggons they made their way with great difficulty, Chris
+ giving a low whistle occasionally. At last they were through the camp.
+ Jack was standing by the horses, and Peters and Field at once rose to
+ their feet. Without a word they mounted, and rode without speaking till
+ they were some little distance from the waggons.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are back earlier than I expected," Field said. "You have been gone
+ scarcely an hour."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; the only difficulty we had was making our way through the mass of
+ waggons and animals all mixed up higgledy-piggledy, and there has been no
+ more excitement than if we had been walking through Dundee. We have got
+ all we wanted to know. Their strength is about four thousand. They have
+ six guns. They are building a stone wall along the brow of the hill, and
+ they are cock-sure that they are going to thrash us without difficulty."
+ Field and Peters laughed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are fools to count their chickens before they are hatched," the
+ latter said. "If they think it is going to be another Laing's Nek business
+ they will find themselves mightily mistaken, though it will be a very
+ difficult business to scale that hill from the other side under such a
+ rifle fire as they will keep up."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Jack had now taken his place ahead of them again, and kept there with
+ ease, although, they broke into a canter as soon as they reached the level
+ ground. In half an hour they reached their camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, Jack," Chris said when he had dismounted, "we have not heard what
+ news you have picked up."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not much news, baas. Talk with some Kaffirs; all hope that we beat them
+ to-day, but think we cannot do so. Too many Boers and big guns. They say
+ Boers very angry because the other commandos not here, and Free State
+ Boers not arrived. They sure going to beat the rooineks, but are afraid
+ that some may get away. If Joubert and Free Staters here, catch them in a
+ trap and kill them all."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Such was the substance of Jack's answer in his own language. By this time
+ the rest of the party had turned out to hear the news. They had had but
+ little sleep, for all were intensely anxious as to the fate of their four
+ comrades, and although delighted that they had returned safely, were a
+ little disappointed on finding that the affair had been so tame and
+ unexciting. While they were talking the two Kaffirs had stirred up the
+ fire, put some wood and some coal on, and hung up the kettle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is right, Jack," Chris said; "day will begin to break in half an
+ hour, and we may have to be moving." All was quiet until half-past five,
+ and the lads had just finished their meal when the Boer guns opened fire,
+ and two or three minutes later those of the British replied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is an uncomfortable feeling sitting here with that terrific roaring
+ noise overhead," Chris said. "One knows that there is not the slightest
+ risk of being hit, but, to say the least of it, it is very unpleasant.
+ There, a shell has just burst over the camp. So it is shell that they are
+ firing."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Indeed, the Boers had been using these missiles only, but owing to some
+ fault in the loading, or the badness of the fuses, they fell for the most
+ part without bursting. It was soon evident to the lads that the range of
+ the British guns was shorter than that of the heavier pieces from Talana.
+ The distance was five thousand yards, and the elevated position of the
+ Boer guns added to the advantage given by their superior weight.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will ride in now," Chris said as he got up from breakfast, "and tell
+ the staff what we have gathered as to the Boers' strength." He had on his
+ way down the hill exchanged his hat for his forage-cap, and taking
+ Horrocks with him he galloped to the camp. Sir Penn Symons was standing on
+ a small elevation watching the fire. Chris rode up and saluted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no orders for you, Mr. King, except that when the fighting is over
+ you will join the cavalry in pursuit."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, sir; I have not come for orders, but to report to you that
+ with Mr. Horrocks and two others, and one of our Kaffir servants, I
+ entered the Boer camp last night in order to ascertain their strength."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You did!" the general exclaimed in surprise. "You hear that, gentlemen?"
+ he said, turning round to three or four of his staff standing but a short
+ distance behind him. "Mr. King and three of his party absolutely entered
+ the Boer camp last night to discover their force. Well, sir, what was the
+ result?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are about four thousand of them, sir, over rather than under, and
+ they have six guns, all of heavy calibre. When I was there they were at
+ work building a thick wall some five feet high of rough stones along the
+ edge of the hill. It will scarcely shelter the guns, but it will provide
+ cover for the riflemen at the edge of the hill. There is an immense
+ gathering of waggons and carts&mdash;there are certainly not less than a
+ thousand of them&mdash;in a confused mass behind the hill. Arriving in the
+ dark, each seems to have gone on until it could get no farther. The
+ fighting men are all on the top of the hill, and between them and the
+ waggons are their ponies. They certainly could not ride away till the
+ waggons have been passed through, but possibly a passage may have been
+ left on each side of these for them to get through, in order, as is their
+ intention, to charge your army when their guns have silenced your
+ artillery. I gathered that expected commandos had not come up. They were
+ disappointed at hearing nothing of the Free Staters, who they expected
+ would have attacked Glencoe from the other side. They are absolutely
+ confident of success, and expect to overwhelm General White at Ladysmith
+ in three days from now, and to be in Pietermaritzburg in a week, and are
+ talking of driving the last rooinek on board the ships at Durban shortly
+ after."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The general smiled. "I am much obliged to you for your information, Mr.
+ King, and am much pleased at the courage with which you and your
+ companions entered the Boer camp to obtain it. It is satisfactory to learn
+ that their force is not much greater than our own. It is also useful to
+ know that their ponies are gathered so close to them, for shells that go
+ over the hill may burst among them; and I believe that one of the Boers'
+ most vulnerable points is their horses, for without them they would feel
+ absolutely lost. I am sure, Mr. King, that you would wish to be in the
+ thick of the fighting, but I would rather that you curbed your
+ impetuosity, for after the manner in which you obtained this news for me,
+ I can see that your party will do far greater service in scouting and in
+ gaining intelligence than they could afford in action. I should advise you
+ to shift your camp, as the troops are about to advance into the town, and
+ the enemy's shot will soon be falling there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A few minutes later two field batteries moved forward and took up their
+ position south of Dundee, escorted by the mounted infantry and the rifles.
+ The third battalion of the Lancashire regiment remained to protect the
+ camp should it be attacked by the Free Staters, while the Dublin Fusiliers
+ and the Royal Irish Fusiliers were to march through the town to a donga or
+ river-bed half a mile to the east. Beyond this the long ascent to Talana
+ begins. The King's Royal Rifles were to take up a position under cover to
+ the east of the town.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris had ridden back fast to Dundee. The work of taking down the tents
+ and packing their materials and all the stores on to the spare horses took
+ but a few minutes, and two of the lads went with the two natives and saw
+ the horses safely placed in a sharp depression half a mile away, in which
+ they would be safe from Boer shells. Chris had told his companions what
+ the general had said. They all looked disappointed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We shall have plenty of opportunities afterwards, and it is a compliment
+ that he considers we had better reserve ourselves for scouting, which,
+ after all, is the work we always intended to carry out. Still, though,
+ after what he has said, we cannot absolutely join the cavalry, we will
+ manage somehow to see some of the fighting without getting into the thick
+ of it. Besides, I should say that in any case the whole brunt of the
+ affair must fall upon the infantry and artillery. If they silence the Boer
+ guns and capture the hill, the battle is won, and the cavalry will have to
+ wait for their chance till they can get the Boers to fight on ground where
+ they can act."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Drizzling rain had now set in, but this and the fact that they had started
+ without breakfast in no way abated the spirits of the troops who soon came
+ along, marching with light step and eager faces which showed that they
+ were delighted at the prospect of action. The batteries to the right had
+ already come into play, and a vigorous cannonade was being directed at the
+ crest of the hill, from which the Boer guns kept up a slower though steady
+ fire in return.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "While nothing else is doing we may just as well ride over and see how
+ things are getting on there," Chris said. And as soon as the two Irish
+ regiments had passed, the little troop trotted across to the rising ground
+ and dismounted a few hundred yards from the guns. They soon saw with
+ satisfaction that the fire of the Boers was far from effective, their aim
+ was not good, and a very small proportion of the shells burst; while on
+ the other hand the shrapnel from the British batteries burst with splendid
+ accuracy over the crest of the hill. For two hours the artillery duel
+ continued, then the Boer guns gradually ceased their fire. The mist that
+ had partly shrouded the summit of Talana, eight hundred feet above the
+ plain, and the smoke that still hung thickly there, rendered it impossible
+ to say whether they had all been put out of action or simply withdrawn,
+ but when it cleared off they could no longer be seen. It was now the turn
+ of the infantry. Beyond the donga in which they were lying the rise of the
+ ground was gradual, up to a plantation which surrounded Smith's farm.
+ Beyond this the ground was rocky. The men advanced at the double in open
+ order, and the moment they were seen by the Boers a continuous fire of
+ musketry was opened. The distance was about a mile, but the Mauser rifles
+ had a much greater range than this and the bullets pattered thickly on the
+ ground. Only four men, however, fell. The two regiments halted in the
+ plantation and farm buildings, and the advanced line at the edge of the
+ trees opened fire in answer to that to which they were exposed. The
+ general at first had taken up his position with the guns, but as soon as
+ the men advanced from the donga he joined them and accompanied them as far
+ as the plantation. Then he returned to the battery, which continued its
+ fire with greater activity to prepare the way for the further advance of
+ the infantry.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Rifles had joined the two Irish regiments, and at half-past nine
+ General Symons galloped up to the farm and gave the order for the advance.
+ This was received with a cheer by the men, who had been impatiently
+ awaiting it. Scarcely had the cheer died away when the general was
+ mortally wounded by a bullet that struck him in the stomach. Unconscious
+ that the wound was so severe he retained his seat a minute or two, and was
+ then carried by the Indian bearer company into the town. The troops,
+ ignorant of the misfortune that had befallen them, were now working their
+ way up the hill, taking advantage of every stone and boulder, and although
+ exposed to a terrific fire, gradually pushing on until they reached a
+ stone wall which ran round the face of the hill. Beyond this the ground
+ was much rougher and very much steeper&mdash;so steep, indeed, that it was
+ almost impossible to climb it. The fire of the enemy was now terrific. The
+ troops were some three hundred yards from the crest, and it was certain
+ death to show a head above the wall. An officer placed his helmet on the
+ end of his sword, and the moment he raised it, it was riddled by five
+ balls.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For a time it was impossible to advance farther, but when the Boer fire
+ moderated a little the order ran along the line for the men to storm the
+ position. A signal was made to the artillery to cease fire, and as it did
+ so the men leapt over the wall and rushed forward. There was now no
+ thought of taking shelter or returning the Boers' fire, every effort was
+ needed for surmounting the difficulties in their way. In some places the
+ rock was so steep that the men had to climb on their hands and knees,
+ sometimes those below pushed their comrades up and were in turn assisted
+ by them to climb. The roar of musketry was unceasing. It seemed to be an
+ impossibility for any man to reach the top unscathed, and yet there was no
+ hesitation or wavering. Numbers fell, but panting and determined the rest
+ pressed on. The Rifles suffered most heavily, and out of the seventeen
+ officers who advanced with them five were killed and seven wounded. At
+ last the steepest part of the ascent was surmounted. Those who first
+ reached this point waited until joined by others, and then fixing bayonets
+ they rushed up the slope to the edge of the plateau cheering loudly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers did not await the onset; the great body had already fled. They
+ had believed it impossible for mortal men to scale the hill under their
+ continuous fire, and our steady advance through the hail of bullets had
+ astounded them and shaken their courage. The artillery, after ceasing
+ fire, had galloped off at full speed and taken up their position on the
+ ridge known as Smith's Nek, overlooking the plain behind the hill. For a
+ distance of three miles this was covered with waggons and galloping men.
+ The guns were about to open fire upon them when a white flag was hoisted,
+ and, believing that the Boers had surrendered, the gunners abstained from
+ firing. It was, however, but the first of numerous similar acts of
+ treachery, and the Boers were thus enabled to make their escape.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The appearance of the plateau gained by the troops was appalling. Some
+ five hundred of the Boers lay dead or wounded, and many had doubtless been
+ carried off. Three of the guns lay dismounted, the others had been
+ removed; for as they could not be sufficiently depressed to bear upon the
+ stormers, they had been taken off as soon as the advance began in earnest.
+ Beyond the plateau smashed waggons and dead animals lay thickly. Great
+ numbers of the Boer ponies had been killed; many were still standing
+ quietly waiting for their masters, lying dead above.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Pursuit was out of the question. The men were exhausted by their efforts;
+ they were wet to the skin by the rain that had for nine hours come down
+ unceasingly; they had had no food since the previous day, and the
+ tremendous climb had taxed their powers to the utmost. For a time they
+ cheered vociferously, the first joy of victory overcoming the thought of
+ their dead and wounded comrades, who had to be collected and carried down.
+ The loss had been severe, ten officers and thirty men had been killed,
+ twenty officers and a hundred and sixty-five men wounded; and nine
+ officers and two hundred and eleven men did not answer to the roll-call.
+ This loss was unaccountable.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris, as soon as the infantry advance began, had, after talking with the
+ others, agreed to set out in the direction in which the three squadrons of
+ cavalry had started in the morning with instructions to work round, and be
+ prepared to cut off the enemy's retreat. They had with them some of the
+ mounted infantry and a machine-gun.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the whole Boer force would be concentrated on the hill, Chris thought
+ that there would be no danger in riding round, especially as, even had the
+ Boers posted a force to protect their line of retreat, he was confident
+ that the speed of his horses would prevent any chance of capture. From
+ some natives he learned the direction that the cavalry had taken, and
+ presently on rising ground, saw two parties halted in hollows some two
+ miles apart. The farthest out on the plain appeared to be the largest, and
+ to this he rode. The officer in command had seen him in camp, and as he
+ saluted on riding up, said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "So you have come to lend us a hand, sir? Can you tell me how matters are
+ going on at Dundee?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "At the time we rode off, sir, the advance of the infantry had just begun,
+ the Boer guns had been silenced, and our men were advancing from Smith's
+ farm under a very heavy fire of the enemy, which continued without
+ intermission as long as we were within hearing distance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Did you see the other squadron as you came along?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are in a hollow two miles away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Ah! that is where we left them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The troopers were all dismounted, and the scouts followed the example. The
+ boom of the British guns was continuing unabated. "They can be getting on
+ but slowly," the officer said. "I am afraid we shall find it a very tough
+ job. I suppose there is a strong force up there?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Over four thousand."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How do you know?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I was up there last night," Chris said, "with three of the others. We did
+ not go up in these caps, as you may suppose, but in wide-brimmed hats. We
+ were able to get about without exciting any suspicion whatever. We found
+ they had six guns and over four thousand men. As we all speak Dutch
+ fluently there was really no chance of our being detected."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The other officers of the squadron had all gathered round.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Danger or no danger, it was a very plucky action," their leader said. "I
+ suppose that was the news you brought in just before the troops marched
+ off. Well, I wish that we had got our breakfast and the horses a feed
+ before we started. It is more important for the horses than it is for us,
+ though I should not be sorry for breakfast myself."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have some food in our haversacks, sir. We breakfasted before we
+ started, and we filled our haversacks with biscuits, thinking that perhaps
+ they would be welcome, for we knew that none of the troops had anything to
+ eat before leaving."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are very good to offer it," the colonel said. "But we could not eat
+ while the men have nothing."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It will go round, sir, though it will be but a small portion for each. We
+ each put about ten pounds of biscuits in our haversacks, and shall not be
+ sorry to get rid of the weight. It will make something like three-quarters
+ of a pound per man all round."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "More than that," the officer said. "I am indeed greatly obliged to you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The haversacks were emptied and divided into four heaps of equal size,
+ with a proportionate heap for the ten officers. Four men were called up
+ from each troop, and in a short time the soldiers were all munching
+ biscuits, every man dividing his rations with his horse. The sight of the
+ rough-looking troop had at first excited some amusement and a little
+ derision among the soldiers, but this feeling was now exchanged for
+ gratitude, and it was unanimously agreed that these young farmers were a
+ capital set of fellows. The hours passed slowly until the officers,
+ through their glasses, saw a great movement in the encampment on the hill.
+ The waggons standing lowest separated from the others, and gradually a
+ general movement set in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Our men must be gaining ground," the colonel said, "and the Boers are
+ beginning to funk."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The bits were put into the horses' mouths again, the saddles buckled up
+ tightly, and an expression of satisfaction succeeded that of disgust at
+ the long hours standing in the pouring rain. Presently, when the leading
+ waggons were abreast of them, at a distance of about a mile, the order was
+ given to mount, and the two squadrons dashed across the plain and were
+ soon among the fugitives. There were many mounted men among them, these
+ being the first to steal away from the fight. They opened fire as the
+ cavalry approached, but were soon overthrown or driven away in headlong
+ flight. Many of the waggons were seized, but each moment their defenders
+ became stronger. The Boers were now flocking down in great numbers, and
+ seeing their teams and property in danger they dismounted, formed some of
+ the waggons up in a square, and from them opened a heavy fire upon the
+ troopers. Chris dismounted his party, and returned the fire, but the
+ officer in command, seeing that with so small a force of infantry he could
+ do nothing, and that the numbers of their enemies were increasing, drew
+ off. He would have continued the fight, but he supposed that the artillery
+ would soon be at work, and knew they could not open fire as long as he was
+ engaging the Boers, he therefore retired with the long train of captured
+ waggons, and late in the afternoon reached camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Nothing was seen of the other squadron and mounted infantry, nor was any
+ news received of them until the following day, when a medical officer with
+ some wounded men came in. Like the larger force, they too had ridden in
+ among the waggons, but had taken a more northerly line, and had come on a
+ point where the Boers were thickest. They had charged and taken several
+ prisoners, and inflicted severe loss on the enemy. These, however, had
+ swarmed round them, keeping up an incessant fire and barring their
+ retreat. They took up a defensive position in a farm, and for three hours
+ repelled all the attacks of the Boers, until their horses were all killed
+ or had broken away and the ammunition exhausted, while the Boers had just
+ brought up the three guns they had withdrawn from the hill. Further
+ resistance would have ended in the extermination of the whole party, and
+ Lieutenant-Colonel Möller was therefore obliged to surrender.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0006" id="link2HCH0006"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VI &mdash; ELANDSLAAGTE
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The scouts erected their tents again on their former ground. The remaining
+ inhabitants of Dundee were jubilant over the victory that had been won,
+ and did their best, by hanging out flags from the windows, to decorate the
+ town. Jack and his companion had returned to the camp with the spare
+ horses as soon as the hill was carried, and had the fires lighted by the
+ time the party came in. In spite of having worn their blankets as cloaks,
+ all were wet through, but after changing their clothes, they went into the
+ town to gather the news of how the hill had been won, and by the time they
+ returned their meal was ready.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you think of affairs, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think that the officer at Ladysmith was right, and that it was a
+ frightful mistake to divide the force and send four thousand men up here.
+ They have thrashed the Boers today, but they may be back again on the top
+ of that hill tomorrow. Besides, we know that Joubert's force was not
+ engaged to-day, and they and the Free Staters will be gathering round. We
+ might win another victory, but we are certain to be obliged to fall back
+ soon, and my opinion is that we shall be very lucky if we get through
+ safely."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Why not start to-morrow morning, Chris?" Peters said. "We shall be of no
+ use scouting here, and not much use if there is hard fighting. I hear that
+ some natives have brought in the news that there was some firing to-day at
+ Elandslaagte. If that is the case, we must have troops there, and the
+ chances are that they will be there to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, that is very likely," Chris agreed. "General White will be sure to
+ hold the line there if he can, for he must feel sure that the force here
+ will have to retreat now that it is attacked in earnest. When we were
+ talking to-day to the cavalry, one of the officers mentioned that we had
+ still telegraphic communication with Ladysmith, for although the wires by
+ the railway are cut, it is possible to communicate through Helpmakaar. The
+ Boers seem to have forgotten that, for it is quite out of the direct line,
+ and nearly double as far round. Well, as we had no orders to come here, I
+ suppose there is no occasion to get orders to go back. I think Peters's
+ proposal is a very good one, but on a point like this everyone ought to
+ give an opinion. My view is that we might be a great deal more useful
+ there than here, and that if we stop we shall run a great chance of being
+ captured. I think that it would be a fair thing to put it to the vote."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He took two or three leaves out of his pocket-book, and tore them up into
+ narrow slips of paper.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," he said, "write 'Yes' if you are in favour of going back, 'No' if
+ you are for stopping here. Drop them into my cap and the majority shall
+ decide."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the strips of paper were examined, it was found that only two out of
+ the twenty-one were in favour of remaining.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That settles it," Chris said. "It is thirty miles down to Elandslaagte by
+ road, and as from here to Glencoe is five miles, and we are no nearer
+ there than we are here, by cutting across to Waschbrank we shall have only
+ five-and-twenty miles to ride. It is well that we should get there as
+ early as possible, so we will settle to start at five o'clock, which will
+ take us there by eight, in time to see anything that is going on. No doubt
+ we shall be able to hear from natives as we go along whether the troops
+ are still there; at any rate if they are, we are sure to hear firing
+ before we get there, unless, of course, the Boers have retired."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The horses had already had an extra feed, and the Kaffirs were warned of
+ the hour at which they were going to start. The pack-horses were able to
+ keep up with the rest, for their loads were by no means heavy&mdash;in
+ fact, they carried less weight than the others. The two hundred pounds of
+ biscuits given to the hussars made no difference in their baggage, for
+ this had been bought at Dundee, as the lads decided to keep their stores
+ as far as possible intact for a time when they might for some days be away
+ scouting in a district where no provisions could be obtained.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At four o'clock the sentries roused the others, and having taken a cup of
+ coffee and some cold meat and bread, and led the horses down to the stream
+ while the Kaffirs were loading up the packets and bundles, they mounted at
+ five o'clock and set off at a trot, Jack and Japhet, a name suggested by
+ Field, who was the wag of the party, were allowed to ride on two of the
+ horses that carried the lightest burdens. All the lads were provided with
+ compasses, but these were not necessary, as both the natives were well
+ acquainted with the country, which was wild and mountainous.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When they reached Wessels station, nine miles from Elandslaagte, they
+ heard the sound of guns. At this proof that there was still a force there,
+ they turned off from the road, and riding west, struck the point where the
+ main road to Meran crossed the Sundays River, and then, still keeping a
+ mile west of the line of railway, found themselves abreast of the station.
+ Just as they did so, a body of mounted volunteers galloped up towards
+ them. As soon as they were seen, they exchanged their hats for
+ forage-caps, and some of them, by Chris's orders, hoisted their
+ union-jacks on their rifles.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is well that you raised those flags," the officer in command said. "We
+ made sure by your appearance that you were Boers, and rather took your
+ change of caps as one of their slim devices, and had our rifles ready to
+ give you a warm reception. I suppose you come from Dundee? We heard news
+ yesterday evening of the battle, and were sorry to hear how heavy the
+ losses were, and particularly of General Symons' wound. I suppose you have
+ no later news?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, beyond that we heard he was very dangerously hit indeed. He is either
+ at the church or town-hall. Both have been turned into hospitals."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is a good deal of anxiety at Ladysmith," the officer said. "The
+ general opinion is that, with the Boers closing in all round it, the
+ position is a very serious one."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am afraid so, sir. There is nothing to prevent the Boers from returning
+ to their position on Talana Hill to-day; and soon after we left the town
+ this morning we heard the sound of guns away on the right, and supposed
+ that the Free Staters had approached Glencoe. As mounted men are of very
+ little use there, and our party is too small to be able to do any good, we
+ thought it would be best to come back here, especially as there was a
+ native report that there was firing in this direction."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; a party of our cavalry under French came up with a battery of field
+ artillery. There was a little skirmishing, but in the evening the Boers
+ were strongly reinforced, and our cavalry returned to Ladysmith. It was
+ only a reconnaissance to ascertain the general situation. To-day we are
+ stronger. Squadrons of the 5th Dragoon Guards, 5th Lancers, the Natal
+ mounted, battery, and several detachments of mounted volunteers, including
+ the Imperial Light Horse, and half the Manchester Regiment, are coming up
+ in an armoured train. I suppose you are not attached to any other corps?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; we form a section of Captain Brookfield's corps of Maritzburg
+ Scouts. As you see, we are not in uniform; it being thought that, as we
+ are all from Johannesburg, and speak Dutch and Kaffir, we should be of
+ more use for scouting if able to appear as Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A very good idea," the officer said, "but somewhat dangerous; for if they
+ caught you they would assuredly shoot you as spies."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We don't mean to be caught if we can help it, as you see we are very well
+ mounted."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Uncommonly well. Brookfield's subscriptions must have come in handsomely
+ for him to be able to buy such horses as those."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We provide our own mounts and equipments," Chris said, "and consider
+ ourselves very lucky in getting hold of this batch of horses from Mr.
+ Duncan on the day he arrived at Maritzburg. I really think they were very
+ cheap at sixty pounds each."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They were not dear, certainly; and the fact that they came from him is in
+ itself a sufficient recommendation. We have got some thirty from him, but
+ they are a different stamp of animal and did not cost half that figure.
+ And now we must be riding to join the rest of our fellows. We made you out
+ when you were a couple of miles away, and were sent off to ascertain what
+ you were. By the way, you will find Brookfield there. He arrived with his
+ men by rail last evening." Riding on, they soon came upon the mounted
+ corps, and were warmly received by Captain Brookfield.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are back just in time," he said. "I suppose that you saw something of
+ the fight yesterday, but, as I see your number still complete, you can
+ scarcely have been in the thick of it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We were with two squadrons of Hussars, and captured a good many waggons
+ and did a little fighting, but nothing very serious. There were only a few
+ casualties. We heard, however, from Colonel Yule, who has succeeded poor
+ Symons, that up to ten o'clock last night, another of the squadrons of the
+ Hussars and a company of mounted infantry with them had not returned, and
+ nothing was known of their whereabouts."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Had they not got into camp when you started?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I did not hear, sir. In fact, we set off by daylight. But last night it
+ was hoped that the squadron, which was acting independently, had lost
+ their way, and would come in this morning. Where is the Boer force now?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Our batteries have shelled them out of the station. They were wholly
+ unprepared for it, and bolted at once to those hills a mile and half east
+ of the line. Their camp lies at the bottom of that conical hill. You can
+ make them out from here with your glass. There, French is moving forward."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The order had indeed been given to advance, the artillery accompanying the
+ cavalry, and halting every two or three minutes to deliver their fire. The
+ ground was flat, but cut up by gullies. As soon as they came within range,
+ the colonials dismounted and added their fire to that of the guns. An
+ immense confusion was seen to reign in the Boer camp, and thirty-seven
+ British subjects, including the officials and staff at the
+ railway-station, and some of the coal-miners, took advantage of this and
+ ran forward to join their friends. They were at once sent back into
+ Ladysmith, after having given the information that General Koch was in
+ command of the Boers, and that Commandant Miellof and the German Colonel
+ Shiel, with many of the Johannesburg commando, were there. Chris and his
+ comrades felt great satisfaction at the news.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have a chance of paying off old scores on the right persons now,"
+ Chris said. "I do hope that the fellows who insulted us when we were
+ coming down are here, and that we shall manage to get among them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For the time, however, this wish was not gratified. The Boers now seeing
+ that they had such a small force opposed to them, steadied themselves and
+ opened fire with some guns, Maxims, and rifles from the crest of the hill,
+ while a swarm of horsemen and dismounted men poured out to threaten the
+ flanks of the British. The odds were too great; the comparatively heavy
+ guns of the enemy were well aimed and served, and quite overpowered the
+ fire of the light cannon of the field and mountain batteries. The order
+ was given to fall back, which was done in good order, though the troops
+ were harassed by a hot fire from the enemy concealed in the gullies. On
+ reaching the high ground near Modder Spruit, the country was more in
+ favour of the British, who were now extended on each flank. The Boers were
+ unable or unwilling to move their heavy guns from their position on the
+ hill, and being now beyond their range, and exposed to the fire of four
+ batteries as well as the infantry, those pressing forward fell back.
+ General French had brought out a signalling apparatus with him, and the
+ telegraph wires were tapped, and a message sent to General White asking
+ him for reinforcements in order to carry the Boer position.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The fight now ceased for a time. A party of the Boers occasionally crept
+ forward and opened fire, but the Colonial Horse dashed forward and sent
+ them flying back to the hills. From nine o'clock till a quarter to two the
+ troops remained idle, but the reinforcements then arrived, a battery of
+ field artillery, several squadrons of Dragoons, Lancers, and Colonials,
+ and the Devonshire regiment and Gordon Highlanders, the infantry being
+ brought up by train. These were under the command of Colonel Ian Hamilton,
+ who had a thorough knowledge of Boer tactics, and knew how to handle his
+ troops. It was well that it was so, for, led by a less experienced
+ commander, they would have suffered terribly in their advance. While the
+ infantry detrained, the Colonials, followed by the 5th Lancers, rode
+ towards some low hills, whence some parties of Boers had maintained a
+ distant fire. These were at once scattered. The infantry marched along
+ some ridges parallel with the railway, but a mile away, while the
+ Devonshire regiment kept along the low ground by the line. The 5th Dragoon
+ Guards, with some troops of Colonials and one of the field batteries,
+ moved forward on the left.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Manchesters were on the right of the infantry, the Gordons in the
+ centre, and the Devons on the left, as they set their faces towards the
+ Boer position. At three o'clock the action began, the Boer riflemen
+ opening a heavy fire. It was still too distant, however, to do any serious
+ execution, and the British moved forward as regularly and unconcernedly as
+ if it had been a field day. The Boer fire grew in intensity, and one of
+ our batteries opened with shrapnel to drive them from the lower ridges. At
+ half-past three the Boer artillery joined their deeper roar to the rattle
+ of musketry and the sharp cracks of the British guns. Although it was
+ still early the light was indistinct, for a heavy thunder-storm had been
+ for some time brewing, and this burst before the heat of the action really
+ began. The darkness was all in favour of the advancing infantry, who in
+ their khaki uniforms were almost invisible to the Boers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The troops were now in extended open order, and advanced towards the foot
+ of the hill by rushes, taking advantage of the ant-hills that studded the
+ plain and afforded an excellent cover, being high enough to cover them
+ while lying down, and thick and compact enough to resist the passage of a
+ Mauser bullet. The Highlanders were suffering the most heavily, their dark
+ kilts showing up strongly against the light sandy soil, and while the
+ Devons and Manchesters sustained but few casualties, they were dropping
+ fast. They and the Manchesters were somewhat in advance of the Devons, who
+ were guarding their flank, which was threatened by a large number of Boers
+ gathered on the ridges on that side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The storm was now at its height, the thunder for a time deadening the roar
+ of the battle, but through the driving rain the infantry pressed on until
+ they reached the foot of the Boers' hill. Large numbers of the enemy were
+ on the slope, hidden from sight by the boulders, but these could not long
+ maintain their position, for the British marksmen shot as straight as the
+ Boer. Our batteries, which had almost silenced those of the enemy,
+ scattered their shrapnel among those higher up the hill, and as the Boers
+ rose to fly before the bayonets of our cheering troops, they were swept
+ away by volleys of the Lee-Metfords. So, with short pauses when shelter
+ was obtainable, our troops bore upwards, cheering and even joking, until
+ they reached the last shoulder of the hill. The Boers made a short but
+ plucky struggle, numbers pushing up from behind to help their comrades,
+ but nothing could check the impetuosity of our troops. The magazines of
+ the rifles were now for the first time set in action, and the Boer force
+ withered away under the terrible storm of shot.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The men of the Imperial Light Horse, who had dismounted and joined in the
+ advance, were fighting side by side with the Highlanders and Manchesters.
+ The pace was now increased to a run, and shouting and cheering the men
+ went forward with levelled bayonets. Many of the Boers, lying behind
+ rocks, maintained their fire until the troops were within two yards of
+ them, and then rising, called for quarter. The men, furious at seeing
+ their comrades shot down when all hope of resistance was over, would have
+ spared none, had not the officers with the greatest difficulty restrained
+ them from bayoneting the Boers, and many of these were in fact killed. As
+ the troops, now joined by the Devons, were rushing down upon the camp, the
+ Boers raised a white flag, and the bugle sounded "Cease firing". The men
+ halted for a moment and then were advancing quietly when a tremendous fire
+ broke out from the Boers, who were scattered over the ridges of the
+ hillside and a slope leading to its summit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Hitherto the British loss had been wonderfully small considering the storm
+ of bullets through which they had passed, but numbers now dropped, and
+ taken wholly by surprise, the troops ran up the hill again. But not for
+ long. Halting when they reached the crest, and furious at the treachery
+ that had been practised with such success upon them, they turned again,
+ and rushed down the hill, scattering the Boers, who still clung to their
+ shelters, with their fire. It was just six o'clock when the Devons carried
+ the last defence of the Boers and then with the Manchesters swept down
+ into the camp. It was now the turn of the cavalry. These had in the
+ darkness moved forward unnoticed, and the Lancers and Dragoons, with a few
+ of the Colonials, among whom were the Maritzburg Scouts, fell upon the
+ flying Boers and cut them up with great slaughter, and, although it was
+ now quite dark, followed them for upwards of two miles, and then returned
+ to camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The losses were heavy. The Gordons had lost four officers killed and seven
+ wounded, and a total of a hundred and fifteen casualties among the four
+ hundred and twenty-five men led into action. The Imperial Light Horse lost
+ their colonel and had seven officers wounded, and eight men killed and
+ forty wounded. Two hundred of the Boers lay dead upon the field. Their
+ wounded were vastly more numerous, and most of the principal officers were
+ killed or captured. General Koch, two of his brothers, a son, and a nephew
+ were all wounded; Shiel, Viljoen, and many others killed or captured.
+ Everything had been left behind. Three guns, all their baggage, their
+ waggons, a great quantity of arms and ammunition, and many horses fell
+ into the hands of the victors. Several battle flags were also captured,
+ and two hundred prisoners were brought in by the cavalry. The night was a
+ dreadful one, the rain still continued to come down, the cold was bitter,
+ and it was next to impossible to find, still less to bring down, the
+ wounded. Nevertheless the soldiers carried on the work during the greater
+ part of the night. Boer waggons were turned for a time into hospital
+ tents, and here by the light of their lanterns the surgeons laboured
+ unweariedly in giving what aid was possible to those brought in, whether
+ Boers or Britons. Chris and his band worked as hard as the rest, and
+ carried down a great number of wounded; but in spite of all the exertions
+ of the troops many remained on the hillside all night, the sufferings from
+ the wounds being as nothing to that caused by the wet and cold. The lads'
+ flasks were of great use now, and enabled many a man, too badly wounded to
+ be carried down the rough hillside, to hold on till morning. General White
+ had arrived from Ladysmith while the battle was going on, but he left the
+ command in the hands of General French. On the following morning orders
+ came for General French to retire, as strong parties of the enemy had been
+ seen further south, and it was hourly becoming more and more evident that
+ it would be impossible to hold the country beyond Ladysmith, and many were
+ of opinion that even this position was too far advanced.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The splendid valour shown by our soldiers at Dundee and Elandslaagte, and
+ the heavy losses they suffered, had been practically thrown away. The
+ coal-fields of Northern Natal had been lost, the loyal settlers had been
+ plundered and ruined. Colonel Yule's force was in imminent peril, and all
+ that had been obtained was the temporary possession of the two heights,
+ both of which had to be relinquished on the following morning. Beyond
+ showing the Boers how enormously they had underrated the fighting powers
+ of the British troops, no advantage whatever had been gained by the
+ advance beyond Ladysmith.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Three of the Johannesburg Scouts had been wounded in the charge among the
+ Boers. None of the injuries were severe, being merely flesh wounds, of
+ which they were hardly conscious during the fighting, and which would not
+ be likely to keep them long from the saddle. None of them applied for
+ medical assistance, as the surgeons were so fully occupied with serious
+ cases. Their comrades bound up the wounds and placed them in the most
+ sheltered position they could find, five of their comrades remaining in
+ charge of them and the horses, there being no possibility of finding the
+ two Kaffirs and the spare animals in the confusion and darkness.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have had one lesson," Chris said, as at seven in the morning the party
+ assembled, worn out by the long night's work, "and that is, that blankets
+ are well enough against a passing shower, but that when there is any
+ probability of wet we must carry our waterproof sheets with us. Of course
+ they would have been no good last night, but on occasions when there is no
+ need for us to be using our hands they will be an immense comfort."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But we should have been wet through before we lay down, Chris."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, they would not have kept us dry, but they would have gone a long way
+ towards keeping us warm. It would be like putting oilskin over wet lint;
+ we should have felt as if we were in a hot poultice in a short time. And
+ even while riding it would have been very comfortable, if we had worn them
+ as we did the blankets, with a hole in the middle to put our heads
+ through."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But that would spoil them for tents," Carmichael said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we could have flaps sewn so as to cover the hole."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Our blankets were very useful last night," Horrocks remarked. "I don't
+ know how we could have got many of those poor fellows down the hill if we
+ had not carried them in the blankets. It was infinitely easier for them
+ and a great deal easier for us. I saw lots of soldiers using theirs in the
+ same way."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are you sure you will be able to sit your horses down to Ladysmith?"
+ Chris asked Brown, Capper, and Harris, the three wounded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All laughed. "One would think that we were babies, Chris," Harris said.
+ "We could ride to Maritzburg if necessary, though I feel my arm rather
+ stiff, and no doubt it will be stiffer still to-morrow. I felt a bit
+ miserable at sunrise after lying there shivering, and envied you fellows
+ who could keep yourselves warm by working; but I am beginning to thaw out
+ now, and the sight of the Kaffirs coming towards us with the horses half
+ an hour ago, and the thought of hot coffee, did even more than the sun to
+ warm me."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It will be ready soon," Willesden, who was specially in charge of the
+ stores, said. "It was a capital idea bringing that large spirit stove and
+ the paraffin with us; even a native could not find any dry sticks this
+ morning."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Except as the soldiers have done," Chris said, pointing to where, a
+ quarter of a mile from the spot where they had gathered, a dozen fires
+ were blazing, the soldiers having utilized some of the Boer waggons that
+ had been smashed by the shell for the purpose of firewood.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, but if we were by ourselves, Chris, there would be no broken
+ waggons; besides, after all I should not care to go down and scramble with
+ the soldiers for a place to put a kettle on. At any rate, the stove will
+ be invaluable out on the veldt."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We all agree with you, Willesden," Peters said, "and it was because you
+ were the one who suggested it that we promoted you to the office of
+ superintendent of the kitchen. It is a comfort, too, that we have some
+ clear water instead of having to get it from one of these muddy streams.
+ The storm has done good anyhow, for if it had not been for that there
+ would have been no breakfast for the troops until they had moved to the
+ river."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In another twenty minutes they were drinking hot coffee and munching
+ biscuits. At ten o'clock the bugle sounded the assembly, and the troops
+ formed up, the wounded were placed in ambulance waggons or carried on
+ stretchers, and all returned to Elandslaagte station. Here the wounded
+ were sent on by train, while the infantry and cavalry returned by road.
+ Talking to some of the officers of the Imperial Horse, several of whom
+ were friends of his father, and had only left Johannesburg a short time
+ before the declaration of war, Chris learned that the principal object in
+ fighting the battle was to drive the Boers off the line by which the
+ Dundee force would retreat; for Colonel Yule in his telegraphic despatch
+ had stated, that although a victory had been won he felt that the position
+ was untenable, and that he might at any moment be forced to evacuate it.
+ He also learned that the safety of the line beyond Ladysmith was already
+ threatened, but whether Sir George White would decide upon falling back
+ towards Pietermaritzburg or would hold Ladysmith no one knew. Certainly
+ nothing could be determined upon until General Yule rejoined with the
+ division from Dundee.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The position there was indeed growing worse every hour. While the battle
+ of Elandslaagte was being fought the Boers had opened fire from the hills
+ above Glencoe on the British camp, and had compelled it to shift its
+ position. The next day they were again obliged to move by artillery on the
+ Impati mountain, and it was then that General Yule decided to retire at
+ once on Ladysmith. A cavalry reconnaissance which was sent out found that
+ the Boers were in great strength in the pass of Glencoe, and it was
+ therefore determined to move by the roundabout way through Helpmakaar.
+ Some stores of ammunition that had been left under a guard in the other
+ camp were fetched, and with full pouches the little army started on its
+ long and perilous march at nine o'clock on the evening of the 22nd. The
+ camp was abandoned as it stood. The wounded remained with some surgeons
+ under the protection of the Red Cross flag. All the available transport
+ accompanied the column, but the men's kits and all other encumbrances were
+ left behind. They were obliged to pass through Dundee to get upon the
+ southern road, but so quietly was the movement effected that but few of
+ the townsmen knew what was happening.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The column was led by Colonel Dartnel, chief of the Natal Police, whose
+ knowledge of the district was invaluable to the troops. The roads were
+ heavy, and the rain continued to pour down in torrents. Each man carried
+ three days' provisions; they tramped along silently through the night;
+ stoppages by swollen streams were frequent, and by daybreak the next
+ morning they had only accomplished nine miles of their journey. Early in
+ the morning the townspeople had woke up to the fact that the army had
+ gone, and there was a general exodus of all who could obtain conveyances.
+ The Boers remained for some time in ignorance that the force whose capture
+ or destruction they had regarded as certain had slipped away. They saw the
+ tents, but the fact that neither men nor horses were visible puzzled them,
+ and it was eleven o'clock before some of the more venturesome galloping
+ down found that the English force had escaped.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then from all sides they poured into the town. Had they at once pursued
+ they might still have overtaken the retreating force before nightfall; but
+ they immediately set to work to loot the great stores of provisions left
+ behind, and to gather their pickings from the deserted houses of Dundee,
+ and so let slip their opportunity, and no pursuit whatever was attempted.
+ For four days the column continued its march, resting for a few hours each
+ day and usually marching all night. The road was terribly bad, leading
+ through narrow mountain passes, and had but a small force of the enemy
+ held the Waschbrank gorge, where the sides were for three miles nearly
+ perpendicular, a terrible calamity might have taken place. Happily,
+ however, the Boers were in absolute ignorance of the road which the
+ British troops were following, and concluded that they must have somewhere
+ crossed the railway and were making their way down by the roads to its
+ west. That they had gone through Helpmakaar does not appear to have
+ occurred to them, for after marching some thirty miles to that town the
+ column was as far off Ladysmith as when it started.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The anxiety at the latter town was intense. The line being still uncut,
+ the arrival of the column at Helpmakaar was known, but beyond that no
+ communication could be received. On Tuesday the 24th Colonel Dartnel
+ arrived in Ladysmith with the news that the column was now twenty miles
+ away, all well, and he at once returned to them with supplies and a small
+ relief force. On Wednesday many of the men came in, and on Thursday the
+ remainder arrived and were heartily greeted. On the 24th&mdash;in order to
+ divert the attention of Joubert and the Free State Boers, both of whom
+ were converging upon General Yule's column, still making its way through
+ the passes&mdash;a force composed of three regiments of cavalry, four of
+ Colonial Mounted Infantry, three batteries, and four infantry regiments
+ went out. The enemy were found near Reitfontein. No actual engagement took
+ place, but for some hours an artillery and rifle duel was maintained and
+ the Boers fell back. The number of casualties was not large, and these
+ were principally among the Gloucester regiment, who, on entering a valley
+ supposed to be untenanted, were received by a heavy fire from a strong
+ party of the enemy hidden there. The fight, however, fulfilled the object
+ for which the advance was undertaken, that of occupying the Boers'
+ attention and enabling the column from Dundee to make its way into
+ Ladysmith unmolested. The Boers were now closing in on the latter town
+ from all directions, and preparations for defence at once began. The
+ town-hall and the schools were fitted up as hospitals and everything
+ arranged for the reception of wounded. As the Boers had already been seen
+ near Colenso, sixteen miles to the south, it was certain that the
+ communications would ere long be cut.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No more unsuitable place for a military camp could well have been selected
+ than Ladysmith, which had indeed been chosen, years before the war was
+ thought of, on account of its position on the railway, and the vicinity of
+ the Klip river. The fact that the country immediately round was fertile
+ and forage was obtainable no doubt influenced the military authorities in
+ their selection. Lying in the heart of a mountainous country, it was
+ commanded by steep and rocky hills at a distance of from two to four
+ miles. Just as many castles built in the days before firearms were in use
+ were rendered untenable against even the clumsy cannon of early days
+ placed on eminences near, so the improvement in artillery and the
+ possession of powerful modern guns by the Boers had gravely imperilled the
+ position of Ladysmith. The military authorities could never have
+ anticipated that the town would be besieged by foes armed with artillery
+ that could carry over five miles. But such was the case now, and all there
+ felt, as soon as it was decided to defend the place till the last, that
+ the position was a precarious one.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Fortunately, a considerable store of provisions had been collected, and so
+ long as the line was open additions were being sent up by every train. The
+ line was a single one, winding along through passes among the hills, and
+ therefore open to attack by small bodies of the enemy. In point of size
+ Ladysmith was the third largest town in Natal. Durban boasted a population
+ of thirty thousand, Pietermaritzburg of twenty thousand, and Ladysmith of
+ four thousand five hundred, being four hundred larger than that of Dundee.
+ It was the point at which the line of railway forked, one branch running
+ north through Glencoe to the Transvaal, the other northwest through Van
+ Reenen's Pass to Bloemfontein. It was a pretty straggling town with its
+ barracks, government buildings and large stores. Almost all the houses
+ were detached and standing in their own gardens, and as these were largely
+ wooded its appearance was very picturesque, with the Klip river, a branch
+ of the Tugela, running through it. The houses were, for the most part,
+ one-storied, and the roofs were all painted white for the sake of
+ coolness. No perfectly open town had ever before undergone a siege by an
+ army of some thirty thousand men provided with excellent guns, and yet the
+ garrison awaited the result with perfect confidence.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0007" id="link2HCH0007"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VII &mdash; LADYSMITH BESIEGED
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ On the 30th, the Boers being now in force on many of the hills around the
+ town, and having inflicted the first annoyance upon Ladysmith by cutting
+ the conduit that brought down the water-supply to the town from a
+ reservoir among the hills, and so forced it for the future to depend upon
+ a few wells and the muddy water of the river, it was determined to make an
+ effort to drive them back and to gain possession of some of the hills from
+ which it was now evident the town would stand a risk of being bombarded.
+ Hitherto there had been considerable apathy in taking measures for keeping
+ the enemy as far as possible out of range. A few redoubts thrown up during
+ the last week and strongly held would have been invaluable, but it seemed
+ to be considered by the military authorities that the siege could be but a
+ short one, and that the Boers would speedily be driven off by the troops
+ now pouring into Durban.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An effort was now to be made to repair the consequences of this remissness
+ and to drive the Boers off the positions they occupied, and it was hoped
+ that if a heavy blow were dealt them they would draw off altogether. The
+ forces of Joubert, Meyer, and the Free Staters were now all within a
+ distance of a few miles, and were all to be beaten up. Their central
+ position was on a hill afterwards known as Signal Hill, and on this they
+ had already planted a forty-pounder gun. A force composed of six companies
+ of the Royal Irish Fusiliers, four and a half of the Gloucesters, a
+ mountain battery and a troop of Hussars started at midnight towards a hill
+ known as Nicholson's Nek, occupied by the Free Staters. Major General
+ Hunter with a brigade of infantry, three batteries, and a small cavalry
+ force were to attack Meyer's commando to the east, while General White,
+ with two infantry brigades, French's cavalry, and six batteries of field
+ artillery moved against Joubert's force on Modder Spruit. It was hoped
+ that the Boers, if defeated, would find their retreat barred by the force
+ that had stated early for Nicholson's Nek. All were well away from the
+ town before daylight broke.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At five o'clock in the morning the guns spoke out, and were at once
+ answered by the Boer artillery, and the roar of fire soon became general.
+ General White's central column was screened by a ridge near the railway,
+ and the big gun on Signal Hill directed its fire partly against the town
+ and partly against the cavalry which could be seen by them in rear of the
+ column. As only a few of the Volunteer Horse had been ordered to accompany
+ the attacking force, Chris and his companions took up their position on an
+ eminence that afforded a general view of the battle, and here a large
+ number of the townspeople also gathered. The general plan of operations
+ was that the two movable columns should form a rough arc of a circle and,
+ driving in both flanks of the Boers, sweep the whole force before them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They have a great many guns," Peters said, as the rattle of the
+ machine-guns and the thud of quick-firing one-pounders joined the
+ continuous fire of several Boer batteries and the deeper roar of their big
+ gun, "and they seem to be in greater force than was supposed, for I can
+ make out large reinforcements coming up to them from behind."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Our artillery were first placed about four thousand yards from the Boer
+ position, but as this was on higher ground than that occupied by our guns
+ our fire did not appear to be effective. They were therefore moved forward
+ some distance, supported by two battalions of the Rifles and the Dublin
+ Fusiliers. The infantry force with them pushed forward rapidly and gained
+ a crest from which they threatened to take the Boer position on Signal
+ Hill in rear; but the Boers, very strongly reinforced, moved to meet them,
+ and heavy fighting took place, until the enemy's force became so strong
+ that they not only checked the further advance of the brigade, but
+ threatened it on both flanks. Two batteries went to their assistance, but
+ even with this aid they could not continue their advance, pressed as they
+ were by greatly superior numbers and harassed by the fire of the Boer
+ field batteries on the hill.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At other points our advance was opposed as hotly. Nowhere were our
+ infantry gaining ground. The enemy had not wasted their time, but had
+ thrown up intrenchments on the steep hills they occupied, and from these
+ shelters maintained a terrible fire, while their numerous machine-guns
+ swept the ground with a hail of bullets and shells. On such ground the
+ cavalry were useless, and the range of the Boer guns was much greater than
+ that of our own.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It seems to me," Chris said, "that instead of gaining ground we are
+ losing it. We can't see at all what is going on, but certainly the firing
+ seems nearer than it was."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All had thought the same though none had cared to suggest such a thing.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Hurrah! there is a train coming in," Field said. "I heard they were
+ expecting a party of sailors with naval guns. They would be useful just at
+ the present moment. Let us go down and see, we can make out nothing from
+ here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Glad to be doing something they went down the hill. As they reached the
+ station they saw a large detachment of sailors at work detraining some
+ twelve-pounders and two large quick-firing guns. Teams of oxen were
+ brought up, the sailors harnessed themselves to ropes, and with tremendous
+ exertions one of the guns was taken up to an eminence, and at eleven it
+ opened fire. It was but just in time. In steady order the columns were
+ retiring with their faces towards the Boers, answering shot for shot,
+ carrying off their wounded as they dropped, in spite of the terrible rifle
+ fire and the roar of the Boers' batteries; but as soon as the first naval
+ gun opened fire, amid the cheers of the townspeople, the situation was
+ changed. The first two shells burst close to the Boer big gun, the third
+ in the midst of the artillerymen, and it was some time before its fire was
+ resumed. In the meantime the sailors had turned their attention to other
+ Boer batteries which the field artillery had scarcely been able to reach,
+ and one by one these were withdrawn over the crest.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At one o'clock Colonel Hamilton's brigade, which had hitherto been lying
+ behind the crest they first occupied, in readiness to repel any
+ counter-attack the Boers might make, now moved out and took up their
+ position to cover the retirement of Hunter's column and Howard's brigade,
+ and although the Boers pressed hotly upon them they held their ground
+ steadily until their comrades had all reached their camp, and then marched
+ in unhindered by the enemy, whose big cannon had now been finally silenced
+ by the naval gun and their batteries for the most part obliged to retire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After seeing the naval gun open fire Chris had gone down to speak to
+ Captain Brookfield, when he met two soldiers of a mountain battery
+ carrying an injured comrade. They took him into the hospital and then came
+ out. Their shoulder-straps showed them to belong to the mountain battery
+ that had gone out with the Royal Irish Fusiliers and the Gloucesters, of
+ whom nothing had been heard, though occasionally, in momentary intervals
+ of fire, the sound of distant musketry could be made out in the direction
+ of Nicholson's Nek.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How are your party getting on?" he asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We don't know anything about them, sir," one of the men said, "except
+ that they have been heavily engaged since daylight. I am afraid that they
+ are in a tight place."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How is it you know nothing about them?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It has been a bad job altogether," the man said. "We were marching up a
+ steep valley with only room for us to lead two mules abreast; we were in
+ the rear of the column. Suddenly a boulder came rolling down the hill and
+ some shots were fired. In a moment the mules stampeded. One or two began
+ it, kicking and plunging and squealing like wild beasts, then the others
+ all set to. There was no holding them? it was almost pitch-dark, and
+ before one could say 'knife' they were tearing down the road we had come
+ up. There was no time to stop, and those who were lucky jumped out of
+ their way, those who were not were knocked down and trampled on. As soon
+ as they had gone those of us who were not hurt set off after them and
+ looked for them everywhere, but only two or three were caught. Where the
+ rest went I don't know, but I hope that they got into the enemy's line of
+ fire and were all shot. At last we gave it up as a bad job and went back
+ to bring in the fellows who were hurt. I think most of them are in now. We
+ have been a long time, for Thompson's leg was broken and one of his arms,
+ and, I expect, most of his ribs, and it hurt him so to be moved that we
+ have had to stop every two yards."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is a bad business indeed," Chris said; "and of course all your guns
+ are lost?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Every one of them, and what is worse, all the reserve small-arm
+ ammunition is lost too. The mules carrying them were with ours, and as the
+ fighting up there has been going on ever since, I am afraid the infantry
+ must have pretty well used up their last cartridges."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was not until the next day that the extent of the calamity was known,
+ when a Boer came down with a white flag asking that doctors might be sent
+ up. The little column instead of, as had been hoped, surprising the Boers
+ had itself been ambushed, being suddenly attacked by two strong parties of
+ the enemy. They at once seized a little eminence, threw up a breastwork of
+ stone, and defended themselves successfully until the ammunition was
+ entirely exhausted, and a hundred and fifty had been killed or wounded.
+ The Boers had, by taking advantage of every bit of cover, crept up close
+ to them, and a murderous fire was poured in. The two regiments asked
+ Colonel Carleton, who commanded them, to allow them to charge with their
+ bayonets and cut their way through. He consented to allow the desperate
+ attempt to be made, and the men were in the act of fixing bayonets when
+ someone raised a white flag, and the Boers standing up advanced to receive
+ the surrender.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After this the laws of war permitted no further defence, and the men, half
+ mad with fury at the situation in which they were placed, threw down their
+ rifles and were made prisoners. This was at two o'clock in the afternoon,
+ after the rest of the force had returned to Ladysmith; and thus some nine
+ hundred men fell into the hands of the Boers. Apart from this the loss was
+ comparatively small considering the heat of the engagement. The day's work
+ had been altogether unsatisfactory; no advantage whatever had been gained
+ beyond the discovery of the Boers' position, and their unexpected strength
+ and fighting powers, and it was evident that the force at Ladysmith was
+ unable to drive off the enemy unaided, and must undergo a siege until the
+ arrival of a relieving army. There were provisions calculated to last for
+ two months, and no one doubted that long before that time General Buller
+ would arrive to their rescue. So confident had the military authorities
+ been, that not only had no defensive works been thrown up, but they had
+ omitted to send the women and children, and the men unfitted to give
+ active assistance, to the rear.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the following morning the scouts held a council of war.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," Chris said, "we have to decide the all-important question. It is
+ quite certain that the town is going to be besieged, and I should say that
+ the siege will last for some time, as nothing can be done to relieve them
+ until a lot of troops arrive from home. We have shown at Dundee and
+ Elandslaagte that our fellows can drive the Boers from their kopjes, but a
+ force arriving to relieve Ladysmith would have to fight its way through a
+ tremendously mountainous district, and to capture at least eight or ten
+ such positions. At Dundee and Elandslaagte the Boers had only a few guns,
+ and the big one from Pretoria had not arrived, nor had they time to
+ fortify themselves. It is certain, therefore, that it will require a very
+ big force to fight its way in here, especially as the Tugela has to be
+ crossed, and the Boers will of course destroy the bridges.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It may be a couple of months before the place is relieved. Of course the
+ question is, Shall we stay here or go? I don't think we should be of much
+ use here; indeed, I don't see that cavalry would be any good at all,
+ whereas if a portion of the Boers push south we may be very useful in our
+ own line of scouting. Still, this is a question for you to decide. You
+ chose to make me your commander when at work, but we should all have an
+ equal voice in a matter of this sort."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was little discussion; all were of their leader's opinion that it
+ was best for them to leave. The prospect of a long siege in which they
+ could take but little active part was not a pleasant one, and it was
+ decided at once that they should leave.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well," Chris said. "Then I will go in to Captain Brookfield and ask
+ his permission to go. Now that we are in camp with him he must be
+ consulted."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had since Elandslaagte taken their places as a part of the Maritzburg
+ Scouts, and had been drilled for some hours each day. They were already
+ favourites among the corps, who were proud of the work they had done, and
+ being a pleasant set of lads their uncouth appearance, which had at first
+ been viewed with much disfavour by many of their comrades, had been
+ forgiven. Chris went to the commander's tent and laid the matter and their
+ decision before him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think that it is just as well that you should go, Chris," the officer
+ said; "and indeed I was on the point of telling you that we are all
+ leaving. For myself I cannot understand why the cavalry should be kept
+ here, and indeed I know that it is their opinion also, and that they have
+ asked the general to let them leave. However, he has decided to keep them.
+ I am sure it is a mistake. Before the siege is over forage is sure to run
+ short, and half the cavalry will be dismounted before the end comes.
+ However, I have seen him and pointed out that as scouts we should be
+ useless here. He has given me leave to go, but has requested me to join
+ the first troops that come up the line. When we are once away I shall give
+ you leave to act altogether independently of us, which will I am sure suit
+ you better than being kept for weeks perhaps at Colenso or Estcourt.
+ Another thing I will do. General Yule was speaking to me only yesterday of
+ the manner in which your party defeated and cut up more than double your
+ number, and how you and three of your party went into the Boer camp at
+ Talana and ascertained their strength for General Symons. I expect that
+ General Buller will come on here, as it is certainly the most serious
+ point at present. I will ask Yule to give you a letter of introduction to
+ him, it will be useful; and I have no doubt that he will give you a free
+ hand, as I have done. I should not call upon General Buller in that
+ rig-out, if I were you. I have heard he is somewhat of a martinet at the
+ War Office, and we know that they have a very poor opinion of volunteers
+ there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris smiled. "Volunteers have done good service at the Cape before now,
+ sir, and have shown over and over again that a man can fight just as well
+ in plain clothes as if he were buttoned up to the chin in uniform; and as
+ the Boers are themselves nothing but volunteers, I should think that
+ before this war is over the War Office will see its mistake."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should think so indeed, Chris, but at present they have certainly not
+ woke up to the fact. I see by the telegrams that the London Scottish and
+ the London Irish have both volunteered almost to a man for service here,
+ and that they have not even had a civil reply to their application. I tell
+ you, lad, this war is going to be a big thing, and before it is over we
+ may have both militia and volunteers out here, and perhaps troops from the
+ colonies. I heard that some of the Australian colonies have already
+ offered to send bodies of mounted men, and that our government are
+ ordering out a larger number of men than was at first intended. I hear
+ this morning that at Kimberley and Mafeking fighting has begun. On the
+ 24th Kimberley made a successful sortie, and on the 25th a general attack
+ on Mafeking was repulsed. The fact that both these places are beleaguered,
+ and that we have again been obliged to fall back here, and are likely to
+ be cut off altogether, has evidently stirred them up, and they begin to
+ understand that it is going to be a much bigger affair than they expected.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I wrote to your mother yesterday at Durban, and told her that I intended
+ to leave while it is still possible. Of course you have written; but I
+ told her of the flattering way in which General Yule had spoken of the
+ doings of you and your party, and said that I hoped she would not be
+ anxious, for it was quite evident that you were able to take good care of
+ yourselves. My letter was in answer to one she wrote to me from Durban,
+ begging me to keep you from undertaking what she called 'mad-brained
+ business', and expressing some regret that you and the others had been
+ allowed to form a separate corps, instead of being under the command of an
+ experienced officer like myself. I told her that I thought that you would
+ have less chance of coming to harm in scouting work than if you had to
+ work in a regular way as the general ordered. If this sort of fighting&mdash;I
+ mean, of attacking in front every position the Boers choose to take&mdash;goes
+ on, our numbers will very speedily dwindle away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The fact is, as far as we colonials can see, the regulars do not as yet
+ understand fighting the Boers. Nothing could be more splendid than the
+ behaviour of the troops, both at Dundee and Elandslaagte, but in our
+ humble opinion neither fight was necessary; and if Talana was to be
+ attacked, it should have been done by marching the troops round the hill
+ and taking it in the rear. In that case the Boers would have bolted
+ without firing a shot. That it could have been done is shown by the fact
+ that the cavalry did it, and encountered no difficulty on the way. Again,
+ at Elandslaagte the object of keeping the road open would have been
+ equally well attained if, after driving them out of the station, we had
+ taken up a strong position there and waited for them to attack us.
+ Therefore, Chris, I think that fighting in our way&mdash;that is to say,
+ in Boer fashion&mdash;and trusting to skill as much as to shooting, you
+ will be running a good deal less risk than you would in fighting under
+ British generals in British fashion. We shall go off quietly this evening.
+ We must keep a bright look-out on the way, for the trains have been fired
+ upon, and at any moment the Boers may pull up the rails and block the
+ roads altogether."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two hours later all was ready for a start, and just before sunset the
+ corps rode out of Ladysmith. They kept a sharp look-out as they went, but
+ saw no signs of the enemy, and crossing the Tugela by the bridge near
+ Colenso, halted there for the night. Here Captain Brookfield reported his
+ arrival to the officer in command of the troops, and on the following day
+ Chris and his friends rode on to Estcourt. They had seen some parties of
+ mounted men in the far distance, but none had come near them, and as the
+ military authorities were well aware of the Boers being in the vicinity,
+ there was nothing to be gained by scouting. But it was now decided that
+ they were in advance of the point that any large number of the enemy were
+ likely to reach, and might therefore strike across the country and resume
+ what they considered their regular work. They added to their stores
+ several articles whose want they had felt, had slits made in the
+ waterproof sheets, and covers sewn on to close the holes when they were
+ used for tents, and had some triangular pieces of the same material made
+ to buckle on so as to close the rear of the tents, which had before been
+ open to the wind and rain. They had employed much of their spare time in
+ training their horses and in teaching them to lie down when ordered, and
+ thus share the shelter taken up by their masters, behind rocks or a wall.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer commanding the small force at Estcourt had at first viewed
+ them with some suspicion, but Colonel Yule had purposely left open the
+ letter with which he had furnished Chris, so that it could be shown to any
+ officers commanding posts or detached forces, and its production now
+ caused his cold reception to be converted into a warm welcome. Riding
+ across country they met more than one farmer trekking with his cattle and
+ belongings towards the ferry across the Mooi river. These reported that
+ the Boers had overrun the whole of the country north of the Tugela, and
+ that some parties had already crossed at the ferry on the road between
+ Helpmakaar and Greytown. Fugitives had come in from the villages on the
+ other side, and complained that the Boers were looting everywhere, and had
+ driven off thousands of cattle and numbers of horses, and had everywhere
+ wantonly destroyed the furniture and everything they could not carry off,
+ in the farmhouses they visited.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A vigilant look-out was kept as the scouts advanced. On the second day
+ after starting they encamped on a slight elevation near Mount Umhlumba,
+ and early next morning they saw a party of some twenty Boers riding in a
+ direction that would bring them within rifle-shot of their camp. All were
+ at once on the alert.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We will not go out and attack them," Chris said to the lads who were
+ running towards their horses. "That would mean that though we might kill
+ all of them, half of us would probably be shot. We will ambush them. Get
+ the picket ropes loose and the bridles on ready for mounting, and then
+ leave the horses in charge of the natives where we camped. They will be
+ out of sight there. When you have done that take your places quietly among
+ the rocks. Do you, Capper and Carmichael, put yourselves twenty or thirty
+ yards apart; you are our best shots. When the Boers get within a thousand
+ yards, which is as near as they will do if they keep the line they are
+ going, open fire upon them and keep it up steadily, but not too fast. When
+ they see that only two men are firing they will think that you are a
+ couple of farmers whose place they have plundered, and who are determined
+ to have their revenge. You are safe to hit some of them, and the others
+ will decide upon wiping you out, and will probably leave their horses and
+ crawl up in their usual style. When they get close it will be our turn. I
+ don't think many of them are likely to get away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ His orders were carried out, and five minutes later the two rifles flashed
+ out one after another. The Boers were riding in a clump. One was seen to
+ fall, and the horse of another gave a violent plunge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very good," exclaimed Chris, who, like the rest, was lying down behind a
+ rock. "Don't fire too fast. Wait half a minute, and then each take another
+ turn, one a little time after the other." The man who had fallen was
+ instantly picked up by one of his comrades, and all rode off at full
+ gallop, but before they could get beyond the range of the Mausers each of
+ the lads had fired two more shots. No more of the Boers dropped, but the
+ watchers, who had their glasses directed upon them, thought by their
+ movements that two had been hit. The Boers, when the firing ceased,
+ stopped, and for some little time remained clustered together. Then they
+ took a long sweep round to a point where the ground was broken, and a
+ shallow donga ran up in a direction that would bring them within a hundred
+ yards of the position occupied by their hidden assailants. There they were
+ seen to dismount, and, after some talk, leaving all the horses in the
+ charge of one man, probably one of the wounded, they entered the donga.
+ Its course was irregular, and once or twice the two lads were able to get
+ a shot at them. The Boers did not return the fire but hurried past the
+ exposed points. As they approached a head was occasionally raised above
+ the bank to view the position, and then disappeared again. The ground
+ between the camp and the nearest point of the donga was thickly strewn
+ with boulders, with bushes growing between them. The lads had all shifted
+ their position to this side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't open fire till I give the order," Chris said quietly. "We have got
+ them now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Except for a slight movement of the bushes, it would not have been known
+ that the Boers had left the donga. Once or twice Capper and Carmichael
+ caught a momentary glimpse of one of them, but held their fire, as Chris
+ had said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Let them come within twenty yards, then both fire at once, whether you
+ catch a glimpse of them or not. Thinking that your rifles are discharged,
+ they will all jump up and make a rush. Then it will be our turn."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: "BOTH RIFLES CRACKED AT ONCE."]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently a man's head was seen peering round a rock at about the right
+ distance. Both the rifles cracked at once, and a Boer fell prone on the
+ ground beyond his shelter. At the same moment there was a shout, and his
+ comrades all sprang to their feet and rushed forward. A volley from the
+ whole of the scouts flashed out. Twelve of the Boers fell, the others
+ leapt back behind their shelters, and in turn opened fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Keep in shelter!" Chris shouted. "They know now that we are two to their
+ one, and will soon be making off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The combatants were so close to each other that neither dared expose
+ shoulder or head to take aim, and after the first shots fired at the Boers
+ all remained quiet. Chris waited for three or four minutes, and then told
+ four of the lads who were in the best shelter to crawl back, mount their
+ horses, and ride out down the other side of the slope, and, after making a
+ slight circuit, to gallop straight at the Boers' horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The fellows may be some distance away already," he said, "as they may
+ have slipped off directly they discharged their rifles. In any case there
+ is no time to be lost in getting hold of their ponies, or at any rate in
+ driving them off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As two or three minutes again passed without a shot being fired by the
+ Boers, Chris was in the act of calling off half the troop to watch the
+ donga and fire at the Boers if they saw them running past the exposed
+ points, when at this moment he heard the horses returning, and directly
+ afterwards one of the lads he had sent off ran up to him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are a whole lot of them coming round the other side," he said,
+ "sixty or seventy of them at least. Some distance behind I can see a lot
+ of cattle and waggons. I suppose they were making for home when they heard
+ the firing." Just at this moment two or three shots rang out, telling that
+ the surviving Boers were seen running down the donga.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Never mind them," Chris shouted; "we are going to be attacked by a big
+ party. Put down your rifles all of you, and pile the stones on the crest,
+ so as to make a shelter, as quickly as you can. We shall have a few
+ minutes. Those who are coming up can't know yet what the firing means." He
+ ran up to the top. "They are not more than six or seven hundred yards
+ away," he said, "and it would be better to fight it out here than to take
+ to our horses. Some of us would certainly not get off without a bullet.
+ You need not mind showing yourselves when they come up. They won't be able
+ to make out what we are."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers, indeed, reined in their ponies when they saw Chris appear on
+ the brow of the eminence, and as a preliminary some of them rode off in
+ both directions and endeavoured to ascertain the position. Those on the
+ right soon caught sight of the clump of horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They will soon know all about it," Chris said, as two of them galloped
+ off. "We may as well teach them to keep their distance. Take your places
+ behind rocks, and then open a sharp fire with your magazines. They cannot
+ know how many of us there are here. Now, are you all ready? Yes? Well,
+ then, set to work!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a moment an almost incessant rattle of musketry broke out upon the
+ astounded Boers, who, turning their horses, scattered at full gallop to
+ escape the hail of bullets; but more than a dozen had fallen before they
+ were beyond the range of the Mausers and were fully two thousand yards
+ away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think we need stop," Chris said. "Fill up your magazines again,
+ and then make for the horses." Directly the first party of Boers had been
+ seen, Jack and Japhet had set to work taking down and rolling up the tents
+ and loading the spare horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Jump up," Chris said to them, "we are off. Mind you keep well with us.
+ Now," he went on, as they rode off in a body, "we will do a little cattle
+ raiding on our own account. Make for them, lads!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ With a shout they rode off at full gallop towards the great herd of
+ cattle. As they approached, the Kaffirs who were driving them fled.
+ Separating as they rode, waving their hats and shouting at the top of
+ their voices, the lads dashed at the herd, who at once turned and went off
+ at a rate that would have astonished animals accustomed only to small
+ pastures and other enclosures.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't press them too much," Chris had ordered before the band separated,
+ "or they will break down. Listen for my whistle; when you hear it, Field,
+ Willesden, Harris, and Bryan will follow up the herd with the Kaffirs and
+ keep them moving, the rest will dismount, make their horses lie down, and
+ open fire. That narrow valley we passed through yesterday afternoon will
+ do to make a stand. It is about five miles away, head the cattle for it.
+ The Boers won't be far behind us when we get there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The enemy indeed had not noticed them leave the little kopje, as they were
+ hidden by a slight fall in the ground where they descended, and it was not
+ until they observed a commotion among the cattle that they perceived what
+ had happened. Then, furious not only at the loss they had suffered, but at
+ seeing their booty driven away, they mounted and pursued in hot haste. But
+ the party had obtained a start of fully a mile, and the valley was reached
+ by the fugitives while the Boers were still half that distance in their
+ rear. Chris rode along until he came to a narrow and defensible point; the
+ horses were taken a hundred yards on and made to lie down, and he and his
+ sixteen companions then ran back and took up their positions among the
+ rocks on each side of the track and the slopes above it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0008" id="link2HCH0008"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VIII &mdash; A DESPERATE PROJECT
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Scarcely had the band taken cover in the gorge than the Boers appeared
+ some five hundred yards away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Open fire at once!" Chris shouted, "the farther they have to come under
+ fire the less they will like it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The rifles at once spoke out. The lads had all used the boulders behind
+ which they crouched as rests for their rifles, and confident of their
+ shooting and their position, their aim was deadly. Five or six of the
+ leading Boers fell and several horses, the rest came to an abrupt pause,
+ galloped back some little distance and then dismounted, and leaving their
+ horses in shelter, disappeared from sight. In a short time a dropping fire
+ was opened from both sides of the valley.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't fire unless you see a man," Chris ordered, "there are gaps on the
+ hillside that they can't pass without giving you a chance. Fire in
+ rotation, it is no use wasting a dozen bullets on one man; if the first
+ misses, let the next shoot instantly, and so on. When they learn that it
+ is death to leave shelter, they will soon get sick of it. Keep yourselves
+ well under cover."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The rifle duel continued for an hour. As Chris had said would be the case,
+ after seven or eight had fallen, as they were trying to make rushes across
+ pieces of ground where boulders afforded no cover, the rest became very
+ cautious, and at last only an occasional shot was heard.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We will fall back now," Chris said, "for aught we know a party of them
+ may be working round somewhere to take us in rear. We know that they have
+ not got their horses with them, for we can see the spot where they hid
+ them. Still, we do not want to be caught between two fires. Let four on
+ each flank crawl back; keep well among the rocks, and don't let them catch
+ sight of you. We will fire occasionally to let them know that we are still
+ here. When you have got the horses up and everything is ready, whistle,
+ and we will come back to you. It will be a long time before they venture
+ to crawl up and discover that we have gone, an hour most likely, and by
+ that time the cattle will be a dozen miles on their way to Estcourt, and
+ the Boers are not likely to follow them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Ten minutes later all were in their saddles. They had left the horses at a
+ spot where there was a sharp elbow in the gorge, and their retreat could
+ not be seen from the valley below. They cantered along in high glee; not
+ one had received a scratch, while some twelve of the first party of Boers
+ had fallen, and fully fifteen of the second, and it was certain that at
+ least as many more must have been wounded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I expect they really gave up all idea of carrying our position long ago,"
+ Chris said, "and have only been keeping up their fire to prevent our
+ turning the tables upon them. They must have seen that we are better
+ mounted than they are, and have been afraid that we should in turn take
+ the offensive. I should not be surprised if they stay where they are all
+ day, and don't venture to mount and ride off till it gets dark."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are something like a leader," Peters said enthusiastically. "We knew
+ that you were a good fellow, and would make the best leader among us, but
+ no one could think that our choice would turn out so well as it has done.
+ This is the second fight we have had with the Boers, and we have thrashed
+ them well each time, although the first time they were twice as strong,
+ and in the second something like four times, and we have not lost one of
+ our number. I am sure if we had been caught where we were without you with
+ us, at least half of us would have been killed, and we should have been
+ lucky to get away with only that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Riding without pressing their horses, it was two hours before they
+ overtook the party with the cattle. These had now broken into a walk.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We kept them at it till half an hour ago," Willesden said apologetically,
+ when they came up, "but the Kaffirs said that unless we gave them a rest
+ half of them would drop, so we let them go easy till you came up."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Quite right," Chris said. "We have given the Boers such a thrashing that
+ there is no fear of their continuing the pursuit. Unless we meet some more
+ of these thieves, we can go on as quietly as we like. I have some sort of
+ respect for men like those we met at Dundee and Elandslaagte, who fight
+ manfully and stoutly, but for these raiding scoundrels who only come out
+ to rob and plunder, and do wanton damage to quiet people, one feels only
+ disgust, and shoots them without the least compunction."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general chorus of agreement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Did they get near you, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not within about four hundred yards. They got it so hot at first that
+ they dismounted and took to the rocks; they pushed on for a bit, and if
+ the whole hillside had been covered with boulders we might have had some
+ sharp fighting, but there were some open spaces to be crossed, and after
+ getting over two or three of them they found it safer to lie as close as
+ rabbits. For aught we know they are there still."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They travelled quietly till sunset, and then halted in an open valley
+ where there was water and good grass. Half the company kept watch by
+ turns, being posted with their horses some half a mile out in the country,
+ taking the animals with them not only because they could fall back more
+ quickly, but because they knew the horses would hear any approaching sound
+ long before their masters were able to do so, and would evince their
+ uneasiness unmistakably. There was, however, no alarm, and two days later,
+ travelling by easy stages, they arrived at Estcourt, where their arrival
+ with so large a number of cattle created quite a sensation. They at once
+ put up a notice at the post-office, that all persons who had been raided
+ by the Boers could come and inspect the herd and take all animals bearing
+ their brand. It soon appeared that the cattle were the property of four
+ farmers living within a short distance of each other. They had arrived in
+ Estcourt with their families two days previously, weary and broken down
+ with fatigue, hunger, and the loss and ruin of their property. Their
+ gratitude was deep indeed at this wholly unexpected recovery of a large
+ portion of their herds, and they started the next morning, mounted on some
+ ponies they had picked up for a trifle, to drive them down the country.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris saw the officer in command as soon as they arrived in the town, and
+ gave him an outline of their adventure, upon which he was warmly
+ congratulated. "Shall I send in a written report to you, sir?" Chris
+ asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, you are not under my orders; and I should say that you had better
+ write and post it to the officer commanding the force at Maritzburg. I do
+ not know who it may be."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Is the road closed to Ladysmith?" Chris asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, two days since. General French, who is ordered to Port Elizabeth to
+ take command of the cavalry brigade that is forming to drive back the
+ Boers who have crossed the Orange River, came down in the last train that
+ got out. It was hotly fired upon by the Boers, but luckily they had not
+ taken up the rails, and the train got through safely. We have had no news
+ since, for even the wire to Colenso has been cut, and for anything we know
+ the place may be in possession of the Boers. We have a little fort here,
+ and have been throwing up entrenchments, but if they come in any force
+ there is not much hope of our getting off. We have an armored train, which
+ yesterday ran to within a mile or so of Colenso without being interfered
+ with, though several parties of the enemy could be seen in the distance. I
+ have great hopes that we shall get half a battalion up from Maritzburg
+ to-morrow; if so, by loopholing the houses and throwing up some
+ breastworks, we ought to be able to keep the Boers out of the place,
+ unless they come in force. At any rate, I should advise you to scout next
+ time beyond the Mooi River and to make Maritzburg your head-quarters. So
+ far as we know the Boers have not yet gone beyond that river, and any news
+ of their doing so would certainly be of value. You have done marvellously
+ well in getting away from that party you met, but you might not be so
+ lucky next time, for as they push on they are sure in a short time to be
+ strong all over the country between the Tugela and the Mooi."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This, after some consultation, was agreed to by the troop. There was no
+ reason for haste, and they rode by easy stages down to Maritzburg,
+ stopping at Weston and Hawick. Many of their friends had gone down to
+ Durban, but some still remained, and from these they received a hearty
+ welcome. All found letters awaiting them, for it had been arranged that as
+ it would be impossible to give any address, these should be sent to
+ Maritzburg. Their friends were scarcely ready to credit their stories,
+ but, on being shown General Yule's letter, saw that at least the accounts
+ of their early doings were strictly correct.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Troops were coming up fast from Durban, and there was already a strong
+ brigade there. Chris called upon the brigadier and presented General
+ Yule's letter, and his own report of the fight with the Boers
+ subsequently.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "This shows what can be done by young fellows who are good shots and good
+ riders, and who, I may say, Mr. King, have been admirably commanded. What
+ are your wishes now? There are two or three troops of volunteer horse
+ here; would you wish to be attached to one of them? Of course, if you do
+ so there will be no difficulty about it; but really, I think that you
+ would be more useful in carrying on your work in your own way."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It had been known for a long time past that a large proportion of the
+ cannon, rifles, and ammunition of the Boers had been landed at the
+ Portuguese port of Lorenzo Marques, and taken up by rail from there to
+ Komati-poort&mdash;a station on the frontier, where there was a bridge
+ across the Komati river&mdash;and thence by rail to Pretoria. Chris heard
+ that it was generally known that the Portuguese officials, who had long
+ been influenced by Boer money extracted from the Uitlanders, were still
+ winking at the practice, although it was a breach of neutrality. So much
+ indignation was expressed on the subject at Maritzburg that Chris, one day
+ when the party assembled at the spot where their horses were tethered,
+ said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I want to have a serious talk with you all. You have all heard that
+ immense quantities of arms and dynamite are passing through Lorenzo
+ Marques. Now, at present we don't see much for us to do here. My idea is,
+ that if we could manage to blow up the bridge across the river that
+ divides Portuguese territory from the Transvaal, we should do an
+ infinitely greater service than by killing any number of plundering
+ Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ His troop looked at each other in surprise.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are not really in earnest, Chris?" Peters said; "it would be a
+ tremendous business."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It would be a big business, no doubt, but I was never more earnest in my
+ life than in proposing it. Now that we know how strong the Boers are round
+ Ladysmith, and what terribly hard work it will be for an army to fight its
+ way through all those hills, we can see that the first calculations as to
+ the time when it can be relieved are a good deal short of the mark. There
+ must be at least twenty thousand men collected here to do it, and I think
+ it is more likely to be the end of January than the end of December before
+ the Boers are driven off. We have in the one case seven weeks and in the
+ other twelve before the place is relieved, and we begin to turn the tables
+ on the Boers; and according to the way we carry my idea out it depends
+ whether we are back here by the end of the year or by the end of January&mdash;that
+ is, I acknowledge, if we get back at all.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have been thinking it over. There are two ways of doing it. We can go
+ on board a ship touching at Durban and going on to Lorenzo Marques. I
+ don't say that we could not all do it, but it would be better to choose
+ only four; a larger number would excite more observation. Those who go
+ will of course take dynamite with them. We can buy that at Durban. At
+ Lorenzo Marques we should assume the character of four young Irish
+ fellows. We know there are lots of them already up there, and Germans too,
+ fighting in the Boer ranks and I am glad to know that they got peppered at
+ Elandslaagte, although that is not to the point. We should go as four
+ Irish lads who have come across from America to fight for the Boers. We
+ have heard plenty of Irish in the mines and at Johannesburg, so shall be
+ able to put enough brogue in our talk to pass. I know from what I have
+ heard that a trip to the Portuguese officials would be quite sufficient
+ for them to pass anything without examination; but even if they did open
+ our cases and find dynamite in them, we could account for it by saying
+ that we had been told before starting that it would be the handiest thing
+ to take with us, and would be of more assistance to the Boers than
+ anything we could bring them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No doubt some of the passengers would know that we got on board at
+ Durban, but if any questions were asked we could account for that by
+ saying that the ship we came over in, was going on to Australia, and
+ therefore we had been obliged to land and take another on to Lorenzo
+ Marques. Once landed, we should of course take a train for Komati-poort,
+ and slip off it after dark at some station a few miles from there. Then,
+ you know, we could first reconnoitre the bridge, and when we had settled
+ on the best place for the dynamite, we could put it there the next night.
+ I know a good deal about the use of dynamite. It is not like gunpowder,
+ that you have to put in a hole and fasten up tightly, you only have to lay
+ it upon an iron girder or arch, and light your fuse and leave it to do its
+ work."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The boys listened with increasing surprise to his proposal.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And what is your other plan?" Peters asked after a long pause.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The other plan is that we should all take a passage in some small craft,
+ which we could hire, to St. Lucia Bay, and then go up through Zululand and
+ Swaziland, which extends to within a short distance of Komati-poort. Both
+ tribes are friendly enough with us, and hate the Boers like poison. Of
+ course in that case we shall take the dynamite with us, and then must be
+ guided by circumstances as to our course and what we should do when we got
+ to the bridge."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was again a long silence, then Brown said: "If anyone but you had
+ proposed it, Chris, I should have scoffed at it as impossible, but for
+ myself I have come to have such confidence in you that I believe you would
+ manage it. There can be no doubt that it would be a grand thing if we
+ could do it. I have heard my father say that the river is a terribly bad
+ one, and that sometimes it is altogether impassable for weeks at a time.
+ Except by the bridge, even in the best times, I should think, from what he
+ said, it would be quite impossible for them to take heavy things like
+ cannon across. Anyhow, I am ready to go with you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, Brown," Chris said. "I should certainly not ask anyone to go.
+ Those who are willing to do so must volunteer. Of course we only combined
+ for the purpose of acting as scouts, and no one ever contemplated doing
+ more. So far, we have, as all allow, carried out that object well; and I
+ have no doubt that those who do not care to join in what is a sort of
+ forlorn hope, will continue to do well after we have started on it, and of
+ course I shall, if I get back, rejoin them. My scheme would, no doubt, be
+ considered a very wild one, but I can see no reason why, with good luck,
+ it should not succeed. Indeed, I believe that it will succeed, if, when we
+ arrive there, we do not find that the Boers are guarding the bridge. Of
+ course, if they do so there is but little hope of carrying the matter out.
+ They will know the importance of the bridge to them, and how greatly its
+ destruction would be desired by the British Government, and may think it
+ possible that such an attempt as I propose would be made, and take
+ precautions to prevent its success.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I do not mean to throw away my life. If, when I get there, I find that it
+ is next to impossible to carry the matter out, I shall give it up; but
+ even then the information I should get about matters up there, both as to
+ the Boers and the Swazis, would be of use. We know that Boer agents have
+ been doing their utmost to get the Basutos to join them, and it is likely
+ that they may be trying to induce the Zulus and Swazis to do the same; and
+ even if we fail in the principal object, I should say that the time would
+ not be wasted. When I am up there, I can, of course, get news as to how
+ the war is going on, and if I find that our forces are pushing up into the
+ Transvaal, I shall make straight across the country and join them. I have
+ been thinking over the matter a good deal since we came here, and made up
+ my mind that anyhow I shall try to carry it out, so I now resign the
+ leadership, and also for the present my membership. Now, I don't want to
+ influence you in any way. It has all come suddenly upon you. You had
+ better talk it over together. All I ask you is that you will not say a
+ word about it to anyone, not even to your relations.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not only because, as I know would be the case, they would be afraid of
+ having anything to do with what they would consider an absolutely mad
+ scheme, but because a chance word might prove fatal to success. As
+ everyone knows, there are a great number of Dutch in the colony, who,
+ although they may not be openly hostile, are in favour of the Boers, and
+ will no doubt keep them acquainted with every movement of troops here, and
+ can have no difficulty in communicating with them by native runners. Were
+ one of our friends even to mention it casually that we had gone north,
+ suspicions might be aroused. Therefore I beg that no one will breathe a
+ word about the matter, but that you will decide for yourselves without
+ consulting anyone. I shall leave you now, and we will meet here at the
+ same time to-morrow. You will have had time to think it over then. I wish
+ to say before I go that I don't consider that the success of my plan
+ depends upon my having the whole twenty of you with me. I repeat, that
+ four would be quite sufficient.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are advantages as well as disadvantages in having only that number.
+ We should travel without exciting so much notice; we should have less
+ difficulty about food; we could conceal ourselves more easily in case we
+ were pursued. On the other hand, with a stronger party we could repulse an
+ attack if chased by the Boers. So you see I really do not want more than
+ three of you to join. I think four is the best number, and should be glad
+ if only two besides Brown wished to go with me; but at the same time if
+ more desire it, of course, as we are all comrades, they would have a right
+ to go."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So saying he turned away, leaving the others to talk the matter over. They
+ went through their usual drill that afternoon without any allusion being
+ made to the subject. When they met the next day Chris said cheerfully,
+ "Well, what have you decided? First, Brown, do you stick to what you said
+ yesterday, or do you think better of it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Certainly I stick to it," Brown said. "When I say a thing I mean it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And how about the others?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have made up my mind to go with you, Chris," Peters said, "and so has
+ Willesden. Field and Capper and Sankey would all go with you if you wanted
+ to take more than four, and all would go if you wanted the troop; but if
+ you would rather only have three of us, it is settled that Brown,
+ Willesden and I go."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well," Chris said, "that just suits me. I am glad that you would all
+ go if you were wanted; but really I think that four would be the best
+ number, so we will consider that as settled. And now there is one other
+ thing I want to ask you about. You see, we have no right to take any money
+ out of the common fund, but we shall have some heavy expenses. In the
+ first place we shall want, I should say, a couple of hundred pounds of
+ dynamite; then we shall have to take some natives with us, a couple of
+ Zulus and two or three Swazis. There will be no difficulty in getting
+ them, as so many have been thrown out of employment owing to the farmers
+ losing their herds. We may find it useful to make presents to chiefs as we
+ go along, and, of course, we shall have to take a certain amount of
+ provisions for the party. Have you any objection to our each taking half
+ our share out of the bank? Nothing has been drawn at present, and with a
+ couple of hundred pounds between us we shall have enough and to spare for
+ however long we may be away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a chorus of agreement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are all awfully sorry that you are going, Chris," Field said. "It
+ won't be the same without you at all. We have agreed to ask you to
+ nominate a leader during your absence."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I would much rather not do that," Chris said. "Everyone has done equally
+ well, and it is a question that you should settle among yourselves."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are all against that," Field said positively. "We have talked it over
+ and agree that we shall never be able to fix on one. Suppose our votes
+ were divided between four and five I don't think we should feel more
+ comfortable afterwards. We would rather put all the names in a hat and
+ draw one out, just leaving it to chance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I almost think that it would be better," Chris said, "to do as you
+ propose. Agree first that, as we have done up till now, all important
+ matters shall be discussed and decided by vote, then draw all the names
+ from a hat and let each be leader for a week in the order in which they
+ come out, with the proviso that if as time goes on you find that you can
+ have more confidence in one than another, you can by a majority of three
+ to one elect him as permanent leader."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That would be a very good plan," Carmichael said, "but, you see, the
+ difficulty is that, supposing we were going to attack the Boers or the
+ Boers attack us, the plan the leader fixed on might not seem to us at all
+ the best. In the two fights we have had there was not that difficulty, for
+ everyone felt that the plan you adopted was the best, and indeed much
+ better than any of us would have been likely to think of. I don't say that
+ that would occur, but it might. It is not everyone who could fix upon the
+ best thing to be done all at once as you did."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris thought for a minute. "I would suggest," he said, "that in such a
+ case as you mention the leader should tell the next two on the list what
+ he proposed. If one of the two agreed with him it would be a majority, and
+ there would be nothing more to be said on the matter. If both disagreed
+ with him there must be a general vote. I should hope such a thing would
+ never occur, because the loss of five minutes would sometimes be
+ disastrous, though in some cases it might not make any difference. Still,
+ that is the best plan I can think of. There is no occasion for you to
+ decide that straight off. At any rate, if you should find that any
+ arrangement you make does not act perfectly well, I should advise you to
+ join Captain Brookfield's troop and act with him."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The general opinion was strongly in favour of Chris's suggestion. It was
+ agreed that at any rate the first leader should be chosen by chance.
+ Carmichael's name came first out of the hat.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I shall not have much responsibility," he said, "as we have settled to
+ remain here until the advance begins. Now, Chris, about the spare horses."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should like to take one of them. We may have to gallop for it, and it
+ is of no use our being well mounted if we are hampered with a pony that
+ cannot keep up with us. We have only to lighten its load by getting rid of
+ most of its burden, and then we should be free to go our own pace.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should like to take one of our Kaffirs. They have both turned out very
+ well, and have a good idea of cooking, and are accustomed to our ways. I
+ don't care which I have, but I should certainly like to have one of them.
+ He would stick to the spare horse, while the other natives would be all
+ right if they scattered and shifted for themselves."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Would you not like two spare horses, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, thank you, one would be enough. He would carry our stores, and I
+ should get two native ponies to take the dynamite along. We shall not be
+ travelling at any extraordinary rate of speed, and if they broke down we
+ could always replace them. Certainly there would be no danger if we go
+ through Zululand, and, I should think, not until we get north of the
+ Swazis' country; for though I know there are Boers settled among them, a
+ good many would of course have joined their army, and it would be easy to
+ avoid the others. The danger will only lie in the last part of the
+ journey."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then you have settled to go by land?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I have decided to go all the way on horseback. We might find
+ difficulties with the Portuguese at Lorenzo Marques, and if we manage to
+ blow up the bridge, should have no horses, and should have a very bad time
+ indeed in getting back. If I can get dynamite here I shall go all the way
+ by land, and it would be safer. No doubt the Boers have spies at Durban,
+ and we might have difficulty in hiring a craft to take us to St. Lucia,
+ and our starting with horses and five or six natives would be safe to
+ attract the attention of someone looking out for news to send to the
+ Boers. I think the best plan will be to keep a little to the east of the
+ road to Greytown, where no doubt there are some Dutch, and strike the road
+ that runs from there to Eshowe. A little west of Krantzkop there must be
+ either a drift or a bridge or a ferry where it crosses the Tugela. I shall
+ of course avoid Eshowe, and then keep along inside the Zulu frontier as
+ far as the Maputa, which is its northern boundary, then we shall cross the
+ Lebombo range into Swaziland. I don't know how far it would be by the way
+ we should have to go, but as the crow flies it is about three hundred
+ miles from here. I suppose, what with the detours and passes and so on, it
+ will be four hundred. Ordinarily that distance could be done in twenty
+ days, but we must allow a good bit longer than that; fifteen miles a day
+ is the utmost we can calculate upon. However, in about a month after we
+ start we ought to be there or thereabouts. Coming back we should do it
+ more quickly, as we should have got rid of our weight and need not be
+ bothered with pack ponies."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You talk as coolly about it," Field laughed, "as if you were going out
+ for a few days' picnic."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is the same sort of thing," Chris said, "except that it will be
+ longer, a bit rougher, and a good deal more interesting."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When will you start?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "As soon as possible; all I have to see about are the dynamite and stores
+ for the journey. We know pretty well by this time what we shall want. We
+ are sure to be able to buy mealies and a bullock when we want one from the
+ natives. Some tea and coffee, a dozen tins of preserved milk, and half a
+ hundredweight of biscuits, in case of finding ourselves at a lonely camp
+ with no native kraals near, and we shall be all right. Of course we will
+ take a gallon or two of paraffin, a frying-pan, a small kettle, and so on,
+ and a lantern that will burn paraffin. We will fill up our pouches with a
+ hundred rounds of rifle cartridges and fifty for our revolvers, and then I
+ think we shall be ready. Now mind, the success of our enterprise depends
+ entirely upon your all keeping the secret absolutely. Neither Willesden,
+ Brown, nor Peters have friends here to bother themselves about their
+ absence. We are not likely to be missed, but if any questions are asked,
+ you can say casually that we are off on a scouting expedition. I shall
+ write four or five letters, with dates a week or ten days apart, and
+ direct them from here, and leave them for you to post one by one to my
+ mother. Be sure you send them in the right order. As she will suppose that
+ we are stopping here quietly, and out of all harm, she won't be uneasy
+ about me. Peters' and Willesden's friends have gone to England, so they
+ are all right, and Brown's are at the Cape. You had better write two or
+ three letters too, Brown, to be posted a fortnight or three weeks apart."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When these matters were arranged, Chris saw Jack, and the Kaffir agreed
+ without hesitation to go with him. He had been so well treated since he
+ joined them that he had become quite attached to Chris, who generally gave
+ him his orders. He was only told they were going up on an expedition to
+ Zululand and Swaziland.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I want you to find two good Zulu and two Swazis. Do you think that you
+ could do that?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are plenty of them here, baas. I look about and get good men. What
+ shall I tell them that they will have to do?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "To act as guides, to tell the chiefs who we are, and on the march to look
+ after two or three ponies. We shall only take one of the spare horses, you
+ will look after him."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Will they have guns, baas? All men like to have guns."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, they may as well carry guns, and you too, Jack."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Much better for men to have guns, baas. They would be thought nothing of
+ without them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "All right Jack, there shall be no difficulty about that; the stores are
+ full of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This was the case. Men entering the volunteer corps, or who intended to do
+ any fighting, sold the rifles they had previously used and obtained those
+ of Government pattern and carrying the regulation cartridge, so that for
+ ten pounds Chris got hold of five really good weapons, carefully selecting
+ those that carried the same-sized cartridge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You can take whichever you like," he said to Jack, who had gone with him
+ to buy them; "and I shall tell the men I engage that if at the end of the
+ journey I am well satisfied with their behaviour, I shall give them the
+ guns in addition to their pay."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A few hours afterwards Jack brought up four natives for his inspection.
+ They were all strong and well-built men, and looked capable of hard work.
+ Having been thrown out of their employment by the events of the past
+ fortnight, they were glad of a fresh job, and were highly satisfied when
+ they were offered wages considerably higher than those they had before
+ received. All preparations were completed by the following evening, and
+ the next morning at daybreak, after bidding their comrades a hearty
+ farewell, the little party started.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0009" id="link2HCH0009"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER IX &mdash; KOMATI-POORT
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The four lads were no longer dressed in the guise of farmers. These suits
+ were carried in the packs to be resumed when they neared the Transvaal.
+ They now dressed in the tweeds they had worn at Johannesburg, and either
+ felt hats or straw. They still wore jack-boots. The heat of the day was
+ now great, much more so, indeed, than they had been accustomed to, for
+ while Maritzburg lies two thousand two hundred feet above the sea,
+ Johannesburg is five thousand seven hundred. Behind them Jack led the
+ spare horse, and the four new men stepped lightly along with their muskets
+ slung behind them by the side of two strong Basuto ponies, each carrying a
+ couple of boxes containing half a hundredweight of dynamite. These were
+ concealed from view by sacks and blankets, the cooking utensils, and other
+ light articles. The spare horse carried the flour, paraffin, fuses, and
+ other stores, which brought up the weight to a hundred and twenty pounds.
+ This was somewhat lighter than that carried by the ponies, but they were
+ anxious to keep it in good condition in case one of their own gave out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The baggage had all been very carefully packed, so that even when going
+ fast it might not be displaced. They had found no difficulty in obtaining
+ the dynamite, as several of the stores kept it for the use of the mines.
+ They made no difficulty in selling it, and would not have been sorry to
+ part with their whole stock. In view of the possibility of a siege, it was
+ not an article that any sane man would care to keep on the premises. Chris
+ had gone round to these stores and had obtained an offer from each, and as
+ he said that he intended to accept the lowest tender, it was offered to
+ him at a price very much below what he would ordinarily have had to give
+ for it. The cases were sewn up in canvas, on which was painted
+ respectively, Tea, Sugar, Biscuits, and Rice. Travelling five hours and
+ halting at ten o'clock at a farmhouse that was still tenanted, and again
+ travelling from half-past three until eight, they made about twenty-five
+ miles the first day. Then they encamped at a spot where there was a small
+ spring and consequently good feed for the horses, and knee-haltering them
+ and taking off their saddles they turned them loose.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The natives had collected fuel as they went along, and a fire was soon
+ made. When the kettle approached boiling, some slices of bacon, of which
+ they had brought thirty pounds with them, were fried. There was no
+ occasion to make bread, as they had enough for a two days' supply. The
+ natives parched some mealies (Indian corn) in the frying-pan when the
+ bacon was done, the fat serving as a condiment that they highly
+ appreciated, and they quenched their thirst from the spring.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Four days' travelling took them to the drift across the Tugela. So far
+ their journey had been wholly uneventful. Before crossing the next day
+ they had a long talk with the two Zulus. Their language differed somewhat
+ from that of Jack, but Chris understood them without difficulty; for a
+ considerable portion of the labourers in the mines at Johannesburg were
+ Zulus, and mixing with these, as Chris had done, he understood them even
+ better than he did Jack.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The different routes were discussed, and the position of kraals, at which
+ mealies for the five natives and the horses could be purchased, and meat
+ possibly obtained. This, unless they bought a sheep, would be in the form
+ of biltong, that is, strips of meat dried by being hung up in the sun and
+ wind, and similar to the jerked meat of the prairies and pampas of
+ America. The points at which water could be obtained were discussed. Some
+ were at considerable distances apart; but the Zulus were of opinion that
+ the late heavy rains had extended to the hills of Zululand, and that there
+ would be abundance of water in little dongas and water-courses that would
+ be dry after a spell of fine weather. While passing through Zululand there
+ would be no occasion whatever for vigilance by day or a watch at night,
+ for there perfect order reigned. Here and there resident magistrates were
+ stationed, and at these points a few white traders had settled. All
+ disputes between the natives were ordinarily decided by their own chiefs,
+ but in serious cases an appeal could be made to the nearest magistrate,
+ who at once interfered in cases of violence or gross injustice.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the first kraal they came to they learned that the natives were
+ everywhere much excited. They were most anxious to be allowed to join in
+ the war against their old enemies, and were greatly disappointed on
+ learning from the magistrates that this was only a white man's war, and
+ that no others must take part in it. If, however, the Boers invaded their
+ territory they would of course be allowed to defend themselves.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some of the Zulus urged with reason, that though the English might wish to
+ make it a white man's war, the Boers did not desire it to be so, for they
+ knew that they had been urging the Swazis and the Basutos to join them
+ against the English, and that offers of many rifles and much plunder had
+ been made also to some of their own chiefs. To this the magistrates could
+ only reply, that they knew of old that the Boers' words could not be
+ trusted, and that they were always ready to break any arrangement that
+ they had made. "They would like you to join them," they said, "because
+ they would take your help and afterwards turn against you and steal your
+ land. You know well enough that we have always stood between you and them;
+ but they would know that if you had joined them against us we should be
+ angry, and after our war with them was over would no longer protect you."
+ The Zulus, from their knowledge of the Boers, felt that this would be so.
+ But in any case no offers made to them would have induced them to side
+ with the Boers; and it was the general hope that something might occur
+ which would induce the English to allow them to attack their enemies.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris and his friends had laid aside their bandoliers, retaining only the
+ cartridges carried in their belts, in order to assume the appearance of
+ Englishmen merely travelling for sport, and as they went on they generally
+ managed to shoot deer enough for the needs of the whole party.
+ Occasionally they slept in the kraals of chiefs, but greatly preferred
+ their own little tents as the smoke in them was often blinding, and more
+ than once the attacks of vermin kept them awake. Still, it would have been
+ a slight to refuse such invitations, and they had to go to the kraals as
+ it was necessary to frequently buy supplies of mealies. At times the
+ travelling was very rough, and with the utmost exertions they could not
+ make more than twelve or fourteen miles a day, and at other times they
+ could make five-and-twenty. Without the supply of Indian corn, the ponies
+ could not have continued this rate of going without breaking down. The
+ native horses are accustomed occasionally to make very long journeys, and
+ can perform from sixty to eighty miles in a day, but after such an
+ exertion they will need a week's rest before making another effort. With
+ their Basuto masters they are not called upon to do so. When one of these
+ makes a long journey he will leave his pony with the person he visits and
+ return on a fresh mount, or if he returns to his own home after his first
+ day's journey he will take a fresh horse from his own stock, which may
+ vary from five to fifty ponies. As they rode they seldom talked of the
+ work that was to be done. Until they saw the country, the positions, and
+ approach, no plans could possibly be formed, and they therefore treated
+ the matter as if it were a mere sporting expedition in a new country, and
+ enjoyed themselves thoroughly. They had heavy work in crossing the Lebombo
+ range, and, travelling a day's journey farther west, turned to the north
+ again. They were now in Swaziland, a wild and mountainous country. Here
+ also they were hospitably received where they stopped, although the Swazis
+ were deeply aggrieved by the shameful manner in which England had refused,
+ after the valuable aid they had rendered in the last war, to give them any
+ support against the Boers. A word would have been sufficient to have kept
+ the latter out of Swaziland, as it had kept them from raiding in Zululand;
+ but that word was not given, and the unfortunate people had been raided
+ and plundered, their best land taken from them, and they themselves
+ reduced to a state of semi-subjection. However, they were glad to see four
+ English sportsmen among them again, and to learn something of the war that
+ had broken out between their oppressors and the British.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If you beat them we shall be free again," they said. "Last time you were
+ beaten, and gave over the whole country to the Boers, and left all our
+ people, who had fought for you, at their mercy. This time you must not do
+ that. If you beat them, shoot them all like dogs, or make slaves of them
+ as they make slaves of the natives who dwell in their land. Only so will
+ there be peace."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't know that the English will do that," Chris said; "but you may be
+ sure that, when the war is over, the Boers will be no longer masters, and
+ there will be just law made by us, and all white men and all natives will
+ be protected, and no evil deeds will be allowed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are no longer united among ourselves," one of the chiefs said. "Some
+ have been taken by the promises and gifts of the Boers, and our queen is
+ also, it is said, in their favour. She is afraid of them, but most of us
+ would take advantage of their fighting you to drive all of them out of our
+ land, and to win back all the territory they have taken from us. We are
+ very poor, our best land is gone, we can scarce grow enough food; and we
+ long for the time when once again we can have rich mealie patches, and
+ good grazing land for our oxen and our horses, and are again a strong
+ people, and they afraid of us. Had not the English interfered and taken
+ over the Boer country, we should have wasted it from end to end; and they
+ knew it well, and begged your Shepstone to hoist your flag and protect
+ them. Ah, he should have stayed there then! The natives, our friends in
+ the plain, still talk of that happy time when you were masters, and the
+ Boers dared no longer shoot them down as if they were wild beasts and
+ treat them as slaves, and the towns grew up, and your people paid for work
+ with money and not with the lash of a whip or a bullet. All of us have
+ mourned over the time when the English bent their knee to the Boers, and
+ gave them all they wanted,&mdash;the mastery of the land, and the right to
+ kill and enslave us at their will."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That was not quite so," Chris said. "They promised to give good treatment
+ to the natives; that was one of the conditions of the treaty."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And you believed them!" the chief said scornfully. "Did you not know that
+ a Boer's oath is only good so long as a gun is pointed at him? Perhaps it
+ will be like this again, and when you have conquered them you will again
+ trust them, and march away. But they tell us, it is not you who will
+ conquer them, but they who will conquer you. They tell our people that
+ they will be masters over all the land, and that your people will have to
+ sail away in your ships. Runners have brought us news that they have
+ gathered round the place where our people go to work digging bright stones
+ from the ground, and that very soon they will take all the English
+ prisoners, and that they have also beset Mafeking, and that they have
+ beaten the English soldiers in Natal, and there will soon be none left
+ there; and more than that, that the people of the other Boer state have
+ joined them, and have entered the English territory, and are being joined
+ by all the Boers there. Therefore we, who would like to fight against
+ them, are afraid. We thought the English a great people; they had beaten
+ the Zulus, and dethroned the great King Cetewayo. But now it seems that
+ the Boers are much greater, and our hearts are sore."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You need not fear, chief," Chris said. "Our country is very many miles
+ away, many days' journey in ships; it will take weeks before our army gets
+ strong. The Boers have always said they wanted peace, and we believed them
+ and kept but a few soldiers here, and until the army comes from England
+ they will get the best of it; but we can send, if necessary, an army many
+ times stronger than that of the Boers, and are sure to crush them in the
+ end."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But how could you believe they wanted peace?" the chief asked. "Everyone
+ knew that they were building great forts, and had got guns bigger than
+ were ever before seen, and stores full of rifles. How could you believe
+ their words when your eyes saw that it was not peace but war that they
+ meant?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Because we were fools, I suppose," Chris said bitterly. "It was not from
+ want of warnings, for people living out here had written again and again
+ telling what vast preparations they were making, but the people who govern
+ the country paid no attention. It was much easier to believe what was
+ pleasant than what was unpleasant; but their folly will cost the country
+ very dear. If they had sent over twenty thousand men a year ago there
+ would have been no war; now they will have to send over a hundred thousand
+ men, perhaps even more; and great sums of money will be spent, and great
+ numbers of lives lost, simply because our government refused to believe
+ what everyone out here knew to be the fact. We did nothing, and allowed
+ the Boers to complete all their preparations, and to choose their own time
+ for war. But though we have made a horrible mistake, do not think, chief,
+ that there is any doubt about our conquering at last; the men who now
+ govern our country are men and not cowards, and will not, as that other
+ government did, go on their knees to the Boers, and even if they would do
+ so, the people would not sanction it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If what the chief has heard is correct," Chris said as they rode along
+ the next morning, "we must get back again as soon as we can. The Boers may
+ be lying, and, of course, they would make the best of things to the
+ Swazis. It certainly sounds as if not only at Ladysmith, but at all other
+ places, things are going badly at present. However, in another couple of
+ days we shall not be far from the bridge. The chief said that the frontier
+ was only a few miles away, and our own men tell us that it is a very hilly
+ country on the other side, just as it is here. We have certainly come
+ faster that we had expected. Thanks to their good feeding, the horses have
+ all turned out well. If it is really only two days farther, we shall get
+ there in just three weeks from starting."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had not brought the same ponies all the way; as soon as one showed
+ signs of fatigue, it was changed for another with the arrangement that,
+ should they return that way, they would take it back and give the chief a
+ present for having seen that it was taken care of. The four natives,
+ although well contented with the way in which they were fed and cared for,
+ were much puzzled at the eagerness of their employers to push on, and the
+ disregard they paid to all the information obtained for them of
+ opportunities for sport. Several times they had said to Jack: "How is it
+ the baas does not stop to shoot? There are plenty of deer, and in some
+ places lions. There are zebras, too, though these are not easy to get at,
+ and very difficult to stalk. Why do you push on so fast that the ponies
+ have to be left behind, and others taken on? We cannot understand it. We
+ have been with white men who came into our country to shoot, or to see
+ what the land was like, but they did not travel like this. Besides, we
+ shall soon be in the land of the Boers, and as the English are at war with
+ them, they will shoot them if they find them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Jack had only been told that his masters were going to strike a blow at
+ the Boers, and had not troubled himself as to its nature. He had seen how
+ they had defeated much larger parties than their own, and had unbounded
+ confidence in them. He therefore only said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The baas has not told me. I know that all the gentlemen are very brave,
+ and have no fear of the Boers. I do not think that we need fear that any
+ harm will happen. They shoot enough for us to eat heartily, they buy drink
+ for us at every kraal they stop at, and if they have seen no game they buy
+ a sheep. What can we want more? They have got you guns, but you have never
+ needed to use them; perhaps you may before you get back. If the Boers
+ meddle with them you will be able to fight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The prospect of a chance of being allowed to fight against the Boers would
+ alone have inspired the four natives to bear any amount of fatigue without
+ a murmur, and each day's march farther north had heightened their hopes
+ that they might use their guns against their old enemies. It was on the
+ twenty-first day after starting that, from a hill commanding a broad
+ extent of country, they caught sight of a train of waggons, and knew that
+ their journey was just at an end. They had debated which side of the
+ Komati river would be the best to follow, and had agreed to take the
+ eastern bank.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boer territory extended a few miles beyond this. Komati-poort was
+ close to the frontier. As they knew nothing as to the construction of the
+ bridge beyond the fact that it was iron, and were not even sure whether it
+ was entirely on Boer ground, or if the eastern bank of the river here
+ belonged to the Portuguese, they decided that at any rate it was better to
+ travel as near the frontier as possible, as, were they pursued they could
+ ride at once across the line. Not that they believed that the Boers would
+ respect this, but they would not know the country so well as that on their
+ own side, and would not find countrymen to join them in the pursuit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Keeping down on the eastern side of the hills, they continued until they
+ could see the white line of steam that showed the direction in which a
+ train from the south-east was coming, and were therefore able to calculate
+ within half a mile where the bridge must be situated. They camped in a dry
+ donga, and next morning at daybreak left their horses behind them in
+ charge of the men and walked forward. A mile farther they obtained a view
+ of the bridge. It stood at the point where the river, after running for
+ some little distance north-west, made a sharp curve to the south. The
+ bridge stood at this loop. If the object had been to render it defensible,
+ it had been admirably chosen by these Boers who laid out the line to the
+ Portuguese frontier, for from the other side of the bank the approach
+ could be swept by cannon and even musketry on both flanks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Lying down, they took in all the details of the construction through their
+ glasses, and then, choosing their ground so that they could not be seen by
+ any on the bridge, they kept on until they were able to obtain a view from
+ a distance of a quarter of a mile. The examination that was now made was
+ by no means of a satisfactory nature. Near the bridge there were sidings
+ on which several lines of loaded trucks stood. An engine was at work
+ shunting. At least a score of natives were at work under the direction of
+ Portuguese, while several men, who were by their dress evidently Boers,
+ were pointing out to the officials the trucks they desired to be first
+ forwarded. Three or four of these carried huge cases, two of them being
+ each long enough to occupy two trucks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no doubt those are guns," Chris said. "If we can do nothing
+ else, we can work a lot of damage here, which will be some sort of
+ satisfaction after our long ride. As to our main object, things don't look
+ well."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Half a dozen armed Boers could be made out stationed at the Portuguese
+ side of the bridge, and as many more at the opposite end. Two
+ lately-erected wooden huts, each of which could give shelter to some fifty
+ men, stood a short distance beyond the bridge, and it was evident by the
+ figures moving about, and a number of horses grazing near, that a strong
+ party was stationed there to furnish guards for the bridge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am afraid we cannot do it," Peters said, after their glasses had all
+ been fixed on the bridge for several minutes; "at least, I don't see any
+ chance. What do you say, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, I am afraid there is none. If we were to crawl up to them to-night
+ and shoot down all at this end of the bridge, we should be no nearer. You
+ see, there are a line of huts on this side, and two or three better-class
+ houses. No doubt the railway officials and natives all live there; they
+ would all turn out when they heard the firing, and the Boers would come
+ rushing over from the other side. It would be out of the question for us
+ to carry forward those four boxes to the middle of the bridge, plant them
+ over the centre of the girders, and light the fuses. A quarter of an hour
+ would be wanted for the business at the very least, and we should not have
+ a minute, if there is as good a guard by night as there is by day. It is
+ likely to be at least as large, perhaps much more than that. The thing is
+ impossible in that way. However, of course we can crawl up close after
+ dark and satisfy ourselves about the guard.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If it is not to be managed in that way, we must go down to the river bank
+ and see whether there is anything to be done with one of the piers. If
+ that is not possible, we must content ourselves with smashing things up
+ generally on this side. Several of the trucks look to me to be full of
+ ammunition, and there are eight with long cases which are no doubt rifles.
+ We all remember that terrific smash at Johannesburg, and though I don't
+ say we could do such awful damage as there was there&mdash;for there were
+ I don't know how many tons of dynamite exploded then, I think about fifty&mdash;still,
+ it would be a heavy blow. Any amount of stores would be destroyed, some
+ thousand of rifles, and, for aught I know, all those waggons with
+ tarpaulins over them are full of cartridges. However, the bridge is the
+ principal thing. We will stop here for an hour or two and examine every
+ foot of the ground, so as to be able to find our way in the dark. We need
+ not mind about the trucks now, we can examine their position to-morrow if
+ we have to give up the idea of the bridge."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On returning to their horses they had a long talk. Chris was deeply
+ disappointed, but the others, who had never quite believed that his scheme
+ could be carried out, were greatly delighted at the knowledge that at any
+ rate they might be able to do an immense deal of damage to the enemy. As
+ soon as it became quite dark, they set out again; they did not take their
+ rifles with them, but each had his brace of revolvers. They had no
+ intention of fighting, except to secure a retreat. Before starting, each
+ had wound strips of flannel round his boots, so that they could run
+ noiselessly. Brown had in the first place suggested that they should take
+ their boots off, but Chris pointed out that if they had to run in the
+ dark, one or other of them was sure to lame himself by striking against a
+ stone or other obstacle. There were several large fires in the shunting
+ yard, and at each end of the bridge, and at the Boer barracks. Crawling
+ along on their hands and knees they were completely in the shade, and
+ managed to get within some twenty or thirty yards of the Boers, who were
+ sitting smoking and talking. They were all evidently greatly satisfied
+ with news that they had heard during the day. Listening to their talk,
+ they gathered something of what had happened since they left Estcourt.
+ Colenso had been evacuated by us, an armoured train coming up from
+ Estcourt had been drawn off the line, and most of the soldiers with it had
+ been killed or captured. The last news was that the British had sallied
+ out from Estcourt, which was now surrounded, and had attacked the Boers
+ posted in a very strong position near a place called Willow Grange, but
+ had been repulsed, principally by the artillery, with, it was said,
+ immense loss. This was not pleasant hearing for the listeners. The Boers
+ then had a grumble at being kept so far away from the fighting. It was not
+ that they were so anxious to be engaged, as to get a share of the loot, as
+ it had been reported that something like twenty thousand cattle and horses
+ had been driven off from Natal.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then their conversation turned upon a point still more interesting to the
+ listeners. A commando had started from Barberton, a border town some
+ thirty or forty miles to the west, into Swaziland. A native had mentioned
+ to one of the Boers there that four Englishmen had passed north. They had
+ stopped at his chief's kraal. They were all quite young, and had five
+ natives with them, and three pack-horses. They had come to shoot and see
+ the country, they said; but they had spoken with one of the men with them,
+ who said that so far they had not done much hunting, only enough for food;
+ he supposed that they were going to begin further on. The Boer had an hour
+ later ridden down to Barberton with the news, and it had been at once
+ resolved to send off a commando of a hundred men to search the hills, for
+ there was a suspicion that the hunters were British officers who had come
+ up to act as spies.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Our cornet had a telegram this afternoon," one of them said, "that we
+ were to be specially vigilant here, and we must keep a sharp lookout at
+ night. I don't suppose they are on this side of the river. They may be
+ going to pull up the railway, or blow up a culvert somewhere between this
+ and Barberton. Four men with their Kaffirs might do that, but they
+ certainly could not damage this bridge."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At ten o'clock most of the party retired into a small shed a few yards
+ away, but two remained sitting by the fire, and were evidently left on
+ guard, for they kept their rifles close at hand. The lads now crawled away
+ some distance, and then made their way down a steep bank to the river. It
+ was a stream of some size, running with great rapidity, and it did not
+ take them long to decide that it would be impossible to swim out with the
+ cases and place these in such a situation that the explosion would damage
+ the structure. They then moved quietly up to the spot where the end of the
+ last span touched the level ground; it rested upon a solid wall built into
+ the rock, and ran some forty feet above their heads. They were now just
+ under where the Boers were sitting, could hear their voices, and see the
+ glow of their fire. They were unable to make out the exact position of the
+ girders, but they had, when watching it, obtained a general view of the
+ construction.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It consisted of two lines of strong girders on each side, connected by
+ lattice bars, with strong communications between the sides at each pier.
+ The depth of the girders was some twenty feet. After cautiously feeling
+ the wall and finding that there were no openings in which their explosives
+ could be placed, they crawled away noiselessly, ascended to the bank again
+ a couple of hundred yards from the bridge, and returned to their camping
+ ground. They observed as they went that there were still fires burning in
+ the station yard, that some Kaffirs were seated near these, and as, in the
+ silence of the night, a faint sound could be heard like that of a distant
+ train, they had no doubt that they were waiting up for one to arrive.
+ Indeed, before they had reached the camping place they saw a train pass
+ by. It had no lights save the head-lights and that of the engine fire, and
+ they therefore had no doubt that it was another train with stores.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When they reached their tents they had a long consultation. No fire had
+ been lighted. The horses had been taken some way up a little ravine down
+ which a stream of water trickled; here the four natives had taken up their
+ post. These had only come down in the middle of the day to fetch their
+ food, which Jack cooked over the spirit stove. This was alight when the
+ lads returned, but was carefully screened round by blankets so that not
+ the slightest glow could be seen from a distance.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you think of it, Chris?" Brown said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't know what to think about it. I have no idea what effect dynamite
+ would have when exploded at a distance of thirty or forty feet below a
+ bridge. Certainly it would blow the roadway up, but I have very great
+ doubts whether it would so twist or smash the main girders as to render
+ the bridge impassable. The distance to the first pier is not great, and
+ unless one entirely destroyed the bridge, I should say that it could be
+ repaired very soon&mdash;I mean, in a week or two&mdash;by a strong gang.
+ If the girders kept their places, two or three days' work might patch it
+ up temporarily. If it were destroyed altogether as far as the first pier,
+ it would stop the cannon getting over till a temporary bridge is
+ constructed; but by rigging up some strong cables, they could pass cases
+ of musket ammunition across the gap in the same way, you know, as I have
+ seen pictures of shipwrecked people being swung along under a cable in a
+ sort of cradle. What do you think, Peters?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Two hundred pounds of dynamite would do a lot of damage, Chris. I should
+ think that it would certainly bring the wall down."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no doubt that it would do that, Peters, but the ironwork goes some
+ ten yards farther, and no doubts rests on the solid rock. I expect the
+ wall is put there more to finish the thing off than to carry much of the
+ weight. Again, you see it is only a single line, and not above ten feet
+ wide, which is against us, for the wider the line the better chance it has
+ of being smashed by an explosion some forty feet below it. Well, we will
+ have another look at the bridge and the waggons to-morrow. Of course the
+ bridge is the great thing if it can be managed, though I don't say that
+ blowing up the yard would not be a good thing if we can't make sure of the
+ other. Anyhow, we need not feel down-hearted about it. We came up here on
+ the chance, and even though we may not be able to do exactly what we want,
+ we ought to manage to do them a lot of damage."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After eating their supper they turned in to their two little tents. The
+ spirit-lamp had been extinguished, and as they had not the least fear of
+ discovery, they did not consider it necessary to place a sentinel. In the
+ morning they were out again early and at their former post of observation.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What are they up to now?" Brown said an hour later when he saw a party of
+ Boers come down the opposite side close to the bridge, carrying posts and
+ planks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris made no answer, he was watching them intently. They stopped near the
+ bank of the river close to the bridge. Then some of them set to work to
+ level a space of ground, while others made holes at the corners.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am afraid that it is all up with our plans as far as the bridge is
+ concerned. They are going to put up a hut there, and I have not the least
+ doubt it means they are going to station a guard under the bridge. If they
+ do it that side, they are probably doing the same on this, only we can't
+ see them. The Boers are stupid enough in some things, but they are sharp
+ enough in others, and it is possible that the commando from Barberton has
+ come upon one of the kraals where we slept, and asking a lot of questions
+ about us, they have found out that we had four heavy boxes with us, and
+ the idea may have struck them that these contained explosives. If that did
+ occur to them, it is almost certain that a man has been sent off at once
+ to Barberton with orders to telegraph here and to other bridges, to take
+ every precaution against their being blown up. Anyhow, there is a hut
+ building there, and I don't see that it can be for any other purpose."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After three hours' work the hut was completed, and a party of eight men
+ brought down blankets and other kit. Two of these at once ascended the
+ bank with their rifles and sat down at the foot of the wall.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That ends the business," Chris said. "However, I will creep round to a
+ point where I can get a view of this side of the bridge. Possibly they
+ have only taken precautions on their own side, for we were travelling for
+ some time in the Swazis' country to the west of the Komati, and that is
+ where they will have heard of us." He crawled away among the rocks, and
+ rejoined his companions an hour later.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is just the same this side. They have settled the question for us. Now
+ we will give our attention to the waggons."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0010" id="link2HCH0010"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER X &mdash; AN EXPLOSION
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Having given up all hopes of blowing up the bridge, Chris and his comrades
+ turned their whole attention to the lines of waggons. The train that had
+ come in on the previous evening had added to the number, although it had
+ taken some of them away with it up country. They now made out that there
+ were eight waggons piled with cases, that almost certainly contained
+ rifles; six with tarpaulins closely packed over them, and these they
+ guessed contained ammunition boxes; four, each with two large cases that
+ might contain field guns; while the two with what they were sure were big
+ guns still remained on the siding.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I should say that about four or five pounds of dynamite would be an
+ abundance for each of those ammunition waggons; less than that would do,
+ as we could, by slitting the tarpaulins, put a pound among the cases, and
+ if one case were exploded it would set all the others off. There is no
+ trouble about them. I will just take a note. They are on the second
+ siding; there are eight other waggons in front of them and six behind, so
+ we cannot make any mistake about that. There must be a good heavy charge
+ under the rifle trucks, for we shall have to blow them all well into the
+ air to bend and damage them enough to be altogether unserviceable. As for
+ the guns, and especially the heavy ones, it is a difficult question. Of
+ course, if we could open the cases and get at the breech-pieces, and put
+ dynamite among them, we could damage all the mechanism so much that the
+ guns would be useless until new breech-pieces were made, which I fancy
+ must be altogether beyond the Boers; but as there is no possibility of
+ opening them, we must trust to blowing the guns so high in the air that
+ they will be too much damaged for use by the explosion and fall. We have
+ got altogether two hundredweight; now two pounds to each ammunition waggon
+ will take twelve pounds. What shall we say for the rifles?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Ten pounds," Brown suggested.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That would take eighty more pounds," Willesden objected, "which would
+ make a big hole in our stores."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We must have a good charge," Chris said. "Suppose we say nine pounds to
+ each, that will save eight pounds; fifteen pounds apiece ought to give the
+ eight cases which we suppose hold field-guns a good hoist; that will leave
+ us with over a hundred pounds, fifty for each of the big guns. Now that we
+ have seen all that is necessary, we may as well be off and begin to get
+ ready."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The covers were taken off the boxes of dynamite, and these were unscrewed,
+ and the explosive was with great care divided into the portions as agreed
+ upon. Two of the cases furnished just sufficient for the ammunition
+ waggons and the two big guns, the other two for the smaller cannon and the
+ trucks with the rifles. The charges were sewn up in pieces of the canvas,
+ the smaller charges for the ammunition boxes being enclosed in thinner
+ stuff that had been sewn under the canvas used in packing; the fuses and
+ detonators were then cut and inserted. Chris was perfectly up in this
+ work, having performed the operation scores of times in the mines. The
+ length it should burn was only decided after a discussion.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There would be in all nineteen charges to explode, and these were in three
+ groups at some little distance from each other, all the cannon being on
+ the same siding. It would be necessary, perhaps, to wait for some time
+ till all these were free from observation by natives or others who might
+ be moving about the yard, then a signal must be given that they could all
+ see. It would not take long to light the fuses, for each of them would be
+ provided with a slow match, which burns with but a spark, and could be
+ held under a hat or an inverted tin cup till the time came for using it.
+ The question was how far must they be away to ensure their own safety, and
+ Chris maintained that at least four or five hundred yards would be
+ necessary to place them in even comparative safety from the rain of
+ fragments that would fall over a wide area. Finally it was agreed to cut
+ the fuses to a length to burn four minutes; this would allow a minute for
+ any hitch that might occur in lighting them, and three minutes to burn. It
+ was of course important that they should be no longer than was absolutely
+ necessary, as there existed a certain risk that one of the little sparks
+ might be seen by a passing Kaffir, or, as was still more probable, the
+ smell of burning powder should attract attention. It was agreed that Chris
+ should light the fuses at the cannon, which were farthest from the others,
+ that Peters should see to the six rifle trucks, and Willesden and Brown
+ attend the eight trucks with the ammunition, one to begin at each end of
+ the line.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When each had finished his work, he was to run straight away in the
+ direction of the encampment, and all were to throw themselves down when
+ they felt sure that the time for the explosions had arrived. As soon as
+ all was over they were to meet at their place of encampment. Tents and all
+ stores were to be removed before the work began to the ravine where the
+ horses were, the men with them being charged to stand at the animals'
+ heads, as there would be a great explosion, and the horses might break
+ loose and stampede. The matter that puzzled them the most was how, when
+ they reached their respective stations&mdash;separated from each other by
+ lines of waggons, and in some cases by distances of a couple of hundred
+ yards&mdash;they were to know when the work of lighting the fuses was to
+ begin. It could not be done by sound, for this would reach the ears of any
+ awake in the yard or the sentries at the bridge. Chris at last suggested a
+ plan.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When we start, Jack shall be stationed at a point on the hillside high
+ enough for us to see him from all points of the yard. We will show him the
+ exact spot while it is light. When we start he shall go down with us to
+ the edge of the yard, and as we separate will turn and go up to the point
+ we had shown him. He will be ordered to walk up quietly, and not to hurry;
+ that will give us ample time to get to our stations before he reaches his.
+ We must all keep our eyes fixed on that point. He will take the dark
+ lantern with him; when he gets there he must turn the shade off, so as to
+ show the light for a quarter of a minute. That will be our signal to
+ begin. It is most unlikely that anyone else will see it, but even if they
+ did they would simply stare in that direction and wonder what it was. Of
+ course, only a flash would be safer; but some of us might not see it, and
+ would remain waiting for it until the other explosions took place."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All agreed that this would be a very good plan. Chris crawled up with Jack
+ until he reached a spot where he commanded a perfect view of the yard, and
+ explained to him exactly what he was to do. He had already been told what
+ was going to take place. Knowing that the Kaffirs have very little idea of
+ time, he said: "You will hold it open while you say slowly like this, 'I
+ am showing the light, baas, and I hope that you can all see it.' You will
+ say that over twice and then turn off the light, and lie down under that
+ big rock till you hear the explosion. Wait a little, for stones and
+ fragments will come tumbling down. When they have stopped doing so make
+ your way straight to where the horses are; you will find us there before
+ you. Now, repeat over to me the words you are to say slowly twice."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Jack did so, and finding on questioning him that he perfectly understood
+ what he was to do, Chris went back with him to the encampment, where they
+ remained quietly until the sun set and darkness came on. Then, according
+ to arrangement, the four natives came in and carried all the things back
+ to the ravine, and laid them down ready to pack the horses as soon as
+ their masters returned.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The day passed slowly to the lads. All were in a state of suppressed
+ excitement, an excitement vastly greater than they had felt during their
+ two fights with the Boers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How they will wonder who did it when they hear the news down in Natal!"
+ Peters said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't expect they will hear much about it," Chris said. "You may be
+ sure the Boers will not say much; they make a big brag over every success,
+ but they won't care to publish such a thing as this. Probably their papers
+ will only say: 'An explosion of a trifling nature occurred on the
+ Portuguese side of Komati-poort. Some barrels of powder exploded; it is
+ unknown whether it was the result of accident or the work of spies. Due
+ precaution will be taken to prevent the recurrence of the accident. Beyond
+ a few natives employed at the station, no one was hurt.'"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The others laughed. "I suppose that will be about it, Chris. However, I
+ have no doubt that that commando from Barberton will keep a very sharp
+ look-out for us as we go back."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, but they won't catch us. We won't venture into Swaziland again, but
+ will make our way down on the Portuguese side, following the railway till
+ we are fairly beyond the mountain range. We can ride fast now that we have
+ got rid of the dynamite. It will be some time before they get the news
+ about what has happened here, for the telegraph wires are sure to be
+ broken and the instruments smashed. I really think that our best way will
+ be to ride straight down to Lorenzo Marques. When we get there we can very
+ well state that we had been ordered to leave Johannesburg, and that, as
+ the trains are so slow and so crowded with fugitives, we had ridden down.
+ I don't suppose that we shall attract the least notice, for we know that a
+ great many of those who had intended to stay have been ordered off. That
+ way we shall get back to Natal in a few days and avoid all danger." The
+ others agreed that this would be a capital plan; and the distance by the
+ road, which they had crossed a few miles to the south, and which runs from
+ Lorenzo Marques up to Ladysdorp and the Murchison and Klein Lemba
+ gold-fields, would not be above seventy miles. They would wait till
+ daybreak showed them the amount of damage that had been done, and then
+ start, and would be down at Lorenzo Marques in the evening, when, even if
+ the news of the explosion reached the town, the Boers' suspicions that
+ some Englishmen were in the hills, and that it was probably their work,
+ would not be known. Not until ten o'clock was a move made. Then they took
+ up the packages of dynamite, and, accompanied by Jack, made their way
+ noiselessly down to the railway yard.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Here they separated. Chris, aided by Jack, carried the big packets for the
+ large guns and for the eight smaller ones. They met no one about, and
+ depositing their packages in the right position under them&mdash;the fuses
+ had been already inserted&mdash;they returned to the spot they had left.
+ In a minute or two they were joined by the others. Peters had placed his
+ parcels under the eight trucks with rifles; Willesden and Brown had cut
+ holes in the tarpaulins of the ammunition trucks, and thrust down their
+ charges well among the boxes. All was ready. While the others stood
+ closely round him Jack opened the lantern just widely enough for them to
+ light their slow matches.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, you are not to hurry back to the place, Jack; we shall all be on the
+ look-out for you by the time you get there. You know your instructions;
+ you are to turn round, open the slide of the lantern, say the words I told
+ you over twice slowly, then shut the lantern and get under that great
+ boulder lying against the rock. You will be perfectly safe in there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I understand, baas," he said, and at once turned and went off. The others
+ hurried to their respective posts, and then turned round and gazed at the
+ spot where the light would be shown. In their anxiety and excitement the
+ time seemed interminable, and each began to think that the native had
+ somehow blundered; at last the light appeared, and they turned at once to
+ their work. Half a minute sufficed to light the fuses, and then they
+ hurried away cautiously until past all the waggons, and then at full speed
+ along the hillside, their thickly-padded shoes making no noise upon the
+ rocks. Knowing that they were sure to be confused as to the time, they had
+ calculated before the sun had set how far they could run in three minutes,
+ which should be, if all went well, the time they would have after leaving
+ the yard. They thought that even on the rough ground, and in the dark,
+ they could make a hundred and fifty yards a minute, and at about four
+ hundred and fifty from the waggons there was a low ridge of rock behind
+ which they would obtain protection from all fragments blown directly
+ outwards.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris was the first to arrive, for the trucks with the cannon were those
+ farthest away from the bridge, and he was able to run for some distance
+ along the line before making for the elope, and therefore travelled faster
+ than his companions, who had farther to run on broken ground. In half a
+ minute they rushed up almost together.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Throw yourselves down," Chris shouted; "we shall have it directly."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Twenty seconds later there was a tremendous roar and a blinding crash, and
+ they felt the ground shake. Almost simultaneously came eight others, then
+ in quick succession followed six other reports, and mingled with these a
+ confused roar of innumerable shots blended together. There was a momentary
+ pause, and then a deafening clatter as rifles, fragments of iron and wood
+ came falling down over a wide area. Several fell close to where the lads
+ were crouched against the rock, but none touched them. For a full
+ half-minute the fragments continued to fall, then the boys stood up and
+ looked round. It was too dark to see more than that the yard was a chaos;
+ the long lines of waggons, the huts and buildings, had all disappeared;
+ loud shouts could be heard from the other side of the bridge, but nearer
+ to them everything was silent. There was no doubt that the success of the
+ attempt was complete, and the lads walked back quietly until they were at
+ the spot where the horses had been placed, Jack overtaking them just as
+ they reached it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It was terrible, baas," he said in an awed voice. "Jack thought his life
+ was gone. Things fell on the rock but could not break it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Nothing short of one of those big cannon would have done that, Jack.
+ Well, we shall see in the morning what damage is done."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The four natives, although they had been warned, were still terribly
+ frightened. The horses had at the first crash broken away and run up the
+ ravine, but they had just brought them down again, still trembling and
+ lathering with fear. For some minutes the boys patted and soothed them,
+ and accustomed to their voices and caresses they gradually quieted down,
+ but were very restless until day began to break. The boys had no thought
+ of sleep. The lamp was lit and tea made, and each of the Kaffirs was given
+ a glass of spirits and water, for they had brought up a bottle with them
+ in case of illness or any special need; and it was evident from their
+ chattering teeth and broken speech that the natives needed a stimulant
+ badly. Before it became light the horses were saddled, and the five
+ natives told to take them along the hill a mile farther. When they had
+ seen them off the lads returned to their former post above the station.
+ They had several times, when they looked out during the night, seen a
+ great light in that direction, and had no doubt that some of the fallen
+ huts had caught fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: "THERE WAS A TREMENDOUS ROAR AND A BLINDING CRASH."]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Prepared as they were for a scene of destruction, the reality far exceeded
+ their expectations. All the waggons within a considerable distance of the
+ explosions were smashed into fragments, their wheels broken and the axles
+ twisted. The ammunition trucks had disappeared, and many close to them had
+ been completely shattered. Those in which the muskets had been were a mere
+ heap of fragments; the rest of the trucks lay, some with their sides blown
+ in, others comparatively uninjured. Some were piled on the top of others
+ three or four deep; their contents were scattered over the whole yard.
+ Boxes and cases were burst open, and their contents&mdash;including large
+ quantities of tea, sugar, tinned provisions in vast quantities, and other
+ stores&mdash;ruined.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some still smoking brands showed where the huts had stood, and the dead
+ bodies of some twenty natives and several Portuguese officials, were
+ scattered here and there. The bodies of eight Boers were laid out together
+ by the bridge, and forty or fifty men were wandering aimlessly amid the
+ ruins. A huge cannon stood upright nearly in the centre of the yard. It
+ had fallen on its muzzle, which had penetrated some feet into the earth.
+ They could not see where its fellow had fallen. Five others, which looked
+ like fifteen-pounders, were lying in different directions, the other three
+ had disappeared. Rifles twisted, bent, and ruined were lying about
+ everywhere.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is not as good as the bridge," Chris said after they had used their
+ glasses for some time in silence, "but it is a heavy blow for them, and I
+ should think it will be a week before the line can be cleared ready for
+ traffic. Even when they begin they will feel the loss of so much
+ rolling-stock. There were five engines in the yard. Every one of these has
+ been upset, and will want a lot of repairs before it is fit for anything
+ again. I wish I had a kodak with me to take a dozen snap-shots, it would
+ be something worth showing when we get back. Well, we may as well be
+ moving. The Boers look as if they were stupefied at present, but they will
+ be waking up presently, and the sooner we start for Lorenzo Marques the
+ better."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Half an hour later they had mounted and were on their way, travelling
+ slowly till they came upon the road, and then at a fast pace. Jack rode
+ the spare horse, the other natives rode the ponies in turn, those on foot
+ keeping up without difficulty by laying a hand on the saddles. Sometimes
+ they trotted for two or three miles, and then went at a walk for half an
+ hour, and stopped altogether for four hours in the heat of the day, for
+ they were now getting on to low land, being only some three hundred feet
+ above the sea. They reached Lorenzo Marques at about nine o'clock in the
+ evening, and failing to find beds, for the town was full of emigrants from
+ the Transvaal, they camped in the open. In the morning they sold the two
+ ponies, and were fortunate in finding a steamer lying there that would
+ start the next day. Being very unwilling to part with their horses they
+ arranged for deck passages for them, taking their own risk of injury to
+ them in case of rough weather setting in. Every berth was already engaged,
+ but this mattered little to them, as they could sleep upon the planks as
+ well as on the ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They found that there was some excitement in the town, as there was a
+ report that there had been an explosion and much damage done near
+ Komati-poort. No particulars were, however, known, as the railway
+ officials maintained a strict silence as to the affair. It was known,
+ however, that the telegraphic communication with the Transvaal was broken,
+ and that three trains filled with Kaffir labourers, and accompanied by a
+ number of officials and a company of soldiers, had gone up early that
+ morning. Among the fugitives strong hopes were expressed that the damage
+ had been serious enough to interrupt the traffic for some little time, and
+ to cause serious inconvenience to the Boers, and some even hazarded the
+ hope that the bridge had suffered. This, however, seemed unlikely in the
+ extreme.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Fortunately the weather was fine on the run down to Durban, and the
+ passage of three hundred miles was effected in twenty-four hours. It was
+ now just a month since they had left Maritzburg, and as soon as they
+ landed with their horses and followers they learned that much had taken
+ place during that time.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had started on the 10th of November. The Boers were then steadily
+ advancing, and so great did the danger appear, that Durban had been
+ strongly fortified by the blue jackets, aided by Kaffir labour. On the
+ 25th Sir Redvers Buller had arrived, and by this time a considerable force
+ was gathered at Estcourt. The British advance began from that town on the
+ following day. The place had been entirely cut off, Boers occupying the
+ whole country as far as the Mooi river. General Hildyard, who commanded at
+ Estcourt, had been obliged to inarch out several times to keep them at a
+ distance from the town, and one or two sharp artillery engagements had
+ taken place, the Boers being commanded by General Joubert in person. They
+ had always retired a short distance, but their movements were so rapid
+ that it was useless to follow; and the troops had each time fallen back to
+ Estcourt. On the 28th the Boers had blown up the bridge across the Tugela,
+ and our army was moving forward, and a great battle was expected shortly.
+ On landing Chris rode at once to the address given by his mother, and
+ found that she had sailed for Cape Town a week before. Riding then to the
+ railway, he found that the line was closed altogether to passenger
+ traffic, but that a train with some troops and a strong detachment of
+ sailors was going up that evening. Learning that a naval officer was in
+ command, as the military consisted only of small parties of men who had
+ been left behind, when their regiments left, to look after and forward
+ their stores, he went to him. He had, before landing, donned his civilian
+ suit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What can I do for you, sir?" the officer, who was watching a party
+ loading trucks with sheep, asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "My name is King, sir. I have just returned from an expedition to Komati,
+ I and three friends with me, and we have succeeded in blowing up a large
+ number of waggons containing a battery of field artillery, two very heavy
+ long guns, which, by the marks on the case, came from Creusot, some eight
+ or ten thousand rifles, and six truck-loads of ammunition."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The deuce you have!" the officer said, looking with great surprise at the
+ lad who told him this astonishing tale. Then sharply he added: "Are you
+ speaking the truth, sir? You will find it the worse for you if you are
+ not."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What I say is perfectly true," Chris said quietly. "We only arrived an
+ hour since from Lorenzo Marques. This open letter from General Yule will
+ show you that the party of boys of whom I was the leader, have done some
+ good service before now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer opened and read the letter. "I must beg your pardon for having
+ doubted your word," he said, as he handed it back. "After adventuring into
+ a Boer camp, and giving so heavy a lesson to a superior force of the
+ enemy, I can quite imagine you capable of carrying out the adventure you
+ have just spoken of. Now, sir, what can I do for you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have come to ask if you will allow myself and my three friends to
+ accompany you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That I will most certainly. And indeed, as you have a report to make of
+ this matter to General Buller, you have a right to go on by the first
+ military train. Is there anything else?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir; I should be greatly obliged if you will authorize the
+ station-master to attach a carriage to the train to take our five horses."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will go with you to him," the officer said. "I can't say whether that
+ can be managed or not."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The station-master at first said that it was impossible, for his orders
+ were for a certain number of carriages and trucks, and with those orders
+ from the commanding officer he could not add to the number.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But you might slip it on behind, Mr. Station-master," the officer said.
+ "There are four gentlemen going up with a very important report to Sir
+ Redvers Buller."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I would do it willingly enough," the station-master said, "but the
+ commanding officer is bound to be down here with his staff, and he would
+ notice the horses directly."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They might be put in a closed van, sir," Chris urged. "And as there are
+ so many full of stores, it would naturally be supposed that this was also
+ loaded with them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The official smiled. "Well, young gentleman, I will do what I can for you.
+ As the officer in command of the train has consented, I can fall back upon
+ his authority if there should be any fuss about it. The train will start
+ at eight this evening; you had better have your horses here two hours
+ before that. Entrain them on the other side of the yard, and I will have
+ the waggon attached to the train quietly as soon as you have got them in.
+ The general is not likely to be down here till half an hour before the
+ train starts, and it is certainly not probable that he will count the
+ number of carriages."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was now half-past five, and Chris joined his friends, who were waiting
+ with the horses and Kaffirs near the station. They had hardly expected him
+ so soon, as they did not know that his mother had left.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Good news," he said. "There is a through train going up this evening, and
+ I have got permission for us and the horses to go; but they must be put in
+ a truck by half-past six, and we may as well get them in at once. We still
+ have our water-skins; the Kaffirs had better get them filled at once, and
+ a good supply of mealies for the horses on the way; there is no saying how
+ long we may be. Willesden, do you run into a store and get a supply of
+ bread and a cold ham for ourselves; a good stock of bread for the Kaffirs,
+ and a jar of water, and a hamper, with a lock, containing two dozen
+ bottles of beer, the mildest you can get, for them. We are sure to get out
+ for a few minutes at one of the stations, and can then unlock the hamper
+ and give them a bottle each. It would never do to leave it to their mercy;
+ they would drink it up in the first half-hour, and then likely enough
+ quarrel and fight. For ourselves, we will have a small skin of water and,
+ say, three bottles of whisky. The carriage is sure to be full, and it will
+ be acceptable in the heat of the day tomorrow. The remainder of our supply
+ of tea and so on, and the lamp and other things, had better all go in with
+ the horses, and everything we do not absolutely want in the train with us;
+ there will be little room enough. Get an extra kettle, then we can not
+ only make ourselves a cup of tea or cocoa on the road, but give some to
+ any friend we may make; besides, it is sure to come in useful when we get
+ to the front."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will see to all that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If you will, take Jack with you to carry the things you buy."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I had better take two of them; it will be a good weight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well, take one of the Zulus; the other can lead the spare horse, and
+ likely enough we shall have some trouble in getting them into the waggon."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ That work, however, turned out more easy than he had expected. The
+ station-master pointed out the waggon that he was to take, which was
+ standing alone on one of the lines of rails. They all set to work, and
+ were not long in running it alongside an empty platform, from which the
+ horses were led into it without trouble, being by this time accustomed to
+ so many changes that they obeyed their masters' orders without hesitation.
+ They had, too, already made one railway journey, and had found that it was
+ not unpleasant. The station-master happened to catch sight of them, and
+ sent two of the porters to take the waggon across the various points to
+ the rear of the train, where it was coupled. The water-skins had been
+ filled and the horses given a good drink before entering the station, and
+ the stores, waterproofs, and other spare articles stowed with the horses.
+ The shutter was closed, and the Kaffirs told that on no account were they
+ to open it or show their faces until the train had left the station.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a few minutes Willesden came up with the two natives heavily laden. As
+ soon as the stores and natives were all safely packed away and the door of
+ the van locked by one of the porters, the lads went out and had a hearty
+ meal at an hotel near the station. When they returned a large number of
+ soldiers and sailors were gathered on the platform. Their baggage had
+ already been stowed, and they were drawn up in fours, facing the train, in
+ readiness to enter when the word was given, the officers standing and
+ chatting in groups. The station was well lighted, as, in addition to the
+ ordinary gas-lamps, several powerful oil-lamps had been hung up at short
+ intervals. The naval men were in the front part of the train, and on Chris
+ walking up there the officer in command beckoned to him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will take you in the carriage with me, Mr. King. We want very much to
+ hear your story, and there is plenty of room for you. Your three
+ companions will go in the next two compartments, which will contain junior
+ officers and midshipmen, and I am sure that they too will be very welcome.
+ Before we board the train I will get you all to go and sit at the windows
+ at the other side. If you will bring your friends up I will introduce them
+ to their messmates on the trip. As soon as we have all entered, we shall
+ be at the window saying good-by to our friends, and no one will catch
+ sight of you. It is just as well, for although I feel perfectly justified
+ in taking you on to make your report to the commander-in-chief, my senior
+ might fuss over it; and although he might let you go on, there would be a
+ lot of explanations and bother. Have you got your horses in?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir; we were able to manage that capitally."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then you had better bring your comrades up at once, Mr. King, and I will
+ introduce them to those they will travel with." Chris brought up his three
+ friends and introduced them to the officer, who then took them to the
+ group of youngsters.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Gentlemen," he said, "these three gentlemen will travel in your
+ compartment. They have seen a great deal of the war, and belong to one of
+ the mounted volunteer corps. They have a wonderful story to tell you, and
+ I am sure you will be delighted with their companionship. They will take
+ their seats just before the men entrain. They must occupy the seats near
+ the farther window, and as you will no doubt all be looking out on this
+ side, they will probably not be noticed, which would be all the better, as
+ it is a little irregular my taking them up."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By this time a considerable number of people were crowded in the station,
+ friends of the officers and comrades of the sailors, who looked enviously
+ at those going forward, while they themselves might possibly not get a
+ chance of doing so. A quarter of an hour later the officer said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am going to give the order to entrain. This is my compartment. You and
+ your friends had better slip into your places at once."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as they had got in the order was given, and with the regularity of
+ a machine the three hundred men entered the train. As soon as they had
+ done so the officers took their places. The crowd moved up on to the
+ platform, and there was much shaking of hands, cheering, and exhortations
+ to do for the Boers. Suddenly there was a backward movement on the part of
+ the spectators, and the commanding naval officer on the station, with
+ several others and a group of military men, came on to the platform. They
+ were received by the officers in command of the sailors and soldiers, and
+ walked with them along the platform talking. This was evidently a matter
+ of ceremony only. The usual questions were put as to the stores, and after
+ standing and chatting for eight or ten minutes the officers took their
+ places in the train, the engine whistled, and the train moved on, amid
+ loud cheering both from those on the platform and the men at the windows.
+ As soon as they were fairly off, Chris's friend said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have already introduced you to these officers, Mr. King, but I have not
+ told them any of your doings. I can only say, gentlemen, that this young
+ officer is in command of a section of Volunteer Horse, and has done work
+ that any of us might be proud indeed to accomplish. The best introduction
+ I can give him, before he begins to tell his story, is by reading a letter
+ with which General Yule has furnished him."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0011" id="link2HCH0011"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XI &mdash; BACK WITH THE ARMY
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ While the letter was being passed round from hand to hand, a good deal to
+ Chris's discomfort, he had time to look more closely than he had done
+ before at his travelling companions. Three of them were young lieutenants,
+ the fourth an older man, shrewd but kindly faced. In introducing him, his
+ friend said: "This is our medico, Dr. Dawlish. I hope that you will have
+ no occasion to make his professional acquaintance." When they had all read
+ the letter, the senior lieutenant said: "Now, Mr. King, we won't ask much
+ of you to-night; we shall have all to-morrow to listen to your story. We
+ have all had a pretty hard day's work, and shall before long turn in.
+ Perhaps you will tell us to begin with what your corps is, and how you
+ became the officer."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are twenty-one of us, sir, and we are all about the same age. We
+ were great friends together at Johannesburg, where our fathers were for
+ the most part connected with mining. As things went on badly, we decided
+ to form ourselves into a corps if the war broke out. They chose me as
+ their leader&mdash;for no particular reason that I know of&mdash;and with
+ the understanding that if I did not quite give satisfaction, I should
+ resign in favour of one of the others. We all came down with our families
+ from Johannesburg when war was declared, and were grossly insulted and
+ ill-treated by the Boers, several of the ladies, among them my mother,
+ being struck on the face with their whips; which, you can imagine, quite
+ confirmed our determination to fight against them. We had all obtained our
+ parents' consent, and when we got to Pietermaritzburg, proceeded to get
+ our horses and equipments. That is all."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A great deal too short, Mr. King," the lieutenant said. "We want to know
+ what steps you took, and how you managed it. Did you come down all the way
+ by train?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris related the events of the journey with more detail, and how, all
+ being well furnished with money, they had lost no time in getting all they
+ required, and going back by train to Newcastle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is a good point to leave off," the officer said. "Tomorrow morning
+ we will take your story in instalments, and I do hope you will give us the
+ details as minutely as you can. They will greatly interest us, as we are
+ going in for that sort of thing, and it will show us what can be done by a
+ small number of young fellows accustomed to the country, well-mounted,
+ and, I am sure, from what General Yule says, remarkably well led." All
+ were provided with flasks, and after sampling the contents of these, they
+ wrapped themselves in their rugs and were soon fast asleep. The other
+ three lads did not get off so easily, the younger officers were all so
+ delighted at the prospect of soon being engaged that they were in no way
+ inclined to sleep, and it was not until the seniors had long been soundly
+ off that they too agreed to postpone the rest of the boys' narrative until
+ the next morning. The train travelled very slowly, and Pietermaritzburg&mdash;a
+ distance of seventy miles&mdash;was not reached until day was breaking.
+ Here there was a long pause, and all alighted to stretch their limbs. The
+ lads ran to the end of the train; Jack was looking out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I thought that we should stop here, baas," he said; "and I have got the
+ kettles boiling and ready."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Good man!" Chris said. "How have the horses passed the night?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They have been very quiet, baas."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is good to know. Take the kettles off and put three good handfuls of
+ tea in each."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, baas."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When they are emptied, fill them with fresh water and put them again on
+ the stove. When they boil, bring them to our carriages, having of course
+ put some tea in before you take them off the lamp. Now, give me one of
+ those large loaves and the ham, and all the mugs and knives. We will start
+ breakfast first in my compartment, Willesden; we will pass you in the ham
+ when we have done with it. Anyhow, the kettles will hold enough for a mug
+ for everyone in our three compartments, and by the time we have drunk that
+ the second lot will be boiling. Open a couple of tins of milk, Jack, and
+ then you can bring them along when you have taken the kettles. There is no
+ extraordinary hurry, for I heard them say that we should wait here at
+ least an hour."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was some amusement among the soldiers and sailors as Jack, carrying
+ the kettles, and Chris, Willesden, Brown, and Peters with ham, bread and
+ butter, tin mugs, plates, and three open tins of preserved milk, came
+ along down the platform.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What have you got here?" the doctor asked in surprise, as they arrived at
+ the carriage.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Breakfast," Chris said. "It is in the rough, but you will get it rougher
+ than this before you get to Ladysmith."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Why, you must be a conjurer. Where did you get the water from? We were
+ just discussing whether we should go out and try to fight our way to those
+ barrels of beer where the Tommies are clustered, or content ourselves with
+ spirit and water, a drink I cannot recommend in the morning."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were exclamations of pleasure from all in the carriage as Jack was
+ handing in the things.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We shall not want the ham, Mr. King," the senior lieutenant said. "We
+ provided ourselves with a great basket of eatables and a few bottles of
+ wine, but the idea of making tea in the train did not, I think, occur to
+ any of us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris was not allowed to cut his ham, for the basket contained pies,
+ chicken, and other luxuries; but the tea was immensely appreciated. By the
+ time that the first mugs were empty Jack arrived with the fresh supply,
+ and long before the train started breakfast was over, pipes had been
+ lighted, and all felt thoroughly awake and cheery. "Do you always travel
+ so well provided, Mr. King?" the doctor asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We always carry tea, preserved milk, and preserved cocoa, and two or
+ three gallons of paraffin for cooking with. In case we can't find wood for
+ a fire, it makes all the difference in the world in our comfort."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, Mr. King, we must waste no more time; so please begin at once, or
+ there will be no time to hear all your story. Tell us something about your
+ expedition to Komati-poort. The other we shall hope to hear on another
+ occasion in our camp, where we shall all be glad to see you at any time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris then related the idea he had formed at Maritzburg, of blowing up the
+ bridge, and how he had carried out the adventure. He passed very briefly
+ over the journey, but described fully how they had been obliged to
+ relinquish their original project, owing to the bridge being so strongly
+ guarded at both ends; and how, failing in that respect, they had
+ determined to do as much damage as possible to the great assemblage of
+ waggons filled with arms and military stores; and fully detailed the
+ manner in which this had been accomplished, and the aspect of the yard on
+ the following morning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Splendidly planned and carried out!" the commander of the party
+ exclaimed, and the others all echoed his words. It was astonishing indeed
+ to think that such a plan should have been conceived and carried out by a
+ lad no older than some of their junior midshipmen, and assisted by only
+ three others of the same age.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The day before we started," the doctor said, "I saw in one of the Durban
+ papers a telegram from Lorenzo Marques saying that there had been an
+ explosion at Komati-poort, where a few waggons had been injured and two
+ natives killed, but that the Boers had suffered in any way, and that the
+ damage would be repaired and the line opened for traffic in a few hours."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is only one word of truth in that, sir," Chris said smiling, "and
+ that is that no Boers suffered. I am convinced that is strictly true, for
+ the eight Boers at the bridge were certainly instantaneously killed; and
+ of the natives, whom I am sorry for, there were certainly eighteen killed,
+ together with some eight or ten Portuguese employés. If I could by any
+ possibility have got the natives out of the way I would have done so. As
+ to the Portuguese I do not feel any great regret, for I believe all the
+ officials in the custom-house on the railway are bribed by the Boers to
+ break the official orders they receive as to observing strict neutrality,
+ and aid in every way in passing the materials of war into the Transvaal."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was no time for further conversation, for they were now within a
+ short distance of the Tugela, and the train was winding its way between
+ steep hills which could have been held successfully by a handful of men.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The only wonder to me is," another officer said, "that the Boers did not
+ take up and drag away the rails all the way from here to Estcourt. If they
+ had lifted them out of their sleepers, they had only to harness a rail
+ behind each horse and trot off with it. I know that there is a
+ considerable amount of railway material at Durban, but I doubt if there is
+ anything like sufficient to make twenty miles of road. And the business
+ would have been still more difficult if the Boers had collected the
+ sleepers in great piles and burned them. Of course they have destroyed a
+ good many culverts and the bridge at Estcourt. It is wonderful that the
+ railway people should have managed to get up a temporary trestle bridge so
+ soon, and to make a deviation of the line to carry the trains over. It
+ does their engineers immense credit. This pass is widening," he added
+ after putting his head out of the window. "I fancy we shall be at
+ Chieveley in a few minutes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The train came to a stand-still at a siding a short distance outside the
+ station, which was crowded by a long line of waggons with stores of all
+ kinds. A number of sailors were unloading shells for their guns, and a
+ crowd of Kaffirs, under the orders of military officers, were getting out
+ the stores. As they alighted, after hearty thanks to the officer whose
+ kindness had been the means of their getting forward so promptly, and who
+ now went to report his arrival to Captain Jones, who was superintending
+ the operations of the sailors, Chris and his party hurried to the rear
+ waggon. It was a work of considerable difficulty to get the horses out,
+ and could not have been accomplished had there not been a stack of
+ sleepers near the spot. A number of these were carried and piled so as to
+ make a sloping gangway, by which the horses were brought down. The
+ sleepers being returned to their places, Chris and his friends mounted and
+ rode to the camp, which was placed behind a long, low ridge which screened
+ it from the sight of the enemy on the opposite hills, although within easy
+ range of their heavy guns.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Here before daybreak on the 12th, Major-general Barton's Fusilier brigade,
+ with a thousand Colonial Cavalry, three field batteries, and the naval
+ guns, had marched north, and were the following night joined by another
+ brigade with some cavalry. The next day the big naval guns had opened
+ fire; but although their shell had reached the lower entrenchments of the
+ Boers, their batteries on the hill had proved to be beyond their range
+ even with the greatest elevation that could be given to them, while the
+ Boer guns carried far beyond the camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris had learned at Estcourt, where the train stopped a few minutes, that
+ Captain Brookfield's troop formed part of the Colonial Horse that had
+ advanced with General Barton's brigade, and they soon discovered their
+ position. Leaving the horses with the natives, they went to his tent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am delighted to see you back," he exclaimed as they entered. "I heard
+ in confidence from one of your party, when they joined me a week back,
+ that you had gone on a mad-brained adventure to try and blow up the
+ Komati-poort bridge. I was horrified! I had, of course, given you leave to
+ act on your own responsibility, but I never dreamt of your undertaking an
+ expedition of that sort. Of course you found it impossible to get there. A
+ lad told me that you had reckoned on being away six or seven weeks, and it
+ is less than a month since the date on which he told me you left. Anyhow,
+ I heartily congratulate you on all getting back."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We got there, sir, but nothing could be done with the bridge, it was so
+ safely guarded. However, we did blow up two big cannon and a battery of
+ small ones, some ten thousand rifles, and an enormous quantity of
+ ammunition."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You don't say so, Chris? Then you had better luck than you deserved. One
+ of the correspondents told me this morning that there was news in the town
+ by a telegram from Lorenzo Marques that there had been an accidental
+ explosion at Komati-poort, but it did not seem to be anything serious.
+ Tell me all about it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I congratulate you most heartily," he said, when Chris had finished the
+ story. "Of course you have written a report of it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Here it is, sir. I have made it very brief, merely saying that I had the
+ honour to report that, with Messrs. Peters, Brown, and Willesden, I
+ succeeded in blowing up, with two hundredweight of dynamite, the things I
+ have mentioned to you, destroying a large quantity of rolling stock, badly
+ damaging five locomotives, and destroying roads and sidings to such an
+ extent that traffic can hardly be resumed for a fortnight. Is the general
+ here, sir?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, but he will be here this afternoon. Now, I will not detain you from
+ your friends. No doubt they saw you ride in, and will be most anxious to
+ hear of your doings. You will hardly know them again. When they came up to
+ join us they adopted the uniform of the corps, feeling that it would be
+ uncomfortable going about in a large camp in civilian dress. They brought
+ with them uniforms for you all, for they seemed very certain that you
+ would return alive."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am very glad of that, sir, for the soldiers all stared at us as we came
+ up here. I suppose they took us for sight-seers who had come up to witness
+ the battle."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As they left the tent they found the rest of their party, gathered in a
+ group twenty yards away, and the heartiest greeting was exchanged. The
+ delight of the party knew no bounds when they found that their four
+ friends had not had their journey in vain. They had two tents between
+ them, and gathering in one of them they listened to Peters, who told the
+ story, as Chris said he had told it twice, and should probably have to
+ tell it again. The four lads at once exchanged their civilian clothes for
+ the uniforms that had been brought up. They were, like those of the other
+ Colonial corps, very simple, consisting of a loose jacket reaching down to
+ the hip, with turned-down collar and pockets, breeches of the same light
+ colour and material, loose to the knee and tighter below it; knee boots,
+ and felt hats looped up on one side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The first step when they were dressed was to mount an eminence some
+ distance in rear of the camp, whence they had a view of the whole country.
+ In front of them was a wide valley with a broad river running through it.
+ Beyond it rose steep hills, range behind range. It was crossed by two
+ bridges, that of the railway, which had been blown up and destroyed, and
+ the road bridge, which was still intact; though, as Sankey, who had
+ accompanied them, told them, it was known to be mined. To the left of the
+ line of railway was a hill known as Grobler's Kloof, on the summit of
+ which a line of heavy guns could be seen. There were other batteries on
+ slopes at its foot commanding the bridge, to the right of which on another
+ hill was Fort Wylie, and in a bend of the river by the railway could be
+ seen the white roof of the church tower of Colenso. There was another
+ battery behind this, and others still farther to the right on Mount
+ Hlangwane. Heavy guns could be seen on other hills to the left of
+ Grobler's Kloof; while far away behind Colenso was the crest of Mount
+ Bulwana, from which a cannonade was being directed upon Ladysmith and an
+ occasional white burst of smoke showed that the garrison were replying
+ successfully. On all the lower slopes of the hills were lines, sometimes
+ broken, sometimes connected, rising one above another. These were the Boer
+ entrenchments, and Cairns said that he heard that they extended for nearly
+ twenty miles both to the right and left.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is believed that we don't see anything like all of them," he went on,
+ "but we really don't know much about them, for the Boers only answer
+ occasionally from their great guns on the hilltops, and although yesterday
+ the sailors fired lyddite shells at these lower trenches, there was no
+ reply."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is an awful place to take," Chris said, after examining the hills for
+ a quarter of an hour with his glasses. "We have seen that the Boers are no
+ good in the open, but I have no doubt they will hold their entrenchments
+ stubbornly, and it is certain that a great many of them are good shots. I
+ have gone over the ground at Laing's Nek, and that was nothing at all in
+ comparison to this position. Do you know how many there are supposed to be
+ of them, Cairns?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They say that there are about twenty-five thousand of them, but no one
+ knows exactly. Natives get through pretty often from Ladysmith, but they
+ know no more there than we do here. They are all jolly and cheerful there,
+ in the thought that they will soon be relieved."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hope that they are not counting their chickens before they are
+ hatched," Chris said. "I doubt very greatly whether we shall carry those
+ hills in front of us, and if we do the ranges behind are no doubt
+ fortified. How about crossing the river?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There are several drifts. There is one about four miles to the left of
+ the bridge, called Bridle Drift. Waggon Drift is about as much farther on.
+ There is a drift just this side of where the Little Tugela runs into it,
+ and one just farther on; there is Skeete Drift and Molen Drift, with a
+ pontoon ferry; there is an important one called Potgieter's Drift, where
+ the road from Springfield to Ladysmith crosses; and another, Trichardt's,
+ where a road goes to Acton Homes. I know there are some to the right, but
+ I don't know their names."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, that is comforting, because even if we take Colenso there would be
+ no crossing if the bridge is mined. And as the town will be commanded by a
+ dozen batteries, we should not gain much by its capture. Well, I tell you
+ fairly that I am well satisfied that we belong to a mounted corps and
+ shall be only lookers-on, for even if we win we shall certainly lose a
+ tremendous lot of men. Is there no way of marching round one way or the
+ other?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I believe not. The only way at all open seems to be round by Acton Homes;
+ that is a place about fifteen miles west of Ladysmith, and on the
+ principal road from Van Reenen's Pass. From there down to Ladysmith the
+ country is comparatively open, but it is a tremendously long way round. I
+ don't know how far, but I should say forty or fifty miles; and certainly
+ the road will in many places be commanded by Boer guns; and they will most
+ likely have fortified strong positions at various points. But, of course,
+ the great difficulty will be transport; I am sure we have nothing like
+ enough to take stores for the army all that distance. Besides, Chris, I
+ don't see that we should gain any advantage from going to Ladysmith that
+ way, we should be as far as ever from thrashing the Boers, and certainly
+ could not remain in Ladysmith; we should eat up all the provisions there
+ in no time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't like the outlook at all," Peters said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Ah, there is a general officer with a staff riding into the camp. Most
+ likely it is Buller. We had better go down, for if Brookfield gives in my
+ report he may want to speak to me."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The party went down the hill. When they reached their camp they were at
+ once sent for to Captain Brookfield's tent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am glad that you are back," he said. "Sir Redvers Buller has just
+ ridden up on to the ridge, I will speak to him as he comes down. You had
+ better come with me and stand a short distance off. Bring your rifles with
+ you, and stand in military order; you three in line, and Chris two paces
+ in front of you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Having got their rifles they followed Captain Brookfield till he stopped
+ at the foot of the slope below the point where the general and his staff
+ were standing. Their leader advanced some fifty yards ahead of them. In a
+ quarter of an hour the party were seen descending the hill. Captain
+ Brookfield stepped forward and saluted the general as he came along a
+ horse's length in front of his staff. Sir Redvers checked his horse a
+ little impatiently.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What is it sir?" he said sharply. "I cannot attend to camp details now."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I command the Maritzburg Scouts," Captain Brookfield said. "Three of my
+ men, with Mr. King, who commands the section to which they belong, have
+ just returned. I wish to hand you Mr. King's report; it contains news
+ which is, I think, of importance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Give it to Lord Gerard," the general said briefly, motioning to one of
+ the officers behind him. "Please see what it is about, Gerard." And he
+ then moved forward again, briefly acknowledging Captain Brookfield's
+ salute. He had gone, however, but twenty yards when Lord Gerard rode up to
+ him and handed to him the open dispatch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is of importance, sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Supposing that it was merely the report of four scouts who had gone out
+ reconnoitring, and with his mind absorbed with weightier matters, the
+ general had hardly given the matter a thought. Without checking his horse
+ he glanced at the paper, and then abruptly reined in his charger and read
+ it through attentively. Then he turned to where Captain Brookfield was
+ still standing and called him up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I do not quite understand this report, sir," he said. "Is it possible
+ that your men have been up to Komati-poort? I gathered from your words
+ that they had merely returned from reconnoitring."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, sir; they only came in this morning by the train from Durban with the
+ naval detachment with details."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But how in the world did they get to Komati-poort?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They started from Maritzburg, sir, and rode up through Zululand and
+ Swaziland. Their object was to blow up the bridge, and to stop supplies of
+ munitions of war continuing to pass up through Lorenzo Marques. I may say
+ that they acted on their own initiative. The section to which they belong
+ is composed entirely of gentlemen's sons from Johannesburg; they provide
+ their horses and equipment, and draw no pay or rations, and when they
+ joined my corps made it a condition that so long as not required for
+ regular work they should be allowed to scout on their own account."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Before calling up Captain Brookfield the general had handed back the
+ despatch to Lord Gerard, with the words, "Pass it round."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are those your men?" the general said, pointing to the little squad.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Sir Redvers rode up to them, and on returning their salute, said: "You
+ have done well indeed, gentlemen; it was a most gallant action. Have you
+ your own horse with you?" he asked Chris.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then mount at once and join me as I leave camp. Then you can tell me
+ about this matter on my way back."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris was soon on horseback. He waited at a short distance while the
+ general talked with General Barton, and as soon as he saw him turn to ride
+ off cantered up and joined the staff. The general looked round as he did
+ so. He beckoned to him to come up to his side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, sir, let me hear more about this. The captain of the troop that you
+ belong to, tells me that you and twenty other young fellows, all from
+ Johannesburg, formed yourselves into a party of scouts, and are making war
+ at your own expense, and that although in a certain way you joined his
+ troop you really act independently when it so pleases you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir. We and our families have received great indignities from the
+ Boers; and although we are conscious that we should be of little use as
+ troops, we thought that we could do service as scouts on our own account,
+ and have been lucky in inflicting some blows on them. I was fortunate
+ enough to attract Colonel Yule's attention at Dundee, and he furnished me
+ with an open letter addressed to you, and to officers commanding stations,
+ saying that we had done so."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you it about you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Sir Redvers held out his hand, and Chris handed him the letter. "So you
+ went into the Boer camp! Do you speak Dutch well?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir; we all speak Dutch fairly, and most of us Kaffir also, that was
+ why we thought that we should be more useful scouting; until now we have
+ all been dressed as young Boers, and could, I think, pass without
+ suspicion anywhere."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now as to this other affair," Sir Redvers said, returning Colonel Yule's
+ letter. "You had better take this, it will be useful to you another time.
+ Now tell me all about it. Was it entirely your own idea?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I first thought of it, sir, and my three friends agreed to go with me. I
+ did not want a large number. We started from Maritzburg with our own
+ Kaffir servant, and two Zulus and two Swazis to act as guides, two ponies,
+ each of which carried a hundredweight of dynamite; we had also a spare
+ riding horse."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then related their proceedings from the time of their start to their
+ arrival at Komati-poort; their failure at the bridge in consequence of the
+ strong guard that the Boers had set over it; and how, finding that the
+ main object of their journey could not be carried out, they proceeded to
+ wreck the station yard and its contents.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, Mr. King," the general said, when Chris concluded by
+ mentioning briefly how they had ridden down to Lorenzo Marques, and taken
+ a ship to Durban, and come up by train. "I saw the telegram of the
+ accident at Komati-poort. I imagined that it was probably more severe than
+ was stated, but certainly had no idea that such wholesale damage had been
+ effected, or that it was the work of any of our people. I think that it
+ would be unwise for me to take any public notice of it at present;
+ possibly there may be another attempt made to destroy that bridge. If
+ nothing more is said about it, the Boers may in time cease to be careful,
+ and a few determined men landed at Lorenzo Marques may manage to succeed
+ where you were unable to do so. It would be worth any money to us to put a
+ stop to the constant flow of arms and ammunition that is going on via
+ Lorenzo Marques. I consider your expedition to have been in the highest
+ degree praiseworthy, and to have been conducted with great skill."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "My father is a mining engineer, and managing-director of several mines
+ round Johannesburg, general. I have been working there under him and
+ learning the business, and therefore know a good deal about dynamite, and
+ what a certain quantity would effect."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you thought of going into the army? because if so, I will appoint
+ you and your three friends to regiments at once, and you will be gazetted
+ as soon as my report goes home."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am very much obliged to you, general, but I have no thought of entering
+ the army. I will, of course, mention it to my friends. I have never heard
+ them say anything on the subject. We are fighting because we hate the
+ Boers. No one can say, unless he has been resident there, what we have all
+ had to put up with, for the past year especially. On the way down the
+ Boers not only threatened to strike us, but struck many of the ladies, my
+ mother among them, besides robbing everyone of watches and all other
+ valuables. If it had not been for that, some of us might have changed our
+ minds before we got down here. That settled the matter. And besides, sir,
+ I hope that we shall be able to do more good in our own way than if we
+ became regular officers, as we know nothing about drill and should be of
+ very little good, whereas we do understand our own way of fighting. I can
+ say so without boasting, for we have twice thrashed the Boers; once when
+ they were twice our number, and the other time when they were nearly four
+ times as strong as we were."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Go on doing so, Mr. King; go on doing so, you cannot do better. However,
+ if any of your three friends, or all of them, choose to accept my offer,
+ it is open to them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They were by this time close to Frere, and the general went on: "I am
+ sorry that I cannot ask you to dine with me this evening, as we shall all
+ be too busy for anything like a regular meal, for in a few hours there
+ will be a general advance. Good-evening. When I am less busy I shall be
+ glad to hear about those two fights that you speak of. You colonists have
+ taught us a few lessons already."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris saluted, wheeled his horse round, and cantered back to Chieveley.
+ There was much satisfaction among the whole of the party when Chris
+ related what General Buller had said. None of his three companions had any
+ desire to accept a commission. Willesden's father was a doctor with a
+ large practice in Johannesburg, and the lad himself was going home after
+ the war was over to study for the profession and to take his medical
+ degree; while Brown and Peters were both sons of very wealthy capitalists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If I could not have done any fighting any other way I should have liked a
+ commission very much. Of course I could have thrown it up at the end of
+ the war. But I would a great deal rather be on horseback than on foot, and
+ I own I have no inclination to fight my way across those hills. Talana was
+ a pretty serious business, but it was child's play to what this will be."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well," Chris said; "I did not think that any of you would care for
+ it, although I could not answer for you. There is no need for hurry in
+ sending in a reply; there will be time to do that when we get into
+ Ladysmith. Then I will get Captain Brookfield to draw up the kind of
+ letter that ought to be sent, for I have not the least idea how I should
+ address a commander-in-chief. Of course, a thing of this sort ought to be
+ done in a formal sort of way; I could not very well say, 'My dear general,
+ my three friends don't care to accept your kind offer. Yours very truly.'"
+ There was a general laugh, and then they talked over the coming fight, for
+ it was now generally known that the attack was to be made in a couple of
+ days at latest. The next morning General Buller's column started before
+ daybreak, and were by nine o'clock encamped on the open veldt three miles
+ north of Chieveley; Barton's brigade having already marched out to the
+ site of a new camp, some five thousand yards south of Colenso. Although
+ well within reach of their guns, the Boers made no effort to hinder the
+ operation, or to shell the camp after it was formed. It was evidently
+ their policy to conceal their guns until the last moment, and although a
+ very heavy bombardment of their positions was maintained all day by the
+ naval guns, no reply whatever was elicited, though through the glasses it
+ could be seen that much damage was being done to the entrenchments.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't like this silence," Chris said, as he and some of the others were
+ standing watching the hills in front of them. "It does not seem natural
+ when you are being pelted like that not to shy something back. I am afraid
+ it will be a terribly hot business when they do open fire tomorrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There had been a discussion that morning whether the four natives Chris
+ had engaged for his expedition should be taken on permanently, and they
+ unanimously agreed that they should be. It was quite possible that all the
+ colonial corps would at some time be called upon to act as infantry, and
+ it would be a good thing to have six men to look after the twenty-five
+ horses while they were away. Then, too, it would be very handy to have a
+ stretcher party of their own. On the question being put to them, the four
+ men had willingly agreed to follow the party whenever they went into a
+ fight, to take two stretchers with which they could at once carry any who
+ might be wounded back to camp. They were all strong fellows belonging to
+ fighting peoples, and would, the boys had no doubt, show as much courage
+ as the Indian bearers had displayed at Dundee and Elandslaagte. In the
+ evening Captain Brookfield sent for Chris.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The orders for to-morrow are out," he said, "as far as we are concerned.
+ A thousand mounted infantry and one battery are to move in the direction
+ of Hlangwane&mdash;that is the hill, you know, this side of the river to
+ the right of Colenso. We shall cover the right flank of the general
+ movement and endeavour to take up a position on the hill, where the
+ battery will pepper the Boers on the kopjes north of the bridge. Two
+ mounted troops of three and five hundred men will cover the right and left
+ flanks respectively and protect the baggage. Half my troop are to
+ accompany Dundonald, the other half will form a part of the force guarding
+ the left wing. Your party will be with this force. You have had your share
+ of fighting, and none of the others have yet had a chance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well, sir, I shall not be sorry to be on this duty; for naturally we
+ shall have a good view of the whole fight, while if we were engaged we
+ should see nothing except what was going on close to us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, it will be something to see, Chris, and something to hear, for I
+ doubt whether there has been so heavy a fire as that which will be kept up
+ to-morrow, ever since war began. We have some twenty-three thousand men,
+ and the Boers more than as many, and what with magazine-guns,
+ machine-guns, and fast-firing cannon of all sizes, it will be an inferno."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0012" id="link2HCH0012"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XII &mdash; THE BATTLE OF COLENSO
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ By daybreak next morning the whole force was under arms. General Hildyard
+ in the centre was to attack the iron bridge at Colenso. General Hart's
+ Irish brigade was to march towards Bridle Drift, and after crossing to
+ move along the left bank of the river towards the kopjes north of the iron
+ bridge. General Barton was to move forward east of the railway towards
+ Hlangwane Hill, and to support General Hildyard, or the Colonial troops
+ moving against that hill as might appear necessary, while General
+ Lyttleton's brigade, half-way between those of Hildyard and Hart, were to
+ be prepared to render assistance to either as might be required. One
+ division of the artillery was to follow Lyttleton's brigade. The six naval
+ guns were to advance on his right. The sixth brigade were to aid General
+ Hart, and three batteries of Royal Artillery to move east of the railway,
+ under cover of the sixth brigade, to a point from which they could prepare
+ the way for Hildyard's brigade to cross the bridge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The action began before six o'clock, the naval guns opening with lyddite
+ on the trenches on Grobler's Hill, and those between it and Fort Wylie. No
+ reply whatever was made by the Boers, and the troopers standing by their
+ horses' heads in readiness to mount should any party of Boers make a raid
+ on the camp, began to wonder whether the enemy had not retreated.
+ Hildyard's men advanced in open order close to the railway; the Queen's
+ own, with the West York in support, on the right of the railway; and the
+ Devons, with East Surrey behind them, on the left. They marched as
+ steadily and in as perfect alignment as if on parade, eight paces apart.
+ Hart's Irish brigade, far away to the left, were in close order. The
+ cavalry could be seen proceeding at a trot towards Hlangwane, General
+ Barton's brigade still bearing to the east; and Colonel Long and Colonel
+ Hunt with their batteries, without waiting for their protection, galloped
+ straight forward, and, taking up a position almost facing Fort Wylie, a
+ few hundred yards beyond the river, opened a heavy fire; the six naval
+ guns, which were drawn by bullocks, being still a considerable distance
+ behind them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Still the Boer guns remained silent. But at half past six their musketry
+ opened suddenly upon the Queen's Own, the Devons, and the guns, in one
+ continuous roar. It came not only from the entrenchments on the face of
+ the hill, but from trenches close down by the river, and from the houses
+ of Colenso, from some railway huts, and from the bushes that fringed the
+ south bank of the river, which had been believed to be wholly unoccupied.
+ Five minutes later their cannon joined in the roar, with machine-guns,
+ one-pounder Maxims, and the great Creusots and Krupps. And yet through
+ this storm of lead and iron our soldiers went on quietly and steadily. The
+ very ground round them was torn up by bullet and ball. Many fell, but
+ there was no flinching; while on their right, Long's batteries, though
+ swept by a hail of missiles from unseen foes, maintained a continuous fire
+ at Fort Wylie.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is awful!" Peters exclaimed as he lowered his glasses. "I thought it
+ would be dreadful, but I never dreamt of anything like this. Look at the
+ bodies dotting the ground our men are passing over, and yet the others go
+ on as if it was a shower of rain through which they were passing. I can't
+ look at it any longer."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is as bad for the artillery," Chris said, with his glasses still
+ riveted upon them. "I saw a lot of the horses go down before they were
+ unlimbered, and I can see the men are falling fast. Surely they can never
+ have been meant to go within five or six hundred yards of magazine rifles.
+ I thought everyone had agreed that artillery could not live within range
+ of breech-loaders. Why doesn't Barton's brigade move down towards them,
+ and try and keep down the fire? How is Hart getting on?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ But it was not easy to see this even with glasses. They had not become
+ engaged until a little later than the others, but as they approached the
+ river an equally terrible fire opened upon them. Being in comparatively
+ close order, they suffered more heavily than Hildyard had done. Presently
+ they came upon a spruit which they took to be the main river, and under a
+ tremendous fire from the Mausers and guns, dashed across it, and swinging
+ round their left made for the drift, sweeping before them a number of
+ Boers who had been hidden in the long grass. Trenches were there line
+ after line, but over these the four regiments&mdash;the Connaught Rangers,
+ the Border regiment, the Inniskilling and Dublin Fusiliers&mdash;dashed
+ forward with such fury that the Boers did not stop to meet their bayonets.
+ By a quarter-past seven the enemy had been driven across the Tugela.
+ Without hesitation the Irish dashed into the river. Many fell headlong,
+ for along the bottom barbed wires had been stretched. Worse still, it was
+ found that instead of being two feet deep, as was expected, it was eight
+ feet; for the Boers had erected a dyke across the river a little lower
+ down, and had dammed the water back.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some swam across with their rifles and ammunition, but it was a feat
+ beyond all except the strongest swimmers, and after maintaining themselves
+ for some time they were forced to retire. The naval guns did their best to
+ assist them, and silenced some of the Boer cannon that were pounding them,
+ but they failed to draw the Boer fire upon themselves. It was only in the
+ centre that even partial success was gained. Hildyard's men had reached
+ but not captured Colenso bridge. In spite of the tremendous fire, some of
+ the soldiers tried to make their way along it, but were recalled; for they
+ were deprived of the support of the artillery that should have covered
+ their passage, had no hope of Hart bringing his brigade round to clear the
+ enemy out from the kloofs on the opposite side, and but little of aid from
+ Lyttleton, who had been obliged to move farther to the left to lend
+ assistance to Hart. Some of the Scottish Fusiliers had joined them from
+ Barton's brigade, but the brigade itself was far away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Terrible as the fighting was at all points, it was the batteries down by
+ the river that most engaged the attention of the anxious spectators.
+ Desperate attempts were being made to get the guns back. Almost all the
+ horses had been killed, but the drivers of the teams of the ammunition
+ waggons, the few survivors of the officers, and several of the general's
+ staff dashed recklessly forward under a hail of fire. Horse and man went
+ over, but two of the guns were carried off. Fortunately, the naval battery
+ and the third field battery had not been taken so far forward, and were
+ withdrawn with comparatively little loss; and the ten guns stood alone and
+ deserted by the last of the party as it seemed. Then, to the surprise of
+ the watchers, one of them spoke out, for four of the men who worked it had
+ stood to their charge to the last. Again and again it sent its shrapnel
+ among the Boer trenches. One fell and then another, but two remained. They
+ continued to fire until the last round of reserve ammunition was finished.
+ Then those who were near enough to make out their figures saw them take
+ their stand, one on each side of the gun, at attention, until both fell
+ dead by the side of the piece they had served so well. Even on the right,
+ where success might really have been hoped for, everything had gone badly.
+ The dismounted Colonials had fought their way gallantly up the slopes of
+ the Hlangwane, and nearly reached the crest. But they were not seconded by
+ Lord Dundonald's cavalry; Barton's brigade, which was charged with aiding
+ them, were kept at a distance, and the Colonials were at last forced to
+ fall back.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Great as was the loss at other points, the failure to capture this hill
+ was really the greatest misfortune of the day. From its position on the
+ south of the river, and in a loop, batteries erected on its summit would
+ have taken all the Boer defences on the lower slopes of the hills in
+ flank, and it would have covered the crossing of the river at Colenso. Cut
+ off by the river from the rest of the Boer position it could hardly have
+ been retaken, and its fire would have searched the valley up which the
+ roadway ran almost as far as Mount Bulwana.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Renewed attempts were made for some time to carry off the guns, but early
+ in the afternoon the general saw that it was but a waste of life to
+ persevere further, and orders were despatched for the troops to retire. It
+ had been a day of misfortunes, and yet a day of glory, for never had the
+ fighting power of British troops been more splendidly exhibited, never
+ were greater deeds of individual daring performed; never had troops
+ supported with heroic indifference so terrible a fire. Undoubtedly the
+ English general had greatly underrated the fighting powers of the Boers
+ and the amount of artillery to which he was exposed. Had he not done so,
+ he would scarcely have distributed his force over so wide a face, or
+ attacked at three points nearly four miles apart, but would have prepared
+ for the grand assault by seizing Hlangwane and firmly establishing some of
+ his batteries there, even at the cost of two or three days' labour, and
+ only attempted to cross the river when the movement would have been
+ covered by their fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers were quick in discovering the importance of the hill, and
+ speedily covered its face with such entrenchments, that not until after
+ long weeks of effort and failure was an attack again attempted against it;
+ and the success of that attack opened the way to Ladysmith. But had the
+ general's orders been carried out at all points it would probably have
+ been captured. Hart's brigade was to have begun the attack, but owing to
+ the map with which he was furnished being defective, his troops losing
+ their way in the spruit, and their being led in far too close a formation
+ under the enemy's fire, its attempt failed; this being, however, largely
+ due to the astuteness of the Boers in damming back the river and rendering
+ the ford impracticable. The impetuosity of the officers commanding two of
+ the batteries of artillery, in pushing their guns forward unattended by
+ infantry as ordered, not only caused the loss of ten guns and of nearly
+ all the men who worked them, but deprived Hildyard's column of the
+ protection they would have had in crossing the bridge, and rendered the
+ undertaking impossible; while the failure of Barton's brigade to give
+ assistance either to Hildyard or to the assailants of Hlangwane,
+ contributed to the one failure, and entirely brought about the other.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ General Buller and General Clery had been wherever the shots were flying
+ the thickest. Three of the former's staff, Captains Schofield and
+ Congreve, and Lieutenant Roberts, son of Lord Roberts, had ridden forward
+ as volunteers to try and get the guns off. Roberts was fatally wounded,
+ Congreve was wounded and taken prisoner, and Schofield alone escaped
+ unharmed with the two guns that were saved.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The day had been almost more terrible for the troops who remained
+ unoccupied near the baggage than for those actually engaged in the
+ terrible light. The latter, animated by excitement and anger at their
+ inability to get at the foe, had scarce time to think of their danger, and
+ even laughed and joked in the midst of the hail of bullets, but the
+ watchers had nothing to distract them during the long hours. With their
+ glasses they could plainly see that no advance had been made at any point.
+ To them it seemed incredible that any could come back from that storm of
+ fire. From time to time they learned from wounded men brought up by the
+ bearers, who fearlessly went down into the thick of the fire to do their
+ duty, news of how matters were going on in the front.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Gladly, had they received orders to do so, would they have dashed down to
+ try and carry off the guns. Many shed tears of rage as they heard how the
+ Irish strove in vain to cross the deep river, and how many were drowned in
+ their attempts to swim it. They expected, when in the afternoon the troops
+ came in, that they would see an utterly dispirited body of men, and were
+ surprised when the Irish, who were the first to return to camp, marched
+ along smoking their pipes and joking as if they had returned from a day of
+ triumph rather than of failure. They were animated by a knowledge that
+ they had done all that men could do, had proved they were worthy
+ successors of their countrymen who had won glory in so many hard-fought
+ fields, and that no shadow of reproach could fall upon them for their
+ share in the day's work. Although they had suffered far more heavily than
+ the other brigade, they returned more cheerfully. And yet there was no
+ depression anywhere evinced, although there was anger, fierce anger, that
+ they had not been able to get at the enemy, and a grim determination that
+ next time they met, things should go differently.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A good many prisoners had been lost. Parties had spread along among the
+ bushes that lined the river, and maintained a steady fire against the Boer
+ entrenchments facing them. Some of these had not heard the bugle sounding
+ the retire. When they were aware what was being done some had left their
+ shelter and rushed across the open ground to join the columns, the
+ majority being shot down as they did so. Others had waited among the
+ bushes, intending to try after nightfall; but as soon as we fell back the
+ Boers had again crossed the river and spread along its banks, and had thus
+ made prisoners those who were in hiding there or in the little dongas.
+ Among those so captured were fourteen of the Devons and as many gunners,
+ with Colonel Hunt, Colonel Bullock, Major MacWalter, and Captains Goodwin,
+ Vigors, and Congreve; the total loss in killed, wounded, and prisoners
+ amounted to about one thousand five hundred, of whom nearly half belonged
+ to the Irish brigade. That evening the searchlight, which had been placed
+ on a lofty hill visible from one end of the high kopjes held by the
+ garrison of Ladysmith, flashed the news that the attack had failed, and
+ that the garrison must be prepared to hold out for some time yet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The news of the reverse created a tremendous sensation throughout Natal,
+ where it had been confidently anticipated that the army would brush aside
+ without difficulty the opposition of the Boers, relieve Ladysmith and,
+ advancing sweep the invaders out of the colony. In England, too, the
+ sensation was scarcely less pronounced, and for the first time the gravity
+ of the war in which we were engaged was recognized. Hitherto it had been
+ thought that fifty thousand men would suffice to bring it to a successful
+ conclusion; now it was perceived that at least double that number would be
+ required. The offers of the colonies to aid the mother country with troops
+ had hitherto been coldly received, but these were now accepted thankfully,
+ and although our military authorities would not as yet recognize that the
+ volunteers could be relied upon as a real fighting force, there was a talk
+ that some of the militia regiments might be embodied, and a large number
+ of reservists were at once summoned back to the ranks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the front matters went on as before. It was now known how it was that
+ the guns had advanced so far. Colonel Long had sent forward some of his
+ mounted men with two officers. The Boers allowed them to approach the
+ river bank without firing a shot. One of the scouts actually rode across
+ the bridge to the other side, and returning to the battery they reported
+ that there were no Boers about, and it was only after receiving this
+ message that Colonel Long took the guns forward to within six hundred
+ yards of the river, and twelve hundred of Fort Wylie.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The wounded were all taken to Frere or Estcourt, where hospitals had been
+ prepared. Hart and Lyttleton's brigades were sent back to Frere, and the
+ camp at Chieveley was moved nearer to the station, both for convenience of
+ supply, and because the position now taken up was a more defensible one,
+ and was less exposed to the fire of the big Boer guns; large numbers of
+ transport animals and waggons were brought up country. It was known that a
+ newly-landed division under General Sir Charles Warren was now coming up,
+ one regiment, the Somersets, arrived in camp two or three days after the
+ battle, and the loss of the cannon was to some extent retrieved by the
+ arrival of a 50-lbs. howitzer battery.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was but dull work in camp. The more impetuous spirits were longing to
+ be employed in annoying the Boers by frequent surprises at night; but as
+ these could have achieved no permanent advantage, and must have been
+ attended with considerable loss of life, Sir Redvers Buller set his face
+ against any such attacks, and went steadily on with his preparations. As
+ troops came up anticipations of a certain success when the next forward
+ movement was made were generally entertained. Chris and his companions
+ passed the time pleasantly enough. Being old friends they had plenty to
+ talk about, and occasional scouting expeditions to the east gave them a
+ certain amount of employment. Not having been engaged in the attack on
+ Hlangwane, they did not participate in the soreness felt by the rest of
+ the colonials at their failure to capture the hill, owing to the want of
+ support from Lord Dundonald's cavalry or Barton's brigade.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The chagrin felt at the mistake that had been made in not making this the
+ prime object of attack was general, for the Boers could be seen working
+ unceasingly at their entrenchments. They had not only made a ford by
+ throwing great quantities of rock and stones into the channel, but had
+ also built a bridge, so that the force on the hill could be speedily
+ reinforced to any extent, and what could have been effected on the day of
+ the attack by half a battalion of infantry would now be a very serious
+ undertaking even by a whole division.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads were chatting one day over the chances of the next fight, most of
+ them taking a very sanguine view.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you say, Chris?" one of them said after the discussion had gone
+ on for some time. "You have not given us your opinion."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "My opinion does not agree with yours," Chris replied. "After what I saw
+ the other day, I think the difficulties of fighting our way over those
+ mountains are so enormous that I doubt whether we shall ever do it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a chorus of dissent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we shall see," he said. "I hope that we shall do it just as much as
+ you do, but it is tremendous business. I have no doubt Sir Redvers will go
+ on trying, but I should not be surprised if at heart he has doubts that it
+ can be done. The Boers have more guns that we have, and any number of
+ those Maxims and Hotchkiss that keep up a stream of balls. The Boers'
+ trenches enable them to fire at us without showing anything but a head,
+ except when they stand up or have to move across the open. If we drive
+ them out of one position they have others to fall back upon. It is not one
+ natural fortress that we have to take, but a dozen of them. They know
+ every foot of the country they occupy, while we know nothing but just what
+ we can see at a distance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, if Sir Redvers thought as you do, why should he go on hammering at
+ it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "For several reasons, Peters. In the first place, if Ladysmith saw that
+ there was no chance of rescue it would at last give in; and in the second
+ place, if there was an end of all attempts to relieve the place England
+ would go wild with indignation; and in the third place, and by far the
+ most important, Sir Redvers knows that he is keeping from twenty-five
+ thousand to thirty thousand of the Boers inactive here, and so relieving
+ the pressure on our troops on the other side. We know regiments are
+ arriving from England at the Cape every day. When they get strong enough
+ to invade the Orange Free State and take Bloemfontein, and march north,
+ the Boers here will be hurrying away to defend their homes. Of course the
+ Free Staters will go first, but the Transvaalers will have to follow. We
+ hear that Methuen has been beaten at Magersfontein, and that he has been
+ brought to a stand-still within the sound of the guns round Kimberley,
+ just as we are here, and that the Boers have a very strong position there
+ also. So at present the advance is as much checked there as it is here.
+ Gatacre has had a misfortune too, so that we are all in the same boat. I
+ saw a Pietermaritzburg paper in the naval camp just now; there are about
+ twenty thousand men on the sea at the present moment, besides those in the
+ colony, and two more divisions are being formed. So it is safe to come
+ right in the long run. But at present, if those twenty-five thousand Boers
+ opposite to us were not there now, they would be riding all over Cape
+ Colony, and if Buller were not to keep on hammering away here a good many
+ of them would be off at once. They say Ladysmith can hold out for another
+ three months. By that time there ought to be such a big force in the
+ Orange State that the Boers won't dare to stop here any longer, and no end
+ of loss of life will be avoided.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I never thought that you were a croaker before," Field said, "except just
+ before the last fight; but certainly things have gone very badly lately.
+ Three disasters in seven or eight days are a facer; but I cannot think
+ that we shall not succeed next time. When Warren's division is up Buller
+ will have over thirty thousand men with him, in spite of our losses the
+ other day, and we ought to be able to do it with that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we shall see, Field. I hope you are right."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The news of Methuen's repulse and the terrible losses in the Highland
+ brigade, and of Gatacre's disaster, cast a greater gloom over Buller's
+ army than their own failure had done. The one topic of conversation among
+ the officers was, what would be the feeling in England, and whether there
+ would be any inclination to patch up another dishonourable peace like that
+ after Majuba. But the feeling wore off as day after day the news came that
+ the misfortunes had but raised the spirit and determination of the people
+ of Great Britain to carry the war through to the bitter end; that
+ recruiting was going on with extraordinary rapidity; that fresh regiments
+ had been ordered out; that Lord Roberts had been appointed to the supreme
+ command in South Africa, and that Lord Kitchener was coming out as chief
+ of his staff. The fact, too, that the volunteers had been asked to send
+ companies to the regiments to which they were attached, that the City had
+ undertaken to raise a strong battalion at its own expense, that the
+ Yeomanry were to furnish ten thousand men, and that public, spirit had
+ risen to fever heat, soon showed that these apprehensions were without
+ foundation, and that Britain was still true to herself, and was showing
+ the same indomitable spirit that had carried her through many periods of
+ national depression, and brought her out triumphant at the end.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Christmas passed cheerily; no gun was fired on either side, although the
+ Boers worked diligently at their trenches; and our men feasted as they had
+ not done since they landed at Durban. Bacon, milk, fresh bread, beef, and
+ a quart of beer were served out for each man, and on these men and
+ officers made a memorable meal; the latter producing the last bottles of
+ wine and spirits that had been specially sent up to them from Maritzburg.
+ And on that and the following day there were sports&mdash;lemon-cutting,
+ tent pegging, races for the cavalry; athletic sports, tugs-of-war, mule
+ and donkey races for the infantry. The drums and fifes played national
+ airs, and the sailors bore their full share in the fun. As time went on
+ the preparations for the next move advanced. None were more pleased at the
+ prospect of active work again than the Colonial Volunteers, who had
+ several times entreated to be allowed to get out and drive back the bands
+ of plundering Boers, who were still wasting the farms and destroying the
+ farmhouses and furniture of the loyalists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the 27th a small party of Captain Brookfield's scouts had been sent out
+ to reconnoitre the windings and turnings of the Tugela to the east, to
+ ascertain as far as possible what the Boer positions were on that side,
+ and whether they had placed bodies of skirmishers on the south side of the
+ river as they did opposite Fort Wylie. Included in the party, which was a
+ hundred strong, was the Johannesburg section. When well away from the camp
+ they were broken up into small parties, the better to escape the
+ observation of the Boers on the Hlangwane and other heights. The
+ instructions given by their commander were that they should take every
+ advantage of ground to conceal their movements from the enemy, but where
+ the ground near the river was level and fit for galloping they should dash
+ across it, and, if not fired at, should skirt along the banks, mark if
+ there were any tracks by which horses or cattle had at some time come down
+ to the water, and observe if similar tracks were to be seen on the
+ opposite bank, as this would show that, though possibly only in dry
+ weather, the river was fordable there. Where the ground was too broken and
+ rock-covered to permit of horses passing rapidly across it, they were to
+ dismount and crawl down the river to make their observations.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Only a small portion of the troop had been engaged on this work, the main
+ body were to keep along on the hills, maintaining a vigilant watch over
+ the country to the south and east as well as that around them, as many
+ parties of marauding Boers were known to be still across the river.
+ Knowing the sharpness of the lads, Captain Brookfield had told off their
+ section to explore the river bank, a choice which excited no jealousy
+ among the rest, as these were hoping for a brush with some wandering party
+ of Boers, and the satisfaction of rescuing cattle and goods they might be
+ carrying off. His instructions to Chris were that he was to detach two of
+ his party at each mile, choosing points where they could best make their
+ way to the river unobserved. As he himself with the main body would go up
+ considerably farther, each pair, when they had searched their section,
+ were to ride a mile or so back from the river and fall in with the main
+ body on its return.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Riding rapidly along, Chris carried out his instructions, until, when some
+ twelve miles from the camp, he remained with only Sankey with him. The
+ country they had passed was rolling, and from time to time he had caught
+ sight of small parties of Captain Brookfield's scouts. Arriving at a spot
+ where there was a slight depression running down towards the river, he
+ said, "We may as well follow it, Sankey. It will deepen into a donga
+ presently, no doubt, and we can leave our horses there and go on on foot.
+ It looks to me as if this had been used as a path. Of course it may only
+ have been made by cattle going down to the water, but it may lead to a
+ drift. If it is, we must be all the more careful, for it is just at these
+ points that the Boers are very likely to be on the look-out."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They rode for some distance and then dismounted, knee-haltered their
+ horses and moved forward cautiously. Chris still believed they were on a
+ track, but the heavy rains of the week before had sent the water rushing
+ down it in a torrent, which would have destroyed any marks there might
+ have been. When they could see the opening to the river in front of them
+ they climbed the side of the donga. All seemed quiet, and stopping and
+ taking advantage of the bushes, they crept forward to the edge of the
+ water. There was no sign of a break in the opposite bank.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no drift here," Chris said. "If there had been there would be a
+ pass cut or worn down on the other side. Now let us push on, but don't
+ show yourself more than you can help, any Boer lurking on the other side
+ could hardly miss us. A hundred and fifty yards, I should say, is about
+ the width."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After walking some little distance along they suddenly came upon another
+ break in the bank.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is a break opposite, Sankey. Ten to one this is a drift. The
+ question is, how deep is it? You can see the river is not as high as it
+ was by four feet, and I dare say that it will be lower yet if we get
+ another week of fine weather. It's very important to find out. I will try
+ to ford it; it's hardly likely there are any Boers so far down, but have
+ your rifle ready, and keep a sharp look-out on the opposite side."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A minute later they went down the slope. "Keep back under the shelter of
+ these bushes as soon as I go in, Sankey." Then he stepped into the water
+ and waded out. In a few yards it was up to his waist; then it deepened
+ slowly. He was a third of the distance across when two rifles cracked out
+ from some bushes on the opposite bank. Chris felt a sudden smart pain in
+ his ear. He instantly threw himself down in the water, and diving, made
+ for the shore, allowing the stream to take him down. Swimming as hard and
+ as long as he could, he came for a moment to the surface, turning on his
+ back before he did so, and only raising his mouth and nose above water. He
+ took a long breath and then sank again, swimming this time towards the
+ shore. His breath lasted until he was in water too shallow to swim
+ farther, and, leaping to his feet, he dashed up the bank and threw himself
+ down. He heard two bullets hum close to him, but the Boers had not been
+ looking in his direction, and only caught sight of him in time to take a
+ snap shot. He crawled along through the high, coarse grass, feeling very
+ anxious as to what had become of Sankey. He had heard the report of the
+ Boer rifles, but there came no reply from his friend, who would assuredly
+ have been lying in shelter in readiness to shoot as soon as he saw a flash
+ on the opposite bank. Could he have forgotten to take cover the instant he
+ himself entered the water, could he possibly have remained standing there
+ watching him? Two shots had been fired: one had certainly hit his ear; had
+ the other been aimed at Sankey? He crawled along until he came to the
+ point where he could see down on to the road. To his horror Sankey was
+ lying there on his back.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0013" id="link2HCH0013"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIII &mdash; PRISONERS
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The exclamation that burst from Chris's lips as he saw Sankey on the
+ ground was answered by another from his friend.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank God that you are there, Chris. I have been in an awful state about
+ you. I saw you go down into the water just as I was bowled over. I made
+ sure that you were killed, and I was in a state, as you may imagine, till
+ I heard two more shots. That gave me a little hope; for as you had not
+ been killed in the first, you might have escaped the others."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But what is the matter with you, Sankey. Where are you hit?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am hit in the arm. I can't tell much about it. I only know that I went
+ slap down; and there is certainly something the matter with my shoulder.
+ Like an idiot I did not take shelter as you told me, but I was watching
+ you so anxiously I never thought about it. If I had not been a fool I
+ should have jumped up and got under cover at once; but I fancy I must have
+ knocked my head as I fell. At any rate, I did not think about moving till
+ I heard those two shots."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is just as well that you didn't," Chris said. "They could have put
+ half a dozen bullets in you with their Mausers before you had moved a
+ foot. The question is, what is to be done?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Have you got your rifle, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I stuck to that, and I expect it is all right; these cartridges are
+ quite water-tight. The question is how to get you out of their line of
+ sight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The best plan will be for me to roll over and over," Sankey said. "I
+ expect it will hurt a bit, but that is no odds."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, no; don't do that yet. Let us think if we can't contrive some plan of
+ attracting their attention."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't do anything foolish, Chris," Sankey said earnestly. "I would rather
+ jump up and make a run for it than that anything should happen to you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will be careful, Sankey. The first thing to do is to find out whether
+ there are only two of these fellows or half a dozen. Where I am lying now
+ the ground is a foot lower than it is just at the edge of the bank. I will
+ put my cap on my rifle and raise it so as just to show."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The instant he did so three or four rifles cracked and two bullets passed
+ through the cap. As it dropped a shout of triumph rose from the Boers. He
+ at once crawled forward, and as he did so five of them ran down the bank
+ and as many more stood up, believing that both the scouts had been killed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Throwing the magazine into play Chris fired three shots in close
+ succession, and then rolled over two or three yards, half a dozen bullets
+ cutting the grass at the spot he had just left. Peering cautiously out
+ again he saw that the Boers had all disappeared except two, one of whom
+ lay apparently dead just at the edge of the water; the other was sitting
+ down, but was waving a white handkerchief.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am not going to shoot you," Chris muttered, "though I know the fellows
+ with you would put a bullet at once into Sankey if they thought that he
+ was alive. Hullo, there!" he shouted in Dutch; "I will let you carry off
+ your wounded man and the dead one if you will let me carry off my dead
+ comrade." The answer was three bullets, but he had drawn back a yard or
+ two before he spoke and was in shelter. The thought of firing again at the
+ wounded man did not enter Chris's mind, and he crawled back to the spot
+ where he had before spoken to Sankey. The latter was looking anxiously up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are you all right?" he asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I wish you would not do it," Sankey said angrily. "If you do I will
+ get up, and they can either pot me or take me prisoner."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't be an ass, Sankey. I am going on all right. I have shot two of
+ them; there are about a dozen of them over there, I should say. Now let us
+ talk reasonably. Of course, if I was sure they would not cross, I would
+ make off to where the horses are, ride out, and meet Brookfield and the
+ others as they come back. The orders were that we were to join them in
+ about an hour and a half, which would give them time to go seven or eight
+ miles farther, and for us to do our work thoroughly. But I am afraid that
+ if I went away the Boers would presently guess I had done so, and would
+ come across and carry you off. But though it would be no joke for you to
+ be taken prisoner to Pretoria, it would be a good deal better than for you
+ to have two or three more rifle bullets in your body, which I am sure you
+ would have were you to move. So we must risk it. Anyhow, I will stop for
+ another hour. There will be plenty of time then for me to make off and
+ meet the others."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris crept forward again and watched the opportunity. Half an hour later
+ he saw what he thought was a head appear, and at once fired, rolling over
+ as before the instant he had pulled the trigger. Three or four shots
+ answered his own almost instantly and there was a laugh that told him that
+ they had practised the same trick that he had done, and had only raised a
+ hat to draw his shot. Again there was silence for some time. Then he went
+ back and told Sankey that he was about to start.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "All right, Chris; I shall be very glad when you have gone. You will get
+ hit sooner or later if you go on firing, and I shall be a great deal more
+ comfortable when you are once off. I don't believe they will venture
+ across the drift; they know how straight you shoot."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris crawled back for some distance, and then got down into the road. He
+ had scarcely done so when a shot rung out fifty yards away. His right leg
+ gave way and he fell, and with a shout of triumph two Boers ran up to him.
+ Chris did not attempt to move. The rifle had flown from his hand as he
+ fell, and lay some five or six yards away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I surrender," he said when they ran up to him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, rooinek," they exclaimed, "you are a brave young fellow to make a
+ fight alone against a dozen of us. It would have been wiser if you had
+ gone away when you were lucky enough to get up the bank without being hit.
+ What was the use of staying by your dead comrade?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "He is not dead," Chris said. "He is hit in the arm or shoulder, but he
+ knew if he moved he would be hit again to a certainty."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But where are you hurt?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "In the calf of my leg."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is lucky for you," the Boer said, "that I stumbled just as I fired.
+ Now, get up and I will carry you across the drift."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They helped him up, and the other assisted him on to his shoulders. The
+ man's clothes were wet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: "WITH A SHOUT OF TRIUMPH THE TWO BOERS RAN DOWN."]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Did you swim the river?" Chris asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, there is a drift a mile lower down. It is a bad one, but we managed
+ to get across. We knew that you were alone, and as you seemed determined
+ to remain here, we made sure of getting you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As they came near to Sankey, Chris called out, "You can get up, Sankey;
+ they have beaten us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am very glad to hear your voice," Sankey replied as he raised himself
+ into a sitting position. "When I heard that shot behind me I made sure it
+ was all up with you. Where are you hit?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Only in my calf. Luckily this gentleman who is carrying me stumbled just
+ as he fired, and I got the ball there instead of through my head. It
+ serves me right for not having thought before that some of them might
+ cross somewhere else and take us in rear. Well, it can't be helped; it
+ might have been a good deal worse."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The other Boer had picked up the two rifles. They now entered the river.
+ The stream in the middle was breast-high, and the Boer with the rifles
+ told Sankey to hold on to him, which he was glad to do, for the force of
+ the stream almost took him off his feet. The other Boers had now left
+ their hiding-places, and received them when they reached the opposite
+ bank. The one who seemed to be their leader said not unkindly, "You have
+ given us a great deal of trouble, young fellows, and killed one of our
+ comrades and badly wounded another."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If you had left us alone we should have been very glad to have let you
+ alone," Chris said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers laughed at the light-heartedness of their prisoner, and then
+ examined their wounds. Chris had, as he said, been hit in the calf. The
+ ball had entered behind, and had come out close to the bone. Chris
+ believed that he could walk, but thought it best to affect not to be able
+ to do so. The wound had bled very little, and the two holes were no larger
+ than would be made by an ordinary slate-pencil. Sankey had been hit just
+ below the shoulder. The ball had in his case also gone right through, and
+ from the position of the two holes it was evident that it must have passed
+ through the bone. The Boers bandaged the wounds, and told them to lie down
+ under the shade of a bush, and then took their places near the bank to
+ watch the drift again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose we have a journey to Pretoria before us," Sankey said. "I don't
+ care so much about myself, because that is only the fortune of war, but I
+ am awfully sorry that you are taken, Chris, and all through my beastly
+ folly in not taking shelter as you told me."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Oh, we may just as well be together, Sankey. Besides, I don't mean to go
+ to Pretoria, I can assure you. I believe I could walk now if I tried; but
+ you may be sure I don't mean to try. I should advise you to avoid making
+ any movement with your arm; make them put it in a sling. When they start
+ with us, we had better be sent up with wounded prisoners rather than with
+ the others. They won't look so sharply after the wounded, and it will be
+ very hard if we cannot manage to slip away somehow. I hope the others will
+ find the horses all right, or that if they don't the horses will find
+ their own way back."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Oh, they are safe to find them," Sankey said confidently. "There will be
+ a hunt for us when it is found that we have not joined the others. Anyhow,
+ they will search to-morrow. I am quite sure that some of our fellows will
+ be out the first thing in the morning, and I dare say they will take a
+ couple of the natives with them. If they start at the point where we
+ turned off they will track the horses down that donga without any
+ difficulty, and even if they have strayed away they will soon have them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I suppose they will be all right," Chris agreed. "Of course we have
+ got the spare horses, but we should miss our own, and I think they are as
+ fond of us as we are of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the sun got low two of the Boers brought up four ponies which were
+ grazing some little distance from the river. They lifted Chris on to one,
+ and helped Sankey to mount another, and then taking their seats on the
+ other horses, rode off at a walk, and arrived an hour and a half later at
+ a camp in a hollow behind Fort Wylie. Here they were put into a large
+ tent, where some thirty wounded prisoners were lying. A German surgeon at
+ once examined and again bandaged their wounds.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are neither of you hurt badly," he said in English. "A fortnight and
+ you will have little to complain of. These Mauser bullets make very slight
+ wounds, except when they hit a vital spot. You are a good deal better off
+ than most of your comrades here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As it was now dark they lay down at once, after taking a basin of
+ excellent soup. The German ambulance was scrupulously clean. The more
+ serious cases were put in beds, those less severely wounded lay on the
+ ground between them; for the number of wounded to be dealt with was very
+ large, and in the tents in which the Boers were treated were many terribly
+ mangled by fragments of shrapnel and lyddite shells. The boys were some
+ time before they went off to sleep, for their wounds smarted a good deal.
+ However, they presently fell off, and it was broad daylight when they
+ woke. Chris lay where he was, while Sankey got up and went round the tent.
+ The men all belonged to either the Devon or the Queen's Own regiment. Most
+ of them were awake, and all asked anxiously for news from Chieveley, and
+ looked disappointed when they heard that it was likely to be some time
+ before a fresh attempt was made to relieve Ladysmith.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are all right there. Of course they were disappointed that we did
+ not get in, but they have provisions enough to last for some time yet."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The Boers don't seem to think so," one of the men said. "As they were
+ carrying us in here I heard one of them say that they had certainly got
+ Ladysmith now, for the provisions there were pretty nearly exhausted, and
+ in a few days they would have to surrender. If they did not, they meant to
+ carry it by assault."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think they will do that," Sankey said confidently.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not they," the soldier replied scornfully. "They will find that it is a
+ very different thing meeting our chaps in the open to what it is squatting
+ in a trench, and blazing away without giving us as much as a sight of
+ them. It is a beastly cowardly way of fighting, I calls it. I was not hit
+ till just the end of the day, and I had been blazing away from six in the
+ morning, and I never caught sight of one of them. I should not have minded
+ being hit if I could have bowled two or three of them over first."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After breakfast the surgeon said to the two lads: "You will be sent off in
+ half an hour; all the slight cases are to go on. There may be another
+ battle any day, and room must be made for a fresh batch of wounded."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well, sir," Chris replied, "as we have to go, it makes no difference
+ to us whether it is to-day or next week."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are colonists, I suppose, as you have not the name of any regiment on
+ your shoulder-straps?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir; we belong to Johannesburg. I know your face. You are Dr.
+ Muller, are you not?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; I do not recognize you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am the son of Mr. King, sir; and my comrade is the son of Dr. Sankey."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I know them both," the doctor said. "I am not one of those who think that
+ the Uitlanders have no grievances, and I am not here by my own choice. But
+ I was commandeered, and had no option in the matter. Well, I am sorry for
+ you lads. For though I believe that in the long run your people will
+ certainly win, I think it will be a good many months before they are in
+ Pretoria. They fight splendidly. I watched the battle until the wounded
+ began to come in, and the way those regiments by the railway advanced
+ under a fire that seemed as if nothing could live for a minute, was
+ marvellous. But brave as they are, they will never force their way through
+ these hills. They will never get to Ladysmith. Well, perhaps we shall meet
+ some day in Johannesburg again."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, doctor. I suppose we shall be taken up in waggons?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You will, for a time, certainly. But I don't know about your friend."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Oh, do order him to be sent up with me, doctor, that is, if it will not
+ hurt him too much. You see, his wound is really more serious than mine, as
+ the ball has gone through the bone."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes. I have a good many cases of that sort, but all seem to be healing
+ rapidly. However, I will strain a point and give instructions that he is
+ to be among those who must go in the waggons."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, sir," both boys said; and Sankey added: "We are great friends,
+ sir. Though I don't care for myself, it would be a great comfort to us to
+ be together, and my wound really hurts me a good deal."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have no doubt it does," the surgeon said. "You can't expect a ball to
+ pass through muscle and bone without causing pain."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Half an hour later some natives came into the tent, and under the
+ directions of the surgeon carried out Chris and three others whose wounds
+ were all comparatively slight, and placed them in a waggon which already
+ contained eight other wounded prisoners. Sankey, with his arm in a sling,
+ walked out and was lifted into the waggon, into which he could indeed
+ scarcely have climbed without assistance. Seven more were collected at
+ other tents, and the waggons then moved off and joined a long line that
+ were waiting on the road. Some more presently came up, and when the number
+ was complete, the native drivers cracked their whips with reports like
+ pistols, and the oxen got into motion. Some twenty mounted Boers kept by
+ the side of the waggons. They followed the road until within four or five
+ miles of Ladysmith, then turned off, crossed the Klip river, and came to a
+ spot where a hospital camp had been erected; here they halted for the
+ night.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The wounded were provided with soup and bread, and such as were able to
+ walk were allowed to get out and stroll about. The surgeon who accompanied
+ the train and the doctor in charge of the hospital attended to all the
+ serious cases, and these were carried into the tent for the night thus
+ making room for the others to lie at length in the waggons. Only three of
+ these contained British wounded, the others were all occupied by Boers.
+ Chris and Sankey excited the admiration of the wounded soldiers by
+ conversing with the Boers and the natives in their own languages. Most of
+ the Boers, indeed, could speak English perfectly, but did not now
+ condescend to use it. Some even refused to speak in Dutch to the lads, as
+ their dislike to the colonists who had taken up arms against them was even
+ more bitter than that which they felt for the soldiers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For six days they travelled on, at the end of that time Chris felt sure
+ that he could walk without difficulty. He had, at very considerable pain
+ to himself, each night undone his bandage, and had with his finger
+ scratched at the two tiny wounds until they were red and inflamed, so that
+ on the two occasions on which they were examined by the doctor, they
+ appeared to be making but little progress towards healing. The
+ inflammation was, however, only on the surface, and after several furtive
+ trials, Chris declared that he was ready for a start. A move was generally
+ made before daylight, in order that a considerable portion of the day's
+ journey should be got over before the heat became very great.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are you quite sure, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I am as sure as anybody can be who has not actually tried it. I may be a
+ little stiff at the start, but I believe that once off, I shall be right
+ for eight or ten miles; and after the first day, ought to be able to do
+ double that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had been travelling at the rate of about twelve miles a day, and
+ halted that night near Newcastle. Chris heard from the guards that they
+ would only go as far as Volksrust, and there be put in a train. The reason
+ why this had not been done before was that the railway was fully occupied
+ in taking down ammunition and stores, and that no carriages or trucks were
+ available. The watch at night was always of the slightest kind. The Boers
+ had no thought whatever that any of the wounded would try to escape. Two
+ were posted at the leading waggon, which contained stores and medical
+ comforts that might, if unguarded, be looted by the native drivers. The
+ rest either slept wrapped up in their blankets, or in any empty houses
+ that might be near.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At nine o'clock the boys told the others in the waggon that they were
+ going to escape. They had before informed them of their intention to do
+ so, somewhere along the road, and had taken down the names and regiments
+ of all of them, with a note as to their condition, and the addresses of
+ their friends. These they had promised to give to the commanding officers
+ if they got safely back. They had filled their pockets with bread, all
+ those in the waggon having contributed a portion of their ration that
+ evening. After a hearty shake of the hand all round, and many low-muttered
+ good wishes, they stepped out at the rear of the waggon, with their boots
+ in their hands. It was a light night, and the figures of the two men on
+ sentry over the store waggon could just be made out. There was no thought
+ of any regular sentry duty, no marching up and down among the Boers; the
+ two men had simply sat down together to smoke their pipes and chat until
+ their turn came to lie down. The lads therefore struck off on the opposite
+ side of the waggon, and making their way with great caution to avoid
+ running against any of the Boers, they were soon far enough away to be
+ able to put on their boots and walk erect.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How does your leg feel, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It feels stiffer than I expected, certainly, but I have no doubt it will
+ soon wear off. We must take it quietly till it warms up a bit."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Gradually the feeling of stiffness passed off, and going at a steady but
+ quiet pace they made their way along the road, to which they had returned
+ after they had gone far enough to be sure that they were beyond the
+ hearing of the Boers and Kaffirs. From time to time they stopped to listen
+ for the tread of horses, which could have been heard a long way in the
+ still night air, but they were neither met nor overtaken. After walking
+ for five hours they came upon a stream that, as they knew, crossed the
+ line at Ingagone station and ran into the Buffalo. They had gone but ten
+ miles, and decided to leave the road here, follow the stream up half a
+ mile, and then lie up. Chris admitted that he could not go much farther,
+ and as they would not cross another stream for some distance they could
+ not, even putting his wound aside, do better than stop here. Sankey was
+ equally contented to rest, for his arm, which he still carried in a sling,
+ was aching badly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It does not feel sore," he said, "or inflamed, or anything of that sort;
+ it just aches as if I had got rheumatism in it. I dare say I shall have
+ that for some time; I have heard my father say that injuries to the bones
+ were often felt that way for years after they were apparently well, the
+ pain coming on with changes of weather. However, it is no great odds."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Neither wanted anything to eat, but had taken long draughts when they
+ first struck the stream, and as soon as they found a snug spot among some
+ bushes a short distance from the water they lay down and were soon asleep.
+ They remained quiet all the day, only going out once after a careful look
+ round to get a drink of water. Starting again as soon as darkness closed
+ in they walked on, with occasional rests, until within a few miles of
+ Glencoe, having followed the line of the railway, where they had no chance
+ whatever of meeting anyone. Here they again halted at a stream. They had
+ agreed that they would on the following night cross the line between
+ Glencoe and Dundee, and take the southern road by which the British force
+ retired after the battle there. By that route they would be altogether out
+ of the line of Boers coming from Utrecht or Vryheid towards the Boer camps
+ round Ladysmith. Their stock of food was, however, now running very short,
+ and they ate their last crust before starting that evening. This they did
+ earlier than usual, as they were determined if possible to get some bread
+ at Dundee. They knew that a few of the residents had remained there, and
+ probably there would not be many Boers about, for as Dundee lay off the
+ direct line from Ladysmith to the north there would be no reason for their
+ stopping there. Sankey had insisted on undertaking this business alone.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is of no use your talking, Chris," he said positively; "I can run and
+ you can't. I may not be able to run quite as fast as I could; but I don't
+ suppose this arm will make much difference, and anyhow, I could swing it
+ for a bit, and I would match myself against any Boer on foot. We will
+ cross the line, as we agreed, about a mile from Dundee. When we strike the
+ southern road you can sit down close to it, and I will go in."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't like it," Chris said, "but I see that it would be the best thing.
+ I wish we had our farmer's suits with us, then I should not fear at all."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think that makes much odds, Chris, lots of the Boers have taken
+ to clothes of very much the same colour; really, the only noticeable thing
+ about us is our caps. If I come upon a loyalist I will see if I can get a
+ couple of hats for us, either of straw or felt would be all right. Well,
+ don't worry yourself; it will be a rum thing if I can't bring you out
+ something for breakfast and dinner to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Don't forget a little bit extra for supper to-night, Sankey," Chris
+ laughed; "that crust went a very short distance, and I feel game for at
+ least a good-sized loaf."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Although he said good-bye to his friend cheerfully, Chris felt more
+ down-hearted than he had done since he had said farewell to his mother
+ more than two months before, as Sankey disappeared in the darkness,
+ leaving him sitting among some bushes close to the road. His last words
+ had been, "It is somewhere about nine o'clock now; if I am not back by
+ twelve don't wait any longer. But don't worry about me; if I am caught, I
+ have no doubt sooner or later I shall give them the slip again, but I
+ don't think there is any real occasion for you to bother. Unless by some
+ unlucky fluke, I am safe to get through all right." Then with a wave of
+ his hand he started confidently along the road.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He met no one until he was close to the town. The first thing he had
+ determined upon was to get hold of a hat somehow. The houses were
+ scattered irregularly about in the outskirts of the town; but very few
+ lights were to be seen in the windows.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Of course they have all been plundered," he said to himself; "but if I
+ only had a light I have no doubt I should be able to find an old hat
+ somewhere among the rubbish, but in the dark there is no chance whatever."
+ Presently he saw a light in a window in a detached house of some size. He
+ made his way noiselessly up and looked in. A party of five or six Boers
+ were sitting smoking round a table. "The place has not been sacked," he
+ said to himself; "therefore there is no doubt the owner is a traitor. It
+ is a beastly custom these Boers have of wearing their hats indoors as well
+ as out, still there are almost sure to be some spare ones in the hall. A
+ Boer out on the veldt would not be likely to possess more than the hat he
+ wears, but a fellow living in such a house as this would be safe to have a
+ variety for different sorts of weather. At any rate I must try."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He took off his boots, and then stole up to the front door and turned the
+ handle noiselessly. As he expected, no light was burning there, but the
+ door of the room in which the men were sitting was not quite closed, and
+ after he had stood still for a minute, his eyes, accustomed to the greater
+ darkness outside, took in his surroundings. To his great delight he saw
+ that four or five hats of different shapes and materials were hanging
+ there, and a heap of long warm coats were thrown together on a bench.
+ Looking round still more closely he saw five or six rifles in the corner
+ by the door, and to these were hanging as many bandoliers. He first took
+ down two felt hats of different sizes, and picked out two of the coats;
+ then, with great care to avoid any noise, he took two rifles with their
+ bandoliers from the corner and crept out through the door, which he closed
+ behind him carefully; for if they found it open the Boers might look round
+ and discover that some of their goods were missing, whereas any one of
+ them coming casually out, even with a light, would not be likely to notice
+ it. He put on one of the bandoliers, then a coat, and then slung one of
+ the rifles behind him; then, after putting on his boots he went out with
+ the other articles and hid them inside the gate of an evidently deserted
+ house a hundred yards from the other. He felt sure that even when the loss
+ was discovered there would be no great search made for the thief. It would
+ be supposed that some passing Kaffir had come in and stolen the things,
+ and they would consider that, until the following morning, it would be
+ useless to look for him. Feeling now perfectly confident that he could
+ pass unsuspected, he entered the principal street. Here there were a good
+ many Boers about, but none paid the slightest attention to him. Presently
+ he came to a store that was still open. The owner was of course Dutch. He
+ had been a pronounced loyalist when Sankey was last in Dundee, but had
+ evidently thought it prudent to change sides when the British left. Sankey
+ had been in the shop twice with Willesden, and had found the man very
+ civil, and, as he thought, an honest fellow, but with so much at stake he
+ dared not trust him now. Food he must have, that was certain, but if he
+ had to obtain it by threats, he must do it at one of the outlying houses.
+ It would be dangerous anyhow, for, though he could frighten a man into
+ giving him what he required, he could not prevent him from giving the
+ alarm afterwards. While he was looking on a mounted Boer stopped at the
+ shop door. He dismounted at once, and lifted a large bundle from his
+ saddle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Look here!" he said to the shopkeeper. "I have just come into the town,
+ having ridden up from near Greytown. I picked up some loot at a house that
+ had been deserted. Here are twenty bottles of wine and a lot of tea&mdash;I
+ don't know how much. There was a chest half-full, and I emptied it into a
+ cloth. What will you give me for them? I am riding home to Volksrust. I
+ want three loaves and a couple of bottles of dop [Footnote: The common
+ country spirit.], and the rest in money." The bargaining lasted for some
+ minutes, the storekeeper saying that the wine was of no use to him, for no
+ Boer ever spent money on wine; the tea of course was worth money, but he
+ had now a large stock on hand, and could give but little for it. However,
+ the bargain was at last struck. The Boer brought out the bread and two
+ bottles of spirits and placed them in his saddle-bag, then he went back
+ into the shop to get the money. The moment he entered Sankey moved quietly
+ up to the other side of his horse, transferred the bottles of spirits to
+ his own pocket, and then, thrusting the loaves under his coat, crossed the
+ street, and turned down a lane some twenty yards farther on. He had gone
+ but a few steps when he heard a loud exclamation followed by a torrent of
+ Dutch oaths. He stood up for a moment in a doorway, and heard the sound of
+ heavy feet running along the street he had left, with loud shouts to stop
+ a thief who had robbed him. The instant that he had passed Sankey walked
+ on again, and in five minutes was in the outskirts of the town. He made
+ his way to the place where he had hidden the other things, and taking them
+ up, walked briskly on until he came to the bushes where his friend was
+ anxiously expecting him. As he uttered his name Chris sprang out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I had not even begun to expect you back, Sankey. How have you done? I see
+ that you have got on another hat and a coat."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is only a part of it. I have got three loaves and two bottles of
+ dop, and a coat and a hat for you, and a rifle and ammunition, as well as
+ clothes for myself and the gun that you see over my shoulder."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But how on earth did you do it, Sankey?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Honestly, my dear Chris, perfectly honestly. The rifles and clothes were
+ fairly spoils of war, the loaves and spirits were stolen from a thief,
+ which I consider to be a good action; but let us go on, I will tell you
+ about it as we walk. Here is your bandolier, slip that on first; there is
+ your coat and hat. Now I will put the sling of the rifle over your
+ shoulder. There you are, complete, a Boer of the first water! I will carry
+ the bottles and the bread. Now, let's be going on."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then he told Chris how he had obtained his spoil, and they both had a
+ hearty laugh over the thought of the enraged Dutchman rushing down the
+ street shouting for the eatables of which he had been bereaved.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It was splendidly managed, Sankey. I shall have to appoint you as caterer
+ instead of Willesden. He pays honestly for all he wants for the mess, but
+ I see that if we entrust the charge to you, we shall not have to draw for
+ a farthing upon our treasure chest. And how is your arm feeling?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have almost forgotten that I have an arm," Sankey said. "I suppose the
+ excitement of the thing drove out the rheumatics."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We might have some supper," Chris suggested.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, no, we must wait till we can get water. I can't take dop neat."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But how are you going to mix it when you do get water?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I had not thought of that, Chris," Sankey said in a tone of disgust.
+ "Well, I suppose we shall be reduced to taking a mouthful of this poison,
+ and then a long drink of water to dilute it. We shall not have very far to
+ go, because, if you remember, we crossed a little stream three or four
+ miles after we rode out from Dundee. I am as hungry as a hunter, but it
+ would destroy all the pleasure of the banquet if we had to munch dry bread
+ with nothing to wash it down." After walking two miles farther they came
+ upon the stream and going fifty yards up it, so as to run no risk of being
+ disturbed, they sat down and enjoyed a hearty meal.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0014" id="link2HCH0014"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIV &mdash; SPION KOP
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ "It is almost a pity that you did not commandeer two ponies and saddles
+ while you were about it," Chris laughed, as they set off again feeling all
+ the better for their meal. "We only want that to complete our outfit."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You should have mentioned it before I started, Chris. There is no saying
+ what I might not have done; and really, without joking, a pony is one of
+ the easiest things going to steal when there are Boers about. They always
+ leave them standing just where they dismount, and will be in a store or a
+ drinking-place for an hour at a time without attending to them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is not the difficulty, but the risk; for even if a thief gets off with
+ a pony, he is almost sure to be hunted down. It is regarded as a sort of
+ offence against the community, and a man, whether a native or a mean
+ white, would get a very short shrift if he were caught on a stolen horse."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I know. Still, for all that, if I could come upon a saddled pony,
+ and there was a chance of getting off with it, I should take it without
+ hesitation as a fair spoil of war."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, so should I, for the betting would be very strongly against our
+ running across its owner; and in the next place, it would greatly increase
+ our chance of getting safely through. It is the fact of our being on foot
+ that will attract attention. We could walk about a camp full of Boers
+ without anyone noticing it, but to walk into the camp would seem so
+ extraordinary, that we should be questioned at once. A Boer travelling
+ across the country on foot would be a sight hitherto unknown."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There I agree with you; and I do think that when we get to Helpmakaar,
+ which we can do to-morrow evening if we make a good long march to-night,
+ we had better see if we can't appropriate a couple of ponies. We can walk
+ boldly into the place, and no one would notice we were new-comers. There
+ are sure to be ponies standing about, and it will be hard if we cannot bag
+ a couple. Then we can ride by the road south from there to Greytown, and
+ after crossing the Tugela, strike off by the place where we had the fight
+ near Umbala mountain, which would be a good landmark for us, and from
+ there follow our old line back to Estcourt. It would be rather shorter to
+ go through Weenen, but there may be Boers about, and the few miles we
+ should save would not be worth the risk."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They made a long journey that night, slept within seven or eight miles of
+ Helpmakaar, and started late in the afternoon. When near the town they
+ left the main road, passed through some fields, and came into the place
+ that way, as had they entered by the road they were likely to be
+ questioned. Once in the little town, they walked about at their ease. It
+ did not seem that there were any great number of Boers there, but the town
+ was well within the district held by them, and such loyalists as remained
+ were sure to be keeping as much as possible without their houses. In front
+ of the principal inn were nearly a score of Boer ponies, but the lads
+ considered it would be altogether too risky to attempt to take a couple of
+ these, as their owners might issue out while they were doing it; however,
+ they stood watching. For some time there was a sound of singing and
+ merriment within, and for a quarter of an hour no one came out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If we had taken a couple of ponies at first," Sankey said savagely, "we
+ might have been two miles away by this time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; I don't know that it is too late now. Wait till they strike up
+ another song with a chorus, none of them are likely to leave the room
+ while that is going on, and it will drown the sound of hoofs."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were few people about in the streets; and even had anyone passed as
+ they were mounting, he could not tell that they were not the legitimate
+ owners.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If anyone should come out," Chris said, "don't try to ride away. We
+ should have the whole lot after us in a minute, and it is not likely we
+ should have got hold of the fastest ponies. Besides, they would shoot us
+ before we got far. So if anyone does come out and raises an alarm, jump
+ off at once and run round the nearest corner, and then into the first
+ garden we come to. We should be in one before they could come out, mount
+ their ponies, and give chase. Once among the gardens we should be safe. If
+ the man who comes out does not shout we would pay no attention to him, but
+ ride away quietly. If the ponies don't happen to belong to him or some
+ friend of his, he would not be likely to interfere, for he would suppose
+ that we were two of the party who had left the place without his noticing
+ them. But if he gives a shout, jump off at once, and rush round the corner
+ of the nearest house."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They waited for a minute or two, and then two Boers came out, mounted a
+ couple of the ponies, and rode quietly down the street. At that moment
+ another song was struck up. "That is lucky. If anyone comes out and sees
+ us mounting he will take us for the two men who have just ridden off."
+ Then they strolled leisurely across the street, took the reins of two of
+ the ponies, sprang into the saddles, and started at a walk, which, twenty
+ yards farther, was quickened into a trot. The two men had fortunately gone
+ in the other direction. Once fairly beyond the town, they quickened their
+ pace. "Now we are Boers all over," Chris said exultantly; "but there is
+ one thing, Sankey, we must be careful not to go near any solitary
+ farmhouse. There must still be some loyal men left in these parts, and if
+ we fell in with a small party of them the temptation to pay off what they
+ have suffered might be irresistible."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, Chris; but they certainly would not shoot unless certain of bringing
+ us both down, for if one escaped, he would return with a party strong
+ enough to wipe them out altogether. However, we need not trouble about
+ that for the present, though no doubt it will be well to be careful when
+ we are once across the Tugela."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we shall be there long before morning; it is not more than seven-or
+ eight-and-twenty miles."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They rode fast, for it was possible that when the loss of the ponies was
+ discovered someone who might have noticed them go down the street might
+ set the Boers on the track, and in that case they would certainly be hotly
+ pursued. The ponies, however, turned out to be good animals, and as the
+ lads were at least a couple of stones lighter than the average Boer, they
+ could not be overtaken unless some of the ponies happened to be a good
+ deal better than these.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After riding at full speed for eight or nine miles, they broke into a
+ walk, stopping every few minutes to listen. They knew that they would be
+ able to hear the sound of pursuit at least a mile away, and as their
+ ponies would start fresh again, they were able to take things quietly. So
+ sometimes cantering sometimes walking, they reached the river at about one
+ o'clock in the morning. On the opposite bank stood the little village of
+ Tugela Ferry. Here there was a drift, and there was no occasion to use the
+ ferry-boat except when the river was swollen by rain. It now reached only
+ just up to the ponies' bellies; they therefore crossed without the least
+ difficulty, and after passing through the village, left the road, and
+ struck off across the country to the south-west. When four or five miles
+ away they halted at a donga, and leading the ponies down, turned them
+ loose to feed, ate their supper, and were soon asleep.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was no longer necessary to travel by night, and at eight o'clock they
+ started again. They kept a sharp look-out from every eminence, and once or
+ twice saw parties of mounted men in the distance and made detours to avoid
+ them. So far as they were aware, however, they were not observed. The
+ distance to be ridden from their last halting-place was about thirty-five
+ miles, and at one o'clock they were within five miles of Estcourt. On an
+ eminence about a mile in front of them they saw a solitary horseman.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is evidently one of our scouts," Chris said. "I dare say there is a
+ party of them somewhere behind him. If I am not mistaken I can see two or
+ three heads against the sky-line&mdash;they are either heads or stones. We
+ should know more about it if the Boers hadn't bagged our glasses when they
+ took us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two or three minutes later Sankey said, "Those little black spots have
+ gone, so they were heads. I dare say they are wondering who we are, and
+ put us down either as Boers or as loyal farmers, though there cannot be
+ many of them left in this district."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently from behind the foot of the hill six horsemen dashed out. The
+ lads had already taken the precaution of taking off their hats and putting
+ on forage-caps again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is always better to avoid accidents," Chris said. "It would have been
+ awkward if they had begun to shoot before waiting to ask questions,
+ especially as we could not shoot back. They are Colonials; one can see
+ that by their looped-up hats, which are a good deal more becoming than
+ those hideous khaki helmets of our men."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The horsemen had unslung their guns, but seeing that the strangers had
+ their rifles still slung behind them with apparently no intention of
+ firing, they dropped into a canter until they met the lads.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Who are you?" the leader asked. "Do you surrender?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We will surrender if you want us to," Chris said; "though why we should
+ do so I don't know. We belong to the Maritzburg Scouts, and were taken
+ prisoners, being both wounded, eight or nine days ago; and, as you see, we
+ have got away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I dare say it is all right," the officer said; "but at any rate we will
+ ride with you to Estcourt."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We shall be glad of your company, though I don't suppose we shall be
+ identified until we get to Chieveley. Will you please tell us what has
+ taken place since we left?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That, I think had better be deferred," the officer said dryly. "We don't
+ tell our news to strangers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Quite right, sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is evident that you are not Dutch," the officer went on; "but there is
+ more than one renegade Englishman fighting among the Boers, and except for
+ your caps you certainly look as if you belonged to the other side rather
+ than to ours."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, they are Boer coats, Boer ponies, and Boer guns," Chris said. "We
+ have taken the liberty of borrowing them as they borrowed our guns and
+ field-glasses. Whether they borrowed our horses we shall not know till we
+ get back. You see," he went on, opening his coat, "we still have our
+ uniforms underneath. Who is at Estcourt now? Ah, by the way, we are sure
+ to find some officers in the hospital who know us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer by this time began to feel that the account Chris had given
+ him of himself was correct, and when they arrived at Estcourt it was
+ rather as a matter of form than anything else that he accompanied him to
+ the hospital. Upon enquiry Chris found that among the wounded there was
+ one of the naval officers he had travelled with from Durban. Upon the
+ surgeon in charge being told that he wished to see him, he was allowed to
+ enter with the officer. The wounded man at once recognized him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Ah, King," he said, "I am glad to see you again. Have you brought me down
+ a message from Captain Jones or any of our fellows?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; I am very sorry to find you here, Devereux, but I am glad to see you
+ are getting better. I have really come in order that you might satisfy
+ this gentleman, who has taken me prisoner, that I am King of the
+ Maritzburg Scouts."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no doubt about that. Why, where have you been to be taken
+ prisoner?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Oh, it was a fair capture. I was with one of my section caught while out
+ scouting, and have got away in Boer attire, and as we were riding in we
+ met this officer's party some five miles out, and not unnaturally they
+ took us for the real thing instead of masqueraders."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: "PRESENTLY FROM BEHIND THE FOOT OF THE HILL SIX HORSEMEN DASHED
+ OUT."]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I can assure you that King is all right," the sailor said. "He came up in
+ the train with three of his party from Durban."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you," the officer said with a smile. "I am perfectly satisfied, and
+ was nearly so before I came in here. Well, I wish you good-day, sir, and
+ hope we may meet again," and shaking hands with Chris he left the tent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris remained chatting for a few minutes more with the sailor.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose there is no great chance of getting a bed here?" he said, as he
+ rose to go. "We have had two pretty long days' ride, and I don't care
+ about going on to Chieveley."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not a chance in the world, I should think."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, it does not matter much. We have been sleeping in the open for the
+ past five nights, and once more will make no difference. We are just back
+ in time, Sankey," he said when he joined his friend outside. "Devereux
+ tells me that there is a big movement going on, and that a severe fight is
+ expected in a day or two. He hears that the baggage train has been moving
+ to Springfield, so that it will be somewhere over in that direction; and I
+ suppose we are going to move round to Acton Homes and force our way into
+ Ladysmith through Dewdrop. You know, they say that it is comparatively
+ flat that way."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They got rid of their long coats and fastened them to their saddles; then
+ led their ponies to the station, and leaving them outside entered. An
+ enterprising store-keeper had opened a refreshment stall for the benefit
+ of the troops passing through, or officers coming down from the front to
+ look after stores or to visit friends in hospital. Chris had explained
+ their position to Devereux, and the latter had said: "Then I suppose they
+ have eased you of all your money?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; they did not leave us a penny."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is my purse with my watch in that little pocket over my bed," he
+ said. "You must let me lend you a sovereign till I see you again." And
+ Chris had thankfully taken the money.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They now had what to them was a gorgeous feast; some soup, cold ham, and a
+ bottle of wine. They gave what little remains they had of bread to the
+ ponies, and then led them a quarter of a mile out of the town and camped
+ out with them there, the Boer coats coming in very useful. The next
+ morning they started at daybreak, and arrived at their camp at Chieveley
+ just as their friends were sitting down to breakfast. They were received
+ with a shout of welcome, and a torrent of questions was poured upon them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will leave Sankey to tell you all about it," Chris said. "I must go and
+ report myself to Brookfield and get our names struck off the list of
+ missing. I shall not be five minutes away."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The captain received Chris as heartily, though not so noisily, as his
+ comrades had done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have been very anxious about you," he said, after the first greeting.
+ "When we came back to the point where you left us, and did not find you
+ there, we thought there might be some mistake, and that you had ridden on.
+ We picked up all the others, but were not uneasy until we got into camp,
+ and found that you did not return. Then two of your friends took fresh
+ horses and rode out again, taking two of your blacks with them. The blacks
+ found the place where you had left us, and following your tracks down came
+ on your horses. Then they went on till they saw the river in front of
+ them. The blacks traced your footsteps along near the bank till they came
+ to a spot where there was evidently a drift, as a road was cut down to the
+ water on both sides. They then crawled along till they could look down
+ into the road. They were some time away, and returned with the news that
+ they had seen below them on the road a patch of blood and the mark of a
+ body in the mud, another step they said had gone down to the water, and
+ had not come back. Crawling along by the edge of the bank they found some
+ empty cartridges. They said whoever had been up there had crawled once or
+ twice to the edge above the sunken road where the other was lying, and
+ that he had then gone back from the river and afterwards down into the
+ road. A little farther there seemed to have been a fall, and then two men
+ with big feet came to the spot, and, they asserted, carried the one who
+ had fallen there down to the other; but they could not see what had
+ happened then, for it was evident that the Boers were in force on the
+ other side of the river, and they dared not go down farther to examine the
+ tracks. Enough had been seen, however, to show that you must both have
+ been wounded. It was pretty certain that you had not been killed, for if
+ so the Boers would not have troubled to carry your bodies across the
+ drift. Now, Chris, let us hear your story."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If you don't mind, Captain Brookfield," Chris said with a smile, "I will
+ put off telling it for another half-hour. The fact is, breakfast is ready,
+ and I have only had one square meal since I went away, and that was
+ yesterday at Estcourt."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Go, by all means," the captain laughed. "I breakfasted half an hour
+ before you came in, and forgot that it was possible that you had not done
+ so." It was a full half-hour before Chris returned, and when he did so he
+ left Sankey still telling the story of their adventures, which had made
+ very little progress, as he had declared that he could not enjoy his
+ breakfast if he was obliged to keep on talking all the time. When Chris,
+ on his part, had told the story to Captain Brookfield, the latter said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I can't say that I am altogether surprised to see you back, though I
+ certainly did not expect you for a long time, for I felt sure that if you
+ and Sankey were not seriously wounded you would manage to give them the
+ slip before you got to Pretoria; and I thought we should hear the first
+ news of you at Durban, for it would be shorter and easier for you to make
+ your way down again to Lorenzo Marques than to follow this line."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We should certainly have gone that way if we had not escaped until we
+ were near Pretoria, but it was a great deal easier to slip away from the
+ waggons than it would have been if we had been once put into the train. I
+ hope, sir, we have not been returned as missing, for it will have
+ frightened our mothers terribly if we have been."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; I thought that there was no occasion to give your names until you had
+ been away for a month. If you were not heard of by that time, I should
+ consider it certain that you were dead or at Pretoria. I knew that, as you
+ say, it would be a terrible shock to your mothers if they were to see your
+ names among the missing; while it could do no harm to anyone if I kept it
+ back for a month, and put you down as missing the first time after the
+ corps were engaged. Well, you are just back in time for a big fight,
+ though we are not likely to take any part in it. It is supposed to be a
+ secret as to the precise position, but orders have been privately
+ circulated this morning. Dundonald with the regular cavalry, the Natal
+ Horse, and the South African Light Horse went on four days ago, with one
+ or two other colonial corps, and occupied Springfield, and the baggage
+ train followed them; and after occupying the place, instead of waiting for
+ infantry to come up, he moved on to a river. Some of his men, with
+ extraordinary pluck, swam across and managed to bring the ferry-boat over
+ under a very heavy fire. Then a number of them crossed, scattered the
+ Boers like chaff, and took possession of a rough hill called Swartz Kop,
+ and held it till support came up. It was a capitally managed affair, and
+ one cannot but regret that the same care was not shown at Hlangwane. We
+ are to go on this afternoon, but as we are not in Dundonald's brigade I
+ expect that our duty will be, as it was in the last fight, to guard the
+ baggage."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But what will Dundonald's brigade do?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The general opinion is, that they will push round to Acton Homes. I am
+ not sure that the whole force is not going that way. It would be a grand
+ thing if it could be done; but I doubt whether the train could carry
+ enough stores, for it would be a long way round, and we should probably
+ have to fight two or three times at least, and it might take us five or
+ six days."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then most of the infantry have gone on already?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, Hart's and Hildyard's brigades have marched straight from Frere. By
+ the way, did you hear of the Boer attack on Ladysmith on the night of the
+ 6th?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; that was the night we were at Glencoe. On our way up we did hear some
+ very heavy firing. At least, we were not certain that it was firing, and
+ rather thought it was a distant thunder-storm."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "The firing began at two o'clock in the morning," Captain Brookfield said,
+ "and was so heavy that everyone turned out. It lasted four hours, and
+ there was no doubt that the Boers were making a determined attack.
+ Everyone wondered that we did not at once make a diversion. When the day
+ broke it could be seen that numbers of mounted Boers were hurrying off
+ from their camps among the hills towards Ladysmith, but it was not until
+ two in the afternoon that five battalions of infantry marched down towards
+ Colenso, and the naval guns opened in earnest on their lines. It had the
+ effect of bringing the Boers scurrying down again to their trenches. Our
+ fellows marched in open order and worked their way nearly down to Colenso,
+ which was more strongly garrisoned than it had been at the time of our
+ last attack. No doubt they had seen us preparing to advance, and strongly
+ reinforced the garrison. Our guns were taken a long way down, and at six
+ o'clock their trenches were bombarded; then it came on to rain, and the
+ Boers ceased to fire, and at seven o'clock our men turned into camp. The
+ firing in Ladysmith had ceased some time before that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And what had taken place there?" Chris asked anxiously, "for I know the
+ place has not fallen or we should have heard of it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No, they beat the Boers off splendidly. However, they had hard work to do
+ it, for the heliograph flashed a signal at about nine o'clock in the
+ morning to say that they had so far beaten off the enemy, but were much
+ pressed. We heard the next day that this had indeed been the case.
+ Caesar's Camp had been taken and retaken several times&mdash;by our men at
+ the point of the bayonet, by the Boers, by rushing up in overwhelming
+ numbers. It is said that we have twelve hundred casualties, and the Boers
+ at least fifteen hundred, of whom a large number were bayoneted. They say
+ the loss fell chiefly upon the Free Staters, who were put in the front by
+ the Transvaal people. They fought pluckily, and several of their
+ commanders were among the killed. I should think that they would hardly
+ try it again. A native got through two days afterwards with a despatch. We
+ have not heard what it contained, but we fancy from what has leaked out
+ that our defences were very weak."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We ought to take a lesson from the Boers," Chris said. "I saw something
+ of their trenches as we went up the railway valley, and they are
+ wonderful."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, we must do the Boers the justice to say that they are not afraid of
+ hard work. Ever since they first came here they have been at work
+ everywhere every day in the week, including Sundays. Of course, as we are
+ not standing on the defensive, there is no occasion for us to construct
+ works to the same extent; but I cannot myself understand why we do not
+ throw up batteries for our guns, pushing forward zigzags every night, and
+ advancing the batteries until we can plant all our naval and field guns
+ within a hundred yards of Colenso, when we should be able to smash their
+ entrenchments in no time, and effectually cover an advance across the
+ bridge or one of the drifts. When I was in the army it was always said
+ that the next war would be fought with the spade as much as with the
+ rifle, but so far we have seen nothing whatever of the spade, except just
+ by the guns. We were also taught that strong positions held by steady
+ troops armed with magazine guns and supported by good artillery were
+ absolutely impregnable against direct attack. I grant that Dundee and
+ Elandslaagte, and Belmont and Enslin on the other side, seemed to
+ contradict that idea, but our experience here is all the other way; and if
+ we keep on knocking our heads against those hills I suppose the axiom is
+ likely to be finally confirmed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then you don't think that we are going to fight our way into Ladysmith,
+ Captain Brookfield?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not direct into Ladysmith. Possibly we may work our way round; but after
+ what we saw of the fire from their position, trench above trench, and
+ miles upon miles in length, my own conviction is, that allowing to the
+ utmost for the gallantry and devotion of our men, we shall never win our
+ way across those hills."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then we move off at two o'clock, sir?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, fresh batches of waggons are going on, and we are to escort them,
+ and if we reach Springfield by to-morrow night we may think ourselves
+ lucky, for some of the officers who went with the first lot have come
+ back, and say that the roads are simply awful&mdash;there are dongas to be
+ passed where the waggons sink up to their axles&mdash;and that at one
+ point ninety oxen were fastened to a single waggon and could not pull it
+ out from a hole in which it was sunk, and there it would be now if one of
+ the Woolwich traction engines hadn't got hold of it and drawn it out. They
+ are doing splendid work, and if the War Office authorities can but take a
+ lesson to heart, the next war we go into we shall have five hundred of
+ them and not a single transport animal. They would cost money, no doubt,
+ but they would eat nothing and drink nothing; they would only require to
+ be oiled and cleaned occasionally to keep them in order, and when they
+ were wanted they would do the work without our having to hunt the world
+ over for transport animals. They would save their cost in one war; there
+ would be a thousand drivers and stokers instead of twenty thousand camp
+ followers; it would not matter whether the country was burnt up dry or
+ deep in grass, they would drag their fuel with them; and would save the
+ artillery horses by dragging the guns till they were in the neighbourhood
+ of an enemy. It might not look so pretty or picturesque as the present
+ system, but it would be enormously more useful, and in the long run vastly
+ more economical. I should like to see Kitchener put at the War Office with
+ authority to sweep it out; Hercules in the Augean stable would be nothing
+ to it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris laughed at the earnestness and vehemence with which the commander
+ spoke.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He went on. "I am an old army man, and have been as staunch a believer in
+ army traditions as any man, but I tell you fairly that I am disgusted at
+ the amount of routine work, delay, and, if I may use the word, priggism,
+ that I see going on. I am not surprised that the Colonials to a man are
+ convinced that they would manage matters infinitely better if they were
+ left to themselves. They would harass the Boers night and day, sweep their
+ plundering parties out of the land, make a circuit no matter how far into
+ Zululand, and come down behind and cut the line of railway, and blow up
+ the bridges, and worry them out of the colony. I don't say they would
+ succeed, but I am sure they would try, and I believe firmly that five
+ thousand mounted Colonials fighting in their own way would relieve
+ Ladysmith and clear Natal sooner than we with thirty thousand shall do. I
+ am not saying that they would succeed in a Continental war, though they
+ would certainly harass and bother any regular force four times their own
+ strength. To succeed they would require guns and a greater degree of
+ discipline than they have got, but such a force would be absolutely
+ invaluable as an assistant to a regular army. Don't repeat what I say,
+ Chris; there is a good deal of soreness of feeling on both sides already,
+ and I don't want any utterance of mine to add to it. Still, I can assure
+ you it has been a relief to me to let the steam off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the appointed hour the Maritzburg Scouts and another Colonial corps
+ started with a train of two hundred waggons, and with immense exertion
+ made eight miles before it became dark. The men were more often on foot
+ than in their saddles, sometimes roping their horses to the sides of the
+ waggons to aid the oxen, sometimes putting their shoulders to the wheels,
+ or working with a score of others with railway sleepers that had been
+ brought for the purpose, to lever the axles out of deep holes into which
+ the wheels had sunk.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think I ever knew what it was to be really dirty before," Field
+ said, as they finally dismounted and prepared to camp. "I thought I did
+ know something about mud, but I can see that I did not. I feel that I am a
+ sort of animated pie, and could be cooked comfortably in an oven. If we
+ could but get a big fire and stand round it, our crust might peel off; and
+ I really don't see any other way. There is one advantage in it, and that
+ is that we shall be able to skirmish, if necessary, across either a sandy
+ or muddy country, without the possibility of our being made out more than
+ fifty yards away by the keenest-sighted Boer. What do you propose, Captain
+ Chris? If there were running water near, the course would be clear. We
+ would lie down by turns, and be rolled over and over, and thumped with
+ stones, and rubbed with anything that came handy till we were in a state
+ of comparative cleanliness."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Why running water?" Chris asked. "Why not a pond?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A pond!" Field said, contemptuously. "Why, sir, before our section alone
+ was washed, the water of anything short of a lake would be solid."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general burst of laughter.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, Field, you do us almost as much good as a wash," Peters said.
+ "Anyhow, we are better off than the others. We have got our tents and our
+ spirit-lamp, and can have our tea with some degree of comfort, which is
+ more than the others will be able to do. Now, as we have not running
+ water, I think we might as well scrape as much of this mud off as we can."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I would almost rather remain as we are," Field said. "Hitherto I have
+ felt rather proud of our appearance. As we only got our uniforms when we
+ came up here, and have always had our tents to sleep in, we looked a great
+ deal cleaner than the average. Now we shall be conspicuous for our
+ dirtiness."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "In spite of what Field says, I will adopt your suggestion, Peters. We had
+ better help the Kaffirs to get up our tents first," Chris said, "then we
+ can do the scraping while they are getting our supper ready. It is very
+ lucky that we had the water-skins filled before starting. We should hardly
+ taste the tea if it had been made from water from any of these spruits."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The tents were erected, and then jack-knives were taken out; and giving
+ mutual aid to each other, they succeeded in removing at least the main
+ portion of the mud. That done, they sat down to supper. Fortunately, the
+ rain that had come down steadily the greater portion of the day had now
+ ceased, and with a tin of cocoa and milk, and some fried ham and biscuits,
+ they made an excellent meal. Their less fortunate comrades brought their
+ kettles, which were boiled for them one after another, until all who had
+ waited up in hopes of their turn coming had been served. As they carried
+ tea and their ration bread, they were able to make a fairly comfortable
+ meal, instead of going supperless to bed, which they would otherwise have
+ done, as few would have cared after their hard work to go out into the
+ veldt to gather soaked sticks, which they would hardly have been able to
+ light had they found them. A small ration of spirits and water was given
+ to each of the five natives, and then the lads crept into their tents
+ feeling that after all, things might have been much worse.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0015" id="link2HCH0015"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XV &mdash; SPION KOP
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The country immediately round Springfield was level and well cultivated,
+ with pretty farmhouses and orchards scattered about. Some little distance
+ to the west rose two hills, Swartz Kop, which had been occupied by the
+ mounted infantry, and Spearman's Hill, named from a farm near its base.
+ Here General Buller had established his head-quarters. Spearman's Hill,
+ which was generally called Mount Alice, was a very important position, and
+ here the naval guns were placed, their fire commanding the greater portion
+ of the hills on the other side of the Tugela, and also Potgieter's Drift,
+ where it was intended the passage of the river should be made. Swartz Kop
+ was a less important position, though it also dominated a wide extent of
+ country; but as ridges on the other side covered some important points
+ from its fire, Mount Alice was selected as the position for the naval
+ battery, and also for the signallers, as from here a direct communication
+ could be kept up by heliograph and flash-light with one of the hills held
+ by the defenders of Ladysmith.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: THE NAVAL GUNS ON MOUNT ALICE]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was late on the 16th when the convoy which the Maritzburg Scouts were
+ escorting arrived at Springfield. All day they had heard the boom of
+ artillery and the rattle of machine-guns and musketry along the line of
+ hills on the other side of the Tugela and from the heights of Mount Alice,
+ and groaned in spirit as they laboured at their work of assisting the
+ waggons, that they were thus employed when hard fighting was going on
+ within eight miles of them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At half-past two that day Lyttleton's brigade had moved forward along the
+ foot of Mount Alice to force the passage of the river at Potgieter's
+ drift. As soon as the Boers caught sight of them, they could be seen
+ galloping forward to take their places in the trenches.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A thunder-storm that burst and a torrent of rain screened the movements of
+ the advancing troops from view for some time, and enabled them to near the
+ river without having to pass through any shell fire from the Boer
+ batteries on the hilltops. Between Mount Alice and the river the brigade
+ passed across meadows and ploughed fields. They reached the ferry, but the
+ boat was stuck fast, and an hour was lost at this point before a party of
+ sailors and colonial troops accustomed to such work came forward to the
+ aid of the Engineers, and speedily got it into working order. But in the
+ meantime the Scottish Rifles and the Rifle Brigade had moved along the
+ banks to the drift. Although usually almost dry, the water was now coming
+ down it breast-deep. Two gallant fellows went across, and when they found
+ the line of shallow water they returned and guided their comrades over.
+ The rush of the water was so great that many would have been swept away;
+ but, joining hands, they crossed in a line, and although this was broken
+ several times, it was always reformed, and not many lives were lost.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as some of the troops had passed, they lined the bank until the
+ two battalions were over, and then advanced over some low hills, clearing
+ out a few Boers who occupied some advanced trenches. By six o'clock the
+ ferry-boat began to carry the main body across, taking over half a company
+ at a time; but it was not until half-past three in the morning that the
+ horses, waggons, the guns of the brigade, and a howitzer battery were on
+ the northern bank, and the whole brigade established on a ridge a mile
+ beyond the river.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Maritzburg Scouts were delighted at receiving orders on the morning
+ after their arrival at Springfield that they were to move forward at once
+ and encamp close to Spearman's Farm, and to furnish orderlies for carrying
+ messages for the general. They started at once, and after an hour's fast
+ riding arrived at the point assigned to them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Twenty men and an officer were at once sent to the farmhouse. They took
+ with them three tents which they had brought in the regimental waggon, and
+ erected these some fifty yards from the house; the rest of the troop
+ established their camp at a point indicated by a staff officer a quarter
+ of a mile away. It had been two o'clock in the morning before the convoy
+ had reached Springfield, and horses and men were alike tired out; and as
+ soon as breakfast had been prepared and eaten most of the troopers turned
+ in to sleep. Chris and half a dozen of his party, however, obtained leave
+ from Captain Brookfield to ascend Mount Alice and see what was going on.
+ From half-past five a tremendous fire had been kept up on the Boer
+ positions. The naval guns were distributing their heavy lyddite shells
+ among the entrenchments distant from three to six miles, and occasionally
+ throwing up a missile on to the summit of the lofty hill known as Spion
+ Kop away to the left front. Not less steadily or effectively the howitzer
+ battery was pounding the Boer position.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At eight o'clock the lads reached the top of Mount Alice, and watched with
+ intense interest the picturesque and exciting scene. Here they were far
+ better able than they had been when at Chieveley to see the general aspect
+ of the country. On the right from Grobler's Kloof hill after hill,
+ separated apparently by shallow depressions, rose, and from the higher
+ points occasional flashes of fire burst out as the guns tried their range
+ against those on Mount Alice, whose heights, however, they failed to
+ reach. Spion Kop stood out steep and threatening, its summit being some
+ hundred feet higher than that of Mount Alice. They could now see that it
+ was not, as it had appeared from the distance, an isolated and almost
+ conical hill, but was, in fact, connected with hills farther to the left
+ by a ridge of which it was the termination.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Immediately behind it was a deep valley, and the ascent from this side was
+ to some extent commanded by the guns on Mount Alice and Swartz Kop.
+ Between Spion Kop and the river there was a flat belt of country, and it
+ was along this that Lord Dundonald had ridden with his brigade of cavalry
+ to Acton Homes, where he was still stationed. The point of greatest
+ interest, however, was at Trichardt's Drift, lying six miles west of Mount
+ Alice. From their look-out they could make out the division under the
+ command of Sir Charles Warren advancing to the ford. As far as they could
+ see, no serious opposition was being offered; they could, however, in the
+ intervals of silence of the guns, hear a dropping musketry fire in that
+ direction, and a few rounds of shot from Warren's field-guns, but it was
+ evident that only a small party of the enemy could be disputing the
+ passage.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Peters, who was intently watching what was going on through his glasses,
+ said: "They are at work at two points on the river. I think they are
+ building bridges."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The naval guns dropped a few shells among the farm buildings and orchards
+ facing the spot where the troops were gathered, as a hint to the Boers
+ that it was well within their range, and that they had best abstain from
+ interfering with what was going on. In an hour from the time the troops
+ reached the bank two bridges had been thrown across the river, and the
+ passage began. By ten o'clock the whole were across, the firing soon after
+ ceased, and Warren's troops bivouacked quietly. It was all over for the
+ day, and the lads returned to their camp. The next day passed quietly,
+ except that in the afternoon the Boer entrenchments near Spion Kop and
+ Brakfontein, a hill facing the position occupied by Lyttleton's brigade,
+ were pounded by the naval guns and howitzers. A message was heliographed
+ from Ladysmith that two thousand Boers were seen moving towards Acton
+ Homes, and as the occupation of that village was of no value until the
+ infantry arrived there, the cavalry were recalled to a position where they
+ could protect Warren's left flank from attack.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the 19th, Warren pushed forward a portion of his force with a view to
+ driving back the Boers' right and gaining the main road leading through
+ Dewdrop to Ladysmith, while Woodgate's brigade watched Spion Kop. Fighting
+ went on all day, the British forcing the enemy back step by step. On the
+ 20th it began early and continued the whole day. Every inch of the ground
+ was contested stubbornly by the Boers, but the Irish Brigade, who were in
+ the hottest position, pressed them back fiercely with sudden rushes, and,
+ had the rest of the division kept up with their advance, might have
+ cleared the way through the enemy's centre. But the cannonade to which the
+ advancing troops were exposed was terrible. Maxims and Nordenfeldts, the
+ heavy cannon, and the field-pieces captured from us a month before, hurled
+ shot and shell incessantly among them, while the rattle of the Boer rifles
+ was continuous. Still, fair progress was made, and with less loss than
+ might have been expected in such strife. Two officers only were killed,
+ Captain Hensley of the Dublin Fusiliers, and Major Childe, who was a most
+ popular officer. He had a presentiment that he would fall, and actually
+ asked a friend the evening before to have a tablet placed over his grave
+ with the inscription, "Is it well with the child? It is well."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At three o'clock the fighting slackened, and a heavy thunderstorm seemed
+ to be the signal for firing to cease. Later Sir Charles Warren summoned
+ all the officers commanding corps, and pointed out that there was not
+ sufficient food remaining to allow of the wide circuit by Acton Homes to
+ be carried out, and gave his opinion that now they had won so much ground,
+ it was better to continue to advance by the shorter line on which they
+ were pushing, but that in order to do this it was necessary that Spion
+ Kop, whose fire would take them in the rear, should be captured. This was
+ unanimously agreed to, and General Warren then saw the commander-in-chief,
+ and obtained his consent to the change of plans. It was not, however,
+ considered necessary to take Spion Kop until the troops had farther
+ advanced. All Sunday, fighting was continued as before, but the progress
+ made was slower, as the Boers were largely reinforced and fresh guns
+ brought up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The 22nd was comparatively quiet. The situation was not improving. Five
+ miles of rough ground had been won in as many days' fighting, but the
+ force was becoming lengthened out and the line weaker. Lyttleton's force
+ had to guard the line from Potgieter's Drift to Warren's right against any
+ attempt of the Boers to cut the lines of communication. Woodgate was
+ similarly employed in keeping the line from Trichardt's Drift to Warren's
+ left, and it became increasingly evident that not much further progress
+ could be made until the left of the advance was protected by the
+ establishment of guns on the great hill. It was then, on the 23rd, decided
+ that Woodgate's brigade should assault Spion Hop that night. It was known
+ that it was not strongly held.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Starting at six o'clock, the column made its way slowly and with vast
+ difficulty up the ascent. This was everywhere rugged and rocky, and in
+ many places so precipitous that men had to be pushed or pulled up by their
+ comrades.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Colonel Thorneycroft led the way with a few men, finding out the spots at
+ which an ascent was practicable, and scouting on either side to discover
+ if Boers were hidden; behind him followed Woodgate leading his men. He was
+ in bad health and quite unfit for such a climb, but in spite of
+ remonstrances he had insisted upon going, although he was obliged to be
+ assisted at the more difficult places. The distance was not more than six
+ miles, but it was not until nearly ten hours after starting that the
+ summit was gained. The hilltop was enveloped in mist, and they were unseen
+ until the Lancashire Fusiliers, who were leading, were within fifty yards
+ of the top. Then a Boer challenged them, and directly fired his rifle.
+ Almost instantly a dozen of his comrades joined him, and bringing their
+ magazines into play opened a fierce fusillade. But the aim was hurried,
+ they could scarce see their foes, and the Lancashire men, cheering loudly,
+ rushed up to the crest without loss.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers did not await their arrival; only one of them was bayoneted
+ before he turned to fly, and but two or three were overtaken by the eager
+ soldiers. As soon as the Boers had gone, the troops set to work to
+ construct breastworks to hold the spot they had gained against any
+ attempts of the Boers to recapture. The ground was too rocky for digging,
+ and the stones that were scattered thickly about were used for the
+ purpose; but long before the breastwork could be completed a dropping fire
+ was opened by the enemy. The morning was gray and misty, and the clouds
+ hung heavily on the hilltop. As these cleared off slowly, it could be seen
+ that the position was less favourable than it had seemed, for the flat
+ crest extended some distance beyond the point they had entrenched, and
+ from the rocks and low ridges a hot fire broke out. Before the mist
+ cleared off, the Boers had crept up in considerable force, and were, it
+ was evident, preparing to retake the position that had been wrested from
+ them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By six o'clock the scattered fire had grown into a continuous roar, the
+ Boers occupying not only the nek itself, but the flanks of the hill.
+ Several times our men made rushes to endeavour to clear off the foe, but
+ these proved too costly, and they were now lying or kneeling behind the
+ unfinished barricade. In a very short time the clouds had lifted
+ sufficiently for the Boer artillery to discover the exact position, and
+ from the hills on three sides a terrible fire of shot and shell, from
+ cannon great and small and machine-guns, rained upon them. Again and again
+ parties of men started to their feet and dashed forward to drive the
+ hidden Boers facing them from their hiding-places. Sometimes they
+ succeeded for a time, but their numbers thinned so fast that the survivors
+ were forced to fall back again. To add to the horror of the situation, the
+ shot from our own guns also fell among the defenders, the officers
+ commanding the batteries not having been informed of the intention to
+ occupy the hill, and knowing nothing of the situation. Scores of men were
+ killed or wounded, but the position was held unflinchingly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At ten o'clock General Woodgate was mortally wounded by the fragment of a
+ shell that struck him in the eye, and Colonel Crofton took the command. He
+ at once flashed a message to General Warren, stating that Woodgate was
+ killed, and that reinforcements must be sent at once; General Coke was
+ therefore ordered to take the Middlesex and Dorset regiments, and assume
+ the command. Immediately afterwards Warren received an order from General
+ Buller to appoint Lieutenant-colonel Thorneycroft, who was colonel of a
+ colonial force, to take the command. It was now hoped that all was well
+ there. Unfortunately, neither Buller nor Warren was able to give his
+ undivided attention to the struggle on the mountain, for Lyttleton's
+ brigade had advanced before daybreak against the eastern slopes of the
+ hills running north from Spion Kop. They advanced briskly, their Maxims
+ clearing out the Boers, from whose fire they suffered but little; but they
+ sustained some loss from the shell fire from Mount Alice, the sailors
+ having been as uninformed of the advance the brigade were to make as they
+ were of the capture of Spion Kop. The Scottish Rifles and the 3rd King's
+ Royal Rifles pushed on rapidly and gained the spur farthest north. Had
+ there been guns on Spion Kop the object of the movement would have been
+ attained, and the advance by direct road on Ladysmith have become a
+ possibility; but no guns had reached the summit, and the troops there were
+ so far from being able to render assistance that they were with difficulty
+ maintaining their desperate resistance. As the two rifle regiments were
+ therefore exposed to a concentrated fire from the Boer batteries, and were
+ without support, they were directed to withdraw, but the order had to be
+ repeated three times before it was obeyed. The fire slackened at this
+ point to some extent in the afternoon, no farther advance being attempted,
+ but it raged as hotly as ever on the summit of Spion Kop.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As neither General Buller nor Warren had come up to see the state of
+ things on the all-important position of Spion Kop, General Coke went down
+ in the evening to explain the situation. He stated that unless the
+ artillery could silence the enemy's guns the troops could not support
+ another day's shelling. In the evening two naval twelve-pounders, the R.
+ A. mountain battery, and one thousand two hundred men as reliefs, started
+ to ascend the hill and to strengthen the entrenchments. On the way up they
+ met Colonel Thorneycroft and the rest of the force coming down, that
+ officer, who had displayed splendid gallantry throughout the day, having
+ decided on his own responsibility that the position could not be longer
+ held. Strangely enough, the news of the retirement was not communicated to
+ General Buller, who, after reporting in his despatches written next
+ morning that Spion Kop was firmly held, was riding to the front when he
+ for the first time learned the news. Altogether it was a day of strange
+ blunders, redeemed only by the splendid bravery of the troops engaged. The
+ news came as a heavy blow to the army, but it was supposed that a fresh
+ attempt would be made to capture the position by ascending the northern
+ spurs that had been carried and held for a time by the two rifle
+ battalions. But while soldiers think only of the chances of battle, and
+ burn to engage the enemy, a feeling only accentuated by previous failures,
+ generals in command have to take other matters into consideration. They
+ may feel that they may conquer in the next fight, but what is to follow?
+ In this case the chances of success would be smaller than before, the loss
+ more serious, for the Boers from all parts had united to oppose us. Many
+ of the cannon had been brought over from the positions from which
+ Ladysmith was bombarded. The advantage of surprise gained by the long
+ march from Chieveley had been lost; more serious still was it that a large
+ proportion of the provisions, brought at the cost of so much labour and
+ exhaustion of the transport animals, was consumed, and what remained would
+ be insufficient had fresh battles to be fought to capture the positions,
+ one behind another, held by the Boers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ General Buller was the last man to retire as long as there was a hope of
+ success. He knew that not only at home, but all over the civilized world,
+ men were anxiously awaiting the news of his second attempt to relieve
+ Ladysmith, and it must have been hard indeed for him to have to
+ acknowledge a second reverse; but in spite of this he sternly determined
+ to fall back. The movement was admirably executed; every horse, waggon,
+ gun, and soldier was taken safely across the Tugela without hindrance by
+ the Boers, a fact that showed how deeply they had been impressed with the
+ valour of our soldiers. Sullenly and angrily the troops marched away. Had
+ they had their will they would have hurled themselves against the Boer
+ entrenchments until the last man had fallen. To them the necessities of
+ the situation were as nothing; to retreat seemed an acknowledgment that
+ they had been beaten, a feeling that is seldom entertained by British
+ soldiers. Their losses had been heavy, but there were still enough of
+ them, they thought, for the work they had to do, and it was with a deep
+ feeling of unmerited humiliation that they received the order to retire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The feeling, however, was not of long endurance, for two days later, when
+ they had settled down in camp near the Tugela and round Spearman's Farm,
+ the general rode through the lines, congratulating the troops on the
+ valour they had displayed, and promising them that ere long they would be
+ in Ladysmith.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I shall be heartily glad when we are there," Chris said when he heard
+ what the general had promised, "not only for the sake of the town, but for
+ our own. We are really doing no good here. It is hateful to look on when
+ other fellows are fighting so desperately. If it were not that the orders
+ were strict against the mounted Colonial corps going out over the country,
+ to clear the scattered Boers out, we might be doing useful service; and as
+ soon as Ladysmith is relieved&mdash;that is to say, if we can hold out
+ till we get there&mdash;I should certainly vote that we come back here
+ instead of staying with the army, and go on again on our own account."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I quite agree with you," Carmichael said. "Still, it is something to have
+ seen two big fights."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes," Brown grumbled, "but if we tell anybody that we were there,
+ naturally the first question will be, 'What part did you take in it', and
+ we shall have to own that we took no part at all, and only looked on at a
+ distance at the other fellows fighting. I call it sickening."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, never mind, Brown," Chris said; "after all, during this business,
+ we have killed twice our own number of Boers at the least, and if everyone
+ had done as much the Boers would be pretty well extinct."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, there is certainly something in that," Brown admitted, "but if we
+ had been allowed to scout on our own account it would be hard if we had
+ not killed twice as many more by this time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We certainly might have done so, but you must remember, also, that a
+ great many of us might have been killed too. One cannot always expect to
+ have the luck we had in those two fights; and, I am sure, we should
+ bitterly regret gaps being made in our number."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That we should," Harris said warmly. "We were all good friends before,
+ but nothing to what we are now after living so long together, roughing it
+ and sharing each others' dangers. For my part I would rather go without
+ any more fighting than that any of us should go down."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I agree with you thoroughly, Harris," Chris said. "As most of us are
+ likely to remain out here for life, we shall often meet, and I do hope
+ that when we talk of these times we shan't have our pleasure marred by
+ having to say how we miss so and so, and so and so. I should be sorry even
+ to lose one of our blacks. They have stuck to their work well, and are
+ always cheerful and willing in the worst of weather and under the most
+ miserable conditions. I should really be very sorry if any of them were
+ killed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It needed but a day or two for the troops to recover their cheerfulness.
+ It was certain that they would soon be launched against the enemy again,
+ and it was known that General Buller would himself command. The ground was
+ now more known than it was before, the plans could be better laid, and all
+ looked forward confidently to the next engagement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No thanks were due to the weather for the renewed spirits of the men. It
+ rained almost unceasingly. The flat ground on which the troops were
+ encamped was a sea of mud. There was one good effect in this: there was
+ water in all the spruits, and the men were able to indulge in a wash-up of
+ their clothes and an occasional bath; and although they had to put their
+ clothes on wet, they were scarcely more damp than when they took them off.
+ There was other work to be done. Two naval guns, a mountain battery, and
+ some large cannon were with great labour got up on the top of Swartz Kop.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads had given up the two tents allotted to them to let the rest of
+ the men have more room, and they now felt the full benefit of their little
+ shelter tents. The allowance throughout the rest of the camp was sixteen
+ men to a tent. On coming in and out, as the men were muddy up to the
+ knees, it was impossible to keep these even tolerably clean, and the
+ discomfort of so many men crowded together and obliged to live, eat, and
+ sleep in such confined quarters was very great indeed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads on the other hand, suffered from none of these inconveniences,
+ and except that they could not stand up, and could only sit upright in the
+ middle of the tent, they were perfectly comfortable. The tents were about
+ seven feet wide on the ground, and as much long. Their natives had cut and
+ brought in bundles of grass, which made them soft beds, one on each side
+ of the tent. A blanket was stretched on each bed, another doubled lay over
+ it. It was a strict rule that everyone should take off his boots on
+ entering his tent, and leave them just inside the entrance. They had
+ purchased at the sale of the effects of some of the officers killed in
+ action some more blankets and rugs, and these were thrown over the
+ entrance to the front of the tents at night, and made them perfectly warm
+ and comfortable. A trench some eighteen inches deep was dug round each
+ tent, and this kept the floor fairly dry.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some blankets had been given to the Kaffirs, who constructed a little
+ shelter, in which they squatted by day and slept at night, and in which
+ cooking operations were carried on. The lads had no occasion to feel dull,
+ for they now knew many officers in the line regiments, and among the
+ Colonial troops, as well as the naval brigade; and "Brookfield's boys", as
+ they were generally called, were always welcome, and it was seldom that
+ more than half of them dined in their own camp. Chris could always have
+ been an absentee, for the sailors had told to each other the story of his
+ attempt to blow up the bridge at Komati-poort, and he received any number
+ of invitations. But he by no means liked to have to retell the story, and
+ generally made some excuse or other for remaining in camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Another battery of artillery arrived on the 31st of January, and on the
+ 3rd of February there were sports in the camp of the South African Light
+ Horse, and a camp-fire sing-song afterwards. The men were all now in high
+ spirits, for it was certain that in a day or two another attack would be
+ made. On Sunday, February 4th, it was known that the move would commence
+ the next day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ General Buller's plan was to make a strong feint against Brakfontein, the
+ highest hill of the ridge connected with the Spion Kop range, while the
+ real attack was to be delivered against an isolated hill named Vaal
+ Krantz, which, as viewed from Swartz Kop and Mount Alice, seemed to be the
+ key to the whole position, and it was thought that its possession would
+ open the way for a direct advance to Ladysmith. All was now in readiness
+ for the attack, and the sailors had with steel hawsers, and the aid of the
+ troops, got four more naval guns on to Swartz Kop.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Before daybreak the troops were ready to advance. The regular cavalry were
+ near the base of Swartz Kop, while all the Colonial Horse, under Lord
+ Dundonald, were near Potgieter's Drift. At six o'clock the cavalry went
+ forward, but not far, for the morning was so misty that the artillery
+ could not make out the Boer positions until an hour later, when a
+ tremendous fire was opened from Mount Alice, Swartz Kop, and guns placed
+ on a lower spur of Spion Kop. While this was going on, a bridge was thrown
+ by the Engineers across another drift. Major-general Wynne led the
+ Lancashire brigade in the direction of Brakfontein. They went forward in
+ skirmishing order, supported by five field batteries and the howitzer
+ battery, all of which kept up an incessant fire of lyddite, shell, and
+ shot against the Boer position, their fire being guided by an engineer
+ officer in a balloon, who was able from a lofty altitude to signal where
+ the Boers were clustering most thickly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When another bridge had been completed General Lyttleton advanced with his
+ brigade across it, and as the feint against Brakfontein had succeeded in
+ gathering the greater portion of the Boers at the spot they supposed to be
+ most in danger, the Lancashire brigade was withdrawn, retiring in
+ excellent order, the movement being covered by an incessant firing of the
+ guns with them, which completely dominated those of the Boers. Lyttleton's
+ brigade now pressed forward under a storm of musketry and shell from
+ machine and other guns, which were answered even more thunderously by the
+ British artillery. The din was tremendous&mdash;greater even than any that
+ had been previously heard. It seemed impossible that men could live for a
+ moment in such a storm of missiles. But they pressed on unfalteringly, and
+ the batteries with them as steadily maintained their fire, though shells
+ fell continually round and among them. The batteries that had gone out
+ with the Lancashire Brigade now directed their fire against Vaal Krantz,
+ having moved across from Brakfontein under a tremendous fire. One of the
+ waggons lost all its horses; but the five artillerymen with it manned the
+ wheels and brought it safely out of fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At three o'clock Lyttleton's brigade advanced in earnest, and dashed
+ forward at the double against Vaal Krantz, heedless of the rifle fire from
+ the hills on both flanks and from the front. The defenders soon lost
+ courage, as they saw the Durhams and 3rd King's Royal Rifles dashing up
+ the hill with bayonets fixed, and scarce two hundred of them remained till
+ the British gained the crest. These were speedily scattered or bayoneted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The position when won was found to be unsatisfactory, for it was dominated
+ by a hill beyond, which could not be seen from the British look-out
+ stations, and the cannon of Spion Kop were able to sweep the plateau. At
+ one time the Boers gathered and made an effort to retake the hill, but two
+ more battalions were sent up to reinforce the defenders, and the enemy
+ were driven back and the fire gradually languished. The troops remained on
+ the ground they had won during the night. From prisoners they learned that
+ four thousand Boers occupied Doornkloof, the hill on their flank, and that
+ the whole of the Transvaalers under Joubert were gathering in their front.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The baggage waggons were all collected by the river in readiness to
+ advance; but the way was not yet sufficiently cleared for them, and the
+ Boer guns on Brakfontein and Spion Kop commanded the road which they would
+ have to traverse. It was evident to all that no advance was possible until
+ the guns on these heights had been silenced or captured. For the same
+ reason the two brigades of cavalry had remained inactive. During the night
+ the Boers set fire to the grass on Vaal Krantz, and by the assistance of
+ the light kept up a shell and Maxim fire upon the troops holding it. By
+ morning they had brought up one of their big hundred-pound Creusot guns on
+ to Doornkloof, and it added its roar to the chaos of other sounds. Under
+ the shelter of its fire and that of the other guns the Boers made several
+ attempts to recapture the hill, but were smartly repulsed each time they
+ advanced.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All day Tuesday and Wednesday the uproar of battle never ceased. We could
+ advance no farther. The Boers could not drive us back, although they made
+ a very determined night attack on Hildyard's brigade. That afternoon
+ General Buller held a council of war, at which all the generals were
+ present. Their opinions were unanimous that the Boer position could not be
+ forced without terrible loss, and that when they arrived at Ladysmith they
+ would but add to the number shut up in that town, as it might be found as
+ difficult to force their way out as to arrive there. General Hart pleaded
+ to be allowed to make an attempt on Doornkloof with his brigade; but,
+ strongly held as that position was, it was deemed impossible that it could
+ be captured by a single brigade. The original intention was that guns
+ should be taken up on to Vaal Krantz, and that with their assistance a
+ strong force would wheel round and take Doornkloof in the rear; but owing
+ to the discovery that the former hill was dominated from several points,
+ it was found impracticable to carry the plan into execution. Orders were
+ therefore given for the supply column, which had advanced some distance,
+ to retire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the movement was being carried out, the Boers kept up a heavy fire upon
+ the waggons and on the hospital, which, relying upon the protection of the
+ Red Cross flag, had advanced within range, but here, as upon almost every
+ occasion, the enemy paid no respect whatever to the Geneva emblem,
+ although when, as once or twice happened, one of our shells fell near an
+ ambulance of theirs, they had sent in indignant protests against our
+ conduct. All that night and the next day the movement to the rear
+ continued, and not only were the infantry moved across the Tugela, but the
+ guns on Swartz Kop and Mount Alice were removed, and orders were given for
+ a general retirement to Springfield, a proof that the next attack would be
+ made in an entirely different direction.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0016" id="link2HCH0016"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVI &mdash; A COLONIST'S ADVENTURE
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ In the morning after the battle orders were issued for the greater part of
+ the troops to return to Chieveley, and among the first to leave were the
+ Maritzburg Scouts. They were heartily glad to be off. During the three
+ preceding days the position of the cavalry had been a galling one. They
+ had seen nothing of the fighting, being kept down at Potgieter's Drift in
+ readiness to advance the moment that orders came. They had nothing to do
+ but to stand or sit down near their horses, watching the fire from the
+ enemy's batteries on the hills, and the bursting of our lyddite shells
+ among them, the outburst of brownish-yellow smoke rendering them easily
+ distinguishable from the sudden puffs of white vapour caused by the
+ explosion of the shrapnel shells of the artillery. How the battle was
+ going was only known from the wounded men brought down from the front. The
+ reports at first were encouraging, but it became evident on the following
+ days that no progress was being made.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Each evening when the sun set both the colonial and regular cavalry
+ returned to their camp, for it was certain that they could not act at
+ night. When it became known on Wednesday evening that a retreat was
+ ordered, the news came almost as a relief, for the suspense had been very
+ trying.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After dinner Chris went into the tent where the officers of the troop were
+ gathered. As usual, the talk was of the battle, but in a short time
+ Captain Brookfield said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Let us try and get away from the subject. We have talked of nothing else
+ for the past three days, and I defy anyone to say anything new about it;
+ it is not a pleasant subject either. Richards, you were in the last war, I
+ know, and took part in the defence of Standerton. Suppose you tell us
+ about that; it is one of the few pleasant memories of that time."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't know that there is much to tell you about it, but I will let you
+ know how I came to take share in it. That was an exciting time for me, for
+ I was never so near rubbed out in all my life. Just before the last
+ business broke out I happened to be returning from Pretoria, intending to
+ sell for anything that I could get a large farm that I owned in the
+ Leydenburg district. Of late the Boers had been getting so offensive in
+ their manner that I thought something would come of it, and made up my
+ mind to sell out at any price and return to Natal. When I rode into
+ Leydenburg I found that two hundred and fifty men of the 94th Regiment
+ were starting next day with a large train of waggons for Pretoria. As I
+ was frequently in the town, and had made the acquaintance of several of
+ the officers, I thought it would be pleasant to ride down with them, as it
+ made no difference whether I got into Pretoria a day or two earlier or
+ later. The general idea was that war would come of it, but no one thought
+ it would begin without the usual notice and warning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I told the officers that I would not trust the Boers further than I could
+ see them, for that a more treacherous set of fellows are not to be found
+ on the surface of the earth. Still, I must own that I had no more idea
+ that an attack would be made upon us than they had. Well, you all know
+ what came of it. We were going along a hollow with rising ground on either
+ side when, without the slightest warning, a tremendous fire was opened
+ from both flanks. It can hardly be said that there was any resistance. The
+ troops were strung out along the line of waggons; numbers were shot down
+ before a single musket was fired in defence. The main body, such as it
+ was, fought stoutly, but as they could only catch an occasional glimpse of
+ the heads of the enemy, while they were themselves altogether exposed,
+ there could be but one end to it. A hundred and twenty men were killed or
+ wounded in a few minutes, and to save the rest from a similar massacre the
+ officer who commanded surrendered.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I fired a few shots at first, but as soon as I saw how it would end I
+ rode for it. I was with the rear-guard when the firing began, and so took
+ the back track. As soon as the firing ceased I saw half a dozen Boers
+ galloping after me. My blood was up, as you may imagine, and on getting to
+ a dip I jumped off my horse, left it in shelter, and threw myself down on
+ the crest of the hollow, and as they came within range I picked off the
+ one who was nearest to me. That brought the others up with a round turn.
+ They retired a little way, then dismounted and separated, and proceeded to
+ stalk me. We exchanged shots for an hour or two. I killed another, and
+ got, as you see by this scar on my cheek, a graze. However, I think they
+ would have tired of the game first. But suddenly I saw a dozen Boers
+ galloping across the country in our direction. They were doubtless a party
+ who had arrived too late to take part in the fight, if you can call such a
+ treacherous massacre a fight, and hearing the sound of shots were riding
+ to see what was going on.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I saw that things were getting too hot, and ran down to my horse again
+ and rode along in the hollow, which fortunately hid me from the sight of
+ either the men I had been fighting or those riding up. I had therefore
+ about a quarter of a mile start when I heard a shout, and knew that they
+ were after me. After what had happened I did not dare ride for Middleburg,
+ as there was no saying whether that place might not have already risen; so
+ there was nothing to depend upon but the speed and bottom of my horse. It
+ was a fairly good animal, but nothing particular. It had had an easy time
+ of it while on the march, for we had only done some fourteen or fifteen
+ miles a day. I might have had hopes that I should outride the men in
+ pursuit of me, but they would be joined by more men on fresh horses from
+ any Boer farmhouse or village we came near. Besides, the news of this
+ intended attack on the convoy must have been known far and wide.
+ Occasionally a shot was fired, but as I was riding at a gallop, and the
+ Boers were doing the same, I had no great fear of being hit. I gained a
+ little at first, but after two hours' riding they were about the same
+ distance behind as when they had first started on the chase.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I felt that my horse was beginning to fag a bit, but the sun was setting,
+ for the attack had taken place in the afternoon. I kept on till it was too
+ dark for me to make out my pursuers, some of whom were not more than three
+ hundred yards behind me; then, while my horse was going at full gallop I
+ leapt of? without checking him, a trick that most hunters can do. I chose
+ the spot because I could make out that there was some low scrub close to
+ the road. Stooping among this I ran forward. I was glad to hear that my
+ horse was still galloping at the top of his speed, and, deprived of my
+ weight, would probably get a good bit farther before he was taken, if he
+ did but keep on. This I hoped he would do, for he had evidently entered
+ into the spirit of the chase, and had laid back his ears whenever the
+ Boers raised their voices in a yell or a rifle was fired. They were
+ yelling pretty hard when they passed me, urging their horses on in the
+ belief that the chase was almost at an end. I heard no more of the Boers
+ that time, for as soon as they had gone on I ran at the top of my speed
+ for some distance, and then broke into a trot, and by the morning must
+ have been thirty miles away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I decided to make for Standerton, for there I felt sure I should be safe,
+ for at that place was a considerable English population, and they would
+ certainly hold out. I had a Colt's rifle with me and a brace of revolvers,
+ for even when I went down to Leydenburg I heard that several Englishmen
+ had been maltreated, and one or two shot by Boers they met. I tramped for
+ four days, and as the attack on our troops had been made on the 20th of
+ December, it was now Christmas-eve. I had not ventured to go near a Boer
+ farm, for fortunately I had shot a springbok, and was therefore under no
+ trouble as to food; but on the previous day I had not come across water,
+ and the heat was terrible, so I felt that whatever came of it I must go
+ and ask for a drink. I saw a farmhouse about nine in the morning and made
+ for it. As I approached, a woman came out of the door and, seeing me,
+ re-entered, and two Boers with their guns in their hands ran out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Who are you?" they shouted. Of course I speak Dutch as well as English,
+ and shouted back that I only wanted some water.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "'Are you an Englishman?' they shouted again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "'Yes, I am,' I said; 'but what difference does that make?' I saw their
+ guns go up to their shoulders, and flung myself down, and their shots went
+ over my head. It was my turn now, and I fired twice, and the two Boers
+ rolled over. I walked forward now ready to fire on an instant, as there
+ might be more of them. Some women ran out but no man, and I went straight
+ up. They were screaming over the bodies of the men, and heaped curses on
+ me as I came up. I slung my rifle behind me, and taking out my pistols I
+ said, 'Your men brought it on themselves. I only asked for water, and they
+ fired at me. I don't want to hurt any of you, but if you attack me I must
+ protect myself.' Several times I thought they would have done so, but the
+ sight of my pistols cowed them, I walked straight into the house, dipped a
+ pannikin into a pail of water, took a long drink, then I filled my
+ water-bottle, and went out. Though they cursed me again, they did not
+ attempt to stop me, as I rather feared they would; but I understood it
+ when, before I had gone fifty yards, I heard a horse's hoofs, and looking
+ round saw a girl riding at full speed across the veldt. She had no doubt
+ gone to fetch the men who were away or to the next farm to summon
+ assistance. The draught of water had done me a world of good, and I soon
+ broke into a run, though I did not conceal from myself that I was in a bad
+ fix. Once out of sight of the farm I changed my course, and did so several
+ times in the course of the next two hours; then, on getting to the crest
+ of high ground, I saw a river half a mile away. This, I felt sure, was
+ Broot Spruit. Before starting to walk down I looked round, and a little
+ over a mile away could see a party of some fifteen Boers. I ran at full
+ speed down the slope, and could see no other place where I could make a
+ fight of it; but many of the rivers have, like those here, steep banks,
+ and I could at least sell my life dearly. It could only be for a time, for
+ some of the Boers would cross the spruit and take me in rear. Still, there
+ was nothing else to be done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When I reached the bank I gave a shout of satisfaction. The river was in
+ flood; there must have been rain up in the hills, and you know how quickly
+ the streams rise. Unless the Boers knew of some very shallow place, there
+ would be no crossing it; for it was running like a mill-stream, and except
+ at some waggon drift the banks were almost perpendicular. At any rate I
+ could not hope to swim half across before the Boers came up, and so I must
+ fight it out where I was. I had scarcely found a point where I could get a
+ comfortable foothold on the bank, with my head just above the level, when
+ the Boers appeared on the top of the hill. They stopped for a minute and
+ then broke up, and scattering rode forward. They felt sure that I must
+ have made for the river, as there was no other place where I could be
+ concealed. When they came within a couple of hundred yards of it they
+ dismounted, and three or four came forward on foot. When the nearest was
+ within a hundred yards of me I fired.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "At so short a distance, and with so good a rest, I could not miss, and
+ before the smoke cleared away I winged another, and the rest ran back
+ hastily. I sent a shot or two among them as they were consulting, with the
+ result that they rode off three or four hundred yards farther back. They
+ did not attempt to return my fire, for, except when I raised my head for a
+ moment, they could see nothing of me. They doubtless learned from the
+ women that I had a Colt's rifle and a brace of revolvers, and that if they
+ were to make a rush across the open not many of them were likely to reach
+ me. After a talk two or three of them mounted their horses and rode so as
+ to strike the river both above and below me, intending no doubt to cross
+ if they found a place where there was a chance of doing so. I felt pretty
+ sure that they would do nothing till it was dark, then they would crawl up
+ and make a rush; I was certain, anyhow, that they would not give it up, as
+ there were two of their number lying on the veldt besides the two at the
+ farmhouse. There was, however, more pluck in them than I had given them
+ credit for, for about mid-day they began to advance, crawling along the
+ ground as if stalking a quarry. The men who had gone out on horseback had
+ all returned, but just as the others started crawling up three of them
+ galloped away down stream. I determined at once to shift my position a
+ bit, so as to put off the evil hour. I pulled a stone as big as my head
+ out of the clay of the bank and put it on the edge where my head had been,
+ and then got down into the water. It was waist-deep at a couple of feet
+ from the bank, which above was too steep to walk along. I had gone a
+ hundred yards when I saw, seven or eight inches above the water-level, a
+ hole, and pushing my arm in I found it was a place where a good bit of the
+ bank had caved in. Laying my gun and pistols down on a ledge I felt about
+ farther. At the top it went in nearly three feet, and was higher at the
+ back than it was at the water's edge. At any rate it afforded a good
+ chance of safety. Holding the revolvers, the chamber of the rifle, and my
+ ammunition above water, I stooped until I could get into the hole, which
+ was but just wide enough for the purpose; then I pushed myself back to the
+ end. I found there was just height enough for me to sit with my mouth
+ above water. The back sloped so that I had to dig my heels into the clay
+ to prevent myself from slipping forward.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It was not a comfortable position, but that was a secondary
+ consideration. I had noticed as I came along that the river was already
+ falling, so that I had no fear of being drowned as long as I kept my
+ position. With some trouble I fastened my pistols and ammunition on the
+ brim of my hat; the rifle I was holding between my knees. There I sat hour
+ after hour. Fortunately, being pretty near midsummer day, the water was
+ not cold. I had at least the consolation of knowing what a state of fury
+ the Boers must be in. They would have seen by my footsteps where I had
+ entered the river, just below where I had been standing. No doubt they
+ would have gone along the top of the bank to see if I had come out of the
+ water again, and when they reached their friends on horseback and heard
+ that I had not swum down the river, they would have concluded that I must
+ have been drowned. Had I managed to cross, they would have seen me climb
+ the opposite bank.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "In an hour the water had fallen to my shoulders, and when it became dark
+ it was but waist-deep where I was sitting. To make a long story short, by
+ midnight the water was below my feet and still falling rapidly. I waited a
+ couple of hours and then started to cross. It was about fifty yards wide,
+ and I was fully half-way over before it reached my chin. The stream had
+ lost much of its force, and I had no difficulty in swimming across the
+ rest of the way, though the water was deep until I was within a couple of
+ yards of the bank. Then I climbed the bank and made off. I saw nothing
+ more of my pursuers, and three days later I arrived at Standerton, and
+ remained there til the end of the war, for the gallant little town
+ repulsed all attempts of the Boers to capture it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That was a narrow escape indeed, Richards," Captain Brookfield said. "If
+ you hadn't had your wits about you the Boers would certainly have got you.
+ It was a first-rate hiding-place, but I don't think many of us would have
+ thought of adopting it. Now, will someone else give us a yarn?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two or three more stories were told, and then the party broke up, feeling
+ all the better for having for an hour avoided the standing topic. Two days
+ later all were settled at Chieveley again, and it was generally believed
+ that the next attack would take place very shortly, and that it would
+ probably be directed against Colenso. That evening a farmer came into
+ camp. His horse had dropped dead a mile away. He stopped, as he passed
+ through the tents of the scouts, and asked where he could find the
+ general. Captain Brookfield, who heard the question, stepped out from his
+ tent with Chris, to whom he had been talking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Why, Searle, is it you? I thought the voice was familiar to me. What is
+ it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have ridden in to get help. The other day a raiding party of Boers came
+ down through Inadi, and riding in between Dingley Dell and Botha's Castle&mdash;you
+ know the hill&mdash;swept off a quantity of cattle. They have not
+ penetrated so far before, and no one about thought that there was any
+ danger while you were attacking them up here. One of the farmers rode to
+ Greytown for help. Most of the young men there had joined one or other of
+ the colonial troops, but fifteen of us said that we could go out. It
+ seemed that there were not more than some fifteen or twenty Boers. Well, I
+ can't tell you all about it, for, as it is a matter of life and death, I
+ have not a moment to lose. However, we came up to them north of Botha's
+ Castle. We had a sharp fight. Two of our men were killed and five of the
+ Boers; the rest rode off. We set to work to bunch all the cattle, and as
+ we were at it we were attacked suddenly by a party sixty or seventy
+ strong. The fellows that we had driven off had evidently come across them
+ and brought them down upon us. We made a running fight, but our horses
+ were not so fresh as theirs; and seeing that they had the speed of us we
+ made for an empty farmhouse, and as they rode up we brought down several
+ of them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There was a wall round the yard, and the Boers drew off for a bit to
+ consider. Then they dismounted and planted themselves round the house in
+ such shelter as they could find within two or three hundred yards, and the
+ affair began in earnest. The first day they kept up a heavy fire, to which
+ we could make but little reply, for it was certain death to lift a head
+ above the wall or to show one's self at a window even for a moment. We
+ lost three men that way. During the night they tried to carry the place,
+ but we were all at the wall; and had the best of it, as we had only to
+ show our heads, while they were altogether exposed. There was not much
+ firing next day, and it was evident that they meant to starve us out.
+ There was not a scrap of food to be found in the place; but fortunately
+ there was a small thatched kraal inside the yard which gave some forage
+ for the horses. The next day we killed one of them for food.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That night we agreed that when the Boers saw that we did not surrender in
+ a day or two they would be sure that we must be eating the horses, as any
+ food we brought with us must be exhausted, and they would then make a
+ determined attack; for we knew we had killed eight or ten of them, and
+ that they would not go away. So we decided that the only hope was for one
+ of us to ride here; we tossed up who should try to get through the Boers,
+ and the lot fell upon me. I took the best of the horses. We had agreed
+ from the first that this would have to be done, and had given what scraps
+ of bread we could spare to it; besides which, they were all in fair
+ condition, as the yard was strewn with rubbish, and some party of Boers
+ had ripped up all the beds and straw mattresses and scattered the contents
+ about.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Some of them were sure to be on watch, and I rode at a walk. I made for
+ the north, as that side was less likely to be watched. I had gone about
+ two hundred yards when a man jumped up just in front of me. My rifle was
+ ready, and before he could lift his I shot him, and then clapped spurs to
+ nay horse. There was a tremendous hubbub; shots were fired at random in
+ all directions, but I doubt whether they could have seen me after I had
+ gone fifty yards. I rode for a quarter of a mile due north, and then
+ turned west. I had no fear of being overtaken, for although the Boers
+ would all have their horses close, in readiness to mount if we should try
+ to break out, I must have got a good quarter of a mile start, and they
+ were not likely to keep up the chase long, as they could not tell which
+ way I might have doubled, and if they pursued far, it would be in the
+ direction of Greytown. It was about a seventy-mile ride, and as I started
+ about twelve, I have done it in nine hours. I foundered the horse, but
+ fortunately he did not drop till I was within half a mile of the camp.
+ Now, where can I find the general?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You will find him at Frere, but I am afraid it will be of no use. We have
+ tried him again and again&mdash;at least, one or other of us have done so&mdash;to
+ let us go out scouting, but he will not hear of it, though the whole of us
+ Colonials are terribly sore at leaving the whole country at the mercy of
+ the Boer marauders; and now that we shall probably be at work here again
+ directly, he is less likely than ever to let anyone go."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You can't go without orders, I suppose?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Captain Brookfield shook his head. "We are just as much under orders as
+ the regular troops are, and it would be a serious matter indeed to fly in
+ the face of his repeated orders on this subject." The farmer made a
+ gesture of despair.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Captain Brookfield," Chris said, speaking for the first time, "I think
+ that by the terms of our enlistment in your corps we were to be allowed to
+ take our discharge whenever we asked for it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That was so, Chris, but&mdash;"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then I beg now, sir, to tender our resignation from the present moment."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "But Chris, you have but twenty men, and by what Searle says, there are
+ sixty or seventy of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Of whom ten or so have been killed. Well, sir, we have fought against
+ nearly a hundred before now, and got the best of it; besides, we shall
+ have the help of the little party shut up. However, now that we have
+ resigned, that is our affair. I suppose that if we rejoin you, you will
+ have no objection to re-enlist us?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Captain Brookfield smiled. "I should have no objection certainly, Chris,
+ but General Buller might have."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't suppose he will know of our having been away, sir; he has plenty
+ more serious things to think of than the numerical strength of your troop,
+ and as the news of a skirmish some thirty miles north of Greytown is not
+ likely to be reported in the papers, or at any rate to attract his
+ attention, I don't think you need trouble yourself on that score. Besides,
+ if it was reported, it could only be said that one of the besieged party
+ escaping, returned with a small body of volunteers he had collected; and
+ the name of the Maritzburg Scouts would not be mentioned. I am sure that
+ Mr. Searle would impress the necessity for silence about that point, on
+ his friends."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I accept your resignation, Chris; a headstrong man will have his
+ way; and indeed I have great faith in your accomplishing, somehow, the
+ relief of this party."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The farmer had listened with surprise to this discussion between the lad
+ and Captain Brookfield. The latter now turned to him and said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "This young gentleman is the commander of twenty lads of about his own
+ age. They have been in two serious fights, and in both cases against a
+ Boer force much superior to themselves in numbers, and I have as much
+ confidence in them as in any men in my troop. They are all good shots, and
+ admirably mounted, and you can be perfectly sure of them, and can take my
+ assurance that if any twenty men can relieve your friends, they will do
+ so."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Will you be able to ride back again with us, sir? I can mount you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Certainly I can, if my friend Captain Brookfield can furnish me with a
+ meal before I start."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That I will with much pleasure. How long will it be before you are ready,
+ Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Half an hour, sir. I left them all rubbing down their horses when I came
+ in here a quarter of an hour ago, and it will take but a very short time
+ to pack up and start."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very well; I dare say that Mr. Searle will be ready by that time.
+ Breakfast shall be ready for you in ten minutes, Searle, and while you are
+ eating it I will tell you enough of these gentlemen's doings to reassure
+ you, for I see that you do not feel very confident that they will be able
+ to tackle the Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "After what you have said, Captain Brookfield, I can have no doubt that
+ they will do all they can, but it seems to me that twenty men&mdash;or
+ twenty boys&mdash;are no match for fifty or sixty Boers. While they were
+ speaking, Chris had returned to his camp. The lads were all engaged in
+ rubbing up their saddlery.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You can knock off at once," Chris said; "I have need for you. You no
+ longer belong to the Maritzburg Scouts."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general exclamation of astonishment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What do you mean, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I mean that I have resigned in my own name and yours, and Captain
+ Brookfield has accepted the resignation."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are you really in earnest, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Very much so; but I will not keep you in suspense. A small party of
+ Greytown men are besieged near Botha's Castle; one of them has just ridden
+ in for help. But you know well enough that Buller will not hear of
+ detached parties going out all over the country; and Captain Brookfield
+ told the farmer that it was of no use his going to the general, and that
+ none of the Colonial troops could leave the camp without orders. As it was
+ evident that there was nothing more to be done, and we could not leave the
+ man's friends to be massacred, the only thing to do was to give in our
+ resignation at once; and of course, now that it is done and accepted, we
+ are at liberty to mount and ride off where we please. When we have done
+ our work we will come back and reenlist, and no one will be any the wiser.
+ We shall start in half an hour. We need not take the tent poles, or
+ anything but a blanket and a waterproof sheet."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was lively satisfaction at the news that they were again going to be
+ employed in what they considered their proper work.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What shall we do about the men and stores?" Willesden asked; "you know
+ that those two big boxes of the things we ordered at Maritzburg arrived
+ yesterday."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think, Willesden, we will take Jack and the two Zulus, and leave Japhet
+ and the Swazis here in charge of the stores, and blankets, and other
+ things we leave behind us. Captain Brookfield will keep an eye on them for
+ us. The farmer is going to ride back with us on one of the spare horses,
+ and the three natives can ride the others. There is a hundredweight of
+ biscuits in the sack that came with the boxes; each of us can take five
+ pounds in his saddle-bag, a tin of cocoa and milk, and a pound or two of
+ bacon. Jack can take a kettle and frying-pan, and the natives their
+ blankets and twenty pounds of mealie flour for themselves and five times
+ as much mealies for the horses. We can get them at the stores that were
+ opened a few days ago."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some of the men from the other tents walked over on seeing the tents
+ pulled down and the waterproof sheets and blankets rolled up, and asked:
+ "Where are you fellows off to?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have resigned; we are sick of doing nothing."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As it was known that they drew neither pay nor rations, the news did not
+ create much surprise.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You are lucky fellows," one said. "We get no share of the fighting and a
+ full share of the hardships; still, I wonder you do not stop till we are
+ in Ladysmith."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When is that going to be?" Field asked innocently. "We have been told
+ that we shall be in Ladysmith in a week many times since we first came up
+ here in the middle of December, and we are no nearer now than when we
+ arrived here. Do you think that you could guarantee that we should be
+ there in another week? because, if so, we might put off going."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The trooper shook his head with a laugh. "That is a question no man in
+ camp can answer," he said. "Perhaps in a week, perhaps in a fortnight,
+ perhaps," he added more gravely, "never. We know by the messages they
+ flash out that they are nearly at the end of their food, and if we don't
+ get there in a fortnight or thereabout, our motive for going on may be at
+ an end. In that case I suppose we shall wait here till Roberts has
+ relieved Kimberley and marches on Bloemfontein. That will send all the
+ Free Staters scurrying back in a hurry, and even the Transvaalers will
+ begin to think that it is time to go. Then I suppose we shall advance and
+ clear Natal out."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, perhaps we may be back again to help you by that time," Field
+ answered; "but we are heartily tired of this place, and of watching the
+ Boers making their positions stronger and stronger every day."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is about the same with us all," the trooper grumbled, "and I for one
+ wish that I could go down with you to Maritzburg and have a week off. It
+ would be such a comfort to sleep in a dry bed and to dress in dry clothes,
+ that I doubt whether I should ever have the strength of mind to come back
+ again. I wish that the general would issue an order dismounting us all and
+ filling up the gaps in the line regiments with us. Then at least we should
+ have a chance of fighting, which does not seem likely ever to come to us
+ here. You are not going to leave those big boxes behind you, are you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, we are going to leave them in the care of the captain, with a note
+ saying that if we do not turn up again before Ladysmith is relieved, they
+ are to be handed over to the poor beggars there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is one thing I cannot say, and that is that we have been short of
+ food, for the Army Service Corps has done splendidly, and no one has ever
+ been hungry for an hour, except when on a long march or engaged in a
+ battle. If everything had been worked as well, we should certainly have no
+ reason whatever to complain. If I were my own master, and could afford it,
+ I would go down to Durban and take a passage for myself and my horse for
+ Port Elizabeth, and then go up and enlist in one of the yeomanry corps
+ with Roberts. When he once starts there will be plenty of movement on that
+ side; while here, even if we get to Ladysmith, we may be fixed there for
+ no one can say how long. You see what it is here, and if the Boers don't
+ lose heart, and defend the Biggarsberg and the Drakensberg, we shall find
+ at least as much difficulty there as we shall here. It is quite certain
+ that the Ladysmith men will take a long time to recover from what they
+ have gone through; and as for the cavalry, I fancy their horses have been
+ eaten. If they had been out here with us, instead of being cooped up in
+ there, we should have been able to make it hot for the Boers when they
+ retire, and to keep them on the run, but with so small a force as we have
+ we should hardly be able to do so. Besides, they have so many lines of
+ retreat. The Free Staters can go over to the left to Van Reenen and the
+ other passes; another commando can go east; there are plenty of fords on
+ the Buffalo; and they would retire on Vryheid, while the main body could
+ make a stand at the Biggarsberg; and as they always seem able to carry
+ their cannon off with them, our cavalry would do nothing without artillery
+ and infantry."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There had been no pause in the work of preparation while they were
+ talking, and the horses were now saddled, the food divided, the
+ saddle-bags packed, and the blankets and waterproofs strapped on. Chris
+ went across to Captain Brookfield's tent. "We are all ready for a start,
+ sir."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer looked at his watch. "It is three minutes under the half-hour,
+ Chris. How much ammunition are you taking with you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "A hundred and fifty rounds each, sir, of which I don't suppose we shall
+ use above ten at the outside. Still, there is never any saying; and if we
+ should get besieged we shall want it all. Your horse is ready for you, Mr.
+ Searle."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And I am ready too," the farmer said, getting up from the table and
+ stretching himself. "I ought not to have sat down. I could ride as far as
+ most at twenty, but I have not done so much for the last fifteen years,
+ and I feel stiff in every limb. However, I shall be all right when I have
+ gone a few miles, and that wash I had before breakfast has done me a world
+ of good. Now, sir, I am ready, and whether we shall succeed or not, I
+ thank you with all my heart for coming with me." "Good-bye, Chris!"
+ Captain Brookfield said. "I expect you will all turn up again, like bad
+ pennies, before many days have gone."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hope so, sir," Chris said. "I should be sorry to miss the end here
+ after having seen it so far."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0017" id="link2HCH0017"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVII &mdash; A RESCUE.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ When Chris went out with Captain Brookfield and the farmer, the lads had
+ shaken hands with all their friends, and were standing by the side of
+ their horses ready to mount. Jack and the two Zulus were standing a few
+ yards behind them. Japhet had brought up the other spare horse.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is a nice piece of horse-flesh," the farmer said as he looked at it
+ critically.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, it was bred by Duncan. We purchased pretty well the pick of those he
+ brought down the country."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That accounts for it. They are in good condition, too."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; our horses all get two feeds of mealies a day, or, when it is wet,
+ one feed of mealies and a hot mash made of mealie flour, besides what they
+ can pick up, for we don't draw horse rations. Now, sir, we will be off;"
+ and he gave the word "Mount!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lads all in a second swung into their saddles.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Good-bye, lads, and good luck!" Captain Brookfield said; and the men
+ standing by broke into a hearty cheer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a strong suspicion that the party were not going down to
+ Maritzburg. It was felt that they were not the sort to throw it up before
+ Ladysmith was relieved. And their suspicions were heightened when they saw
+ the farmer mount and ride by the side of Chris.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is all gammon about their resigning, is it not, Brookfield?" one of
+ the officers said, as they stood looking after them. "Why should they have
+ left two of their men here with some of their traps and stores if they had
+ not been coming back? They would naturally give them all away. Besides, I
+ noticed that farmer come in on foot half an hour ago; there was no talk of
+ their leaving before he arrived, and he has gone off with them on one of
+ their horses."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Captain Brookfield smiled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "All I know about it officially is that this morning Mr. King resigned in
+ the name of himself and his party; and as you know, I told you when they
+ first joined us, they did so on the explicit understanding that they
+ should be allowed to resign when they chose, and that provision was
+ inserted when they were sworn in."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is all you know officially?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes. If they are missed, and the question is asked me what has become of
+ them, that is the answer I shall give. What else I know I must for the
+ present keep to myself."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose we shall see them back soon?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I consider that that is within the limits of possibility."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I suppose that you have formed no plan yet, Mr. King?" the farmer said,
+ when they had left the camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; my present idea is to follow the line half-way down to Frere. If we
+ were to strike off towards the country at once, we should, of course, be
+ noticed; so I would rather get three miles on. You say it is about seventy
+ miles?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "About that."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, allowing for a halt, we can do it in twelve hours; that would be
+ just as it is getting dark. Of course we shall not show ourselves till
+ they begin to attack the house. I hope we shall find your friends still
+ holding out."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hope so indeed. You see, the Boers were quiet when I started, and I
+ should hardly think that they would make an attack again after I left.
+ They seemed to have settled down to starve us out; but it is quite
+ possible that now I have got away they will grow nervous lest I should
+ bring help up, and are very likely to make another attempt this evening.
+ They would be pretty sure to succeed this time, for there are only seven
+ of us left there; and though they could make a good fight in daylight,
+ they would have no real chance if the Boers went at them in earnest, which
+ they are sure to do next time. We agreed before I started that it would
+ not do to try to defend the yard. After I left they were going to pile
+ everything movable against the doors and windows and fight hard to keep
+ the Boers out, and would then go upstairs and sell their lives dearly."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How far are the Boer horses out?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "About five hundred yards away, in a dip. We know they always keep three
+ or four men on guard there, for we have seen them come out of the hollow
+ sometimes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And the cattle, have they driven them off yet?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; four of the Boers and twenty or thirty natives went straight on with
+ them as soon as they had driven us into the farmhouse. I am afraid there
+ is no use thinking of getting them back."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It depends upon how far they have gone," Chris said. "The rains have
+ brought the grass up, and as likely as not they may halt when they get to
+ some good pastures and wait till the others join them. It is not likely
+ that all that gang came from one place."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I expect that they have been gathered up from lonely farmhouses where
+ they have escaped the commandos, and they will want to divide their
+ plunder between them; they don't trust each other a bit, and each would
+ cheat his fellows of his share if he could. So I should think that what
+ you suggest is likely enough, and that it has been arranged to wait when
+ they come to a good place till the others arrive. But you are not thinking
+ of rescuing them, are you?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If we thrash the Boers at the farm I shall certainly have a try. We did
+ carry off two or three thousand head about two months ago from the hands
+ of at least as large a party as this, and I don't see why we should not do
+ it again. It was near Mount Umhlumba."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Was it your party that did that?" the farmer exclaimed. "Why, it was the
+ talk of the whole district, and some of the cattle belonged to a friend of
+ mine. He told me how he had been saved from ruin. Well, sir, after that I
+ shall feel more confident than I acknowledge I have been up to now.
+ Captain Brookfield told me about your going into the Boer camp in
+ disguise, and to Komati-poort, and how you surprised a party of Boers
+ looting a farm near Dundee; but he did not mention that. In fact, he had
+ only just finished telling me the other affairs when you came in saying
+ that you were ready to start. Well, well, it is wonderful that a party of
+ young gentlemen like yours should have done such things!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They did not hurry their horses, but for the most part went at the steady
+ canter to which the animals were most accustomed; occasionally they would
+ walk for a bit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At Weenan, where they crossed the Bushman river, they halted for half an
+ hour, and for double that time after crossing the Mooi at Intembeni; then
+ as the sun began to lose its power they went fast, until, when they
+ reached one of the farthest spurs of Botha's Castle, the farmer said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "When we get over the next rise we shall see the house."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris gave the order to dismount, and, going forward on foot, they threw
+ themselves down when close to the crest, and crawled forward until they
+ obtained a fair view. Sankey and Chris were again provided with glasses,
+ having bought them on the day before starting at the sale of the effects
+ of several officers who had fallen in a fight at Vaal Krantz, and all
+ gazed intently for some time at the house. "Thank God they are all right
+ so far!" Chris said to the farmer. "I can see the Boers lying all round
+ the house, and that dark clump is their horses; so our ride has not been
+ in vain. I suppose it is about a mile and a half from here. I don't see
+ the gate into the yard. Which side is it?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That corner of the house hides it. It is on the eastern side."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It will be quite dark in an hour; when it is so, we will move down a bit
+ farther, then we will halt till we hear them attacking. We must not go
+ nearer, for the moon will be up by that time. If I had known that we
+ should have got here before dark, we need not have troubled to bring the
+ Zulus. I intended to send them forward to see how matters stood, then they
+ could have guided us right up to the gate. However, as they have all got
+ guns, and can shoot, it will add to the panic our attack will create, and
+ they will all be pleased at the chance of at last getting a shot at the
+ Boers. They were complaining to me the other day that they were very happy
+ in all other respects, but they were very much disappointed at not having
+ had a fight."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The natives were indeed delighted when, on Chris rejoining them, he told
+ them that they should take their share in the attack on the Boers. Chris
+ and his friends all threw themselves on the ground, after sending up Jack
+ to the crest to keep watch. But the farmer said, "I dare not lie down; if
+ I did, I should never get up again."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He had, indeed, to be lifted off his horse when they dismounted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I can quite understand that," Chris said. "I feel stiff and tired myself,
+ and you must be almost made of iron to have ridden one hundred and forty
+ miles almost without halting."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "If anyone had told me that I could do it, I should not have believed him.
+ Of course one is on horseback a good many hours a day. Often, after going
+ round the farm, I start at two or three o'clock and ride into Greytown and
+ back; but that is only a matter of some fifteen miles each way. Still,
+ when one has got seven men's lives depending upon one, one makes a big
+ effort."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I tell you what, Mr. Searle. The best thing you can do is to strip and
+ lie down. I will set the two Zulus to knead you. You will find yourself
+ quite a new man after it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is a good idea, King, and I will adopt it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For half an hour the two men rubbed and kneaded the farmer's muscles from
+ head to foot, exerting themselves until the perspiration streamed from
+ them. Then one of them brought up one of the water-skins and poured the
+ contents over him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That has certainly done me a world of good," the farmer said when he had
+ dressed himself. "I don't say the stiffness has all gone, but I certainly
+ don't feel any worse than I did when I got to your camp. I should never
+ have thought of it myself."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is what is done after a Turkish bath," Chris said. "I have had them
+ often at Johannesburg. The natives do something of the same sort. They
+ make a little hut of boughs, and fill a hole in the middle with hot stones
+ and pour water over them, and steam themselves, and I believe get rubbed
+ too."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as they considered it dark enough to be perfectly safe, they led
+ their horses down until they judged that they were within half a mile of
+ the house, then dismounted and waited. Chris had already made all
+ arrangements. Carmichael, who was the leader for the time being of one of
+ the sections of five, was with his party to ride straight for the Boers'
+ horses directly the attack began. The firing at the house would act as a
+ guide to the spot where they were placed, and he was, if possible, to
+ attack them from behind. He was to shoot down the guards, but not to
+ pursue them if the horses bolted on hearing the attack on the house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What you have to do is to stampede them," Chris said. "As soon as you
+ have got them on the run, keep them going, and if they scatter, do you
+ scatter too. The Boers without their horses will be at our mercy. Don't
+ stop till you have driven them five miles away. Then you can halt till
+ morning. As you come back, you are likely enough to hear firing, and can
+ then ride towards it and join us. But don't get within rifle-shot of the
+ Boers. I don't want any lives thrown away. If you hear three shots at
+ regular intervals during the night ride towards the sound. I may want you
+ here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was just ten o'clock when there was a violent outburst of fire at the
+ farmhouse, and all sprung into their saddles.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, Carmichael, do you gallop on. Get as close as you can to the horses
+ without being observed. Go at a walk the last hundred yards or so; the
+ horse guards are not likely to hear you, they are sure to be up on the
+ edge of the dip watching the farm. Stay quiet till you hear our yell, and
+ then go straight in to them. In that case you may manage without their
+ getting a shot at you, for as likely as not they will have strolled up
+ without their rifles."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as Carmichael's little party had started, Chris moved on with the
+ rest at a walk.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is no occasion to hurry," he said. "It will take the Boers some
+ time to force their way in, and the hotter they are at work the less
+ likely they will be to hear us." In two or three minutes he ordered them
+ to canter. "It is of no use charging; I expect that they are all inside
+ the yard." It was, however, at a fast pace that they rode up towards the
+ wall. Chris blew his whistle, and the cheer of the whites and the warcry
+ of the two Zulus burst out at the top of their voices.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Give it to them hot, lads!" Chris shouted, for the benefit of the Boers.
+ "Kill every man-jack of the scoundrels!" And at once nineteen rifles
+ opened upon the dark figures clustered round the house. "Use your
+ magazines," Chris shouted again. "Don't let a man of them get off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Appalled by the sudden attack, ignorant of the number of their assailants,
+ and mown down by the terrible fire, the Boers on the two sides of the
+ house exposed to it did not think of resistance, but all who could do so
+ made a rush round to the other sides, and, joining their companions there,
+ clambered over the wall and made for their horses; but these had already
+ gone. As Chris had anticipated, the four guards were watching the
+ farmhouse, and did not hear the approach of Carmichael's party. As Chris's
+ whistle sounded these galloped forward, and at their volley three of the
+ Boers fell, the other fled. At once with loud shouts they charged in among
+ the ponies, who were already kicking and plunging at the sudden sound of
+ firearms. A minute later they were all in full flight, followed by the
+ five lads shouting and yelling. The firing had been unnoticed by the Boers
+ round the house, and these, when on arriving at the hollow they found
+ their horses gone, gave vent to their alarm and rage in many strange
+ oaths, and then scattered in flight all over the country.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is of no use trying to pursue," Chris said, as soon as it was found
+ that all the Boers, save those lying dying or dead, had escaped from the
+ yard. "We should only ruin the horses, and they have done a big day's work
+ already."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The besieged could be heard hastily removing the barricades against the
+ door, and in two or three minutes ran out, almost bewildered at the
+ suddenness of their relief, when they thought that nothing remained to be
+ done but to sell their lives dearly. A few hurried words explained the
+ position to them, and their gratitude to Chris and his party was
+ unbounded. Their first step was to attend to the fallen Boers. Of these
+ there were eighteen wounded and eleven killed, and as soon as all in their
+ power had been done for the former, and they had been carried into the
+ house, a blazing fire was lit in one of the rooms and the party all
+ gathered there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now, Mr. King," Searle said, "you are the baas of this party; what do you
+ think had best be done?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I think the first thing," Chris said, "is to post half a dozen men, three
+ or four hundred yards away, round the house. We must not run the risk of
+ the tables being turned on us by the Boers crawling up and surprising us;
+ they may still be hanging about in numbers. Peters, you take Harris,
+ Bryan, and Capper, and the two Zulus, and post them round the house. The
+ natives' ears are much sharper than yours are, and if either of them
+ thinks he hears anything let them crawl out in that direction and
+ reconnoitre. When I whistle, do you come in to me, leaving the others on
+ guard, then I will tell you what we have decided upon."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The four named at once went outside, and, calling the natives, left the
+ yard. Jack had already filled the kettles the colonists had brought with
+ them, and placed them over the fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "While the tea is getting ready," Chris said, "we had better give a good
+ feed of mealies to all the horses. How many of yours are there left?" he
+ asked one of the colonists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "All the twelve we had at first were unwounded this evening, but I can't
+ say whether any of them have been hit since. The wall was too high for
+ bullets to touch them as long as the Boers were outside, but most likely
+ as we were firing through the window we may have hit some of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't suppose you did so, because I fancy that directly the Boers began
+ fighting here the horses bunched in one corner of the yard. Well, will you
+ feed them also, and see how many are uninjured. That is a matter of
+ importance, for our horses will scarcely be fit for work in the morning.
+ Do you think yours may be?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I think so; we have only been shut up three days, and they have had
+ a good deal of pickings, what with the beds and what was lying about in
+ the yard before; and a good feed now will certainly set them up. What do
+ you propose to do?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I want in the first place to get enough of the Boer ponies in to
+ mount us all, and in the second to overtake and cut the Boers off if
+ possible, and lastly to rescue the cattle. Five of our party are away
+ after the horses, but their object was to scatter them. They were to halt
+ about five miles away, and if they heard three rifle shots at regular
+ intervals they were to ride towards them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Do you want them in here? if so, I will go out and give the signal. We
+ have taken it by turns to sleep, so we are all fairly fresh."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I want them in, but I specially want them to collect and drive in a
+ score of the Boer ponies."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "At daybreak we will all go," another of the farmers said, "and lend a
+ hand."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "With this moon we ought to be able to find some of the men without
+ waiting for daylight," Chris said. "It would be an immense thing if we
+ could be after them before they have got too long a start."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It would indeed. Well, we will feed our horses at once, and by the time
+ we have had a cup of tea they will be ready to start. If we have luck, we
+ ought not to be away more than a couple of hours."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It would make our success pretty well a certainty if we could get the
+ ponies by that time," Chris said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In less than half an hour the seven farmers started. Only one of the
+ horses had been killed, and they rode away at a rate that showed that the
+ others were none the worse for their three days on somewhat short rations.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," Chris said, after seeing them off, "we will get a couple of hours'
+ sleep. I wish Peters and his party could do the same, but it would not do
+ to trust to the Boers not coming back again."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All were asleep in a few minutes, but an hour later they heard a shot
+ fired, followed by several others. They leapt to their feet, seized their
+ rifles, and ran out into the yard. There was, however, no repetition of
+ the firing, and a few minutes later Peters came in and reported that the
+ Zulus had discovered a number of Boers making their way cautiously
+ forward. Both had fired, and some shots had been returned, but the Boers
+ had at once drawn off.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't suppose we shall hear any more of them. They hoped they might
+ catch us asleep. Now they find that we are on watch. I expect they will
+ give up the idea and make off. It is a nuisance having been disturbed, but
+ I am not sorry for it, for the Boers will have lost a couple of hours, and
+ even if the horses do not come in we shall still have a chance of
+ overtaking them. Now, Peters, you had better get forty winks; I will go
+ out with Brown, Field, and Sankey, and relieve the three out there. I
+ don't suppose they will come in, but they can take a nap where they are.
+ You need not send out when the farmers come back; we shall see them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris had been nearly two hours on watch when he made out in the bright
+ moonlight a number of horses and mounted figures going towards the house.
+ He at once woke the sleepers and called the others in, and by the time
+ they reached the farm some thirty unmounted ponies, followed by
+ Carmichael's party and the farmers, came up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have been longer than we expected," one of the latter said as he
+ dismounted, "but we were lucky at last in finding this lot together in a
+ kloof. Have you seen anything of the Boers? We thought we heard a few
+ shots."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, they came here and tried to turn the tables on us; but we had the
+ Zulus and some of the scouts out. When they found that we were watchful
+ they decamped. Now, Carmichael, go in with your party and get a cup of
+ tea."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What! are we going to start again?" Carmichael asked rather dismally; "we
+ were only just getting off to sleep when Willesden, who was on watch,
+ heard three shots."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Some of us have only had an hour's sleep, Carmichael. But there is
+ another day's work before us, and after that you may sleep for twenty-four
+ hours if you like."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Oh! I suppose I can do it if the others can; still, after seventy-five
+ miles here, five miles out, and something like five miles chasing the
+ horses, and five miles back again, I think we have done a pretty good
+ day's work."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No doubt you have," Chris said, "a thundering good day's work; but a
+ fellow is not worth calling a fellow if he can't manage to do two days'
+ work at a stretch for once in a way. At any rate, the horses will be
+ fresh, which is of much more importance than our being so; they have had
+ three days' perfect rest. Now, while you are having your tea we will see
+ about the other arrangements. Of course Mr. Searle will stop here; he has
+ done double the work that we have. His friends can do as they like.
+ Naturally we shall be glad to have them with us, but that is as they
+ choose."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Of course we will go with you," one of the colonists said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you! At any rate two of you had better stop with Mr. Searle. There
+ are the wounded Boers to look after. I see there is a waggon in the yard;
+ I should think they had better be put in that and carried to Greytown. If
+ we recover the cattle, we will drive them down there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ None of the farmers was willing to stay, and at last they had to decide
+ the question by lot.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," Chris said, "you gentlemen know the country a great deal better
+ than we do, and can tell us which way they are most likely to take their
+ cattle."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They are sure to go north, there is no other way for them to go. If the
+ whole party were together and mounted, they might go up through Zululand;
+ as it is, they would not venture to do that. They will cross the Tugela, I
+ should say, between the point where the Mooi runs into it and its junction
+ with the Buffalo, and go up through Colsie, and then either through
+ Helpmakaar or Lazarath."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, I hope we shall catch them long before they get to the Tugela."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I expect the cattle will be somewhere near Inadi; there is some good
+ grazing along there, and as all the loyalists have cleared off long ago
+ they will have no fear of being disturbed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The saddles were transferred from their own horses to the Boer ponies, and
+ it was finally arranged that the waggon with the wounded should not start
+ until their return. Jack and the two Zulus were left with them, and even
+ should another party of Boers come along the six men would be able to
+ defend themselves till the others returned. Half an hour after the arrival
+ of Carmichael's party they started in pursuit, and directed their course
+ for Inadi, as it would have been useless to search for the Boers, and it
+ was certain that these would make for the point where it had been arranged
+ that the cattle should cross. It was some fifteen miles away, and they
+ were confident that they would arrive there before the Boers, who, bad
+ walkers at the best of times, and disheartened by their failure, at the
+ loss of many of their companions and of all their horses, would not have
+ got more than half-way by the time they started.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was half-past two when they left, and when they approached Inadi day
+ was breaking. They had put on their Boer hats, and knew that the men in
+ charge of the herd would take them to be some of their own party until
+ they were quite close. To their satisfaction they saw the herd grazing
+ half a mile south of the village, and it was not until they were within a
+ hundred yards of the spot where the smoke of a fire showed that the guard
+ were posted, that they saw any movement. Then a man rose to his feet, and,
+ looking at them earnestly, gave a shout of alarm. The others leapt up at
+ once and ran towards their ponies; these were fifty yards away, and before
+ they could reach them Chris and his party dashed up, rifle in hand.
+ "Surrender," he shouted in Dutch, "or we fire! Down with your rifles!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Seeing that resistance was useless the Boers threw down their weapons, and
+ in a minute were tied hand and foot with the ropes from their saddles.
+ They were then lashed to bushes at some little distance from each other,
+ so as to prevent their rolling together and loosening each other's cords.
+ The natives with them had at the first alarm fled at full speed, and were
+ already out of sight. Then the whole party rode to a ridge a quarter of a
+ mile back, dismounted at its foot, and crawled up to the crest. A mile
+ away some fifty men could be seen wearily making their way on foot towards
+ them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have done quite enough in the way of fighting," Chris said, "and I
+ should think that they have had more than enough; we will get them to
+ surrender if we can. We will wait till they are within forty or fifty
+ yards and then fire a few shots over their heads, and see what comes of
+ it. We have good cover here, and they are in the open. They will know very
+ well that there is not a chance of their getting away, for, as we have
+ horses and they have none, we could defend any eminence we chose to
+ occupy, and ride off to another if they were likely to take it. Besides,
+ they would never be able to cross the river under our fire."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the Boers were within eighty yards half a dozen rifles were
+ discharged. They at once threw themselves on the ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will give them a chance of talking it over," Chris said, "then I will
+ hail them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A pause ensued, and the Boers could be heard talking excitedly together.
+ When he thought that he had given them time enough to appreciate their
+ condition, Chris shouted in Dutch:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Hullo, Boers! We don't want to have to kill you all, which we could
+ certainly do. You must see that you are at our mercy. If you choose to
+ surrender you may go home; if you don't, we shall let you lie there as
+ long as you like, and shoot you down when you get on your feet. I will
+ give you five minutes to make up your minds."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the end of that time one of the Boers held up his rifle with a white
+ flag tied to it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: "ONE OF THE BOERS HELD UP HIS RIFLE WITH A WHITE FLAG TIED TO
+ IT."]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is not good enough for us," Chris shouted. "That trick has been
+ tried too often. If you surrender, you will take off your bandoliers and
+ belts and leave them and your rifles behind you, and come forward
+ unarmed."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a shout of fury among the Boers as they found that their
+ treacherous design had failed in success.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I will give you another five minutes," Chris shouted; "and if you don't
+ do as I tell you we shall open fire on you."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Before that time was up the Boers were seen to be taking off their
+ bandoliers, and one by one they rose and came forward in a body without
+ their rifles. Chris allowed them to come half-way, so that they could not,
+ when they found themselves in superior force, run back to their arms
+ again. He gave the word, and his party rose to their feet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Now," he said, as the Boers came up, "you will turn all your pockets
+ inside out. I have not the least doubt that you are all taking off
+ mementos of your visit here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Indeed, the pockets of the prisoners were all bulging out. Sullenly the
+ Boers obeyed the order. The collection was a miscellaneous one. They had
+ between them the spoil of a dozen farms. Women's finery formed a large
+ proportion of their loot, and was evidently intended for their wives at
+ home. Besides this were spoons, forks, and cutlery, chimney ornaments,
+ children's clothes, several purses, and packets of spare cartridges.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That will do very nicely," Chris said, when it had been ascertained that
+ all the plunder had been disgorged. "Now, gentlemen, you are at liberty to
+ go, and I wish you a pleasant walk home. It is only about a hundred miles.
+ Your friends with the cattle shall join you at once. I have no doubt that
+ you will be able to obtain food from your countrymen as you go along. You
+ are sure to find friends at all the villages, and some of you may get
+ ponies at Helpmakaar."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then, paying no attention to the curses and threats of the Boers, the
+ party rode forward and collected the Boer guns, emptied the bandoliers and
+ belts, and then rode back to the cattle and released the four Boers with
+ them, and, pointing to their comrades, told them to rejoin them. Then they
+ collected the cattle, and, driving them before them, rode off. When they
+ had gone five miles away they halted, and the farmers undertaking to keep
+ watch by turns, the lads, throwing themselves down, were in a few minutes
+ fast asleep.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In four hours they were roused, and continued their course till they
+ reached the farm. Here they rested till the next morning, then at daybreak
+ the wounded Boers were placed in a waggon; the ammunition was divided
+ among the farmers; and the rifles taken from the Boers, and those that
+ belonged to the killed and wounded, amounting in all to eighty-one, were,
+ after the charges had been carefully drawn, also placed in the waggon,
+ Chris saying, "They would be useless to us, and they may be useful to you,
+ for they will arm all the people in Greytown; and with eighty magazine
+ rifles you ought to be able to beat off any parties you may meet. As the
+ cattle are all branded you will have no difficulty in returning them to
+ their owners; as to the Boer ponies and saddles, no doubt there are many
+ who have lost their horses who will be glad of them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then, after renewed expressions of gratitude from the farmers, the party
+ separated, the colonists going south to Greytown, while the scouts rode
+ west by the line they had come, and late that evening arrived at
+ Chieveley. They had intended to halt after crossing the Bushman's river at
+ Weenan, but they heard the sound of artillery and knew that Buller was
+ again moving forward.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Their return created quite an excitement in the camp of the Maritzburg
+ Scouts, and innumerable questions were asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We have been on a little business of our own," Chris said. "Beyond the
+ fact that it has been successful we have nothing to say. You know how
+ strict the orders are against scouting, and therefore I can only say that
+ we wanted to give our horses a change of food, and have taken them three
+ days off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Your horses don't look any better for the change, anyhow," one of the
+ troopers said. "They look as if they had been worked off their legs."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, they look a little drawn, but in a couple of days they will feel the
+ benefit of it; they were getting too fat before. Some day we may be able
+ to tell you more about it, but just at present we feel that it is as well
+ to keep the matter to ourselves. What has been doing here? We heard the
+ firing; that brought us in, or we should not have been back till
+ to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Nothing particular, except that we have been battering them all along the
+ line. No move has been made yet, but the general idea is that we shall
+ this time make a try at Hlangwane to-morrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hope we shall take it," Chris said. "We shall have a good deal more
+ trouble about it than we should have had at the attack in December, when
+ it was virtually in our hands, whereas now it looks stronger than any
+ point along the line."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris, however, was much more communicative to Captain Brookfield, who
+ said as he entered his tent, "Well, Chris, did you get there in time?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, sir; we caught them as they were attacking the house at ten o'clock
+ that night. They were too busy to notice us, and we killed eleven and
+ wounded eighteen, and stampeded their ponies. They bolted on foot, but
+ came back in hopes of surprising us two hours later, which I need hardly
+ say they failed to do. Then they made off for the place where the herds
+ they had captured were waiting for them. We drove their ponies in, as our
+ own were too much done up to go on, and intercepted the Boers close to
+ Inadi, and made them surrender. We took their guns, ammunition, and loot
+ from them, and let them go. There were forty-nine of them altogether, and
+ we did not see what we were to do with them. We could not have brought
+ them here without the whole thing being made public, and we were certainly
+ not disposed to escort them down to Maritzburg. They will have at least a
+ hundred miles to tramp home. We recovered all the cattle, about two
+ thousand head. We gave them to the farmers to find their proper owners,
+ and thirty of the Boer horses that we captured. I dare say they will pick
+ up some more of them; for as we were in a hurry, we only drove in as many
+ as we wanted. We have no casualties. It could hardly be called a fight, it
+ was a sudden surprise, and they did not stop to count us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Bravo! bravo, Chris! And now I suppose you are going to enlist again?"
+ "Yes, sir, if you will take us."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Certainly I will. Fortunately Buller was at Frere until they moved on
+ again yesterday, and nobody has missed your little camp as far as I know,
+ so I don't think that there is any chance of questions being asked. I will
+ swear you all in again if you will bring the others round."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0018" id="link2HCH0018"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVIII &mdash; RAILWAY HILL
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ There was little talking that evening. As soon as the tents had been
+ erected, a cup of cocoa and a biscuit taken, all turned in, and even the
+ constant booming of the artillery and the occasional sharp crack of
+ musketry had no effect whatever on their slumbers. Just before Chris lay
+ down, however, an orderly told him that Captain Brookfield wished to see
+ him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I have just received orders, Chris, that our brigade of cavalry is to
+ turn out tomorrow morning to support the infantry. Hildyard, Lyttleton,
+ and Barton are going. Their object is to carry Cingola, which is the small
+ peak at the end of the nek extending from it to the high peak of Monte
+ Cristo. The duty of the mounted infantry will be to clear the eastern side
+ of the southern end of the range, and to hold the nek separating it from
+ the highest peak, and so prevent the Boers from their main position
+ reinforcing the defenders of the lower peak. I think that your party had
+ better remain in camp, for after doing over seventy miles today they won't
+ be fit for work tomorrow."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We should not like to be left behind here, sir, and the hill is not very
+ far away, so that it would not be hard work for the horses. No doubt we
+ should be dismounted a considerable part of the day."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then you would rather go, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Much rather, sir. We should all be terribly disappointed if we could not
+ go out the first day that there has been a chance of our doing something."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is always as well to be on the right side, but I hardly think so many
+ troops will really be required; and I think it is a symptom that a serious
+ attack will be made in a day or two on Monte Cristo and Hlangwane. You
+ see, the possession of Cingola and Monte Cristo will take us pretty well
+ round its flank, and I do not expect the Boers will be so much prepared
+ there as they are in front."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An hour before daylight all were out engaged in grooming their horses,
+ which, having received a hot mash of mealie flour directly they came in on
+ the previous evening, looked better than could have been expected after
+ their hard work on two days out of three. By the time they had finished,
+ the natives had breakfast ready, and they had scarcely eaten this when a
+ trumpet sounded to horse. Five minutes later the mounted infantry
+ belonging to the regular regiments and the Colonial Horse formed up, and,
+ led by Lord Dundonald, marched north-east, followed by the three infantry
+ brigades and some batteries of artillery. When within a couple of miles of
+ the nek, the mounted infantry galloped forward, and selecting a spot where
+ the ascent was gradual, pushed rapidly up the hill until they reached its
+ brow. Here the horses were placed in a depression, and the men scattered
+ themselves across the crest. They were but just in time, for a
+ considerable force of Boers from Monte Cristo were hurrying along to
+ assist the defenders of Cingola, it having now become evident to them that
+ this was the point to which the infantry moving across the plain were
+ making.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A brisk fire was opened as they approached, and the Boers at once stopped
+ in surprise, for as they came along they had been unable to see that the
+ cavalry had quitted the rest of the column, and had therefore no idea
+ whatever that their way to Cingola was barred. As the rapid fire showed
+ them that the nek was held in force, they did not think it prudent to
+ advance farther, but after an exchange of fire fell back to Monte Cristo.
+ The task of the infantry was now comparatively easy. Cingola was not held
+ in any great force; and seeing that their retreat along the nek was cut
+ off, and that they could not hope to resist the strong force that was
+ approaching, the enemy contented themselves with keeping up a brisk fire
+ for a time, and then retreated hastily down the northern face of the hill,
+ and scattered among numerous kopjes between it and the river. Lyttleton
+ and Hildyard's brigades occupied the peak, and Barton, with the Fusilier
+ battalions, remained to the left of its base.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the mounted infantry had, before opening fire, taken shelter behind
+ bushes and rocks, there were only two or three casualties, and they were
+ much disappointed that the affair had been so trifling. It was afternoon
+ now, and for the rest of the day comparative quietude reigned, although
+ Monte Cristo threw an occasional shell on to the crest of Cingola. The
+ mounted infantry remained all night in their position, acting as an
+ advanced guard to the infantry; but they had orders to descend the hill
+ before daybreak and return to Chieveley, there being no water obtainable
+ for their horses, and their services not being required for the succeeding
+ operations. The next morning (Sunday) a battery of field-artillery, which
+ had been taken half-way up Cingola, began to shell Monte Cristo, and as if
+ this had been the signal, the whole of the artillery on the plain opened a
+ terrific fire on the entrenchments of Monte Cristo, Hlangwane, and Green
+ Hill, which was close to Monte Cristo.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the morning of the 18th, Lyttleton and Hildyard's brigades moved
+ forward to storm the precipitous peak, and Barton's brigade marched
+ against the tangled and difficult ground that surrounded Green Hill. The
+ Queen's on the right and the Scotch Fusiliers on the left led the attack
+ against the peak. The hillside was partly wooded, but although the
+ smokeless powder gave little indication as to the progress the troops were
+ making, occasional glimpses of the Boers flitting among the trees showed
+ that these were falling back. The roar of musketry was continuous, as
+ Hildyard's brigade and Lyttleton's were both engaged. For a short time
+ there was a pause, and then Lyttleton's men, having gathered at the edge
+ of a wood some couple of hundred yards from the summit, advanced with a
+ rush up the terribly steep rocks. The Boers fired hurriedly, but the
+ bullets flew for the most part far over the heads of the Queen's, and
+ then, fearful of being caught by Hildyard's men, who were also rapidly
+ coming up, they fled hastily.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The opposition had finally been trifling. The vast majority of the Boers
+ had cleared off, and the rest, after emptying their magazines, had
+ followed their example before the troops gained the summit, upon which a
+ heavy cannonade was at once opened from Grobler's Hill, Fort Wylie, and
+ other Boer positions. This, however, gradually slackened under the storm
+ of lyddite shells with which they were pelted by the naval guns, and the
+ important position of Hlangwane was at last secured, and no time was lost
+ in getting up guns and preparing for a farther advance. Barton's brigade
+ had been equally successful in their attack, and half an hour after the
+ capture of Monte Cristo the Fusiliers crowned the summit of the
+ wood-covered Green Hill.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers' defences were now examined, and proved to be of a most
+ formidable nature. On the south face of the hill the trenches were in
+ tiers, line behind line. Most of them were fully six feet deep, and in
+ many cases provided with shelter from the weather by sheets of corrugated
+ iron, taken from the roofs of the houses in Colenso. In some cases these
+ were supported by props, and covered with six feet of earth. These had
+ evidently been used for sleeping and living places. The ground was strewn
+ with straw, empty tins, fragments of food, bones, cartridge-cases, old
+ bandoliers, and large quantities of unopened tinned food and sacks of
+ mealie flour. Here and there were patches of dried blood, showing where
+ the wounded by our shell had been brought in, and laid down until they
+ could be removed to the hospital under cover of night. On the plateau the
+ scene was similar. Here every irregularity of ground had been utilized,
+ and long lines of trenches intersected it, showing that the Boers had
+ intended to make a desperate resistance even after we had won our way up
+ the hill. These were in a similar state of litter and disorder.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Although they had saved their guns, they had left behind them large
+ quantities of ammunition and provisions in the hurried flight,
+ necessitated by our attack being delivered in a direction from which no
+ danger had been apprehended, Four waggons full of ammunition had been left
+ by them in a kloof near the river. These had been observed by the
+ Engineers in the balloon, and their position had been signalled to the
+ naval brigade, who, turning their guns upon them, before long succeeded in
+ blowing them up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the infantry prepared for their final rush the Boers appeared,
+ indeed, to be entirely disconcerted at an attack from an altogether
+ unexpected direction. While for weeks they had been working incessantly to
+ render the hill impregnable, they had prepared it only on the face against
+ which they made sure the British infantry would dash itself. Nevertheless,
+ in this, as in every action, the Boers, as soon as they saw that there was
+ a risk of the position being taken, began early to make preparations for
+ retreat. While keeping up a very heavy musketry fire on the woods through
+ which the British infantry were advancing, they began to withdraw their
+ guns.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The speed and skill with which on every occasion throughout the war they
+ shifted heavy pieces of artillery from one point to another, or withdrew
+ them altogether, was a new feature in warfare. Except when the garrison of
+ Ladysmith, on two occasions of night sorties, surprised and destroyed
+ three of their guns, they scarcely lost a piece either in the numerous
+ actions during our advance to Ladysmith, or in their final retreat from
+ that town. And similarly on the other side, of the very large number of
+ guns employed at the fight on the Modder, at Magersfontein, and in the
+ siege of Kimberley the whole were, with the exception of a few pieces
+ captured when Cronje was surrounded, withdrawn in spite of the hurried
+ evacuation of their position, a feat almost unparalleled even in an army
+ accompanied only by field-artillery, and extraordinary indeed in the case
+ of works mounting heavy siege-guns.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No farther advance was made till the afternoon, when General Buller
+ arrived on the summit of Green Hill, and seeing that Hlangwane was not
+ entrenched on its northern side, which was completely turned by our
+ advance, sent Barton's brigade against it. But the loss of Monte Cristo
+ had for the time quite taken the fight out of the Boers, and after
+ maintaining a brisk fire for a short period, they evacuated the position
+ as soon as the infantry neared the summit, and, hurrying down the western
+ slope, crossed the Tugela. Three camps full of provisions, blankets, and
+ the necessaries of Boer life fell into the hands of the captors, together
+ with a large amount of rifle and Maxim ammunition. The place had been
+ turned into a fortress. Trenches and some breastworks covered all the
+ approaches by which the Boers might look for an attack, and as the whole
+ mountain was covered with huge boulders, they were able to withstand even
+ the storm of lyddite shell that was poured upon them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the following day Hart's brigade received orders to advance towards
+ Colenso. This was still held in force by the Boers, but was now commanded
+ by guns that had been got up the slopes of Hlangwane, and on Tuesday
+ morning General Hart captured the position without serious loss, the Boers
+ suffering severely from our shrapnel fire as they retreated, some by the
+ iron bridge and others by a ford. Thorneycroft's Mounted Infantry, which
+ was called up in the evening, took advantage of the discovery that a drift
+ existed there, and a squadron forded the river in spite of a scattered
+ fire from the Boers on the opposite bank. Another portion of the colonial
+ force occupied Fort Wylie, a redoubt that had been thrown up by our troops
+ when they occupied Colenso, but had been abandoned when the advance of the
+ Boers to cut the line between Colenso and Frere forced them to retire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning Thorneycroft's regiment crossed, and, moving to the left,
+ seized the kopjes facing Grobler's Kloof; the Boers, still suffering from
+ the effect of their unexpected reverses, offered no resistance, but,
+ abandoning all their camps, trenches, and redoubts, retired at once to the
+ hill. The Scouts had followed Thorneycroft's Horse in support, and now,
+ placing their horses under shelter in the abandoned entrenchments,
+ prepared to act as infantry should the Boers take the offensive. This,
+ however, they showed no intention of doing, and in the afternoon the
+ troops who had crossed were able to examine the deserted camps. They
+ presented very much the same appearance as those on Monte Cristo and
+ Hlangwane. Many of them appeared to have been occupied by men of a better
+ position, as many articles of luxury, choicer food, wearing apparel,
+ newspapers, Bibles, fruit, and other signs of comfort littered the places;
+ but even here dirt had reigned supreme. Although they must have been
+ inhabited for a long time, it could be seen that no attempts had been made
+ to clear away the refuse, or to make them in any degree tidy. As was
+ natural, the effect of the heat of the sun on scraps of food, vegetables,
+ and refuse of all kinds caused a sickening stench, and the soldiers spent
+ as short a time as possible over their investigations. One article which
+ would have been found in a British camp was altogether absent from those
+ of the enemy, and it was a joke among our troops that the only piece of
+ soap ever captured was found in the pocket of a dead Boer, and that its
+ wrapper was still unopened.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The strength of the position was, however, even more surprising than the
+ state of filth; every trench was enfiladed by another, great boulders were
+ connected by walls of massive construction, this being specially the case
+ where guns had been placed in position. Colenso itself had been in a
+ similar manner rendered almost impregnable to a frontal attack, and could
+ hardly have been captured by an assaulting force until Hlangwane had been
+ taken.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The hills beyond the railway still covered the road bridge by their fire,
+ and had the troops marched across it they would have suffered severely.
+ Accordingly a pontoon train was sent through an opening in the Hlangwane
+ range, and a bridge thrown over the Tugela north of Fort Wylie. The
+ Dorsets, Middlesex, and Somersets crossed at once, and, ascending the
+ kopjes, extended their line south until they were in communication with
+ Thorneycroft's men, holding therefore the railway line along the river
+ bank nearly half the distance between Colenso and Pieters station. Other
+ regiments and artillery followed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was now six days since the advance had commenced, and for the past four
+ fighting had been almost continuous. On Wednesday the three regiments
+ advanced towards Grobler's Hill in order to ascertain what force was
+ occupying it. They met with no opposition until they reached the lower
+ slopes, nor could any Boers be seen moving. Then suddenly a heavy fire
+ broke out from the boulders which covered the whole face of the hill, and
+ afforded such perfect shelter that it had not been considered necessary to
+ form entrenchments. As only a reconnaissance, and not an attack, had been
+ ordered, the force retired, the Somersets, who were the leading regiment,
+ having nearly a hundred casualties. The other regiments had as many more
+ between them. The next day a continuous fire from all the points held by
+ the Boers showed that large reinforcements had reached them. The
+ Lancashire Brigade, under Colonel Wynne, started at two o'clock that
+ afternoon to carry the kopjes up the Brook Spruit, which ran in the rear
+ of Grobler's Kloof. The Royal Lancasters led the way, but as soon as they
+ left the shelter of the ridges by the side of the railway they were
+ exposed to a terrible fire, both in front and from Grobler's Kloof. The
+ artillery on Hlangwane, and those still on the plain, endeavoured to
+ silence the enemy's guns, but though they poured numbers of lyddite and
+ shrapnel shells among them they were unable to do so. The Lancasters
+ advanced with the greatest coolness up the spruit, followed by the South
+ Lancasters. As they pressed forward they were met by a heavy rifle fire
+ both from the kopjes in front and on the left. The Boers stuck to the hill
+ until the Lancasters were within a hundred yards, then most of them slunk
+ off. Not knowing this, the Lancasters lay under shelter for a few minutes
+ until their ammunition pouches had been replenished, then, being joined by
+ the South Lancasters and King's Royal Rifles, they rushed to the crest.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For the past two days the Dublin Fusiliers had been lying near Colenso.
+ They had suffered very heavily in the first attack at Potgieter's Drift,
+ but they now volunteered to take Grobler's Hill; and this, aided with the
+ fire of the artillery and Colonel Wynne's brigade, they did in gallant
+ style, the Boers being evidently nervous that they might find their
+ retreat cut off should the Lancasters advance farther up the spruit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On Friday afternoon the Irish Brigade advanced along the line, and then
+ turned off towards Railway Hill, a steep jagged eminence almost triangular
+ in shape, with one angle pointing towards the river. The sides were broken
+ with sharp ledges covered with boulders. The railway passed through this,
+ separating the last jagged ledge from the higher portion of the hill,
+ which rises almost precipitously. Running back several hundred yards at
+ the base of this line was a dip full of thorn trees. This deep winds round
+ the rear of the hill, and here there was a large Boer Camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A little farther to the rear was another steep hill, on which the enemy's
+ Creusot guns were now mounted. Several trenches were cut alongside the
+ hillsides, and on the crest were some strong redoubts. It was a most
+ formidable position, but as it seemed to bar all progress farther up the
+ line, it was necessary to carry it at all costs. The mounted infantry had,
+ after the skirmish towards Grobler's Kloof, returned to the camp, as the
+ country was so terribly broken as to be altogether impracticable for
+ mounted men.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On Thursday, Captain Brookfield had obtained a pass for himself and three
+ other officers to go to Hlangwane to view the operations, but one of these
+ being unwell, Captain Brook-field invited Chris to take his place. After
+ inspecting the plateau, they made their way down to the left. Hearing that
+ an attack was about to be made on Railway Hill, they clambered down until
+ they reached a point where, seated in an open spot among the trees, they
+ could command a view of what was passing.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is an awful place," Chris said, "and it seems to me almost impossible
+ to be carried."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is an awful place," Captain Brookfield agreed. "This is one of the
+ times, Chris, when one feels the advantage of belonging to a mounted
+ corps, for without being less brave than other men, I should regard it as
+ an order to meet certain death were I told to attack that rugged hill. Ah,
+ there are the Irish Brigade!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The storming party consisted of the Inniskillings, with companies of the
+ Dublins, the Connaught Bangers, and the Imperial Light Infantry. From a
+ building called Platelayer's House at the mouth of the spruit, to the foot
+ of the hill, the ground was perfectly open to the point where the left
+ face of Railway Hill rose steeply up, and across this open ground, a
+ distance of half a mile, the assailants had to march.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Here they come!"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As, in open order, with their rifles at the trail, the Inniskillings
+ appeared in view, a terrible fire broke out from every ledge of Railway
+ Hill, while the cannon joined in the roar. The guns on Hlangwane, and
+ those on the slopes nearer the river, with Maxims and quick-firing guns,
+ replied on our side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is awful," Chris said, speaking to himself rather than to the captain
+ who was standing beside him. "I don't think that even at Badajos, British
+ soldiers were ever sent on a more desperate enterprise. It looks as if
+ nothing could live under that fire even now; what will it be when they get
+ closer?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Not a shot was fired by the advancing infantry in reply to the storm of
+ bullets from the Boer marksmen. Every round of ammunition might be wanted
+ yet, and it would only be wasted on an invisible foe. They took advantage
+ of what little shelter could be obtained, sometimes close to the river
+ bank, sometimes following some slight depression which afforded at least a
+ partial protection. At last they reached a deep donga running into the
+ river; this was crossed by a small bridge, and in passing over it they had
+ to run the gauntlet of the Boer fire. Many fell here, but the stream of
+ men passed on, and then at a double rushed to a sheltered spot close to
+ the foot of the ascent, where they had been ordered to gather. Here they
+ had a breathing space. Their real work was yet to begin, but already their
+ casualties had been numerous. The Inniskillings alone had lost
+ thirty-eight killed and wounded. Not a word had been spoken among the
+ little group on the hill, for the last ten minutes; they stood with
+ tightly-pressed lips, breath coming hard, and pale faces looking at the
+ scene. Occasionally a short gasp broke from one or other as a shell burst
+ in the thick of the men crossing the little bridge, a cry as if they
+ themselves had been struck. When the troops gained their shelter there was
+ a sigh of relief.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They will never do it," Captain Brookfield said decidedly. "It would need
+ ten times as many men to give them a chance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This was the opinion of them all, and they hoped even now that this was
+ but the advance party, and that ere long they would see a far larger body
+ of men coming up. But there were no signs of reinforcements, and at five
+ o'clock the troops were re-formed and the advance began. They dashed
+ forward up the hill under a heavy fire, to which the supporting line
+ replied. The boulders afforded a certain amount of shelter, and of this
+ the Inniskillings took every advantage, until they reached the last ledge
+ with comparatively little loss. But the work was still before them.
+ Leaping over, they rushed down on to the railway line. Here a wire-fence
+ arrested their course for a moment, and many fell while getting through or
+ over it. Then they ran across the line, passed through a fence on the
+ other side, and dashed up the steep angle of the hill to the first trench.
+ Hitherto the fire of the Boers had been far less destructive than might
+ have been expected, their attention being confused and their aim flurried
+ by the constant explosion of lyddite shell from the British batteries.
+ They had but one eye for their assailants, the other for the guns, and as
+ each of the heavy pieces was fired, they ducked down for shelter, only to
+ get up again to take a hasty shot before having to hide again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Thus, then, they were in no condition to reckon the comparatively small
+ numbers of their assailants, and as they saw the Irishmen dashing forward,
+ cheering loudly, with pointed bayonets, they hesitated, and then bolted up
+ the hill to the next trench. Instead of waiting until the supports had
+ come up for another rush, the Irishmen with a cheer dashed across the
+ trench in hot pursuit. But the next line was far more strongly manned, and
+ a storm of bullets swept among them. Still, for a time they kept on, but
+ wasting so rapidly that even the most desperate saw that it could not be
+ done; and, turning, the survivors retreated to the trench that they had
+ already won, while the supports fell back to the railway, both suffering
+ heavily in the retreat. No fewer than two hundred of the Inniskillings had
+ fallen in that desperate charge, their colonel and ten officers being
+ either killed or wounded, while the Dublins also lost their colonel.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All through the night the trench was held sternly, in spite of repeated
+ and desperate efforts of the Boers to dislodge its defenders. Nothing
+ could be done for those who lay wounded on the hill above. Morning broke,
+ and the fight still continued. At nine o'clock another desperate charge
+ was made; but the Boers were unable to face the steady fire that was
+ maintained by the defenders of the trench, and they again turned and ran
+ for their shelters. Just as this attack was repulsed, Lyttleton's brigade
+ arrived on the scene, exchanging a hearty cheer with the men who had so
+ long borne the brunt of this terrible conflict. The Durham Light Infantry
+ at once relieved those in the trenches, and these descended the hill for
+ the rest that was so much needed. All that day the fighting continued, and
+ while Lyttleton's men held to the position on Railway Hill, there was
+ fierce fighting away to the left, where the Welsh Fusiliers and other
+ regiments were hotly engaged. The roar of artillery and musketry never
+ ceased all day, but towards evening white flags were hoisted on both
+ sides, and a truce was agreed upon for twelve hours to bury the dead.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The scene of the conflict presented a terrible sight. The hillside between
+ the two trenches was strewn with dead and wounded. The sufferings of the
+ latter had been terrible. For six-and-thirty hours they had lain where
+ they fell, their only relief being a little water, that in the short
+ intervals during the fighting some kindly Boers had crept down to give
+ them. The truce began at four o'clock in the morning of Sunday the 25th,
+ and the foes of the previous day mingled with each other in the sad work,
+ conversing freely with each other. The Boers expressed their astonishment
+ that such an attempt should ever have been made, and their stupefaction at
+ the manner in which the Irish had pressed on through a fire in which it
+ had seemed that no human being could have existed for a minute. When
+ informed of the relief of Kimberley, and the fact that Cronje was
+ hopelessly surrounded, they scoffed at the news as a fable, and were so
+ honestly amused that it was evident they had been kept absolutely in the
+ dark by their leaders. Captain Brookfield and his party had remained at
+ the lookout until darkness set in. After the first exclamation of pain and
+ grief as they saw the attack fail, and the fearfully thinned ranks run
+ back to shelter, there had been little said. "It was impossible from the
+ first," Captain Brookfield sighed as they turned. "If the relief of
+ Ladysmith depends on our carrying that hill, Ladysmith is doomed to fall."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They returned to the spot where they had left their horses in charge of
+ two of the blacks, and rode back to Chieveley. It was a sorrowful evening.
+ The men's hopes had risen daily as position after position had been
+ carried, and now it seemed that once again the enterprise had hopelessly
+ failed. On Monday there was a continuation of the lull of firing. Many of
+ the officers in camp who were off duty rode up to examine the scene of the
+ fight, and they were not surprised when they saw the infantry recrossing
+ the pontoon bridge. All wore a dejected aspect, but especially the men who
+ had fought so heroically and, as it now seemed, in vain. They sat watching
+ until the last soldier had crossed, and then rode to the top of Hlangwane.
+ All Chris's party had come out, and those who had not before seen the view
+ waited there for a couple of hours, ate some refreshment they had brought
+ with them, discussed the difficulties that lay in the way of farther
+ advance, and the probable point against which General Buller would next
+ direct his attack.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Hullo!" Chris exclaimed suddenly, "that pontoon train is not coming back
+ to camp. Do you see, after moving to the point where it passed through
+ this range, it has turned to the north again and not to the south. Hurrah!
+ Buller is not going to throw up the sponge this time. The Boers have not
+ done with us yet." This indeed was the case. The general, seeing that
+ Railway Hill was too strong to be carried by assault, unless with an
+ enormous loss of life, had caused the river to be reconnoitred some
+ distance farther up, and this had resulted in the discovery of a spot
+ where, with some little labour, the troops could get down to the river and
+ a pontoon bridge be again thrown. Such a spot was found by Colonel
+ Sandbach of the Royal Engineers, and a strong working party was at once
+ set to work to make a practicable approach. The point lay some three or
+ four miles below Railway Hill, and the most formidable of the obstacles
+ would therefore be turned. That night the troops crossed, and the Boers&mdash;who
+ were in ignorance of what had been going on, the point chosen for the
+ passage being at the bend of the river and hidden by an intervening
+ eminence from their positions&mdash;were astonished at finding a strong
+ force again across the river.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the news reached the camp that the army was again crossing,
+ satisfaction took the place of the deep depression that had reigned during
+ the past two days, and the situation was eagerly discussed. Those who at
+ all knew the country were eagerly questioned as to the ground farther on
+ near the line of railway. All these agreed that the hill called Pieter's
+ was a formidable position, almost, though not perhaps quite, as strong as
+ Railway Hill, but that beyond it the line ran through a comparatively open
+ country, and that if this hill could be captured the relief of Ladysmith
+ would be ensured. The Scouts had not escaped altogether scatheless. At the
+ reconnaissance towards Grobler's Hill, Brown, Harris, and Willesden had
+ all been wounded, but none very seriously, although at first it was
+ thought that Willesden's was a mortal injury, for he had been hit in the
+ stomach. The doctors, however, assured his anxious comrades that there was
+ every ground for hope, for very many of those who had been so injured had
+ made a speedy recovery.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Poor old Willesden!" Field had said as they talked it over; "it is hard
+ that he should have been hit in the stomach, for he was a capital hand at
+ taking care of it."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "And of ours too, Field. He has been a first-rate caterer. I do hope he
+ will pull through it." The lad himself had not seemed to suffer much pain,
+ and three days later the surgeon had been able to assure his friends that
+ as no fever had set in they had little fear of serious consequences
+ ensuing. The boys had not been allowed to see him. Captain Brookfield,
+ however, reported that he was going on capitally, but was in a very bad
+ temper because he was allowed to eat nothing but a piece of bread and a
+ sip of milk, while he declared himself desperately hungry, and capable of
+ devouring a good-sized leg of mutton.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think you need worry about him," he said to Chris; "the doctor
+ told me that in a fortnight he would be very likely to be about again, and
+ none the worse for the wound, the bullet having evidently missed any vital
+ point, in which case its passage would heal as quickly as the little
+ wounds where the bullet enters and passes out usually do."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Harris had his arm broken just above the elbow, and Brown a flesh wound
+ below the hip. He was the stoutest of the party, and jokingly said, as he
+ was carried back, that the bullet had passed through the largest amount of
+ flesh in the company. Chris once or twice went into the hospitals with a
+ doctor whose acquaintance he had made. They offered a strong contrast to
+ the scene that had taken place after the battle of Elandslaagte, as in the
+ hospitals at Chieveley and Frere everything was as admirably arranged as
+ they would have been in one of a large town. In the daytime the sides of
+ the marquees were lifted to allow of a free passage of air. The nurses in
+ their neat dresses moved quietly among the patients with medicines, soups,
+ jellies, and other refreshments ordered for them. There were books for
+ those sufficiently convalescent to be able to read them, and those who
+ wished to send a letter home always found one of the nurses ready to write
+ at their dictation. By some of the bedsides stood bouquets of flowers sent
+ by the ladies of Maritzburg, and all had an abundance of delicious fruit
+ from the same source.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0019" id="link2HCH0019"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIX &mdash; MAJUBA DAY
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ "Did you hear of that plucky action of Captain Philips, of the Royal
+ Engineers, last night?" an officer who had just ridden in from the front
+ asked Chris that evening.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; I heard that the Boers set up a tremendous musketry fire in the
+ evening after the truce was over, but no one that I have spoken to knew
+ what it was about."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we ourselves didn't know till next morning. The general idea was
+ that it was a Boer scare. They thought that we were crawling up to make a
+ night attack, and so blazed away for all they were worth. We found out
+ afterwards that Philips had conceived the idea that it was possible to
+ destroy that search-light of the Boers. He had learned from prisoners that
+ it was the last they had with them, and although we have not made any
+ night attacks yet, it was possible we might do so in the future, and so he
+ made up his mind to have a try to smash it up. He took with him eight
+ blue-jackets, crawled along in the dark beyond our lines, and got in among
+ the Boers. He had taken particular notice of points he should have to
+ pass, boulders and so on, and he found his way there without making a
+ blunder. There were plenty of Boers round, but no one just at the
+ search-light. The blue-jackets all understood the working of their own
+ search-lights; but the Boers have no electric lights, you know, and work
+ their signals with acetylene, and so they stood on guard while Philips
+ opened the lamp, took out the working parts, whatever they are, and shut
+ the lamp again. Just as they had done so they heard four Boers who had
+ been sitting talking together get up. He and his party dropped among the
+ bushes and lay there quiet while the Boers came up to the lamp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "'We are to keep it going to-night,' one of them said, 'for they may take
+ it into their heads to make an attack, thinking that after having had a
+ truce all day we shall not be expecting trouble, and they may catch us
+ unprepared. I expect our German officer in a few minutes; he said he would
+ be here about ten o'clock, for the rooineks are not likely to move until
+ they think we are asleep.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They moved away again, and Philips and his men stole quietly off, but
+ before they rejoined our fellows they heard a sudden shot, and in a minute
+ a tremendous rifle fire broke out. Evidently the German had arrived and
+ found the search-light would not act, and they concluded at once that we
+ were marching against them, and for twenty minutes every man in the
+ trenches blazed away at random as fast as he could load. I should say that
+ they must have wasted a hundred thousand cartridges. As there was no reply
+ they began to think that they had been fooled. Our fellows were just as
+ much puzzled at the row, and fell in, thinking that the Boers might
+ possibly be going to attack them. However, matters quieted down, and it
+ was not until the next morning that anyone knew what it had all been
+ about."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That was a plucky thing indeed," Chris said; "though, as I should hardly
+ think we should attack at night, it may not be of much service, for the
+ Boers have long since given up trying with their feeble flash-lights to
+ interrupt our night signalling with Ladysmith, especially as, now the
+ weather is finer, we can talk all day if we like with our heliograph."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris was just turning in when Captain Brookfield came to the entrance of
+ his tent. "I have just heard, Chris, that the pontoon bridge has been
+ successfully thrown across just below the cataract, and that the troops
+ are all crossing. I just mention it to you. I cannot get away myself, but
+ if I find you and your boys are&mdash;not here in the morning, I shall say
+ nothing about it. We certainly shall not be wanted. The orders are out,
+ and there is no mention of our corps nor any of the mounted colonials."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, sir! I am very much obliged." Chris went round to the tents
+ and told the others that they must be up an hour before daybreak and be
+ ready to start at once, as there would probably be another very big fight.
+ Then he told the natives, who were, as usual, still talking together in
+ their tent, that they were all going off very early, and that chocolate
+ must be ready at daybreak, and the water-skins filled, as the horses would
+ probably be out all day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Will you want anything cooked, baas?" Jack asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No; we will take some tins with us. There is going to be another big
+ fight to-morrow; as we are all going, you can go too if you like. We shall
+ want you for the horses. Three of you can stop with them at a time, and
+ the others can go and see what is doing, and then change about, you know,
+ so that you can all see something. The spare horses must have plenty of
+ food left them, and must have a good drink before we start."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They were all astir in good time. The natives had made some hot cakes, and
+ these they ate with their chocolate. Then they saw that the horses had a
+ good feed, and a stock of biscuit and tinned meat for themselves was put
+ into the saddle-bags, and when daylight broke they were across the plain
+ and arrived at the dip in the hills through which the pontoon train had
+ gone. Knowing where the cataract was, they were able to calculate pretty
+ accurately where they had best dismount. This they did in a small clump of
+ trees. Then each took a tin of meat and a couple of pounds of biscuit in
+ his pocket. "Now," Chris said to the natives, "you had better all stay
+ here quietly till you hear firing begin; then, Jack, you can go with the
+ two Zulus. You can stay and look on till the middle of the day. When the
+ sun is at its highest you must come back and let Japhet and the Swazis go.
+ At sunset you must all be here again, and wait till we come. Perhaps we
+ may be back sooner, and if so we shall ride away at once; and those of you
+ who are away when we start must go back to camp at once if you find that
+ the horses have gone when you get here. Now let's be off."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They made their way up the hills, well pleased that there were enough
+ trees and bushes to shield them from observation. The roar of artillery
+ and the rattle of musketry had been going on for some time, but not with
+ the fury that marked the commencement of an attack. A fortnight before it
+ would have seemed to them that a great battle was in progress, but by this
+ time they were accustomed to the almost incessant fire, and knew that
+ although the cannonade was heavier than usual, no actual fighting was
+ going on. They met no officers as they went along, nor did they expect to
+ do so, for none of these would be able to leave their regiments, as even
+ were these not included in the force told off to assault, they might be
+ called upon later in the day. At last they reached the top of a hill whose
+ face sloped steeply down to the river, and from here they could obtain a
+ view of the Boer position, and of the line of railway up and down.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ To the right was Pieter's station, with a steep hill of the same name
+ rising close to it. To the left of this was another strongly-posted hill,
+ while beyond it was the scene of the fighting on Friday and Saturday,
+ Railway Hill, which had been rechristened Hart's Hill, in honour of the
+ commander of the brigade that had fought so valiantly. It was evident that
+ at these three points the whole of the fighting force of the Boers had
+ gathered. A heavy rifle fire was being kept up against the British
+ infantry, whose passage of the river had now been discovered, and who were
+ lying crouched behind boulders and other shelter.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They now saw that the guns had all been brought forward during the night,
+ had taken up commanding positions, and were pouring a terrible fire into
+ the enemy's encampment at a distance of little over a mile. The enemy's
+ guns were replying, but at this short range the naval guns were able to
+ fire point-blank, and their shells ripped the defences erected to shelter
+ the Boer camp into fragments, and carried destruction everywhere.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On a kopje about a quarter of a mile behind and above them General Buller
+ and his staff had taken up their position, and the lads kept themselves
+ well within the trees to avoid observation.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "See, Chris, there are some of our fellows creeping along by the side of
+ the river. They must be hidden from the sight of the Boers. I expect they
+ will be the first to begin."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All their glasses were turned upon the column of men. They were two
+ battalions of the eth Brigade and the Dublin Fusiliers, and these, under
+ General Barton's command, made their way down the river bank for a mile
+ and a half. Then the lads saw that they were leaving the river and
+ crossing the line of railway.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "They have evidently gone down there," Sankey said, "because that spur
+ just this side must hide them from the Boers on Pieter's Hill."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The column were lost sight of for upwards of an hour, and then they
+ appeared on the opposite crest, five hundred feet above the line; then
+ they were lost sight of again as they passed beyond the crest.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is a splendid move!" Chris exclaimed. "By working round there they
+ will gain the top of Pieter's Hill, and come down like a thunderbolt upon
+ the Boers."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The roar of artillery continued unabated. Clouds of yellowish-brown smoke
+ floated over the Boer entrenchments, lit up occasionally by a vivid flash
+ of a bursting lyddite shell. So terrible was the bombardment that the
+ rifle fire of the Boers against the troops crouching behind their shelters
+ was feeble and intermittent, as they dared not merge from their
+ shelter-places to lift a head above their line of trenches. It was a long
+ time before Barton's troops were again seen. Doubtless they had orders to
+ wait for a time when they had gained their desired position, in order to
+ allow the bombardment to do its work, and prepare the way for the assault
+ of the other positions by the fourth and eleventh brigades. It was not,
+ indeed, until the afternoon that the lads saw Barton's brigade sweeping
+ along to the attack of Pieter's Hill.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Boers saw them now, and could be seen leaping out of their
+ entrenchments, regardless of the redoubled fire of the artillery now
+ concentrated upon them, and climbing up the hill to oppose this unexpected
+ attack. But before they could gather in sufficient numbers the British
+ were upon them, keeping up a terrible fire as they advanced. The Boers,
+ however, fought sturdily. Many, indeed, had already begun to make their
+ way along the southern face of the hill, either to join their comrades on
+ the hill between Pieter's and Hart's, or to escape up the valleys between
+ them, and so make their way to Bulwana, where a large force was still
+ encamped.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We may as well help," Chris said; "the general can but blow us up."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Delighted to be able to do even a little towards the success of the day,
+ the party at once picked up their rifles lying beside them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is about a thousand yards, I should say, to the middle of the hill.
+ Take steady aim and try and pick them off as they leave their trenches."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The firing began at once slowly and steadily, and occasionally there was
+ an exclamation of satisfaction when a bullet found its mark. Five minutes
+ later a dismounted staff-officer came down to the trees behind them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What men are these?" he asked; "the general wishes to know."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are the Johannesburg Scouts," Chris said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Are you in command, sir?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Then, will you please to accompany me at once to the general."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On arriving at the spot where the general was standing a little in advance
+ of his staff, the latter at once recognized Chris. "Oh, it is you, Mr.
+ King!" he said. "I was afraid some of the men had left their stations. And
+ what are you doing here?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We are trying to lend a hand to the troops over there, and as we are all
+ good shots, I think we are being of some assistance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You had no right to leave the camp, sir. I suppose you call this
+ independent service?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I do, general. I hope that we are affording some help here, and we should
+ not be doing any good in camp; and as we have been nearly out of it
+ through all this fighting, and there were no orders for the corps to do
+ anything to-day, we thought we might be of use."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You did wrong, sir," the general said, his face relaxing into a smile at
+ the lad's defence of himself. "Well, as you are there, you may as well
+ stop."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Thank you, sir!" Chris said, saluting, and then hurried off to rejoin his
+ comrades.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "He is a plucky boy," the general said to his staff. "I heard the other
+ day&mdash;though not officially, so I was not obliged to take notice of it&mdash;that
+ he, with the twenty lads with him, rode out to a place seventy miles away,
+ and rescued some farmers who were besieged by Boers, defeated their
+ assailants, killed and wounded more than their own number, made the rest
+ of them, still double their own strength, lay down their arms, and
+ recaptured nearly two thousand head of cattle they had driven off. The
+ news came to me from the mayor of Maritzburg, who had heard of it from a
+ friend who had ridden in from Grey town. He wrote to me expressing his
+ admiration at the exploit. I sent privately to their captain and
+ questioned him about it, intending to reprimand him severely for letting
+ them go; but he said that they had all resigned, as they had a right to
+ do, for they are all sons of gentlemen, and draw no pay or provisions, and
+ that he had therefore no control whatever over their actions after they
+ left camp. I told him not to say anything about his having seen me, for
+ that, as they had returned, I should be obliged to take notice of the
+ matter if it came to be talked about. That young fellow who came here is
+ the one who, with three of the others, tried to blow up the bridge at
+ Komati-poort. He could not do that, but he played havoc with a large store
+ of rifles, ammunition, and six or eight guns. After that I could not very
+ well scold him." And he again turned his glass on the opposite hill.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Here the fighting was almost over, and in a very short time all resistance
+ had ceased. Some of the Boer guns on the next hill had now been turned
+ round, and opened upon the captured position, which took their own in
+ flank. An aide-de-camp was sent off to order some of the guns to be taken,
+ if possible, up to the top of Pieter's Hill, and after immense exertions
+ two batteries were placed there. As soon as this was accomplished, orders
+ were sent for the rest of the infantry to advance. General Warren was in
+ command, and the fourth brigade, under Colonel Norcott, and the eleventh,
+ under Colonel Kitchener, now moved forward, taking advantage of what
+ shelter could be obtained as they advanced. At the same time a strong
+ force of colonial infantry moved to the right to attack the Boer trenches
+ farther up the line of railway, and were soon hotly engaged. The defenders
+ of Hart's Hill, and the position between that and Pieter's, opened a heavy
+ fire as soon as the British infantry showed themselves; but their morale
+ was so shaken by the terrific bombardment to which they had been
+ subjected, by the loss of Pieter's Hill, and by the rifle fire now opened
+ by its captors, that their fire was singularly ineffective. Many men
+ dropped, but the loss was comparatively much smaller than that suffered by
+ the Irish division when moving across the open on the 23rd.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Taking advantage of every shelter, the troops moved steadily forward,
+ maintaining a heavy fire whenever they did so, and winning their way
+ steadily. Colonel Kitchener's Brigade pressed on towards Hart's Hill,
+ which on the side by which they now attacked was far less formidable than
+ that against which the Irish had dashed themselves. It had never entered
+ the Boer's minds that they would be attacked from this side, and their
+ most formidable entrenchments had all been placed to resist an assault
+ from Colenso. Arrived at its foot, the troops were in comparative shelter
+ among the boulders that covered the slopes. Foot by foot they made their
+ way upwards, until at last they gathered for a final assault, and then
+ with a loud cheer scrambled up the last slope and with fixed bayonets
+ drove the Boers in headlong flight. A similar success attended the
+ eleventh brigade, who just at sunset carried the centre position, and a
+ mighty cheer broke out all along the line at the capture of what all felt
+ to be the last serious obstacle to their advance to Ladysmith. On the
+ right, the Colonial troops had driven the Boers in front of them for
+ nearly three miles, capturing entrenchment after entrenchment, until they
+ arrived at Nelthorpe station. The three camps of the Boers contained an
+ even larger amount of spoil than had been discovered in those of Monte
+ Cristo and Hlangwane. It seemed that they had been perfectly confident
+ that the positions were impregnable, and had accumulated stores sufficient
+ for a prolonged residence. It was evident, too, that the wealthier men
+ with them had preferred this situation to the more exposed camps on the
+ summit of the hills. The amount of provisions and stores of all kinds was
+ large, Great quantities of rifle ammunition were found in every trench.
+ Clothes of a superior kind proved that their owners had been residents of
+ Johannesburg or Pretoria, and of a different class altogether from the
+ farm-labourers and herdsmen who formed the majority of the Boer army. The
+ haste with which they had fled, when to their astonishment they discovered
+ that the British attack could not be repulsed, was shown by the fact that
+ a good many watches were found on bed-places and rough tables where they
+ had been left when the Boers rushed to arms, and in the hurry of flight
+ had been forgotten.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The number of rifles that had been thrown away was very large. Among the
+ dead bodies found were those of two women, one quite young and the other
+ over sixty. It was notorious that women had more than once been seen in
+ the firing ranks of the Boers, and there were reports that Amazon corps
+ were in course of formation in the Transvaal, the Boers, perhaps,
+ remembering how sturdily the women of Haarlem had fought against the
+ Spaniards in defence of their city.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So complete had been the panic evinced by the headlong fight of the enemy
+ that the general opinion was that it would be some time before they would
+ again attempt a stand against our men, and that unless any entrenchments
+ higher up the valley were held by men who had not witnessed what had taken
+ place, and were commanded by leaders of the most determined character,
+ Ladysmith would almost certainly be relieved within a couple of days, and
+ the rescuing army would be thus rewarded for its toils and sacrifices.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a state of the wildest delight the lads returned to the spot where they
+ had left their horses, where they found that Japhet and the two Swazis had
+ arrived just before them. They and the Zulus were exhibiting their intense
+ satisfaction at the defeat of the Boers by a wild war-dance. The party
+ rode fast back to camp, for their spirits did not admit of a leisurely
+ pace, and they left the natives to follow them more deliberately. The news
+ had already been received in camp by the return of officers who witnessed
+ the scene from a point near to that which the lads had attained, and its
+ occupants were in a frenzy of delight. The Colonial corps were especially
+ jubilant. This was the anniversary of Majuba Hill, the blackest in the
+ history of the Colony, and one that the Boers in the Transvaal and Orange
+ State always celebrated with great rejoicings, to the humiliation of the
+ British Colonists. Now that disgrace was wiped out. A position even
+ stronger than that of Majuba, fortified with enormous pains, defended by
+ artillery and by thousands of Boers, had been captured by a British force,
+ and although it was as yet unknown in camp, the old reverse had been
+ doubly avenged by the surrender on that day of Cronje and his army.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Late that evening an order was issued that Lord Dundonald with a squadron
+ of Lancers and some Colonial corps, in which the Maritzburg Scouts were
+ included, were to reconnoitre along the line of railway. All felt sure
+ that no serious opposition was likely to be met with; the defeat of the
+ Boers had been so crushing and complete that assuredly few of the
+ fugitives would be found willing to again encounter the terrible artillery
+ fire, followed by the irresistible onslaught of the infantry. That
+ evening, in spite of the scarcity of wood, bonfires were lighted, and the
+ Scouts gathered round them. Every bottle of spirits and wine that remained
+ in the camp was broached, and a most joyous evening was spent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I shall be able to breathe freely;" one of the colonists, a man from
+ Johannesburg, said, "on Majuba Day in future. I have made a point for
+ years, whenever I wanted to do any business in Natal, to put it off till
+ that date, so that I could get out of the Transvaal. When I could not
+ manage it, I shut myself up and stopped in bed all day, though even there
+ I used to grind my teeth when I heard the brutes shouting and singing in
+ the streets. Still, to me it was not half such a humiliation as surrender
+ day. The one was a piece of carelessness, a military blunder, no doubt;
+ the other was a national disgrace. And though I saw Majuba myself, it did
+ not affect me half as much as did the abject backing down of the British
+ Government after they had collected an army at Newcastle in readiness to
+ avenge Majuba. We could not believe the news when it came. The fury of the
+ troops was unbounded, and I would not have given a farthing for the lives
+ of any of the men who were the authors of the surrender, had they been in
+ the camp that day."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "What were you doing there?" Chris asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I had a farm near Newcastle at that time, and two of my waggons had been
+ taken up by the military for transport purposes. I was not on the hill, as
+ you may suppose, or I might not be here to tell the story. I went forward
+ with Colley. It was just the same then as it was at the beginning here.
+ There were plenty of colonists ready to take up arms, but the military
+ authorities would have none of them; they could manage the thing
+ themselves without any aid from civilians. They knew that the natives had
+ over and over again beaten the Boers, and what natives could do would be,
+ merely child's play to British soldiers. Sir George Colley was a brave
+ officer, and I believe had proved himself a skilful one, but he knew
+ nothing whatever of the Boer style of fighting, while we colonists
+ understood it perfectly, and could match them at their own game. As it
+ turned out, the British soldiers on that occasion did not, and it made all
+ the difference. If Sir George Colley had accepted a few hundreds of us,
+ who knew the Boers well, as scouts and skirmishers, the affair would have
+ turned out very differently; for, as you know, they did not succeed
+ through the whole affair in taking one of the places held by our
+ colonists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we started from Newcastle, and the blundering began from the first.
+ It was but twenty-five miles to Laing's Nek. At the time we started there
+ was not a Boer there, for they were doubtful which line we should advance
+ by. That twenty-five miles could have been done in a day, and there we
+ should have been with our difficulties at an end; the baggage and stores
+ could have come up in two or three days, and then another advance could
+ have been made. Instead of that, six days were wasted in going over that
+ miserable bit of ground. The Boers, of course, took advantage of the time
+ we had given them to prepare and entrench Laing's Nek. I don't think that
+ troubled the military authorities at all; an entrenchment thrown up by
+ farmers and peasants could be but a worthless affair, and would not for a
+ moment check the advance of British infantry. The consequence of all this
+ was that we got the licking we deserved. Their entrenchment at the crest
+ of the ridge was held by something like three thousand men. Colley had but
+ three hundred and seventy infantry, a force in itself utterly inadequate
+ for the work in hand. But, seeing some parties of Boer horsemen riding
+ about, he thought it necessary to leave a strong body for the defence of
+ his baggage, and accordingly sent only about two hundred and fifty men
+ forward to attack the place.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, we among the waggons hadn't a doubt how it was going to turn out.
+ The one battery with us opened fire upon the entrenchment, but you who
+ know what their entrenchments are will guess that there was little damage
+ done; and when the soldiers went up the hill the Boers held their fire
+ until they were close, and then literally swept them away, and, leaping
+ over the entrenchments, took many of them prisoners. None would have got
+ away at all if a few mounted infantry, who had managed to get up the Nek
+ at another point, hadn't charged down and so enabled the survivors to
+ escape. One hundred and eighty out of the two hundred and fifty were
+ killed or taken prisoners. Colley at once fell back four miles. The Boers
+ on their part, making sure that they had got him safe, sent a strong force
+ round, and this planted itself on the road between him and Newcastle, but
+ before they did so some small reinforcements joined us. Three or four days
+ passed, and then we Colonials quite made up our mind that there was
+ nothing for it but surrender. Colley determined at last to try and open
+ the road back, and with about two hundred and fifty men, with four cannon&mdash;two
+ of them mountain guns&mdash;moved out. Some sixty soldiers were left on a
+ commanding spot to cover the passage of the Ingogo. As soon as the force
+ under Colley had got to the opposite crest of the ravine through which the
+ river runs, they were attacked in great force. They took shelter among the
+ boulders, and fought as bravely as it was possible for men to fight. The
+ guns, however, were useless, for in half an hour every officer, man and
+ horse, was killed or wounded. However, the Boers could not pluck up
+ courage to make a rush, and the little force held on till it was dark, by
+ which time more than two-thirds of them were killed or wounded. A lot of
+ rain had fallen, the Boers thought that the Ingogo could not be forded,
+ and so, believing they would have no trouble in finishing the little force
+ in the morning, they were careless. Colley, however, sent down and found
+ that the water had not risen so high as to make it impossible to pass, and
+ in the darkness, covered by the blinding rain that was falling, he and the
+ survivors moved quietly off, crossed the river, picked up the party left
+ on the eminence commanding it, and returned to camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It was certain now that unless succoured our fate was sealed, but
+ fortunately Evelyn Wood came up to Newcastle with a column that had been
+ pressing forward from the sea. Colley, of course, ought to have waited for
+ him to arrive before he moved at all, and if he had done so, things might
+ have turned out very differently. But he made the mistake of despising the
+ Boers, and thinking that it was nothing but a walk over. When they heard
+ that the column had reached Newcastle the Boers cleared off the line of
+ communication, and Colley rode into Newcastle and saw Wood. We felt that
+ we were well out of a bad business; and were sure that the Boers, who are
+ no good in attack, however well they fight behind shelter, would not
+ venture to attack us, and that even if they did so we could keep them off
+ till help came. But Colley could not let well alone. Instead of waiting
+ till Wood came up and joined him, lie thought he might make a good stroke
+ on his own account, and so retrieve the two defeats he had suffered; so
+ when the 92nd Regiment came up he determined to seize Majuba Hill.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It was well worth seizing, for it completely commanded the Boer's
+ position on Laing's Nek, and had the whole force come up the Boers must
+ have fallen back directly it was captured. However, Colley decided not to
+ wait, and with about five hundred and fifty men and officers he started at
+ night. The hill was only four miles off as the crow flies, but the ground
+ was frightfully cut up, and it was not until after six hours of tremendous
+ work that they reached the summit. Two hundred men were left at the bottom
+ of the hill to keep open communications with the camp.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "From a hill close to the camp we could make out what was going on. Soon
+ after daybreak we saw a party of mounted men ride towards the hill, where
+ they usually stationed vedettes. They were fired at as they approached,
+ and directly a turmoil could be seen on Laing's Nek. Waggons were
+ inspanned, and we thought at first that they were all going to move off,
+ but this was not so. They were only getting ready to go if they failed to
+ recapture the hill, and in a short time we could see all their force
+ moving towards it. Well, from where we were it seemed that the force on
+ Majuba could have kept a hundred thousand Boers at bay, and so they ought
+ to have done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "For a time the Boers did not make much progress. With glasses, puffs of
+ smoke could be made out all along the crest, and among the rocks below.
+ The firing began in earnest at seven, and between twelve and one the Boer
+ fire had ceased and ours died away. We thought it was all over, and went
+ back to our waggons again. Soon after one o'clock there was a sudden
+ outburst, and the men with the glasses observed that the Boers were close
+ up to the top of the hill. A few minutes later it was on the plateau
+ itself that the firing was going on.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Colley had not known the Boers. No doubt his men were completely done up
+ with their six hours' toil among the hills and six hours' fighting, and I
+ don't think a tenth of them were ever engaged, for Colley thought it was
+ impossible that the position could be stormed; so he only kept a handful
+ of men at the edge of the plateau and allowed the rest to lie down and
+ sleep. Certainly that was the case when the Boers, who had been crawling
+ up among the rocks and bushes, made their rush.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Well, you all know what happened. The few men on the edge were cut down
+ at once. The Boers dashed forward, keeping up a heavy fire. Our fellows
+ jumped up, but numbers were shot down as they did-so, and in spite of the
+ efforts of their officers, a panic seized them. They had far better rifles
+ than the Boers, and had they been steady might still have driven them
+ back; but only a few of them ever fired a shot, and but one Boer was
+ killed and five wounded; while on our side eight officers, among them
+ Colley himself, were killed, and seven taken prisoners. Eighty-six men
+ were killed, one hundred and twenty-five wounded, fifty-one taken
+ prisoners, and two missing. A few managed to make their way down the hill,
+ and joined the party that had been left there at the bottom.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "These were also attacked, but beat off the Boers, and, maintaining
+ perfect order, fought their way back to camp. You can imagine the
+ consternation there was when the hideous business became known. We fell
+ back at once to Newcastle, and mightily lucky we thought ourselves to get
+ there safely. Fresh troops came up, and we were on the point of advancing
+ again, confident that, after the lesson the Boers had given us, things
+ could be managed better. Suddenly, like a thunderclap, the news came that
+ the British Government had surrendered to the Boers, given up everything,
+ abandoned the colonists, who had so bravely defended their towns, to their
+ fate; and, with the exception of making a proviso that the natives should
+ be well treated&mdash;but which, as nothing was ever done to enforce it,
+ meant allowing the Boers to enslave and ill-treat them as they had done
+ before&mdash;and another proviso, maintaining the purely nominal supremacy
+ of the Queen, the treaty was simply an entire and abject surrender.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "There is not a colonist who, since that time, has not known what must
+ come of it, and that sooner or later the question whether the Dutch or the
+ British were to be masters of the Cape would have to be fought out. But
+ none of us dreamt that the British Government would allow the Boers to
+ import hundreds of thousands of rifles, two or three hundred cannon, and
+ enormous stores of ammunition in readiness for the encounter. Well, they
+ have done it, and we have seen the consequences. Natal has been overrun,
+ and a considerable portion of Cape Colony. We have lost here some ten
+ thousand men, and half as many on the other side, and we may lose as many
+ more before the business is finished. And all this because a handful of
+ miserable curs at home twenty years ago were ready to betray the honour of
+ England, in order that they might make matters smooth for themselves at
+ home." Just as the story came to an end the assembly blew in the camp of
+ the Scouts, and on running in the men found that Captain Brookfield had
+ received an order to mount at once and ride to join the cavalry under Lord
+ Dundonald at the front, as a reconnaissance was to be made in the morning.
+ Five minutes later all were in the saddle and trotting across the plain
+ towards Colenso, as they were to follow the line of railway up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0020" id="link2HCH0020"> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XX &mdash; LADYSMITH
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ It was exciting work as the mounted horse under Lord Dundonald rode along.
+ As far as could be seen from the various points in our possession the
+ passage was clear, but experience had taught how the Boers would lie
+ quiet, even when in large numbers, while scouts were passing close to
+ them. At Colenso Colonel Long had sent two mounted men on ahead of his
+ battery. They had been permitted to pass within a hundred yards of
+ thousands of Boers among the bushes on the river bank, and had even
+ crossed the bridge and returned without a rifle shot being fired or a Boer
+ showing his head. And it was on their report that there were apparently no
+ Boers in the neighbourhood that the batteries were pushed forward into the
+ fatal trap prepared for them. So Chris and his companions, at the rear of
+ the colonial cavalry, trotted along ready at a moment's notice to swing
+ round their rifles for instant action. They watched every stone and clump
+ of bushes on the slopes of the valley for any foe that might be lurking
+ there, and who at any moment might pour out a rain of bullets into the
+ column. Very few words were spoken on the way, the tension was too great.
+ They knew that Ladysmith had telegraphed that the Boers appeared to be
+ everywhere falling back. But a few thousands of their best fighting men
+ might have remained to strike one terrible blow at the troops who in open
+ fight had shown themselves their superiors, and had driven them from
+ position after position that they believed impregnable. However, as one
+ after another of the spots where an ambuscade would be likely to be laid
+ passed, and there were still no signs of the enemy, the keenness of the
+ watch began to abate, and the set expression of the faces to relax. Then
+ as the hills receded and the valley opened before them a pleasurable
+ excitement succeeded the grim expectation of battle. The task that had
+ proved so hard was indeed fulfilled; the Boers were gone, and the siege of
+ Ladysmith was at an end. As they emerged from the valley into the plain in
+ which Ladysmith is situated, there was an insensible increase of speed;
+ men talked joyously together, scarcely waiting for replies; the horses
+ seemed to catch the infection of their riders' spirits, and the pennons of
+ the Lancers in front to flutter more gaily. Onward they swept, cantering
+ now until they approached the town.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then men could be seen running towards the road; from every house they
+ poured out, men and women, some waving hats and handkerchiefs, some too
+ much overpowered by their feelings for outward demonstrations. As the
+ columns reached this point they broke into a walk, and answered with
+ ringing cheers the fainter but no less hearty hurrahs of those they came
+ to rescue; and yet the troopers themselves were scarcely less affected
+ than the crowd that pressed round to shake them by the hand. They had
+ known that provisions were nearly exhausted in the city, and that for some
+ time past all had been on short rations; but they had not dreamt of
+ anything like this. It seemed to them that they were surrounded by a
+ population of skeletons, haggard and worn, almost too weak to drag
+ themselves along, almost too feeble to shout, their clothes in rags, their
+ eyes unnaturally large, their hands nerveless, their utterances broken by
+ sobs. They realized for the first time how terrible had been the
+ privations, how great the sufferings of the garrison and people of
+ Ladysmith. For the soldiers were there as well as the civilians. There was
+ little military in their appearance; there was no uniformity in their
+ dress, save that all were alike ragged, stained and destitute of colour.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Could their rescuers have seen them, themselves unseen, a few days
+ earlier, they would have been even more shocked. Then the listlessness
+ brought about by hope deferred, and of late almost the extinction of hope,
+ weakness caused by disease and famine, had been supreme; and had the Boers
+ had any idea of the state to which they were reduced, a renewal of the
+ attack of the eth of January could hardly have failed of success. The last
+ few days, however, had revived their hopes. They had learned by the
+ ever-nearing roar of the cannon that progress was being made, and for the
+ past four days had from elevated points near the town been able to make
+ out the movements of our troops on the positions they had captured. They
+ had seen the Boers breaking up their camps, carrying off their stores
+ either by waggon across the western passes or by the trains from Modder
+ Spruit. They had seen the cannon being withdrawn from their positions on
+ the hills, and felt that their deliverance was at hand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Through an ever-increasing crowd the column moved on.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ [Image: THE RELIEF OF LADYSMITH.]
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ From barrack and hospital, from dwelling-house and the dug-out
+ shelter-caves on the railway bank people flocked up. Sir George White and
+ his staff, the mayor, and the town guards, every officer and soldier,
+ joined in the greeting. But no stay was made. After a few minutes' talk
+ with Sir George White, Lord Dundonald gave the order, and the cavalry
+ moved forward, and as soon as they were free from the crowd trotted on at
+ a rapid pace in hopes of overtaking the retiring Boers, and glad that the
+ scene to which they had looked forward with such pleasant expectations was
+ at an end. There had not been a dry eye among them. None could have
+ witnessed the sobbing women, the men down whose cheeks the tears streamed
+ uncontrolledly, and have remained himself unmoved.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "It is terrible," Chris said to Sankey, who was riding next to him. "I
+ could not have imagined anything so dreadful as their appearance. I did
+ not realize what it was like when, two or three months before I left
+ Johannesburg, I read in Motley's book about the war in the Netherlands of
+ the state of things in Leyden when the Prince of Orange burst his way
+ through to their rescue, and of the terrible appearance of the starved
+ inhabitants, but now I can quite understand how awfully bad it was. It
+ must have been even worse then. Here there were some rations distributed&mdash;little
+ enough, but some. There the people had nothing but the weeds they
+ gathered, and boiled down with the scraps they could pick up. There they
+ died in hundreds of actual starvation; it cannot have been quite so bad
+ here. But as we see, though there has been just enough food to keep life
+ together, that has been all, and it has been from disease brought on by
+ famine, and not by famine itself, that they have died. Then, too, shells
+ were always falling among them, and at any moment they might be attacked.
+ I expect that anxiety and fever have had as much to do with it as hunger."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, Chris. You know, when we were grumbling sometimes at not being
+ employed in the fighting, we have wished we had stopped in Ladysmith, and
+ gone through the siege there; now, one can thank God that one did not do
+ so. We have pictured to ourselves everyone actively employed, the
+ vigilance at all the outposts, the skirmishing with the Boers who crept up
+ too closely, the excitement of repelling their attack, and all that sort
+ of thing. It is all very good to read about, but now we know what it
+ really meant one sees that we were a pack of fools to have wished to be
+ there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; I suppose one never knows what is good for one, Sankey. Now as I
+ look back I think that we have been extraordinarily fortunate. We have had
+ some fights, just in the way we had expected, and, thanks principally to
+ our being so well mounted, we have done very well. We have lived well; I
+ don't say we have not had a certain amount of discomfort, but of course we
+ expected that. What I am most pleased at is that not one of us has been
+ killed, and only a few of us wounded, the only serious one being
+ Willesden, and he is fairly on the way to recovery. For boys we have done
+ a very good share, and I expect that now we have driven the Boers back
+ here, and Kimberley has been relieved, and there is a tremendous force
+ gathering on that side, it will soon be over."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes, I think with you, Chris. And I fancy that the others are all
+ beginning to long for the end of it. I should say that those whose people
+ have gone to England may stop on for a bit, but the rest of us will go to
+ our friends at Durban or the Cape, at any rate for a time, till we see how
+ things go. We know that Lord Roberts has got Cronje surrounded and shut
+ up. I expect that is one of the reasons that the Boers have been moving
+ from here. The Free Staters will certainly wish to get back to defend
+ Bloemfontein, and the Transvaal people must feel that it is no use
+ stopping here when their own country will be shortly invaded."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Yes; I expect that is the reason for their shutting up as suddenly as
+ they have done after fighting so hard for the first five or six days of
+ our advance."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On arriving at Modder Spruit it was found that the last train had left an
+ hour before; they pushed on, however, until a smart fire from a hill in
+ front of them, which was evidently held in force, broke out suddenly, and
+ two cannon from another eminence joined in. Having thus discovered that
+ the Boers were not entirely evacuating the country, but intending to
+ defend the Biggarsberg, at any rate until a strong force came up, Lord
+ Dundonald returned to Ladysmith. In the afternoon General Buller rode over
+ attended by only one or two of the staff. He stayed but a very short time,
+ to learn from General White the state of affairs, and then returned.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Do you think that we shall pursue at once, sir?" Chris asked Captain
+ Brookfield.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "Not at once, Chris. Practically, as you see, there is not a soldier here
+ fit to carry arms, nor a horse fit for work, and I should say that it will
+ be a month before General Buller can reckon upon any assistance from the
+ garrison. As to his own army, I expect he will keep the main portion round
+ Chieveley. No doubt he will bring the greater part if not all the garrison
+ of Ladysmith back to Frere and Estcourt, both to get them out of the
+ pestilential air here and for convenience of feeding them. The civilian
+ population will leave, of course, as soon as they possibly can. I should
+ think that Buller will leave in garrison here an infantry brigade, part of
+ the cavalry, and two or three batteries, and this with the sick who cannot
+ be moved, will be about as much as our transport will be able to manage
+ until the railway bridge is repaired and the line put in running order.
+ Till that is done there is no possibility of a general advance; and indeed
+ there will have to be a great accumulation of stores here, as this will
+ then become our base instead of Chieveley.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "No doubt a great deal will depend on how things are going on the other
+ side. Now that Roberts has as good as captured Cronje and his force he
+ will of course advance to Bloemfontein and occupy it. He will then be no
+ more able to advance farther than Buller can&mdash;in fact, less able. Our
+ line of railway is secured, and we can be fed by it; but at present we
+ have not crossed the Orange River from the south, and the railway between
+ that and Bloemfontein is in the hands of the Boers, and we know that they
+ have blown up the bridges across the river. Until these are restored, and
+ the line secure in our hands, Roberts's army will have to live on the
+ stores that they have brought with them. Then the work of forming a base
+ depot from the coast will begin, and it needs something enormous in the
+ way of provisions and carriage to supply an army of sixty or seventy
+ thousand men, all of whom must as they advance be fed from Bloemfontein.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "As long as he is stationary there it is likely enough that the bulk of
+ Joubert's army will cling to Natal, knowing well enough that before we
+ shall be in a condition to move forward they can entrench their positions
+ on the Biggarsberg and the Drakenberg until they are quite as formidable
+ as those we have been knocking our heads against. I should not be at all
+ surprised if it is a couple of months before Roberts is in a position to
+ advance. Of course at present we have no idea what the plans are, but
+ likely enough at least half the force here may be sent down to Durban, and
+ then by water to East London, and from there to Bloemfontein by rail. It
+ would be ridiculous for us to renew the sort of fighting we have been
+ doing when the enemy are sure to clear out when Roberts crosses the Vaal,
+ and Natal be thus freed without any further loss of life. Possibly the
+ troops may not be sent round by sea, but will remain here until Roberts
+ gets as far as Kroonstadt. Then, no doubt, a division will be sent down
+ through Bethlehem to Harrismith, and so open Van Reenen's Pass, in which
+ case the troops from here can go up by train to Bethlehem. At any rate, I
+ am afraid that most of us will remain here for at least two months.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "You see, most of the colonial irregulars were enlisted for only three
+ months, and that is up already, and no doubt a great many of them will not
+ extend their time, and I don't suppose the military authorities will want
+ them to do so. There is no doubt that while mounted men were invaluable in
+ the fighting in Cape Colony, and will be so in the Orange Free State, they
+ are of very little use in this mountainous country in the north of Natal&mdash;they
+ are so many more mouths to be fed, man and beast, without any
+ corresponding advantage. They have done splendidly where they have had a
+ chance, and the Imperial Light Horse have suffered heavily, but as a whole
+ I think that we should have been more useful as infantry than as mounted
+ men. Infinitely more useful if, instead of being kept at the head-quarters
+ of the army as we have been, for no possible reason that anyone can see,
+ we had all been scattered over the country to the east, in which case we
+ should have kept the marauding Boers from wandering about, should have
+ saved hundreds and hundreds of loyal farmers from being ruined, and the
+ loss of many thousands of cattle and horses, which will have to be paid
+ for after the war is over. I do not think that there is a single colonist
+ who is not of opinion that the way in which we have been kept inactive
+ from the beginning of the war, instead of being employed as irregular
+ cavalry should have been, in protecting the country, preventing the Boers
+ from drawing supplies, and forcing them to keep in a body as our own
+ troops have done, has been a stupendous mistake."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chris repeated this conversation to his comrades. "I think," he said,
+ "that if there is no chance of doing anything for another two or three
+ months, we might as well break up. I have no doubt a good many of the
+ Colonials will re-enlist. Numbers of them are working men, either from
+ Johannesburg or belonging to Natal; they would find it very difficult to
+ get work here, and the five shillings a day pay is therefore of the
+ greatest importance to them. But it is different with us. We don't draw
+ pay, we simply agreed to band ourselves together to have an opportunity of
+ paying out the Boers for their treatment of us. At the time we agreed to
+ that, we had no idea that they would invade Natal. Of course that was an
+ additional inducement to us to fight. As loyalists, and capable of bearing
+ arms, it would have been our duty, even if we had no personal feeling in
+ the matter, to enlist to help to clear the country of the enemy who
+ invaded it. Now that Ladysmith is rescued and there are certainly enough
+ troops in South Africa to finish the business up, I do not see that it is
+ our duty to continue our service. Anyhow, I have pretty well made up my
+ mind to resign and go round to Cape Town. There I am almost sure to find
+ my mother, and perhaps my father, for we know that they have expelled
+ almost all the English remaining about the mines, and he may have been
+ among them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I agree with you heartily," Sankey said. "At any rate, I should vote for
+ our breaking up for the present. It will be beastly for us to have to stop
+ here doing nothing for another month or two, and then perhaps, when Buller
+ moves forward to join Roberts, to be told that the colonial force will no
+ longer be required."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Twelve of the others expressed similar opinions. The friends of the eight
+ who did not do so had returned to England. Carmichael was one of these.
+ "Well," he said after a pause, "I do not say that you are not quite right,
+ but I have no one to go to here. My people went home as soon as they
+ reached Durban. If I were to join them I might hear when I landed that the
+ war was just over, and that they had either started to come back again, or
+ were on the point of doing so. I was born out here, and have never seen
+ any of my relations in Scotland. Though I should like very much to spend a
+ few months in the old country, it would not be worth while going home for
+ so short a time; for I am sure my father will hurry back to his work at
+ the mines as soon as Johannesburg is taken by us. I fancy all those who
+ have not spoken are in about the same situation that I am."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a murmur of assent. "I don't say," he went on, "that I should
+ care, any more than you do, to stop here for the next two months. The
+ smell of dead horses and things is enough to make one ill. The water of
+ the river is poisonous, for we know the Boers used to throw their dead
+ animals in it on purpose. So I shall go down to Maritzburg and wire to my
+ people where I am, and ask for orders. There remains, Willesden said the
+ other day, still about £80 apiece at the bank, and I expect we shall get
+ as much for the horses as we gave for them, so that we who have no friends
+ here could live very comfortably for two or three months, or have enough
+ to pay our passage home in case they send for us. I shall tell them to
+ telegraph, so in a week after sending off my wire I shall get an answer."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The others who had no friends in South Africa expressed their intention of
+ doing the same.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I don't think we need bother about the horses," Chris said; "being such
+ good animals, I have no doubt that there are plenty of officers in the
+ cavalry regiments here who will be glad to buy them as remounts for the
+ money we gave for them. That would save us all the trouble of getting them
+ down by train to Maritzburg and selling them there. Well, then, as there
+ are no dissentients, I will tell Captain Brookfield what we have settled."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I quite agree with you," the officer said when Chris had told him of
+ their intentions. "In the first place, it would be a serious waste of time
+ for you to remain here. Still, that is of comparatively little
+ consequence, but I do think that it would be a grievous pity for you to
+ risk your lives further. You have done wonderfully good service. You have
+ had an experience that you will look back upon with satisfaction all your
+ lives. You have done your duty, and more than your duty. You have before
+ you useful lives, and have amply shown that in whatever position you may
+ be placed you will be a credit to yourselves and your friends. Therefore,
+ Chris, I think in every respect your decision is right. It will be some
+ relief to me, for to tell you frankly, when you started on that expedition
+ to Komati, and the other day, when you all rode off to the farm, I felt
+ that it would probably be my duty to write to some of your parents to tell
+ them of your deaths. Therefore, by all means give me your resignations. I
+ dare say that a good many of the men in my own and other corps will be
+ leaving also; and in that case those who remain will, I should think, be
+ formed into one strong regiment, which will be of a good deal more use
+ than half a dozen small corps."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was agreed among the party that as they had decided to go they might as
+ well go at once.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I hear," Chris said, "that General Buller is going to make a formal entry
+ here on Saturday, and that the garrison will line the road. I don't know
+ whether Dundonald's brigade will have anything to do with it; but if he
+ does, Brookfield will certainly like to make a good show. So until that is
+ over I won't do anything about the horses."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the day appointed the garrison turned out to receive the general and
+ the troops who had struggled so long and gallantly to effect their rescue,
+ and the Devons, Gloucesters, Rifles, Leicesters, Manchesters, Liverpools,
+ sappers, artillerymen, and the Naval Brigade marched out from their camps
+ and lined the road as far as the railway-station, where the remnant of the
+ cavalry brigade were drawn up. At eleven o'clock Sir George White, Sir
+ Archibald Hunter, and Colonel Duff and his staff rode up and took their
+ place in the front of the shattered tower of the town-hall. Here, too,
+ Captain Lambton and many other officers took their place. Not far from
+ these were a score of civilians who had not shared in the general exodus
+ that had been going on from the day on which the town was relieved, but
+ had delayed their departure in order to witness the historical scene. At
+ last the head of the column was seen approaching. Lord Dundonald's men had
+ ridden down on the previous day, and the mounted Colonial Volunteers had
+ now the honour of forming the general's escort. They led the way, and
+ after them came General Buller with his escort. The Dublin Fusiliers were
+ placed at the head of the column in acknowledgment of the gallantry
+ displayed by them in every fight; then came the men of Warren's,
+ Lyttleton's, and Barton's brigades, with their artillery. Great indeed was
+ the contrast between the sturdy, bronzed, and well-fed soldiers who
+ cheered as they marched, many of them carrying their helmets on their
+ bayonets, and the lines of emaciated men through whom they passed. These
+ cheered too, but their voices sounded strange and thin, and many, indeed,
+ were too much overcome by weakness and emotion to be able to add their
+ voices to the shouts. The enthusiasm of the troops rose to the highest
+ when they passed a group of women and children, who, with streaming eyes,
+ greeted them as they passed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The pipes of the Highlanders and the beating of drums added to the roar of
+ sound. The contrast between the dress of rescuers and rescued was as great
+ as their personal appearance. Sir George White's men had of late had but
+ little work, and had prepared for the occasion to the best of their power,
+ as if for a review at Aldershot. They had done what they could. Their
+ khaki suits had been washed and scrubbed until, though discoloured, they
+ were scrupulously clean. The belts, accoutrements, and rifles had all been
+ rubbed up and scoured. On the other hand, the uniforms of regiments that
+ marched in were travel-stained, begrimed with the dust of battle and the
+ mud of bivouac, until their original hue had entirely disappeared. They
+ looked as if they had at first been dragged through thorn bushes and then
+ been given a mud-bath.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Captain Lambton rode forward to meet the sailors of the Terrible with the
+ guns that had done such service, followed by the howitzers which had
+ almost equally contributed to the final success of the operations. He was
+ loudly cheered by the sailors, and the heartiest greetings were exchanged
+ between him and their officers. Both in attack and defence the Naval
+ Brigade had performed inestimable services.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Behind the column came a large body of men in civilian dress. Their
+ appearance was as unkempt as that of the troops, but among these there was
+ no approach to military order, and yet their heroism had been in no way
+ inferior to that of the troops. These were the stretcher-bearers, who had
+ in every fight carried on their work of mercy under the heaviest fire, and
+ that without the excitement that nerves soldiers to face danger. Many of
+ them had fallen while so engaged, but this had in no way unnerved their
+ companions, who had not only carried on the work during daylight, but had
+ often laboured all night until the last wounded man had been found and
+ carried down to the hospital. When the names of the heroes of the force
+ that relieved Ladysmith are recounted those of the stretcher-bearers are
+ worthy of a place among them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After the troops had been dismissed and matters had settled down a little,
+ Chris went over to the camp of the cavalry brigade, and spoke to the first
+ officer he met. "I have come across, sir," he said, "to ask if any of you
+ wish to buy remounts. The party to which I belong have twenty-five horses;
+ they are exceptionally good animals, and cost us sixty pounds apiece last
+ October. We furnished our own equipment. As we are all sons of gentlemen
+ at Johannesburg, we did not much mind what we paid. Anyhow, we are ready
+ to sell them at the price we gave for them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We all want remounts badly enough," the officer said. "Will you come in
+ with me to the colonel?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Entering the mess tent, where the colonel and several officers were
+ standing talking, Chris's guide introduced him to them, and repeated the
+ offer he had made. "Well, at any rate, Leslie," the colonel said, "you and
+ Mainwaring may as well go down and look at the horses; it would certainly
+ be a comfort to get remounts, for more than half of our chargers are gone,
+ and the rest are skeletons. I can't ask you, Mr. King, if you would like
+ to take anything to drink. I suppose it will be another ten days before we
+ are in a position to be able to offer even the smallest approach to
+ hospitality."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "I quite understand that, sir," Chris said. "In that respect we have been
+ nearly as badly off at Chieveley. We have had plenty to eat and drink, but
+ a cup of tea or chocolate has been the only refreshment we have been in a
+ position to offer to a visitor, for the line has been so fully occupied
+ with government transport that it has been next to impossible to get up
+ any private stores. I am afraid that very little in that way can be
+ brought up here until the bridge is repaired and the line in working
+ order, for it is as much as the transport will be able to do to bring food
+ enough from Chieveley for the troops and people here."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two officers were more than satisfied with the appearance of the
+ horses. On their report all their comrades went down, and eleven of the
+ animals were at once taken; a visit to the camps of two other regiments
+ resulted in the sale of the remainder. None of the officers was able to
+ pay in gold, as the paymaster's department had not a coin left, though
+ small payments were made to the men until nearly the end of the siege.
+ Chris, however, readily accepted their drafts and cheques, as these could
+ be paid into the bank at Maritzburg.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "That is all done," he said to his friends. "Now we will get rid of our
+ remaining stores which the men brought up yesterday. I propose that
+ instead of selling them we divide them into three and send them down to
+ the three cavalry messes. I am sorry we have not a few bottles of spirits
+ left, but the tea, and chocolate, and sugar, and so on, will be very
+ welcome to them."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The six natives carried the things down, and brought back with them notes
+ of warm thankfulness from the colonels.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "How about our saddles, Chris?"
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ "We can take them with us to Maritzburg. We can hand over the kettles and
+ so on, and the waterproof sheets, to Brookfield's men who remain here, and
+ the blankets can be given to the natives when we get there."
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next day, after a hearty farewell from Captain Brookfield and their
+ comrades, who sent them off with a ringing cheer, the party started,
+ marching by the side of one of the waggons that had brought up stores; in
+ this they placed their saddles and blankets. When they arrived at
+ Chieveley they had no difficulty in getting a place in a covered truck. In
+ this they travelled to Maritzburg. Here they stayed for three or four
+ days; then, after making a handsome present in addition to what they had
+ promised to the natives, and further gladdening their hearts by giving
+ them their blankets, Chris and those who were going down said good-bye to
+ Carmichael and his party, with hopes that they would all meet again at
+ Johannesburg before long. Three or four whose friends had remained at
+ Durban stayed there, the rest took passage together for Cape Town.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At Maritzburg Chris had found a letter awaiting him from his mother,
+ saying that his father had a fortnight before joined her there, as the
+ Boers had commandeered the mines and had ordered him to leave, as he would
+ not work them for their benefit and so provide funds for the support of
+ the Boer army. She said that they intended to leave at once for England,
+ and that he was to follow them when he gave up his work with the army. He
+ therefore, with Field, Brown, and Capper, continued the voyage straight on
+ to England, and joined his parents in London, where he enjoyed a
+ well-earned rest, his pleasure being only marred by the necessity for
+ telling the story of his adventures again and again to the relations and
+ friends of his parents.
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 6em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+<pre xml:space="preserve">
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of With Buller in Natal, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK WITH BULLER IN NATAL ***
+
+***** This file should be named 7334-h.htm or 7334-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/7/3/3/7334/
+
+Etext produced by Tony Hyland, Charles Franks and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team.
+
+HTML file produced by David Widger
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
+ www.gutenberg.org/license.
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809
+North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email
+contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the
+Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+ </body>
+</html>